Make "break foo" find "A::foo", A::B::foo", etc. [C++ and wild matching]
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1642 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1643 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1644 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1645 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1646 Operators}).
1647
1648 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1649 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1650 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1651 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1652 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1653 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1654 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1655 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1656 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1660 func<int>() func<float>()
1661 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1662 @end smallexample
1663
1664 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1665 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1666 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1667 function:
1668
1669 @smallexample
1670 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1671 func<int>() func<float>()
1672 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1673 @end smallexample
1674
1675 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1676 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1677 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1678 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1679 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1680 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1681
1682 @smallexample
1683 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1684 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1686 bubble(double)
1687 @end smallexample
1688
1689 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1690 require quoting.
1691
1692 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1693 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1694 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1695 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1696
1697 @cindex completion of structure field names
1698 @cindex structure field name completion
1699 @cindex completion of union field names
1700 @cindex union field name completion
1701 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1702 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1703 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1704 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1705 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1706 left-hand-side:
1707
1708 @smallexample
1709 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1710 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1711 to_data to_isatty to_write
1712 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1713 to_flush to_read
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716 @noindent
1717 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1718 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1719 follows:
1720
1721 @smallexample
1722 struct ui_file
1723 @{
1724 int *magic;
1725 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1726 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1727 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1728 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1729 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1730 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1731 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1732 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1733 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1734 void *to_data;
1735 @}
1736 @end smallexample
1737
1738
1739 @node Help
1740 @section Getting Help
1741 @cindex online documentation
1742 @kindex help
1743
1744 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1745 using the command @code{help}.
1746
1747 @table @code
1748 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1749 @item help
1750 @itemx h
1751 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1752 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1753
1754 @smallexample
1755 (@value{GDBP}) help
1756 List of classes of commands:
1757
1758 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1759 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1760 data -- Examining data
1761 files -- Specifying and examining files
1762 internals -- Maintenance commands
1763 obscure -- Obscure features
1764 running -- Running the program
1765 stack -- Examining the stack
1766 status -- Status inquiries
1767 support -- Support facilities
1768 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1769 stopping the program
1770 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1771
1772 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1773 commands in that class.
1774 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1775 documentation.
1776 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1777 (@value{GDBP})
1778 @end smallexample
1779 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1780
1781 @item help @var{class}
1782 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1783 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1784 help display for the class @code{status}:
1785
1786 @smallexample
1787 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1788 Status inquiries.
1789
1790 List of commands:
1791
1792 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1793 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1794 info -- Generic command for showing things
1795 about the program being debugged
1796 show -- Generic command for showing things
1797 about the debugger
1798
1799 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1800 documentation.
1801 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1802 (@value{GDBP})
1803 @end smallexample
1804
1805 @item help @var{command}
1806 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1807 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1808
1809 @kindex apropos
1810 @item apropos @var{args}
1811 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1812 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1813 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1814
1815 @smallexample
1816 apropos alias
1817 @end smallexample
1818
1819 @noindent
1820 results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @c @group
1824 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1825 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1826 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1827 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1828 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1829 @c @end group
1830 @end smallexample
1831
1832 @kindex complete
1833 @item complete @var{args}
1834 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1835 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1836 command you want completed. For example:
1837
1838 @smallexample
1839 complete i
1840 @end smallexample
1841
1842 @noindent results in:
1843
1844 @smallexample
1845 @group
1846 if
1847 ignore
1848 info
1849 inspect
1850 @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1854 @end table
1855
1856 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1857 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1858 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1859 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1860 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1861 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1862 Index}.
1863
1864 @c @group
1865 @table @code
1866 @kindex info
1867 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1868 @item info
1869 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1870 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1871 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1872 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1873 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1874 @w{@code{help info}}.
1875
1876 @kindex set
1877 @item set
1878 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1879 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1880 @code{set prompt $}.
1881
1882 @kindex show
1883 @item show
1884 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1885 @value{GDBN} itself.
1886 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1887 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1888 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1889 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1890
1891 @kindex info set
1892 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1893 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1894 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1895 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1896 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1897 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1898 @end table
1899 @c @end group
1900
1901 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1902 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1903
1904 @table @code
1905 @kindex show version
1906 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1907 @item show version
1908 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1909 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1910 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1911 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1912 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1913 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1914 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1915 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1916 @value{GDBN}.
1917
1918 @kindex show copying
1919 @kindex info copying
1920 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1921 @item show copying
1922 @itemx info copying
1923 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1924
1925 @kindex show warranty
1926 @kindex info warranty
1927 @item show warranty
1928 @itemx info warranty
1929 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1930 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1931
1932 @kindex show configuration
1933 @item show configuration
1934 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1935 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1936 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1937 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1938 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1939 your report.
1940
1941 @end table
1942
1943 @node Running
1944 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1945
1946 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1947 debugging information when you compile it.
1948
1949 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1950 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1951 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1952 kill a child process.
1953
1954 @menu
1955 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1956 * Starting:: Starting your program
1957 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1958 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1959
1960 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1961 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1962 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1963 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1964
1965 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1966 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1967 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1968 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1969 @end menu
1970
1971 @node Compilation
1972 @section Compiling for Debugging
1973
1974 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1975 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1976 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1977 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1978 and addresses in the executable code.
1979
1980 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1981 the compiler.
1982
1983 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1984 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1985 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1986 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1987 executables containing debugging information.
1988
1989 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1990 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1991 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1992 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1993 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1994
1995 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1996 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1997 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1998
1999 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2000 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2001 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2002 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2003 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2004 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2005
2006 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2007 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2008 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2009
2010 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2011 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2012 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2013 format in @value{GDBN}.
2014
2015 @need 2000
2016 @node Starting
2017 @section Starting your Program
2018 @cindex starting
2019 @cindex running
2020
2021 @table @code
2022 @kindex run
2023 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2024 @item run
2025 @itemx r
2026 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2027 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2028 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2029 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2030 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2031
2032 @end table
2033
2034 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2035 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2036 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2037 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2038 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2039 message like this one:
2040
2041 @smallexample
2042 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2043 Try "help target" or "continue".
2044 @end smallexample
2045
2046 @noindent
2047 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2048 first (@pxref{load}).
2049
2050 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2051 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2052 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2053 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2054 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2055 divided into four categories:
2056
2057 @table @asis
2058 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2059 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2060 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2061 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2062 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2063 the arguments.
2064 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2065 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2066 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2067 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2068 below for details).
2069
2070 @item The @emph{environment.}
2071 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2072 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2073 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2074 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2075
2076 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2077 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2078 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2079 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2080 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2081 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2082 Directory}.
2083
2084 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2085 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2086 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2087 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2088 set a different device for your program.
2089 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2090
2091 @cindex pipes
2092 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2093 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2094 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2095 wrong program.
2096 @end table
2097
2098 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2099 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2100 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2101 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2102 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2103
2104 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2105 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2106 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2107 your current breakpoints.
2108
2109 @table @code
2110 @kindex start
2111 @item start
2112 @cindex run to main procedure
2113 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2114 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2115 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2116 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2117 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2118 procedure, depending on the language used.
2119
2120 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2121 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2122 the @samp{run} command.
2123
2124 @cindex elaboration phase
2125 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2126 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2127 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2128 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2129 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2130 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2131 will remain to halt execution.
2132
2133 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2134 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2135 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2136 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2137 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2138
2139 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2140 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2141 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2142 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2143 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2144 use the @code{starti} command.
2145
2146 @kindex starti
2147 @item starti
2148 @cindex run to first instruction
2149 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2150 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2151 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2152 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2153 the start of the elaboration phase.
2154
2155 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2156 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2157 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2158 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2159 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2160 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2161 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2162 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2163 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2164 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2165 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2166 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2167
2168 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2169 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2170 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2171 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2172
2173 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2174 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2175 environment:
2176
2177 @smallexample
2178 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2179 (@value{GDBP}) run
2180 @end smallexample
2181
2182 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2183 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2184
2185 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2186 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2187 @item set startup-with-shell
2188 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2189 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2190 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2191 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2192 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2193 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2194 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2195 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2196 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2197 startup failures such as:
2198
2199 @smallexample
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 Starting program: ./a.out
2202 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2203 @end smallexample
2204
2205 @noindent
2206 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2207 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2208 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2209 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2210 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2211 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2212
2213 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2214 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2215 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2216 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2217 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2218 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2219
2220 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2221 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2222 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2223 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2224 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2225 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2226
2227 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2228 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2229 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2230
2231 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2232 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2233
2234 @smallexample
2235 (@value{GDBP}) run
2236 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2237 @end smallexample
2238
2239 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2240 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2241
2242 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2243 @code{target native} command. For example,
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2247 (@value{GDBP}) run
2248 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2249 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Starting program: ./a.out
2252 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2253 @end smallexample
2254
2255 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2256 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2257 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2258 disconnect.
2259
2260 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2261 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2262 proc}, @code{info os}.
2263
2264 @kindex set disable-randomization
2265 @item set disable-randomization
2266 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2267 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2268 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2269 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2270 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2271
2272 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2273 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2274
2275 @smallexample
2276 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2277 @end smallexample
2278
2279 @item set disable-randomization off
2280 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2281 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2282 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2283 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2284 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2285 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2286
2287 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2288 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2289 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2290 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2291 a code at its expected addresses.
2292
2293 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2294 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2295 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2296 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2297 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2298 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2299 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2300 a randomly chosen address.
2301
2302 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2303 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2304 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2305 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2306 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2307
2308 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2309 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2310
2311 @item show disable-randomization
2312 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2313 the virtual address space of the started program.
2314
2315 @end table
2316
2317 @node Arguments
2318 @section Your Program's Arguments
2319
2320 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2321 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2322 @code{run} command.
2323 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2324 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2325 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2326 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2327 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2328
2329 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2330 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2331 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2332 the program, not by the shell.
2333
2334 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2335 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2336
2337 @table @code
2338 @kindex set args
2339 @item set args
2340 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2341 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2342 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2343 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2344 it again without arguments.
2345
2346 @kindex show args
2347 @item show args
2348 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2349 @end table
2350
2351 @node Environment
2352 @section Your Program's Environment
2353
2354 @cindex environment (of your program)
2355 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2356 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2357 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2358 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2359 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2360 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2361 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2362
2363 @table @code
2364 @kindex path
2365 @item path @var{directory}
2366 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2367 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2368 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2369 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2370 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2371 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2372 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2373
2374 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2375 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2376 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2377 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2378 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2379 @var{directory} to the search path.
2380 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2381 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2382
2383 @kindex show paths
2384 @item show paths
2385 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2386 environment variable).
2387
2388 @kindex show environment
2389 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2390 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2391 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2392 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2393 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2394
2395 @kindex set environment
2396 @anchor{set environment}
2397 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2398 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2399 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2400 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2401 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2402 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2403 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2404 null value.
2405 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2406 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2407
2408 For example, this command:
2409
2410 @smallexample
2411 set env USER = foo
2412 @end smallexample
2413
2414 @noindent
2415 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2416 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2417 are not actually required.)
2418
2419 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2420 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2421 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2422 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2423 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2424
2425 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2426 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2427 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2428
2429 @kindex unset environment
2430 @anchor{unset environment}
2431 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2432 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2433 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2434 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2435 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2436
2437 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2438 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2439 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2440 @end table
2441
2442 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2443 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2444 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2445 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2446 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2447 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2448 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2449 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2450 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2451 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2452
2453 @node Working Directory
2454 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2455
2456 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2457 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2458 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2459 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2460 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2461 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2462 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2463 debugging.
2464
2465 @table @code
2466 @kindex set cwd
2467 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2468 @anchor{set cwd command}
2469 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2470 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2471 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2472 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2473 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2474 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2475 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2476 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2477 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2478 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2479 fallback.
2480
2481 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2482 the @code{cd} command.
2483 @xref{cd command}
2484
2485 @kindex show cwd
2486 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2487 @item show cwd
2488 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2489 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2490 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2491
2492 @kindex cd
2493 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2494 @anchor{cd command}
2495 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2496 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2497 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2498
2499 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2500 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2501 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2502 @xref{set cwd command}
2503
2504 @kindex pwd
2505 @item pwd
2506 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2507 @end table
2508
2509 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2510 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2511 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2512 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2513 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2514 current working directory of the debuggee.
2515
2516 @node Input/Output
2517 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2518
2519 @cindex redirection
2520 @cindex i/o
2521 @cindex terminal
2522 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2523 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2524 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2525 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2526 running your program.
2527
2528 @table @code
2529 @kindex info terminal
2530 @item info terminal
2531 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2532 program is using.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2536 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2537
2538 @smallexample
2539 run > outfile
2540 @end smallexample
2541
2542 @noindent
2543 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2544
2545 @kindex tty
2546 @cindex controlling terminal
2547 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2548 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2549 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2550 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2551 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 tty /dev/ttyb
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2559 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2560 that as their controlling terminal.
2561
2562 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2563 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2564 terminal.
2565
2566 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2567 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2568 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2569 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2570
2571 @cindex inferior tty
2572 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2573 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2574 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2575 program.
2576
2577 @table @code
2578 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2579 @kindex set inferior-tty
2580 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2581 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2582 @value{GDBN}.
2583
2584 @item show inferior-tty
2585 @kindex show inferior-tty
2586 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2587 @end table
2588
2589 @node Attach
2590 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2591 @kindex attach
2592 @cindex attach
2593
2594 @table @code
2595 @item attach @var{process-id}
2596 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2597 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2598 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2599 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2600 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2601
2602 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2603 executing the command.
2604 @end table
2605
2606 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2607 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2608 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2609 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2610
2611 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2612 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2613 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2614 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2615 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2616 Specify Files}.
2617
2618 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2619 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2620 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2621 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2622 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2623 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2624 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2625
2626 @table @code
2627 @kindex detach
2628 @item detach
2629 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2630 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2631 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2632 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2633 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2634 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2635 executing the command.
2636 @end table
2637
2638 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2639 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2640 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2641 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2642 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2643 Messages}).
2644
2645 @node Kill Process
2646 @section Killing the Child Process
2647
2648 @table @code
2649 @kindex kill
2650 @item kill
2651 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2652 @end table
2653
2654 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2655 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2656 is running.
2657
2658 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2659 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2660 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2661 outside the debugger.
2662
2663 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2664 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2665 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2666 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2667 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2668 breakpoint settings).
2669
2670 @node Inferiors and Programs
2671 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2672
2673 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2674 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2675 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2676 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2677 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2678 from multiple executables.
2679
2680 @cindex inferior
2681 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2682 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2683 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2684 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2685 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2686 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2687 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2688 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2689 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2690 threads running in it.
2691
2692 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2693 inferiors}}:
2694
2695 @table @code
2696 @kindex info inferiors
2697 @item info inferiors
2698 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2699
2700 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2701
2702 @enumerate
2703 @item
2704 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2705
2706 @item
2707 the target system's inferior identifier
2708
2709 @item
2710 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2711
2712 @end enumerate
2713
2714 @noindent
2715 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2716 indicates the current inferior.
2717
2718 For example,
2719 @end table
2720 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2721
2722 @smallexample
2723 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2724 Num Description Executable
2725 2 process 2307 hello
2726 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2727 @end smallexample
2728
2729 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2730
2731 @table @code
2732 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2733 @item inferior @var{infno}
2734 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2735 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2736 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2737 @end table
2738
2739 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2740 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2741 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2742 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2743 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2744 information on convenience variables.
2745
2746 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2747 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2748 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2749 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2750 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2751 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2752
2753 @table @code
2754 @kindex add-inferior
2755 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2756 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2757 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2758 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2759 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2760 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2761
2762 @kindex clone-inferior
2763 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2764 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2765 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2766 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2767 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2768
2769 @smallexample
2770 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2771 Num Description Executable
2772 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2773 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2774 Added inferior 2.
2775 1 inferiors added.
2776 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2777 Num Description Executable
2778 2 <null> helloworld
2779 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2780 @end smallexample
2781
2782 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2783
2784 @kindex remove-inferiors
2785 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2786 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2787 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2788 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2789
2790 @end table
2791
2792 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2793 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2794 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2795 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2796
2797 @table @code
2798 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2799 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2800 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2801 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2802 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2803 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2804
2805 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2806 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2807 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2808 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2809 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2810 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2811 @end table
2812
2813 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2814 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2815 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2816 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2817
2818
2819 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2820 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2821
2822 @table @code
2823 @kindex set print inferior-events
2824 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2825 @item set print inferior-events
2826 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2827 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2828 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2829 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2830 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2831 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2832
2833 @kindex show print inferior-events
2834 @item show print inferior-events
2835 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2836 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2837 @end table
2838
2839 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2840 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2841 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2842
2843
2844 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2845 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2846 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2847 info program-spaces}} command.
2848
2849 @table @code
2850 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2851 @item maint info program-spaces
2852 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2853 @value{GDBN}.
2854
2855 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2856
2857 @enumerate
2858 @item
2859 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2860
2861 @item
2862 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2863 the @code{file} command.
2864
2865 @end enumerate
2866
2867 @noindent
2868 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2869 indicates the current program space.
2870
2871 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2872 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2873 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2874
2875 @smallexample
2876 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2877 Id Executable
2878 * 1 hello
2879 2 goodbye
2880 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2881 @end smallexample
2882
2883 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2884 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2885 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2886 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2887 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2888
2889 @smallexample
2890 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2891 Id Executable
2892 * 1 vfork-test
2893 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2894 @end smallexample
2895
2896 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2897 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2898 @end table
2899
2900 @node Threads
2901 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2902
2903 @cindex threads of execution
2904 @cindex multiple threads
2905 @cindex switching threads
2906 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2907 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2908 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2909 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2910 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2911 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2912 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2913
2914 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2915 programs:
2916
2917 @itemize @bullet
2918 @item automatic notification of new threads
2919 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2920 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2921 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2922 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2923 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2924 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2925 messages on thread start and exit.
2926 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2927 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2928 isn't compatible with the program.
2929 @end itemize
2930
2931 @cindex focus of debugging
2932 @cindex current thread
2933 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2934 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2935 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2936 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2937 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2938
2939 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2940 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2941 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2942 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2943 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2944 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2945 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2946 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2947 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2948 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2949
2950 @smallexample
2951 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2952 @end smallexample
2953
2954 @noindent
2955 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2956 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2957 further qualifier.
2958
2959 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2960 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2961 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2962 @c program?
2963 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2964 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2965 @c threads ab initio?
2966
2967 @anchor{thread numbers}
2968 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2969 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2970 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2971 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2972 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2973 between threads of different inferiors.
2974
2975 @cindex qualified thread ID
2976 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2977 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2978 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2979 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2980 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2981 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2982 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2983 inferior.
2984
2985 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2986 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2987 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2988 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2989
2990 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2991 @cindex thread ID lists
2992 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2993 argument. A list element can be:
2994
2995 @enumerate
2996 @item
2997 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2998 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2999 @samp{1}.
3000
3001 @item
3002 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3003 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3004 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3005
3006 @item
3007 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3008 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3009 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3010 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3011 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3012
3013 @end enumerate
3014
3015 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3016 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3017 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3018 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3019 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3020 7.1}.
3021
3022
3023 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3024 @cindex global thread number
3025 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3026 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3027 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3028 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3029 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3030 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3031
3032 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3033 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3034 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3035
3036 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3037 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3038 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3039 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3040 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3041 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3042 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3043 general information on convenience variables.
3044
3045 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3046 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3047 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3048
3049 @smallexample
3050 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3051 @end smallexample
3052
3053 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3054
3055 @smallexample
3056 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3057 @end smallexample
3058
3059 @table @code
3060 @kindex info threads
3061 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3062
3063 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3064 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3065 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3066 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3067
3068 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3069
3070 @enumerate
3071 @item
3072 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3073
3074 @item
3075 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3076 option was specified
3077
3078 @item
3079 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3080
3081 @item
3082 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3083 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3084 program itself.
3085
3086 @item
3087 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3088 @end enumerate
3089
3090 @noindent
3091 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3092 indicates the current thread.
3093
3094 For example,
3095 @end table
3096 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3097
3098 @smallexample
3099 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3100 Id Target Id Frame
3101 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3102 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3103 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3104 at threadtest.c:68
3105 @end smallexample
3106
3107 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3108 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3109 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3110
3111 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3112 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3116 Id GId Target Id Frame
3117 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3118 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3119 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3120 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3121 @end smallexample
3122
3123 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3124 Solaris-specific command:
3125
3126 @table @code
3127 @item maint info sol-threads
3128 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3129 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3130 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3131 @end table
3132
3133 @table @code
3134 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3135 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3136 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3137 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3138 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3139 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3140
3141 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3142 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3143
3144 @smallexample
3145 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3146 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3147 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3148 8 printf ("hello\n");
3149 @end smallexample
3150
3151 @noindent
3152 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3153 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3154 threads.
3155
3156 @kindex thread apply
3157 @cindex apply command to several threads
3158 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3159 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3160 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3161 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3162 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3163 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3164 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3165 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3166
3167
3168 @kindex thread name
3169 @cindex name a thread
3170 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3171 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3172 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3173 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3174
3175 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3176 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3177 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3178 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3179 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3180
3181 @kindex thread find
3182 @cindex search for a thread
3183 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3184 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3185 matches the supplied regular expression.
3186
3187 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3188 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3189 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3190 is the LWP id.
3191
3192 @smallexample
3193 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3194 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3195 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3196 Id Target Id Frame
3197 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3198 @end smallexample
3199
3200 @kindex set print thread-events
3201 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3202 @item set print thread-events
3203 @itemx set print thread-events on
3204 @itemx set print thread-events off
3205 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3206 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3207 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3208 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3209 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3210
3211 @kindex show print thread-events
3212 @item show print thread-events
3213 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3214 have started and exited.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3218 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3219 programs with multiple threads.
3220
3221 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3222 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3223
3224 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3225 @table @code
3226 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3227 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3228 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3229 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3230 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3231 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3232 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3233 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3234 macro.
3235
3236 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3237 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3238 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3239 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3240 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3241 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3242
3243 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3244 refers to the default system directories that are
3245 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3246 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3247 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3248
3249 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3250 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3251 was loaded in the inferior process.
3252
3253 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3254 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3255 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3256 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3257 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3258 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3259 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3260
3261 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3262 only on some platforms.
3263
3264 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3265 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3266 Display current libthread_db search path.
3267
3268 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3269 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3270 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3271 @item set debug libthread-db
3272 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3273 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3274 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3275 @end table
3276
3277 @node Forks
3278 @section Debugging Forks
3279
3280 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3281 @cindex multiple processes
3282 @cindex processes, multiple
3283 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3284 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3285 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3286 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3287 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3288 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3289 will cause it to terminate.
3290
3291 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3292 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3293 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3294 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3295 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3296 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3297 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3298 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3299 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3300 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3301
3302 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3303 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3304 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3305 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3306
3307 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3308 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3309 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3310
3311 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3312 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3313
3314 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3315 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3316
3317 @table @code
3318 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3319 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3320 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3321 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3322 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3323
3324 @table @code
3325 @item parent
3326 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3327 unimpeded. This is the default.
3328
3329 @item child
3330 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3331 unimpeded.
3332
3333 @end table
3334
3335 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3336 @item show follow-fork-mode
3337 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3338 @end table
3339
3340 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3341 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3342 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3343
3344 @table @code
3345 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3346 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3347 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3348 retain debugger control over them both.
3349
3350 @table @code
3351 @item on
3352 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3353 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3354 independently. This is the default.
3355
3356 @item off
3357 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3358 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3359 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3360 is held suspended.
3361
3362 @end table
3363
3364 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3365 @item show detach-on-fork
3366 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3367 @end table
3368
3369 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3370 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3371 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3372 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3373 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3374 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3375
3376 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3377 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3378 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3379 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3380 and Programs}.
3381
3382 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3383 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3384 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3385 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3386 the child process's @code{main}.
3387
3388 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3389 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3390
3391 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3392 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3393 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3394 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3395 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3396 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3397 command.
3398
3399 @table @code
3400 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3401 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3402
3403 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3404 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3405
3406 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3407
3408 @table @code
3409 @item new
3410 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3411 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3412 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3413 original inferior.
3414
3415 For example:
3416
3417 @smallexample
3418 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3419 (gdb) info inferior
3420 Id Description Executable
3421 * 1 <null> prog1
3422 (@value{GDBP}) run
3423 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3424 Program exited normally.
3425 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3426 Id Description Executable
3427 1 <null> prog1
3428 * 2 <null> prog2
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @item same
3432 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3433 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3434 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3435 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3436 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3437
3438 For example:
3439
3440 @smallexample
3441 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3442 Id Description Executable
3443 * 1 <null> prog1
3444 (@value{GDBP}) run
3445 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3446 Program exited normally.
3447 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3448 Id Description Executable
3449 * 1 <null> prog2
3450 @end smallexample
3451
3452 @end table
3453 @end table
3454
3455 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3456 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3457
3458 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3459 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3460 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3461
3462 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3463 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3464
3465 @cindex checkpoint
3466 @cindex restart
3467 @cindex bookmark
3468 @cindex snapshot of a process
3469 @cindex rewind program state
3470
3471 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3472 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3473 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3474 later.
3475
3476 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3477 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3478 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3479 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3480 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3481
3482 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3483 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3484 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3485 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3486 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3487 start again from there.
3488
3489 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3490 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3491
3492 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3493
3494 @table @code
3495 @kindex checkpoint
3496 @item checkpoint
3497 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3498 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3499 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3500
3501 @kindex info checkpoints
3502 @item info checkpoints
3503 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3504 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3505 listed:
3506
3507 @table @code
3508 @item Checkpoint ID
3509 @item Process ID
3510 @item Code Address
3511 @item Source line, or label
3512 @end table
3513
3514 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3515 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3516 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3517 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3518 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3519 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3520 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3521
3522 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3523 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3524 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3525 the debugger.
3526
3527 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3528 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3529 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3530
3531 @end table
3532
3533 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3534 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3535 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3536 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3537 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3538 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3539 previously read data can be read again.
3540
3541 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3542 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3543 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3544 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3545 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3546 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3547
3548 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3549 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3550 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3551 different execution path this time.
3552
3553 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3554 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3555 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3556 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3557 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3558 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3559 potentially pose a problem.
3560
3561 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3562
3563 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3564 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3565 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3566 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3567 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3568 next.
3569
3570 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3571 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3572 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3573 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3574 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3575
3576 @node Stopping
3577 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3578
3579 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3580 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3581 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3582
3583 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3584 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3585 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3586 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3587 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3588 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3589 explicitly request this information at any time.
3590
3591 @table @code
3592 @kindex info program
3593 @item info program
3594 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3595 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3596 @end table
3597
3598 @menu
3599 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3600 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3601 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3602 Skipping over functions and files
3603 * Signals:: Signals
3604 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3605 @end menu
3606
3607 @node Breakpoints
3608 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3609
3610 @cindex breakpoints
3611 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3612 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3613 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3614 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3615 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3616 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3617 program.
3618
3619 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3620 the executable is run.
3621
3622 @cindex watchpoints
3623 @cindex data breakpoints
3624 @cindex memory tracing
3625 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3626 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3627 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3628 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3629 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3630 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3631 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3632 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3633 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3634 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3635 same commands.
3636
3637 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3638 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3639 Automatic Display}.
3640
3641 @cindex catchpoints
3642 @cindex breakpoint on events
3643 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3644 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3645 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3646 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3647 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3648 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3649 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3650
3651 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3652 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3653 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3654 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3655 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3656 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3657 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3658 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3659 enable it again.
3660
3661 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3662 @cindex breakpoint lists
3663 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3664 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3665 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3666 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3667 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3668 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3669 are operated on.
3670
3671 @menu
3672 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3673 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3674 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3675 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3676 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3677 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3678 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3679 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3680 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3681 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3682 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3683 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3684 @end menu
3685
3686 @node Set Breaks
3687 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3688
3689 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3690 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3691 @c
3692 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3693
3694 @kindex break
3695 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3696 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3697 @cindex latest breakpoint
3698 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3699 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3700 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3701 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3702 convenience variables.
3703
3704 @table @code
3705 @item break @var{location}
3706 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3707 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3708 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3709 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3710 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3711
3712 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3713 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3714 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3715 that situation.
3716
3717 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3718 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3719 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3720
3721 @item break
3722 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3723 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3724 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3725 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3726 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3727 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3728 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3729 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3730 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3731 inside loops.
3732
3733 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3734 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3735 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3736 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3737 existed when your program stopped.
3738
3739 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3740 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3741 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3742 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3743 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3744 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3745 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3746
3747 @kindex tbreak
3748 @item tbreak @var{args}
3749 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3750 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3751 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3752 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3753
3754 @kindex hbreak
3755 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3756 @item hbreak @var{args}
3757 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3758 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3759 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3760 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3761 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3762 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3763 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3764 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3765 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3766 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3767 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3768 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3769 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3770 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3771 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3772 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3773 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3774 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3775
3776 @kindex thbreak
3777 @item thbreak @var{args}
3778 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3779 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3780 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3781 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3782 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3783 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3784 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3785 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3786
3787 @kindex rbreak
3788 @cindex regular expression
3789 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3790 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3791 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3792 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3793 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3794 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3795 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3796 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3797 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3798
3799 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3800 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3801 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3802 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3803 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3804 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3805
3806 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3807 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3808 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3809 classes.
3810
3811 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3812 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3813 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3814
3815 @smallexample
3816 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3817 @end smallexample
3818
3819 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3820 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3821 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3822 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3823 every function in a given file:
3824
3825 @smallexample
3826 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3827 @end smallexample
3828
3829 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3830 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3831
3832 @kindex info breakpoints
3833 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3834 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3835 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3836 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3837 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3838 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3839 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3840
3841 @table @emph
3842 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3843 @item Type
3844 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3845 @item Disposition
3846 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3847 @item Enabled or Disabled
3848 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3849 that are not enabled.
3850 @item Address
3851 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3852 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3853 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3854 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3855 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3856 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3857 @item What
3858 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3859 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3860 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3861 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3862 @end table
3863
3864 @noindent
3865 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3866 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3867 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3868 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3869 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3870 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3871
3872 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3873 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3874 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3875 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3876
3877 @noindent
3878 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3879 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3880 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3881 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3882 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3883
3884 @noindent
3885 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3886 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3887 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3888 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3889 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3890 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3891
3892 @noindent
3893 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3894 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3895
3896 @end table
3897
3898 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3899 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3900 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3901 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3902
3903 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3904 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3905 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3906 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3907
3908 @itemize @bullet
3909 @item
3910 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3911
3912 @item
3913 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3914 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3915
3916 @item
3917 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3918 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3919
3920 @item
3921 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3922 several places where that function is inlined.
3923 @end itemize
3924
3925 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3926 the relevant locations.
3927
3928 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3929 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3930 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3931 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3932 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3933 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3934 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3935
3936 For example:
3937
3938 @smallexample
3939 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3940 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3941 stop only if i==1
3942 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3943 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3944 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3945 @end smallexample
3946
3947 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
3948 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3949 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3950 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
3951 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
3952 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
3953 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
3954 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
3955 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
3956 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
3957 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
3958
3959 @cindex pending breakpoints
3960 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3961 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3962 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3963 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3964 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3965 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3966 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3967 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3968 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3969 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3970 is not yet resolved.
3971
3972 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3973 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3974 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3975 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3976 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3977 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3978
3979 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3980 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3981 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3982 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3983
3984 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3985 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3986 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3987
3988 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3989 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3990 address specification to an address:
3991
3992 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3993 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3994 @table @code
3995 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3996 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3997 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3998
3999 @item set breakpoint pending on
4000 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4001 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4002
4003 @item set breakpoint pending off
4004 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4005 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4006 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4007
4008 @item show breakpoint pending
4009 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4010 @end table
4011
4012 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4013 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4014 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4015
4016 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4017 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4018 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4019 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4020 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4021 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4022 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4023 breakpoints.
4024
4025 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4026
4027 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4028 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4029 @table @code
4030 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4031 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4032 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4033 breakpoint must be used.
4034
4035 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4036 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4037 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4038 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4039 @end table
4040
4041 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4042 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4043 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4044 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4045 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4046 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4047 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4048 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4049 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4050
4051 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4052 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4053 @table @code
4054 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4055 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4056 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4057 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4058
4059 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4060 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4061 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4062 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4063 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4064 @end table
4065
4066 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4067 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4068 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4069
4070 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4071 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4072
4073 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4074
4075 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4076 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4077 @table @code
4078 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4079 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4080 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4081 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4082 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4083
4084 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4085 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4086 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4087 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4088 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4089 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4090 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4091 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4092 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4093 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4094 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4095 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4096 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4097
4098 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4099 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4100 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4101 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4102 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4103 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4104 @end table
4105
4106
4107 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4108 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4109 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4110 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4111 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4112 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4113 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4114 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4115
4116
4117 @node Set Watchpoints
4118 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4119
4120 @cindex setting watchpoints
4121 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4122 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4123 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4124 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4125 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4126
4127 @itemize @bullet
4128 @item
4129 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4130
4131 @item
4132 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4133 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4134 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4135
4136 @item
4137 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4138 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4139 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4140 @end itemize
4141
4142 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4143 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4144 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4145 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4146 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4147 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4148 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4149 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4150 the expression changes.
4151
4152 @cindex software watchpoints
4153 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4154 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4155 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4156 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4157 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4158 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4159 culprit.)
4160
4161 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4162 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4163 slow down the running of your program.
4164
4165 @table @code
4166 @kindex watch
4167 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4168 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4169 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4170 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4171 to watch the value of a single variable:
4172
4173 @smallexample
4174 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4175 @end smallexample
4176
4177 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4178 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4179 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4180 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4181 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4182 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4183
4184 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4185 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4186 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4187 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4188 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4189 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4190 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4191 error.
4192
4193 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4194 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4195 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4196 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4197 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4198 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4199 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4200 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4201 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4202 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4203 Examples:
4204
4205 @smallexample
4206 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4207 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4208 @end smallexample
4209
4210 @kindex rwatch
4211 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4212 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4213 by the program.
4214
4215 @kindex awatch
4216 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4217 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4218 or written into by the program.
4219
4220 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4221 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4222 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4223 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4224 @end table
4225
4226 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4227 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4228 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4229 a never-changing value:
4230
4231 @smallexample
4232 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4233 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4234 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4235 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4236 @end smallexample
4237
4238 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4239 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4240 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4241 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4242 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4243 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4244
4245 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4246 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4247 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4248 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4249 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4250 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4251 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4252 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4253
4254 @table @code
4255 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4256 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4257 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4258
4259 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4260 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4261 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4262 @end table
4263
4264 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4265 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4266 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4267
4268 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4269
4270 @smallexample
4271 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4272 @end smallexample
4273
4274 @noindent
4275 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4276
4277 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4278 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4279 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4280 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4281 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4282 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4283 will print a message like this:
4284
4285 @smallexample
4286 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4290 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4291 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4292 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4293 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4294 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4295 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4296 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4297
4298 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4299 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4300 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4301 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4302 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4303 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4304
4305 @smallexample
4306 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @noindent
4310 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4311
4312 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4313 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4314 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4315 expression with separately allocated resources.
4316
4317 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4318 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4319 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4320
4321 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4322 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4323 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4324 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4325 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4326 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4327 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4328 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4329 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4330
4331 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4332 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4333 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4334 watched expression from every thread.
4335
4336 @quotation
4337 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4338 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4339 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4340 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4341 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4342 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4343 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4344 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4345 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4346 @end quotation
4347
4348 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4349
4350 @node Set Catchpoints
4351 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4352 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4353 @cindex exception handlers
4354 @cindex event handling
4355
4356 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4357 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4358 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4359
4360 @table @code
4361 @kindex catch
4362 @item catch @var{event}
4363 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4364
4365 @table @code
4366 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4367 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4368 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4369 @kindex catch throw
4370 @kindex catch rethrow
4371 @kindex catch catch
4372 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4373 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4374
4375 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4376 regular expression will be caught.
4377
4378 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4379 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4380 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4381 exception being thrown.
4382
4383 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4384 @value{GDBN}:
4385
4386 @itemize @bullet
4387 @item
4388 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4389 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4390 supported.
4391
4392 @item
4393 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4394 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4395 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4396 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4397 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4398 built.
4399
4400 @item
4401 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4402 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4403
4404 @item
4405 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4406 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4407 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4408 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4409
4410 @item
4411 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4412 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4413 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4414 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4415 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4416 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4417 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4418 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4419 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4420
4421 @item
4422 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4423
4424 @item
4425 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4426 @end itemize
4427
4428 @item exception
4429 @kindex catch exception
4430 @cindex Ada exception catching
4431 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4432 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4433 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4434 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4435 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4436
4437 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4438 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4439 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4440 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4441 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4442 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4443 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4444 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4445
4446 @item exception unhandled
4447 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4448 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4449
4450 @item assert
4451 @kindex catch assert
4452 A failed Ada assertion.
4453
4454 @item exec
4455 @kindex catch exec
4456 @cindex break on fork/exec
4457 A call to @code{exec}.
4458
4459 @item syscall
4460 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4461 @kindex catch syscall
4462 @cindex break on a system call.
4463 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4464 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4465 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4466 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4467 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4468 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4469 will be caught.
4470
4471 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4472 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4473 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4474 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4475
4476 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4477 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4478 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4479 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4480
4481 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4482 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4483 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4484 available choices.
4485
4486 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4487 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4488 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4489 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4490 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4491 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4492 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4493 behind the OS upgrades).
4494
4495 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4496 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4497 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4498 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4499 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4500 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4501 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4502 syscall groups available on your environment.
4503
4504 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4505 arguments to it:
4506
4507 @smallexample
4508 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4509 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4510 (@value{GDBP}) r
4511 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4512
4513 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4514 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4515 (@value{GDBP}) c
4516 Continuing.
4517
4518 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4519 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4520 (@value{GDBP})
4521 @end smallexample
4522
4523 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4524
4525 @smallexample
4526 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4527 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4528 (@value{GDBP}) r
4529 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4530
4531 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4532 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4533 (@value{GDBP}) c
4534 Continuing.
4535
4536 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4537 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4538 (@value{GDBP})
4539 @end smallexample
4540
4541 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4542 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4543 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4544
4545 @smallexample
4546 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4547 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4548 (@value{GDBP}) r
4549 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4550
4551 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4552 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4553 (@value{GDBP}) c
4554 Continuing.
4555
4556 Program exited normally.
4557 (@value{GDBP})
4558 @end smallexample
4559
4560 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4561
4562 @smallexample
4563 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4564 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4565 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4566 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4567 (@value{GDBP}) r
4568 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4569
4570 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4571 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4572
4573 (@value{GDBP}) c
4574 Continuing.
4575 @end smallexample
4576
4577 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4578 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4579 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4580 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4581
4582 @smallexample
4583 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4584 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4585 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4586 (@value{GDBP})
4587 @end smallexample
4588
4589 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4590 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4591 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4592 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4593 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4594 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4595
4596 @smallexample
4597 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4598 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4599 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4600 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4601 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4602 (@value{GDBP})
4603 @end smallexample
4604
4605 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4606
4607 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4608 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4609
4610 @smallexample
4611 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4612 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4613 @end smallexample
4614
4615 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4616
4617 @item fork
4618 @kindex catch fork
4619 A call to @code{fork}.
4620
4621 @item vfork
4622 @kindex catch vfork
4623 A call to @code{vfork}.
4624
4625 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4626 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4627 @kindex catch load
4628 @kindex catch unload
4629 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4630 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4631 matches one of the affected libraries.
4632
4633 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4634 @kindex catch signal
4635 The delivery of a signal.
4636
4637 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4638 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4639 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4640
4641 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4642 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4643 signal names.
4644
4645 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4646 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4647 will be caught.
4648
4649 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4650 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4651 catchpoint.
4652
4653 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4654 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4655 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4656 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4657 commands.
4658
4659 @end table
4660
4661 @item tcatch @var{event}
4662 @kindex tcatch
4663 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4664 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4665
4666 @end table
4667
4668 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4669
4670
4671 @node Delete Breaks
4672 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4673
4674 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4675 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4676 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4677 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4678 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4679 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4680
4681 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4682 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4683 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4684 their breakpoint numbers.
4685
4686 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4687 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4688 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4689
4690 @table @code
4691 @kindex clear
4692 @item clear
4693 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4694 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4695 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4696 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4697
4698 @item clear @var{location}
4699 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4700 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4701 most useful ones are listed below:
4702
4703 @table @code
4704 @item clear @var{function}
4705 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4706 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4707
4708 @item clear @var{linenum}
4709 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4710 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4711 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4712 @end table
4713
4714 @cindex delete breakpoints
4715 @kindex delete
4716 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4717 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4718 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4719 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4720 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4721 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4722 @end table
4723
4724 @node Disabling
4725 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4726
4727 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4728 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4729 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4730 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4731 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4732
4733 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4734 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4735 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4736 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4737 do not know which numbers to use.
4738
4739 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4740 affects all of its locations.
4741
4742 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4743 different states of enablement:
4744
4745 @itemize @bullet
4746 @item
4747 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4748 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4749 @item
4750 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4751 @item
4752 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4753 disabled.
4754 @item
4755 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4756 N times, then becomes disabled.
4757 @item
4758 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4759 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4760 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4761 @end itemize
4762
4763 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4764 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4765
4766 @table @code
4767 @kindex disable
4768 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4769 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4770 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4771 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4772 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4773 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4774 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4775
4776 @kindex enable
4777 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4778 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4779 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4780
4781 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4782 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4783 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4784
4785 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4786 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4787 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4788 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4789 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4790 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4791 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4792
4793 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4794 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4795 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4796 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4797 @end table
4798
4799 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4800 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4801 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4802 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4803 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4804 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4805 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4806 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4807 Stepping}.)
4808
4809 @node Conditions
4810 @subsection Break Conditions
4811 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4812 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4813
4814 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4815 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4816 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4817 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4818 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4819 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4820 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4821 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4822
4823 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4824 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4825 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4826 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4827 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4828
4829 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4830 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4831 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4832 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4833 one.
4834
4835 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4836 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4837 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4838 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4839 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4840 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4841 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4842 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4843 conditions for the
4844 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4845 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4846
4847 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4848 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4849 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4850 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4851 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4852 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4853
4854 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4855 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4856 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4857 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4858 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4859
4860 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4861 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4862 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4863 with the @code{condition} command.
4864
4865 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4866 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4867 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4868 catchpoint.
4869
4870 @table @code
4871 @kindex condition
4872 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4873 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4874 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4875 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4876 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4877 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4878 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4879 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4880 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4881 prints an error message:
4882
4883 @smallexample
4884 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4885 @end smallexample
4886
4887 @noindent
4888 @value{GDBN} does
4889 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4890 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4891 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4892
4893 @item condition @var{bnum}
4894 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4895 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4896 @end table
4897
4898 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4899 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4900 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4901 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4902 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4903 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4904 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4905 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4906 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4907 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4908 your program reaches it.
4909
4910 @table @code
4911 @kindex ignore
4912 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4913 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4914 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4915 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4916 takes no action.
4917
4918 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4919 a count of zero.
4920
4921 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4922 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4923 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4924 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4925
4926 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4927 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4928 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4929
4930 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4931 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4932 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4933 Variables}.
4934 @end table
4935
4936 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4937
4938
4939 @node Break Commands
4940 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4941
4942 @cindex breakpoint commands
4943 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4944 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4945 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4946 enable other breakpoints.
4947
4948 @table @code
4949 @kindex commands
4950 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4951 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4952 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4953 @itemx end
4954 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4955 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4956 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4957
4958 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4959 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4960
4961 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4962 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4963 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4964 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4965 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4966 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4967 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4968 Expressions}).
4969 @end table
4970
4971 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4972 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4973
4974 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4975 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4976 that resumes execution.
4977
4978 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4979 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4980 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4981 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4982 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4983
4984 @kindex silent
4985 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4986 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4987 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4988 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4989 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4990 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4991
4992 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4993 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4994 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4995
4996 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4997 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4998
4999 @smallexample
5000 break foo if x>0
5001 commands
5002 silent
5003 printf "x is %d\n",x
5004 cont
5005 end
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5009 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5010 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5011 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5012 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5013 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5014 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5015
5016 @smallexample
5017 break 403
5018 commands
5019 silent
5020 set x = y + 4
5021 cont
5022 end
5023 @end smallexample
5024
5025 @node Dynamic Printf
5026 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5027
5028 @cindex dynamic printf
5029 @cindex dprintf
5030 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5031 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5032 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5033 having to recompile it.
5034
5035 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5036 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5037 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5038 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5039 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5040 redirects to files and so forth.
5041
5042 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5043 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5044 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5045 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5046 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5047 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5048 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5049
5050 @table @code
5051 @kindex dprintf
5052 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5053 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5054 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5055 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5056
5057 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5058 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5059 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5060 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5061 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5062 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5063
5064 @table @code
5065 @item gdb
5066 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5067 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5068
5069 @item call
5070 @kindex dprintf-style call
5071 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5072 @code{printf}).
5073
5074 @item agent
5075 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5076 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5077 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5078 support running commands on the target.
5079 @end table
5080
5081 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5082 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5083 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5084 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5085 command.
5086
5087 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5088 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5089 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5090 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5091 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5092 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5093
5094 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5095 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5096 you could do the following:
5097
5098 @example
5099 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5100 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5101 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5102 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5103 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5104 (gdb) info break
5105 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5106 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5107 continue
5108 (gdb)
5109 @end example
5110
5111 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5112 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5113 the variable settings.
5114
5115 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5116 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5117 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5118 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5119 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5120 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5121
5122 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5123 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5124 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5125
5126 @end table
5127
5128 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5129 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5130 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5131 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5132 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5133 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5134
5135 @node Save Breakpoints
5136 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5137
5138 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5139 breakpoints}} command.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex save breakpoints
5143 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5144 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5145 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5146 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5147 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5148 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5149 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5150 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5151 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5152 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5153 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5154 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5155 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5156 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5157 that can no longer be recreated.
5158 @end table
5159
5160 @node Static Probe Points
5161 @subsection Static Probe Points
5162
5163 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5164 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5165 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5166 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5167 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5168
5169 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5170 ELF-compatible systems:
5171
5172 @itemize @bullet
5173
5174 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5175 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5176 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5177 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5178 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5179 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5180 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5181 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5182
5183 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5184 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5185 C@t{++} languages.
5186 @end itemize
5187
5188 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5189 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5190 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5191 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5192 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5193 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5194 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5195 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5196 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5197
5198 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5199 probes}, with optional arguments:
5200
5201 @table @code
5202 @kindex info probes
5203 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5204 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5205 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5206 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5207
5208 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5209 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5210 probes from all providers are listed.
5211
5212 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5213 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5214 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5215
5216 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5217 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5218 given, all object files are considered.
5219
5220 @item info probes all
5221 List the available static probes, from all types.
5222 @end table
5223
5224 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5225 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5226 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5227 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5228 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5229
5230 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5231 commands, with optional arguments:
5232
5233 @table @code
5234 @kindex enable probes
5235 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5236 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5237 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5238 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5239
5240 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5241 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5242 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5243
5244 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5245 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5246 given, all object files are considered.
5247
5248 @kindex disable probes
5249 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5250 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5251 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5252 @end table
5253
5254 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5255 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5256 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5257 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5258 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5259 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5260 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5261 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5262 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5263 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5264 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5265 at the current probe point.
5266
5267 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5268 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5269 an error message.
5270
5271
5272 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5273 @node Error in Breakpoints
5274 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5275
5276 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5277 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5278
5279 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5280 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5281 @smallexample
5282 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5283 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5284 @end smallexample
5285
5286 @noindent
5287 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5288 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5289 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5290
5291 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5292 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5293
5294 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5295 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5296 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5297
5298 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5299 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5300 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5301 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5302
5303 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5304 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5305 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5306 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5307 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5308 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5309 first in the bundle.
5310
5311 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5312 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5313 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5314 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5315 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5316 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5317 is hit.
5318
5319 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5320 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5321
5322 @smallexample
5323 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5324 @end smallexample
5325
5326 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5327 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5328 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5329 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5330 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5331 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5332 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5333 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5334
5335 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5336 adjusted breakpoints:
5337
5338 @smallexample
5339 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5340 to 0x00010410.
5341 @end smallexample
5342
5343 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5344 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5345 frequently than expected.
5346
5347 @node Continuing and Stepping
5348 @section Continuing and Stepping
5349
5350 @cindex stepping
5351 @cindex continuing
5352 @cindex resuming execution
5353 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5354 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5355 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5356 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5357 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5358 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5359 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5360 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5361 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5362 handlers}).)
5363
5364 @table @code
5365 @kindex continue
5366 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5367 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5368 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5369 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5370 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5371 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5372 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5373 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5374 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5375 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5376
5377 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5378 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5379 @code{continue} is ignored.
5380
5381 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5382 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5383 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5384 @code{continue}.
5385 @end table
5386
5387 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5388 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5389 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5390 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5391
5392 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5393 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5394 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5395 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5396 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5397 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5398
5399 @table @code
5400 @kindex step
5401 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5402 @item step
5403 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5404 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5405 abbreviated @code{s}.
5406
5407 @quotation
5408 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5409 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5410 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5411 @c distinction here.
5412 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5413 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5414 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5415 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5416 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5417 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5418 below.
5419 @end quotation
5420
5421 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5422 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5423 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5424 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5425 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5426 called within the line.
5427
5428 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5429 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5430 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5431 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5432 was any debugging information about the routine.
5433
5434 @item step @var{count}
5435 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5436 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5437 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5438
5439 @kindex next
5440 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5441 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5442 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5443 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5444 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5445 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5446 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5447 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5448
5449 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5450
5451
5452 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5453 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5454 @c
5455 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5456 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5457 @c function are executed without stopping.
5458
5459 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5460 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5461 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5462
5463 @kindex set step-mode
5464 @item set step-mode
5465 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5466 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5467 @itemx set step-mode on
5468 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5469 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5470 information rather than stepping over it.
5471
5472 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5473 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5474 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5475
5476 @item set step-mode off
5477 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5478 debug information. This is the default.
5479
5480 @item show step-mode
5481 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5482 source line debug information.
5483
5484 @kindex finish
5485 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5486 @item finish
5487 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5488 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5489 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5490
5491 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5492 ,Returning from a Function}).
5493
5494 @kindex until
5495 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5496 @cindex run until specified location
5497 @item until
5498 @itemx u
5499 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5500 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5501 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5502 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5503 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5504 than the address of the jump.
5505
5506 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5507 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5508 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5509 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5510 through the next iteration.
5511
5512 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5513 stack frame.
5514
5515 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5516 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5517 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5518 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5519 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5520
5521 @smallexample
5522 (@value{GDBP}) f
5523 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5524 206 expand_input();
5525 (@value{GDBP}) until
5526 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5527 @end smallexample
5528
5529 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5530 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5531 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5532 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5533 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5534 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5535 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5536
5537 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5538 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5539 argument.
5540
5541 @item until @var{location}
5542 @itemx u @var{location}
5543 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5544 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5545 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5546 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5547 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5548 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5549 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5550 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5551 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5552 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5553 invocations have returned.
5554
5555 @smallexample
5556 94 int factorial (int value)
5557 95 @{
5558 96 if (value > 1) @{
5559 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5560 98 @}
5561 99 return (value);
5562 100 @}
5563 @end smallexample
5564
5565
5566 @kindex advance @var{location}
5567 @item advance @var{location}
5568 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5569 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5570 @ref{Specify Location}.
5571 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5572 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5573 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5574 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5575
5576
5577 @kindex stepi
5578 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5579 @item stepi
5580 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5581 @itemx si
5582 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5583
5584 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5585 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5586 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5587 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5588
5589 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5590
5591 @need 750
5592 @kindex nexti
5593 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5594 @item nexti
5595 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5596 @itemx ni
5597 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5598 proceed until the function returns.
5599
5600 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5601
5602 @end table
5603
5604 @anchor{range stepping}
5605 @cindex range stepping
5606 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5607 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5608 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5609 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5610 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5611 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5612 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5613 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5614 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5615 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5616 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5617 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5618 if necessary:
5619
5620 @table @code
5621 @kindex set range-stepping
5622 @kindex show range-stepping
5623 @item set range-stepping
5624 @itemx show range-stepping
5625 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5626
5627 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5628 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5629 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5630 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5631 default is @code{on}.
5632
5633 @end table
5634
5635 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5636 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5637 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5638
5639 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5640 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5641 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5642 a particular file when stepping.
5643
5644 For example, consider the following C function:
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 101 int func()
5648 102 @{
5649 103 foo(boring());
5650 104 bar(boring());
5651 105 @}
5652 @end smallexample
5653
5654 @noindent
5655 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5656 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5657 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5658 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5659
5660 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5661 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5662 is called from many places.
5663
5664 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5665 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5666 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5667 @code{foo}.
5668
5669 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5670 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5671 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5672
5673 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5674 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5675 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5676 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5677 the underlying system.
5678 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5679 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5680
5681 @table @code
5682 @kindex skip
5683 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5684 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5685 that specify what to skip.
5686 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5687
5688 @table @code
5689 @item -file @var{file}
5690 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5691 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5692
5693 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5694 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5695 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5696 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5697 over when stepping.
5698
5699 @smallexample
5700 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5701 @end smallexample
5702
5703 @item -function @var{linespec}
5704 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5705 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5706 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5707 @xref{Specify Location}.
5708
5709 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5710 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5711 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5712 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5713
5714 This form is useful for complex function names.
5715 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5716 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5717 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5718 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5719 regular expression makes this easier.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5723 @end smallexample
5724
5725 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5726 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5727
5728 @smallexample
5729 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5730 @end smallexample
5731 @end table
5732
5733 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5734 will be skipped.
5735
5736 @kindex skip function
5737 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5738 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5739 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5740 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5741
5742 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5743 will be skipped.
5744
5745 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5746 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5747
5748 @kindex skip file
5749 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5750 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5751 will be skipped over when stepping.
5752
5753 @smallexample
5754 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5755 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5756 @end smallexample
5757
5758 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5759 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5760 @end table
5761
5762 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5763 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5764
5765 @table @code
5766 @kindex info skip
5767 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5768 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5769 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5770 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5771
5772 @table @emph
5773 @item Identifier
5774 A number identifying this skip.
5775 @item Enabled or Disabled
5776 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5777 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5778 @item Glob
5779 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5780 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5781 @item File
5782 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5783 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5784 @item RE
5785 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5786 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5787 @item Function
5788 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5789 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5790 @end table
5791
5792 @kindex skip delete
5793 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5794 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5795 skips.
5796
5797 @kindex skip enable
5798 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5799 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5800 skips.
5801
5802 @kindex skip disable
5803 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5804 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5805 skips.
5806
5807 @end table
5808
5809 @node Signals
5810 @section Signals
5811 @cindex signals
5812
5813 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5814 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5815 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5816 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5817 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5818 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5819 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5820 requested an alarm).
5821
5822 @cindex fatal signals
5823 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5824 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5825 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5826 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5827 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5828 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5829
5830 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5831 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5832 signal.
5833
5834 @cindex handling signals
5835 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5836 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5837 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5838 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5839 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5840
5841 @table @code
5842 @kindex info signals
5843 @kindex info handle
5844 @item info signals
5845 @itemx info handle
5846 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5847 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5848 the defined types of signals.
5849
5850 @item info signals @var{sig}
5851 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5852
5853 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5854
5855 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5856 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5857 for details about this command.
5858
5859 @kindex handle
5860 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5861 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5862 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5863 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5864 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5865 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5866 say what change to make.
5867 @end table
5868
5869 @c @group
5870 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5871 Their full names are:
5872
5873 @table @code
5874 @item nostop
5875 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5876 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5877
5878 @item stop
5879 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5880 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5881
5882 @item print
5883 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5884
5885 @item noprint
5886 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5887 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5888
5889 @item pass
5890 @itemx noignore
5891 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5892 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5893 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5894
5895 @item nopass
5896 @itemx ignore
5897 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5898 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5899 @end table
5900 @c @end group
5901
5902 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5903 program until you
5904 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5905 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5906 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5907 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5908 program sees that signal when you continue.
5909
5910 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5911 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5912 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5913 erroneous signals.
5914
5915 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5916 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5917 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5918 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5919 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5920 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5921 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5922 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5923 Program a Signal}.
5924
5925 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5926 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5927
5928 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5929 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5930 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5931 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5932 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5933 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5934 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5935 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5936 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5937 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5938 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5939 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5940 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5941
5942 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5943
5944 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5945 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5946 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5947 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5948
5949 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5950 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5951 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5952 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5953
5954 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5955 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5956
5957 @smallexample
5958 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5959 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5960 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5961 (@value{GDBP}) c
5962 Continuing.
5963
5964 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5965 main () sigusr1.c:28
5966 28 p = 0;
5967 (@value{GDBP}) si
5968 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5969 9 @{
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5973 program to receive the signal first:
5974
5975 @smallexample
5976 (@value{GDBP}) n
5977 28 p = 0;
5978 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5979 (@value{GDBP}) si
5980 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5981 9 @{
5982 (@value{GDBP})
5983 @end smallexample
5984
5985 @cindex extra signal information
5986 @anchor{extra signal information}
5987
5988 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5989 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5990 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5991 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5992 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5993 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5994 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5995 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5996 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5997 system header.
5998
5999 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6000 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6001
6002 @smallexample
6003 @group
6004 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6005 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6006 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6007 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6008 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6009 type = struct @{
6010 int si_signo;
6011 int si_errno;
6012 int si_code;
6013 union @{
6014 int _pad[28];
6015 struct @{...@} _kill;
6016 struct @{...@} _timer;
6017 struct @{...@} _rt;
6018 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6019 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6020 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6021 @} _sifields;
6022 @}
6023 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6024 type = struct @{
6025 void *si_addr;
6026 @}
6027 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6028 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6029 @end group
6030 @end smallexample
6031
6032 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6033
6034 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6035 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6036 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6037 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6038 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6039 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6040 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6041 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6042 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6043 information is displayed.
6044
6045 The usual output of a segfault is:
6046 @smallexample
6047 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6048 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6049 68 value = *(p + len);
6050 @end smallexample
6051
6052 While a bound violation is presented as:
6053 @smallexample
6054 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6055 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6056 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6057 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6058 68 value = *(p + len);
6059 @end smallexample
6060
6061 @node Thread Stops
6062 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6063
6064 @cindex stopped threads
6065 @cindex threads, stopped
6066
6067 @cindex continuing threads
6068 @cindex threads, continuing
6069
6070 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6071 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6072 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6073 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6074 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6075 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6076 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6077 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6078 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6079
6080 @menu
6081 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6082 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6083 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6084 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6085 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6086 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6087 @end menu
6088
6089 @node All-Stop Mode
6090 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6091
6092 @cindex all-stop mode
6093
6094 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6095 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6096 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6097 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6098 underfoot.
6099
6100 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6101 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6102 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6103
6104 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6105 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6106 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6107 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6108 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6109 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6110 stops.
6111
6112 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6113 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6114 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6115 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6116
6117 @cindex automatic thread selection
6118 @cindex switching threads automatically
6119 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6120 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6121 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6122 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6123 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6124 thread.
6125
6126 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6127 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6128
6129 @table @code
6130 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6131 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6132 @cindex lock scheduler
6133 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6134 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6135 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6136 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6137 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6138 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6139 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6140 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6141 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6142 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6143 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6144 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6145 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6146 @code{on} in replay mode.
6147
6148 @item show scheduler-locking
6149 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6150 @end table
6151
6152 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6153 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6154 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6155 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6156 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6157 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6158 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6159 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6160 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6161 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6162 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6163 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6164 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6165 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6166
6167 @table @code
6168 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6169 @item set schedule-multiple
6170 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6171 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6172 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6173 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6174 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6175 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6176
6177 @item show schedule-multiple
6178 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6179 multiple processes.
6180 @end table
6181
6182 @node Non-Stop Mode
6183 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6184
6185 @cindex non-stop mode
6186
6187 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6188 @c with more details.
6189
6190 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6191 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6192 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6193 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6194 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6195 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6196
6197 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6198 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6199 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6200 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6201 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6202 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6203 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6204 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6205 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6206 independently and simultaneously.
6207
6208 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6209 or attach to your program:
6210
6211 @smallexample
6212 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6213 set pagination off
6214
6215 # Finally, turn it on!
6216 set non-stop on
6217 @end smallexample
6218
6219 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6220
6221 @table @code
6222 @kindex set non-stop
6223 @item set non-stop on
6224 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6225 @item set non-stop off
6226 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6227 @kindex show non-stop
6228 @item show non-stop
6229 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6230 @end table
6231
6232 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6233 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6234 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6235 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6236 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6237 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6238 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6239 default.
6240
6241 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6242 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6243 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6244
6245 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6246 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6247 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6248 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6249 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6250
6251 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6252 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6253 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6254 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6255 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6256
6257 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6258
6259 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6260 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6261 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6262 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6263 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6264 previously current thread.
6265
6266 @node Background Execution
6267 @subsection Background Execution
6268
6269 @cindex foreground execution
6270 @cindex background execution
6271 @cindex asynchronous execution
6272 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6273
6274 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6275 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6276 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6277 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6278 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6279 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6280
6281 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6282 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6283
6284 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6285 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6286 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6287 are:
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @kindex run&
6291 @item run
6292 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6293
6294 @item attach
6295 @kindex attach&
6296 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6297
6298 @item step
6299 @kindex step&
6300 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6301
6302 @item stepi
6303 @kindex stepi&
6304 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6305
6306 @item next
6307 @kindex next&
6308 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6309
6310 @item nexti
6311 @kindex nexti&
6312 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6313
6314 @item continue
6315 @kindex continue&
6316 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6317
6318 @item finish
6319 @kindex finish&
6320 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6321
6322 @item until
6323 @kindex until&
6324 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6325
6326 @end table
6327
6328 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6329 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6330 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6331 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6332 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6333 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6334
6335 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6336 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6337
6338 @table @code
6339 @kindex interrupt
6340 @item interrupt
6341 @itemx interrupt -a
6342
6343 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6344 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6345 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6346 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6347 @end table
6348
6349 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6350 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6351
6352 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6353 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6354 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6355
6356 @table @code
6357 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6358 @cindex thread breakpoints
6359 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6360 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6361 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6362 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6363 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6364 specify some source line.
6365
6366 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6367 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6368 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6369 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6370 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6371
6372 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6373 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6374 program.
6375
6376 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6377 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6378 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6379
6380 @smallexample
6381 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6382 @end smallexample
6383
6384 @end table
6385
6386 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6387 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6388 thread list. For example:
6389
6390 @smallexample
6391 (@value{GDBP}) c
6392 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6393 @end smallexample
6394
6395 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6396 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6397 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6398 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6399 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6400 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6401 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6402 command.
6403
6404 @node Interrupted System Calls
6405 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6406
6407 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6408 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6409 @cindex premature return from system calls
6410 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6411 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6412 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6413 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6414 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6415 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6416 stop execution.
6417
6418 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6419 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6420 style anyways.
6421
6422 For example, do not write code like this:
6423
6424 @smallexample
6425 sleep (10);
6426 @end smallexample
6427
6428 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6429 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6430
6431 Instead, write this:
6432
6433 @smallexample
6434 int unslept = 10;
6435 while (unslept > 0)
6436 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6437 @end smallexample
6438
6439 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6440 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6441 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6442 @value{GDBN}.
6443
6444 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6445 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6446 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6447 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6448
6449 @node Observer Mode
6450 @subsection Observer Mode
6451
6452 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6453 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6454 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6455 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6456 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6457
6458 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6459 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6460 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6461 mode.
6462
6463 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6464 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6465 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6466 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6467 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6468
6469 @table @code
6470
6471 @kindex observer
6472 @item set observer on
6473 @itemx set observer off
6474 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6475 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6476 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6477 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6478
6479 @item show observer
6480 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6481
6482 @kindex may-write-registers
6483 @item set may-write-registers on
6484 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6485 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6486 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6487 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6488
6489 @item show may-write-registers
6490 Show the current permission to write registers.
6491
6492 @kindex may-write-memory
6493 @item set may-write-memory on
6494 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6495 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6496 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6497 defaults to @code{on}.
6498
6499 @item show may-write-memory
6500 Show the current permission to write memory.
6501
6502 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6503 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6504 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6505 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6506 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6507 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6508
6509 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6510 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6511
6512 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6513 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6514 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6515 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6516 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6517 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6518 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6519
6520 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6521 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6522
6523 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6524 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6525 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6526 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6527 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6528 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6529 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6530
6531 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6532 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6533
6534 @kindex may-interrupt
6535 @item set may-interrupt on
6536 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6537 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6538 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6539 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6540 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6541
6542 @item show may-interrupt
6543 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6544
6545 @end table
6546
6547 @node Reverse Execution
6548 @chapter Running programs backward
6549 @cindex reverse execution
6550 @cindex running programs backward
6551
6552 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6553 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6554 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6555 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6556
6557 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6558 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6559 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6560 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6561 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6562 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6563
6564 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6565 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6566 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6567 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6568 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6569 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6570 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6571 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6572 prior values@footnote{
6573 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6574 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6575 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6576
6577 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6578 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6579 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6580 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6581 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6582 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6583 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6584 }.
6585
6586 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6587 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6588
6589 @table @code
6590 @kindex reverse-continue
6591 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6592 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6593 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6594 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6595 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6596 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6597 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6598
6599 @kindex reverse-step
6600 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6601 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6602 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6603 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6604
6605 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6606 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6607 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6608 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6609 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6610 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6611
6612 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6613 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6614
6615 @kindex reverse-stepi
6616 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6617 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6618 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6619 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6620 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6621 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6622 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6623
6624 @kindex reverse-next
6625 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6626 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6627 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6628 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6629 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6630 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6631 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6632 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6633 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6634 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6635
6636 @kindex reverse-nexti
6637 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6638 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6639 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6640 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6641 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6642 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6643 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6644 frame) is reached.
6645
6646 @kindex reverse-finish
6647 @item reverse-finish
6648 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6649 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6650 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6651 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6652
6653 @kindex set exec-direction
6654 @item set exec-direction
6655 Set the direction of target execution.
6656 @item set exec-direction reverse
6657 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6658 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6659 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6660 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6661 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6662 @item set exec-direction forward
6663 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6664 This is the default.
6665 @end table
6666
6667
6668 @node Process Record and Replay
6669 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6670 @cindex process record and replay
6671 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6672
6673 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6674 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6675 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6676
6677 @cindex replay mode
6678 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6679 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6680 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6681 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6682 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6683 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6684 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6685 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6686 execution log.
6687
6688 @cindex record mode
6689 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6690 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6691 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6692 for future replay.
6693
6694 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6695 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6696 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6697 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6698 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6699 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6700
6701 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6702 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6703 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6704 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6705
6706 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6707 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6708
6709 @table @code
6710 @kindex target record
6711 @kindex target record-full
6712 @kindex target record-btrace
6713 @kindex record
6714 @kindex record full
6715 @kindex record btrace
6716 @kindex record btrace bts
6717 @kindex record btrace pt
6718 @kindex record bts
6719 @kindex record pt
6720 @kindex rec
6721 @kindex rec full
6722 @kindex rec btrace
6723 @kindex rec btrace bts
6724 @kindex rec btrace pt
6725 @kindex rec bts
6726 @kindex rec pt
6727 @item record @var{method}
6728 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6729 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6730 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6731 recording methods are available:
6732
6733 @table @code
6734 @item full
6735 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6736 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6737 execution.
6738
6739 @item btrace @var{format}
6740 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6741 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6742 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6743 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6744 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6745 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6746 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6747
6748 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6749 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6750 formats are available:
6751
6752 @table @code
6753 @item bts
6754 @cindex branch trace store
6755 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6756 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6757 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6758
6759 @item pt
6760 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6761 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6762 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6763 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6764
6765 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6766 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6767 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6768
6769 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6770 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6771 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6772 buffer-size with care.
6773 @end table
6774
6775 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6776 @end table
6777
6778 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6779 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6780 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6781 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6782
6783 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6784 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6785 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6786 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6787 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6788
6789 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6790 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6791 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6792 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6793 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6794 does not support these two modes.
6795
6796 @kindex record stop
6797 @kindex rec s
6798 @item record stop
6799 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6800 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6801 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6802
6803 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6804 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6805 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6806 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6807 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6808
6809 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6810 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6811 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6812 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6813 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6814
6815 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6816 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6817
6818 @kindex record goto
6819 @item record goto
6820 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6821 ways to specify the location to go to:
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @item record goto begin
6825 @itemx record goto start
6826 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6827
6828 @item record goto end
6829 Go to the end of the execution log.
6830
6831 @item record goto @var{n}
6832 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6833 @end table
6834
6835 @kindex record save
6836 @item record save @var{filename}
6837 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6838 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6839 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6840
6841 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6842
6843 @kindex record restore
6844 @item record restore @var{filename}
6845 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6846 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6847
6848 @kindex set record full
6849 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6850 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6851 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6852 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6853
6854 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6855 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6856 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6857 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6858 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6859 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6860 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6861 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6862
6863 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6864 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6865 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6866
6867 @kindex show record full
6868 @item show record full insn-number-max
6869 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6870 recording method.
6871
6872 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6873 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6874 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6875 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6876 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6877 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6878 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6879 oldest one to be deleted.
6880
6881 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6882 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6883
6884 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6885 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6886
6887 @item set record full memory-query
6888 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6889 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6890 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6891 case.
6892
6893 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6894 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6895 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6896 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6897 results.
6898
6899 @item show record full memory-query
6900 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6901
6902 @kindex set record btrace
6903 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6904 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6905 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6906 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6907 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6908 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6909 You can use the following command for that:
6910
6911 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6912 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6913 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6914 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6915 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6916 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6917 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6918 position.
6919
6920 @kindex show record btrace
6921 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6922 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6923
6924 @kindex set record btrace bts
6925 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6926 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6927 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6928 format. Default is 64KB.
6929
6930 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6931 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6932 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6933 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6934 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6935 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6936 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6937
6938 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6939 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6940
6941 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6942 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6943
6944 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6945 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6946 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6947
6948 @kindex set record btrace pt
6949 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6950 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6951 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6952 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6953
6954 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6955 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6956 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6957 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6958 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6959 actual buffer size for each thread.
6960
6961 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6962 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6963
6964 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6965 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6966
6967 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6968 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6969 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6970
6971 @kindex info record
6972 @item info record
6973 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6974 method:
6975
6976 @table @code
6977 @item full
6978 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6979 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6980
6981 @itemize @bullet
6982 @item
6983 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6984 @item
6985 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6986 @item
6987 Highest recorded instruction number.
6988 @item
6989 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6990 @item
6991 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6992 @item
6993 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6994 @end itemize
6995
6996 @item btrace
6997 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6998
6999 @itemize @bullet
7000 @item
7001 Recording format.
7002 @item
7003 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7004 @item
7005 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7006 instructions.
7007 @item
7008 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7009 @end itemize
7010
7011 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7012 @itemize @bullet
7013 @item
7014 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7015 @end itemize
7016
7017 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7018 @itemize @bullet
7019 @item
7020 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7021 @end itemize
7022 @end table
7023
7024 @kindex record delete
7025 @kindex rec del
7026 @item record delete
7027 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7028 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7029 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7030 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7031
7032 @kindex record instruction-history
7033 @kindex rec instruction-history
7034 @item record instruction-history
7035 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7036 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7037 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7038 are printed in execution order.
7039
7040 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7041 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7042 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7043
7044 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7045 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7046 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7047 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7048 @code{/p} modifier.
7049
7050 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7051 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7052 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7053
7054 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7055 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7056
7057 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7058 disassemble:
7059
7060 @table @code
7061 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7062 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7063 @var{insn}.
7064
7065 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7066 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7067 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7068 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7069 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7070 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7071
7072 @item record instruction-history
7073 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7074
7075 @item record instruction-history -
7076 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7077
7078 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7079 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7080 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7081 number @var{end} is included.
7082 @end table
7083
7084 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7085
7086 @kindex set record
7087 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7088 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7089 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7090 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7091 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7092
7093 @kindex show record
7094 @item show record instruction-history-size
7095 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7096 instruction-history} command.
7097
7098 @kindex record function-call-history
7099 @kindex rec function-call-history
7100 @item record function-call-history
7101 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7102 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7103 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7104 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7105 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7106 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7107 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7108 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7109 given together.
7110
7111 @smallexample
7112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7113 1 void foo (void)
7114 2 @{
7115 3 @}
7116 4
7117 5 void bar (void)
7118 6 @{
7119 7 ...
7120 8 foo ();
7121 9 ...
7122 10 @}
7123 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7124 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7125 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7126 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7127 @end smallexample
7128
7129 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7130 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7131 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7132 to print:
7133
7134 @table @code
7135 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7136 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7137
7138 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7139 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7140 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7141 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7142 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7143
7144 @item record function-call-history
7145 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7146
7147 @item record function-call-history -
7148 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7149
7150 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7151 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7152 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7153 @end table
7154
7155 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7156
7157 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7158 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7159 Define how many lines to print in the
7160 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7161 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7162
7163 @item show record function-call-history-size
7164 Show how many lines to print in the
7165 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7166 @end table
7167
7168
7169 @node Stack
7170 @chapter Examining the Stack
7171
7172 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7173 stopped and how it got there.
7174
7175 @cindex call stack
7176 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7177 is generated.
7178 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7179 the arguments of the call,
7180 and the local variables of the function being called.
7181 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7182 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7183 stack}.
7184
7185 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7186 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7187
7188 @cindex selected frame
7189 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7190 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7191 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7192 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7193 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7194 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7195
7196 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7197 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7198 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7199
7200 @menu
7201 * Frames:: Stack frames
7202 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7203 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7204 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7205 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7206
7207 @end menu
7208
7209 @node Frames
7210 @section Stack Frames
7211
7212 @cindex frame, definition
7213 @cindex stack frame
7214 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7215 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7216 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7217 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7218 which the function is executing.
7219
7220 @cindex initial frame
7221 @cindex outermost frame
7222 @cindex innermost frame
7223 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7224 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7225 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7226 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7227 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7228 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7229 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7230 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7231
7232 @cindex frame pointer
7233 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7234 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7235 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7236 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7237 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7238 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7239
7240 @cindex frame number
7241 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7242 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7243 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7244 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7245 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7246
7247 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7248 @c underflow problems.
7249 @cindex frameless execution
7250 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7251 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7252 @smallexample
7253 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7254 @end smallexample
7255 generates functions without a frame.)
7256 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7257 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7258 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7259 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7260 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7261 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7262 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7263
7264 @node Backtrace
7265 @section Backtraces
7266
7267 @cindex traceback
7268 @cindex call stack traces
7269 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7270 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7271 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7272 stack.
7273
7274 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7275 @table @code
7276 @kindex backtrace
7277 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7278 @item backtrace
7279 @itemx bt
7280 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7281 frames in the stack.
7282
7283 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7284 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7285
7286 @item backtrace @var{n}
7287 @itemx bt @var{n}
7288 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7289
7290 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7291 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7292 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7293
7294 @item backtrace full
7295 @itemx bt full
7296 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7297 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7298 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7299 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7300
7301 @item backtrace no-filters
7302 @itemx bt no-filters
7303 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7304 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7305 @itemx bt no-filters full
7306 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7307 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7308 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7309 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7310 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7311 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7312 support.
7313 @end table
7314
7315 @kindex where
7316 @kindex info stack
7317 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7318 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7319
7320 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7321 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7322 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7323 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7324 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7325 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7326 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7327 multi-threaded program.
7328
7329 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7330 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7331 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7332 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7333 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7334 line number.
7335
7336 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7337 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7338
7339 @smallexample
7340 @group
7341 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7342 at builtin.c:993
7343 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7344 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7345 at macro.c:71
7346 (More stack frames follow...)
7347 @end group
7348 @end smallexample
7349
7350 @noindent
7351 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7352 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7353 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7354
7355 @noindent
7356 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7357 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7358 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7359 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7360 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7361
7362 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7363 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7364 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7365 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7366 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7367 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7368 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7369 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7370 such a backtrace might look like:
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 @group
7374 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7375 at builtin.c:993
7376 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7377 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7378 at macro.c:71
7379 (More stack frames follow...)
7380 @end group
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 @noindent
7384 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7385 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7386
7387 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7388 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7389 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7390
7391 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7392 @cindex program entry point
7393 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7394 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7395 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7396 @code{main}@footnote{
7397 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7398 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7399 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7400 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7401 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7402 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7403
7404 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7405 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7406
7407 @table @code
7408 @item set backtrace past-main
7409 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7410 @kindex set backtrace
7411 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7412
7413 @item set backtrace past-main off
7414 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7415 default.
7416
7417 @item show backtrace past-main
7418 @kindex show backtrace
7419 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7420
7421 @item set backtrace past-entry
7422 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7423 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7424 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7425 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7426
7427 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7428 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7429 application. This is the default.
7430
7431 @item show backtrace past-entry
7432 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7433
7434 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7435 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7436 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7437 @cindex backtrace limit
7438 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7439 or zero means unlimited levels.
7440
7441 @item show backtrace limit
7442 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7443 @end table
7444
7445 You can control how file names are displayed.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @item set filename-display
7449 @itemx set filename-display relative
7450 @cindex filename-display
7451 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7452
7453 @item set filename-display basename
7454 Display only basename of a filename.
7455
7456 @item set filename-display absolute
7457 Display an absolute filename.
7458
7459 @item show filename-display
7460 Show the current way to display filenames.
7461 @end table
7462
7463 @node Selection
7464 @section Selecting a Frame
7465
7466 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7467 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7468 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7469 of the stack frame just selected.
7470
7471 @table @code
7472 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7473 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7474 @item frame @var{n}
7475 @itemx f @var{n}
7476 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7477 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7478 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7479 @code{main}.
7480
7481 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7482 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7483 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7484 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7485 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7486 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7487 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7488 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7489
7490 @kindex up
7491 @item up @var{n}
7492 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7493 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7494 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7495
7496 @kindex down
7497 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7498 @item down @var{n}
7499 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7500 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7501 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7502 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7503 @end table
7504
7505 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7506 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7507 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7508 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7509
7510 @need 1000
7511 For example:
7512
7513 @smallexample
7514 @group
7515 (@value{GDBP}) up
7516 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7517 at env.c:10
7518 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7519 @end group
7520 @end smallexample
7521
7522 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7523 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7524 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7525 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7526 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7527 for details.
7528
7529 @table @code
7530 @kindex select-frame
7531 @item select-frame
7532 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7533 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7534 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7535 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7536
7537 @kindex down-silently
7538 @kindex up-silently
7539 @item up-silently @var{n}
7540 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7541 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7542 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7543 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7544 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7545 distracting.
7546 @end table
7547
7548 @node Frame Info
7549 @section Information About a Frame
7550
7551 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7552 stack frame.
7553
7554 @table @code
7555 @item frame
7556 @itemx f
7557 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7558 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7559 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7560 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7561 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7562
7563 @kindex info frame
7564 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7565 @item info frame
7566 @itemx info f
7567 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7568 including:
7569
7570 @itemize @bullet
7571 @item
7572 the address of the frame
7573 @item
7574 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7575 @item
7576 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7577 @item
7578 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7579 @item
7580 the address of the frame's arguments
7581 @item
7582 the address of the frame's local variables
7583 @item
7584 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7585 @item
7586 which registers were saved in the frame
7587 @end itemize
7588
7589 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7590 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7591 the usual conventions.
7592
7593 @item info frame @var{addr}
7594 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7595 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7596 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7597 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7598 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7599 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7600
7601 @kindex info args
7602 @item info args
7603 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7604
7605 @item info locals
7606 @kindex info locals
7607 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7608 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7609 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7610
7611 @end table
7612
7613 @node Frame Filter Management
7614 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7615 @cindex managing frame filters
7616
7617 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7618 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7619
7620 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7621 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7622
7623 @table @code
7624 @kindex info frame-filter
7625 @item info frame-filter
7626 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7627 their name, priority and enabled status.
7628
7629 @kindex disable frame-filter
7630 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7631 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7632 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7633 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7634 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7635 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7636 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7637 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7638 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7639 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7640 may be enabled again later.
7641
7642 @kindex enable frame-filter
7643 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7644 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7645 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7646 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7647 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7648 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7649 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7650 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7651 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7652
7653 Example:
7654
7655 @smallexample
7656 (gdb) info frame-filter
7657
7658 global frame-filters:
7659 Priority Enabled Name
7660 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7661 100 Yes Reverse
7662
7663 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7664 Priority Enabled Name
7665 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7666
7667 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7668 Priority Enabled Name
7669 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7670
7671 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7672 (gdb) info frame-filter
7673
7674 global frame-filters:
7675 Priority Enabled Name
7676 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7677 100 Yes Reverse
7678
7679 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7680 Priority Enabled Name
7681 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7682
7683 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7684 Priority Enabled Name
7685 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7686
7687 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7688 (gdb) info frame-filter
7689
7690 global frame-filters:
7691 Priority Enabled Name
7692 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7693 100 Yes Reverse
7694
7695 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7696 Priority Enabled Name
7697 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7698
7699 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7700 Priority Enabled Name
7701 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7702 @end smallexample
7703
7704 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7705 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7706 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7707 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7708 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7709 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7710 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7711
7712 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7713 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7714 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7715 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7716 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7717 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7718 dictionary resides.
7719
7720 Example:
7721
7722 @smallexample
7723 (gdb) info frame-filter
7724
7725 global frame-filters:
7726 Priority Enabled Name
7727 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7728 100 Yes Reverse
7729
7730 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7731 Priority Enabled Name
7732 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7733
7734 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7735 Priority Enabled Name
7736 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7737
7738 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7739 (gdb) info frame-filter
7740
7741 global frame-filters:
7742 Priority Enabled Name
7743 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7744 50 Yes Reverse
7745
7746 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7747 Priority Enabled Name
7748 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7749
7750 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7751 Priority Enabled Name
7752 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7753 @end smallexample
7754 @end table
7755
7756 @node Source
7757 @chapter Examining Source Files
7758
7759 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7760 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7761 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7762 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7763 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7764 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7765 source files by explicit command.
7766
7767 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7768 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7769 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7770
7771 @menu
7772 * List:: Printing source lines
7773 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7774 * Edit:: Editing source files
7775 * Search:: Searching source files
7776 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7777 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7778 @end menu
7779
7780 @node List
7781 @section Printing Source Lines
7782
7783 @kindex list
7784 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7785 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7786 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7787 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7788 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7789
7790 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7791
7792 @table @code
7793 @item list @var{linenum}
7794 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7795 current source file.
7796
7797 @item list @var{function}
7798 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7799 @var{function}.
7800
7801 @item list
7802 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7803 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7804 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7805 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7806 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7807
7808 @item list -
7809 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7810 @end table
7811
7812 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7813 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7814 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7815
7816 @table @code
7817 @kindex set listsize
7818 @item set listsize @var{count}
7819 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7820 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7821 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7822 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7823
7824 @kindex show listsize
7825 @item show listsize
7826 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7827 @end table
7828
7829 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7830 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7831 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7832 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7833 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7834
7835 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7836 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7837 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7838 to specify some source line.
7839
7840 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7841
7842 @table @code
7843 @item list @var{location}
7844 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7845
7846 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7847 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7848 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7849 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7850 the same source file as the first location.
7851
7852 @item list ,@var{last}
7853 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7854
7855 @item list @var{first},
7856 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7857
7858 @item list +
7859 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7860
7861 @item list -
7862 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7863
7864 @item list
7865 As described in the preceding table.
7866 @end table
7867
7868 @node Specify Location
7869 @section Specifying a Location
7870 @cindex specifying location
7871 @cindex location
7872 @cindex source location
7873
7874 @menu
7875 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7876 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7877 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7878 @end menu
7879
7880 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7881 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7882 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7883 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7884 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7885
7886 @node Linespec Locations
7887 @subsection Linespec Locations
7888 @cindex linespec locations
7889
7890 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7891 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7892 specifying a linespec:
7893
7894 @table @code
7895 @item @var{linenum}
7896 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7897
7898 @item -@var{offset}
7899 @itemx +@var{offset}
7900 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7901 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7902 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7903 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7904 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7905 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7906 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7907 linespec.
7908
7909 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7910 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7911 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7912 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7913 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7914 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7915 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7916
7917 @item @var{function}
7918 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7919 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7920
7921 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
7922 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
7923 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
7924 means in all packages.
7925
7926 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
7927 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
7928 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
7929
7930 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
7931 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
7932 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
7933 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
7934
7935 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
7936
7937 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7938 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7939
7940 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7941 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7942 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7943 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7944 functions in different source files.
7945
7946 @item @var{label}
7947 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7948 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7949 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7950 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7951
7952 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7953 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7954 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7955 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7956 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7957 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7958
7959 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7960 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7961 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7962 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7963 each one of those probes.
7964 @end table
7965
7966 @node Explicit Locations
7967 @subsection Explicit Locations
7968 @cindex explicit locations
7969
7970 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7971 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7972
7973 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7974 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7975 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7976 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7977 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7978
7979 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7980 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7981 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7982 the symbol table to know.
7983
7984 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7985 following table:
7986
7987 @table @code
7988 @item -source @var{filename}
7989 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7990 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7991 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7992 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7993 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7994
7995 @item -function @var{function}
7996 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7997 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7998 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7999 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8000
8001 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8002 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8003 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8004 means in all packages.
8005
8006 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8007 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8008 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8009 breakpoint on both symbols.
8010
8011 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8012
8013 @item -qualified
8014
8015 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8016 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8017
8018 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8019 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8020 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8021
8022 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8023 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8024 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8025
8026 @item -label @var{label}
8027 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8028 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8029 selected stack frame.
8030
8031 @item -line @var{number}
8032 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8033 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8034 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8035 relative to the current line.
8036 @end table
8037
8038 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8039 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8040
8041 @node Address Locations
8042 @subsection Address Locations
8043 @cindex address locations
8044
8045 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8046 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8047
8048 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8049 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8050 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8051 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8052 source files.
8053
8054 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8055 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8056 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8057 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8058 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8059 of @var{address}:
8060
8061 @table @code
8062 @item @var{expression}
8063 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8064
8065 @item @var{funcaddr}
8066 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8067 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8068 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8069 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8070 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8071 (although the Pascal form also works).
8072
8073 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8074 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8075
8076 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8077 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8078 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8079 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8080 functions with identical names in different source files.
8081 @end table
8082
8083 @node Edit
8084 @section Editing Source Files
8085 @cindex editing source files
8086
8087 @kindex edit
8088 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8089 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8090 The editing program of your choice
8091 is invoked with the current line set to
8092 the active line in the program.
8093 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8094 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8095
8096 @table @code
8097 @item edit @var{location}
8098 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8099 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8100 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8101 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8102 command most commonly used:
8103
8104 @table @code
8105 @item edit @var{number}
8106 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8107
8108 @item edit @var{function}
8109 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8110 @end table
8111
8112 @end table
8113
8114 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8115 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8116 @footnote{
8117 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8118 following command-line syntax:
8119 @smallexample
8120 ex +@var{number} file
8121 @end smallexample
8122 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8123 the file where to start editing.}.
8124 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8125 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8126 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8127 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8128 @smallexample
8129 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8130 export EDITOR
8131 gdb @dots{}
8132 @end smallexample
8133 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8134 @smallexample
8135 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8136 gdb @dots{}
8137 @end smallexample
8138
8139 @node Search
8140 @section Searching Source Files
8141 @cindex searching source files
8142
8143 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8144 regular expression.
8145
8146 @table @code
8147 @kindex search
8148 @kindex forward-search
8149 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8150 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8151 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8152 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8153 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8154 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8155 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8156 @code{fo}.
8157
8158 @kindex reverse-search
8159 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8160 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8161 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8162 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8163 this command as @code{rev}.
8164 @end table
8165
8166 @node Source Path
8167 @section Specifying Source Directories
8168
8169 @cindex source path
8170 @cindex directories for source files
8171 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8172 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8173 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8174 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8175 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8176 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8177 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8178
8179 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8180 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8181 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8182 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8183 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8184 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8185 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8186 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8187 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8188 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8189 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8190
8191 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8192 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8193 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8194 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8195 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8196 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8197
8198 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8199 source files.
8200
8201 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8202 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8203 each line is in the file.
8204
8205 @kindex directory
8206 @kindex dir
8207 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8208 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8209 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8210
8211 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8212 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8213
8214 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8215 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8216 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8217 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8218 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8219 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8220 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8221 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8222 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8223 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8224 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8225 name to look up the sources.
8226
8227 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8228 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8229 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8230 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8231 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8232 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8233 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8234 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8235
8236 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8237 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8238 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8239 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8240 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8241 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8242 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8243
8244 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8245 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8246 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8247 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8248 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8249 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8250 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8251 command.
8252
8253 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8254 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8255 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8256 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8257 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8258 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8259 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8260
8261 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8262 @cindex default source path substitution
8263 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8264 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8265 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8266 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8267 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8268 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8269 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8270 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8271 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8272 together.
8273
8274 @table @code
8275 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8276 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8277 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8278 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8279 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8280 part of absolute file names) or
8281 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8282 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8283
8284 @kindex cdir
8285 @kindex cwd
8286 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8287 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8288 @cindex compilation directory
8289 @cindex current directory
8290 @cindex working directory
8291 @cindex directory, current
8292 @cindex directory, compilation
8293 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8294 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8295 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8296 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8297 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8298 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8299
8300 @item directory
8301 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8302
8303 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8304 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8305
8306 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8307 @kindex set directories
8308 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8309 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8310
8311 @item show directories
8312 @kindex show directories
8313 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8314
8315 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8316 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8317 @kindex set substitute-path
8318 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8319 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8320 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8321
8322 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8323 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8324
8325 @smallexample
8326 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8327 @end smallexample
8328
8329 @noindent
8330 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8331 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8332 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8333
8334 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8335 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8336 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8337 the substitution.
8338
8339 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8340
8341 @smallexample
8342 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8343 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8344 @end smallexample
8345
8346 @noindent
8347 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8348 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8349 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8350 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8351
8352
8353 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8354 @kindex unset substitute-path
8355 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8356 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8357 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8358
8359 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8360
8361 @item show substitute-path [path]
8362 @kindex show substitute-path
8363 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8364 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8365
8366 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8367 rules.
8368
8369 @end table
8370
8371 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8372 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8373 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8374
8375 @enumerate
8376 @item
8377 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8378
8379 @item
8380 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8381 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8382 directories in one command.
8383 @end enumerate
8384
8385 @node Machine Code
8386 @section Source and Machine Code
8387 @cindex source line and its code address
8388
8389 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8390 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8391 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8392 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8393 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8394 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8395 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8396 well as hex.
8397
8398 @table @code
8399 @kindex info line
8400 @item info line @var{location}
8401 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8402 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8403 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8404 @end table
8405
8406 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8407 the object code for the first line of function
8408 @code{m4_changequote}:
8409
8410 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8411 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8412 @smallexample
8413 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8414 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8415 @end smallexample
8416
8417 @noindent
8418 @cindex code address and its source line
8419 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8420 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8421 @smallexample
8422 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8423 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8424 @end smallexample
8425
8426 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8427 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8428 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8429 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8430 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8431 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8432 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8433 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8434 Variables}).
8435
8436 @table @code
8437 @kindex disassemble
8438 @cindex assembly instructions
8439 @cindex instructions, assembly
8440 @cindex machine instructions
8441 @cindex listing machine instructions
8442 @item disassemble
8443 @itemx disassemble /m
8444 @itemx disassemble /s
8445 @itemx disassemble /r
8446 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8447 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8448 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8449 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8450 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8451 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8452 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8453 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8454 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8455 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8456
8457 @table @code
8458 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8459 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8460 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8461 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8462 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8463 @end table
8464
8465 @noindent
8466 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8467 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8468
8469 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8470 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8471
8472 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8473 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8474 @end table
8475
8476 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8477 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8478
8479 @smallexample
8480 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8481 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8482 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8483 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8484 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8485 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8486 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8487 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8488 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8489 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8490 End of assembler dump.
8491 @end smallexample
8492
8493 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8494 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8495 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8496
8497 @smallexample
8498 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8499 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8500 5 @{
8501 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8502 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8503 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8504 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8505 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8506
8507 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8508 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8509 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8510
8511 7 return 0;
8512 8 @}
8513 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8514 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8515 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8516
8517 End of assembler dump.
8518 @end smallexample
8519
8520 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8521 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8522 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8523 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8524 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8525 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8526 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8527 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8528 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8529
8530 @file{foo.h}:
8531
8532 @smallexample
8533 int
8534 foo (int a)
8535 @{
8536 if (a < 0)
8537 return a * 2;
8538 if (a == 0)
8539 return 1;
8540 return a + 10;
8541 @}
8542 @end smallexample
8543
8544 @file{foo.c}:
8545
8546 @smallexample
8547 #include "foo.h"
8548 volatile int x, y;
8549 int
8550 main ()
8551 @{
8552 x = foo (y);
8553 return 0;
8554 @}
8555 @end smallexample
8556
8557 @smallexample
8558 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8559 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8560 5 @{
8561
8562 6 x = foo (y);
8563 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8564 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8565
8566 7 return 0;
8567 8 @}
8568 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8569 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8570 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8571 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8572
8573 End of assembler dump.
8574 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8575 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8576 foo.c:
8577 5 @{
8578 6 x = foo (y);
8579 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8580
8581 foo.h:
8582 4 if (a < 0)
8583 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8584 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8585
8586 6 if (a == 0)
8587 7 return 1;
8588 8 return a + 10;
8589 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8590 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8591 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8592 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8593
8594 foo.c:
8595 6 x = foo (y);
8596 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8597
8598 7 return 0;
8599 8 @}
8600 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8601 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8602
8603 foo.h:
8604 5 return a * 2;
8605 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8606 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8607 End of assembler dump.
8608 @end smallexample
8609
8610 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8611
8612 @smallexample
8613 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8614 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8615 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8616 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8617 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8618 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8619 End of assembler dump.
8620 @end smallexample
8621
8622 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8623 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8624 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8625 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8626
8627 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8628 mnemonics or other syntax.
8629
8630 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8631 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8632 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8633 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8634 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8635
8636 @table @code
8637 @kindex set disassembler-options
8638 @cindex disassembler options
8639 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8640 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8641 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8642 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8643 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8644 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8645 The default value is the empty string.
8646
8647 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8648 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8649 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8650 and S/390.
8651
8652 @kindex show disassembler-options
8653 @item show disassembler-options
8654 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8655 @end table
8656
8657 @table @code
8658 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8659 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8660 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8661 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8662 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8663 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8664
8665 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8666 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8667 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8668 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8669
8670 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8671 @item show disassembly-flavor
8672 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8673 @end table
8674
8675 @table @code
8676 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8677 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8678 @item set disassemble-next-line
8679 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8680 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8681 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8682 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8683 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8684 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8685 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8686 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8687 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8688 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8689 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8690 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8691 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8692 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8693 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8694 instruction.
8695 @end table
8696
8697
8698 @node Data
8699 @chapter Examining Data
8700
8701 @cindex printing data
8702 @cindex examining data
8703 @kindex print
8704 @kindex inspect
8705 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8706 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8707 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8708 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8709 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8710 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8711
8712 @table @code
8713 @item print @var{expr}
8714 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8715 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8716 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8717 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8718 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8719 Formats}.
8720
8721 @item print
8722 @itemx print /@var{f}
8723 @cindex reprint the last value
8724 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8725 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8726 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8727 @end table
8728
8729 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8730 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8731 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8732
8733 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8734 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8735 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8736 Table}.
8737
8738 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8739 @kindex explore
8740 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8741 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8742 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8743 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8744 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8745 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8746 embedded in the higher level data types.
8747
8748 @table @code
8749 @item explore @var{arg}
8750 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8751 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8752 @end table
8753
8754 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8755 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8756 C program as
8757
8758 @smallexample
8759 struct SimpleStruct
8760 @{
8761 int i;
8762 double d;
8763 @};
8764
8765 struct ComplexStruct
8766 @{
8767 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8768 int arr[10];
8769 @};
8770 @end smallexample
8771
8772 @noindent
8773 followed by variable declarations as
8774
8775 @smallexample
8776 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8777 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8778 @end smallexample
8779
8780 @noindent
8781 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8782 @code{explore} command as follows.
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785 (gdb) explore cs
8786 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8787 the following fields:
8788
8789 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8790 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8791
8792 Enter the field number of choice:
8793 @end smallexample
8794
8795 @noindent
8796 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8797 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8798 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8799 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8800 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8801 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8802 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8803 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8804
8805 @smallexample
8806 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8807 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8808 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8809 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8810
8811 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8812 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8813
8814 Press enter to return to parent value:
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 @noindent
8818 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8819 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8820 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8821 to explore.
8822
8823 @smallexample
8824 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8825 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8826
8827 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8828
8829 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8830
8831 Press enter to return to parent value:
8832 @end smallexample
8833
8834 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8835 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8836 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8837 level data structure).
8838
8839 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8840 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8841 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8842 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8843 same example as above, your can explore the type
8844 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8845 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8846
8847 @smallexample
8848 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8849 @end smallexample
8850
8851 @noindent
8852 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8853 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8854 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8855 example.
8856
8857 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8858 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8859 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8860 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8861 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8862
8863 @table @code
8864 @item explore value @var{expr}
8865 @cindex explore value
8866 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8867 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8868 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8869 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8870 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8871
8872 @item explore type @var{arg}
8873 @cindex explore type
8874 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8875 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8876 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8877 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8878 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8879 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8880 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8881 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8882 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8883 @end table
8884
8885 @menu
8886 * Expressions:: Expressions
8887 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8888 * Variables:: Program variables
8889 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8890 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8891 * Memory:: Examining memory
8892 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8893 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8894 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8895 * Value History:: Value history
8896 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8897 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8898 * Registers:: Registers
8899 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8900 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8901 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8902 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8903 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8904 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8905 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8906 character set than GDB does
8907 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8908 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8909 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8910 @end menu
8911
8912 @node Expressions
8913 @section Expressions
8914
8915 @cindex expressions
8916 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8917 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8918 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8919 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8920 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8921 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8922 @ref{Compilation}.
8923
8924 @cindex arrays in expressions
8925 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8926 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8927 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8928 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8929 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8930 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8931
8932 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8933 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8934 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8935 languages.
8936
8937 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8938 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8939
8940 @cindex casts, in expressions
8941 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8942 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8943 at that address in memory.
8944 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8945
8946 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8947 to programming languages:
8948
8949 @table @code
8950 @item @@
8951 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8952 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8953
8954 @item ::
8955 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8956 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8957
8958 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8959 @cindex type casting memory
8960 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8961 @cindex casts, to view memory
8962 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8963 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8964 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8965 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8966 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8967 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8968 @end table
8969
8970 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8971 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8972 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8973
8974 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8975 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8976 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8977 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8978 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8979 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8980 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8981
8982 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8983 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8984 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8985 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8986 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8987 as well.
8988
8989 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8990 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8991 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8992 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8993 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8994 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8995 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8996 choices.
8997
8998 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8999 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9000 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9001
9002 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9003 @smallexample
9004 @group
9005 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9006 [0] cancel
9007 [1] all
9008 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9009 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9010 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9011 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9012 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9013 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9014 > 2 4 6
9015 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9016 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9017 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9018 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9019 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9020 breakpoints.
9021 (@value{GDBP})
9022 @end group
9023 @end smallexample
9024
9025 @table @code
9026 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9027 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9028 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9029
9030 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9031 is ambiguous.
9032
9033 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9034 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9035 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9036 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9037 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9038 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9039 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9040 in the use of the menu.
9041
9042 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9043 when an ambiguity is detected.
9044
9045 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9046 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9047
9048 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9049 @item show multiple-symbols
9050 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9051 @end table
9052
9053 @node Variables
9054 @section Program Variables
9055
9056 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9057 in your program.
9058
9059 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9060 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9061
9062 @itemize @bullet
9063 @item
9064 global (or file-static)
9065 @end itemize
9066
9067 @noindent or
9068
9069 @itemize @bullet
9070 @item
9071 visible according to the scope rules of the
9072 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9073 @end itemize
9074
9075 @noindent This means that in the function
9076
9077 @smallexample
9078 foo (a)
9079 int a;
9080 @{
9081 bar (a);
9082 @{
9083 int b = test ();
9084 bar (b);
9085 @}
9086 @}
9087 @end smallexample
9088
9089 @noindent
9090 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9091 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9092 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9093 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9094
9095 @cindex variable name conflict
9096 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9097 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9098 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9099 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9100 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9101 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9102 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9103
9104 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9105 @ifnotinfo
9106 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9107 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9108 @end ifnotinfo
9109 @smallexample
9110 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9111 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9112 @end smallexample
9113
9114 @noindent
9115 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9116 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9117 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9118 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9119
9120 @smallexample
9121 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9122 @end smallexample
9123
9124 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9125 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9126 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9127 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9128 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9129
9130 @smallexample
9131 void
9132 foo (int a)
9133 @{
9134 if (a < 10)
9135 bar (a);
9136 else
9137 process (a); /* Stop here */
9138 @}
9139
9140 int
9141 bar (int a)
9142 @{
9143 foo (a + 5);
9144 @}
9145 @end smallexample
9146
9147 @noindent
9148 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9149 here is what you might see
9150 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9154 $1 = 10
9155 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9156 $2 = 5
9157 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9158 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9159 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9160 $3 = 5
9161 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9162 $4 = 0
9163 @end smallexample
9164
9165 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9166 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9167 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9168 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9169 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9170
9171 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9172 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9173 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9174 @code{some_global}.
9175
9176 @smallexample
9177 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9178 $1 = 23
9179 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9180 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9181 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9182 $2 = 27
9183 @end smallexample
9184
9185 @cindex wrong values
9186 @cindex variable values, wrong
9187 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9188 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9189 @quotation
9190 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9191 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9192 scope, and just before exit.
9193 @end quotation
9194 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9195 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9196 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9197 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9198 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9199 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9200 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9201 variable definitions may be gone.
9202
9203 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9204 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9205 when compiling.
9206
9207 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9208 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9209 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9210 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9211 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9212 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9213 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9214
9215 @smallexample
9216 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9217 @end smallexample
9218
9219 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9220 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9221 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9222 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9223 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9224
9225 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9226 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9227 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9228 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9229
9230 @cindex no debug info variables
9231 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9232 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9233 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9234 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9235 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9236 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9237 example, in a C program:
9238
9239 @smallexample
9240 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9241 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9242 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9243 $1 = 3.14
9244 @end smallexample
9245
9246 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9247 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9248 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9249 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9250 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9251
9252 @smallexample
9253 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9254 29 i++;
9255 (gdb) next
9256 30 e (i);
9257 (gdb) print i
9258 $1 = 31
9259 (gdb) print i@@entry
9260 $2 = 30
9261 @end smallexample
9262
9263 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9264 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9265 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9266 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9267 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9268 For program code
9269
9270 @smallexample
9271 char var0[] = "A";
9272 signed char var1[] = "A";
9273 @end smallexample
9274
9275 You get during debugging
9276 @smallexample
9277 (gdb) print var0
9278 $1 = "A"
9279 (gdb) print var1
9280 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9281 @end smallexample
9282
9283 @node Arrays
9284 @section Artificial Arrays
9285
9286 @cindex artificial array
9287 @cindex arrays
9288 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9289 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9290 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9291 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9292 program.
9293
9294 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9295 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9296 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9297 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9298 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9299 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9300 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9301 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9302 example. If a program says
9303
9304 @smallexample
9305 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9306 @end smallexample
9307
9308 @noindent
9309 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9310
9311 @smallexample
9312 p *array@@len
9313 @end smallexample
9314
9315 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9316 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9317 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9318 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9319 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9320
9321 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9322 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9323 The value need not be in memory:
9324 @smallexample
9325 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9326 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9327 @end smallexample
9328
9329 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9330 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9331 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9332 @smallexample
9333 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9334 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9335 @end smallexample
9336
9337 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9338 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9339 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9340 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9341 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9342 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9343 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9344 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9345 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9346 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9347
9348 @smallexample
9349 set $i = 0
9350 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9351 @key{RET}
9352 @key{RET}
9353 @dots{}
9354 @end smallexample
9355
9356 @node Output Formats
9357 @section Output Formats
9358
9359 @cindex formatted output
9360 @cindex output formats
9361 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9362 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9363 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9364 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9365 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9366
9367 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9368 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9369 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9370 letters supported are:
9371
9372 @table @code
9373 @item x
9374 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9375 hexadecimal.
9376
9377 @item d
9378 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9379
9380 @item u
9381 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9382
9383 @item o
9384 Print as integer in octal.
9385
9386 @item t
9387 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9388 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9389 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9390 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9391
9392 @item a
9393 @cindex unknown address, locating
9394 @cindex locate address
9395 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9396 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9397 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9398
9399 @smallexample
9400 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9401 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9402 @end smallexample
9403
9404 @noindent
9405 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9406 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9407
9408 @item c
9409 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9410 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9411 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9412 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9413
9414 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9415 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9416 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9417 data.
9418
9419 @item f
9420 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9421 using typical floating point syntax.
9422
9423 @item s
9424 @cindex printing strings
9425 @cindex printing byte arrays
9426 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9427 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9428 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9429 natural types.
9430
9431 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9432 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9433 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9434 array.
9435
9436 @item z
9437 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9438 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9439 to the size of the integer type.
9440
9441 @item r
9442 @cindex raw printing
9443 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9444 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9445 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9446 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9447 pretty-printer which might exist.
9448 @end table
9449
9450 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9451
9452 @smallexample
9453 p/x $pc
9454 @end smallexample
9455
9456 @noindent
9457 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9458 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9459
9460 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9461 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9462 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9463
9464 @node Memory
9465 @section Examining Memory
9466
9467 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9468 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9469
9470 @cindex examining memory
9471 @table @code
9472 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9473 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9474 @itemx x @var{addr}
9475 @itemx x
9476 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9477 @end table
9478
9479 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9480 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9481 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9482 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9483 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9484
9485 @table @r
9486 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9487 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9488 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9489 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9490 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9491 @c 4.1.2.
9492
9493 @item @var{f}, the display format
9494 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9495 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9496 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9497 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9498 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9499
9500 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9501 The unit size is any of
9502
9503 @table @code
9504 @item b
9505 Bytes.
9506 @item h
9507 Halfwords (two bytes).
9508 @item w
9509 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9510 @item g
9511 Giant words (eight bytes).
9512 @end table
9513
9514 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9515 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9516 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9517 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9518 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9519 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9520 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9521 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9522 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9523 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9524 be altered.
9525
9526 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9527 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9528 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9529 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9530 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9531 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9532 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9533 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9534 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9535 a value from memory).
9536 @end table
9537
9538 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9539 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9540 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9541 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9542 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9543
9544 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9545 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9546 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9547
9548 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9549 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9550 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9551 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9552 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9553
9554 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9555 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9556 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9557 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9558 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9559 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9560 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9561 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9562 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9563
9564 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9565 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9566 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9567 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9568 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9569 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9570
9571 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9572 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9573 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9574 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9575 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9576 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9577 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9578
9579 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9580 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9581
9582 @smallexample
9583 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9584 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9585 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9586 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9587 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9588 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9589 @end smallexample
9590
9591 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9592 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9593 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9594 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9595 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9596 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9597 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9598 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9599 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9600
9601 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9602 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9603 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9604
9605 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9606 @cindex addressable memory unit
9607 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9608 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9609 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9610 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9611 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9612 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9613 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9614 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9615 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9616
9617 @cindex remote memory comparison
9618 @cindex target memory comparison
9619 @cindex verify remote memory image
9620 @cindex verify target memory image
9621 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9622 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9623 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9624 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9625 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9626 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9627
9628 @table @code
9629 @kindex compare-sections
9630 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9631 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9632 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9633 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9634 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9635 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9636
9637 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9638 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9639 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9640 @end table
9641
9642 @node Auto Display
9643 @section Automatic Display
9644 @cindex automatic display
9645 @cindex display of expressions
9646
9647 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9648 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9649 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9650 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9651 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9652 The automatic display looks like this:
9653
9654 @smallexample
9655 2: foo = 38
9656 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9657 @end smallexample
9658
9659 @noindent
9660 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9661 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9662 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9663 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9664 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9665 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9666
9667 @table @code
9668 @kindex display
9669 @item display @var{expr}
9670 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9671 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9672
9673 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9674
9675 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9676 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9677 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9678 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9679 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9680
9681 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9682 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9683 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9684 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9685 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9686 @end table
9687
9688 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9689 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9690 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9691
9692 @table @code
9693 @kindex delete display
9694 @kindex undisplay
9695 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9696 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9697 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9698 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9699 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9700 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9701 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9702
9703 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9704 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9705
9706 @kindex disable display
9707 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9708 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9709 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9710 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9711 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9712 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9713 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9714 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9715
9716 @kindex enable display
9717 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9718 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9719 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9720 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9721 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9722 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9723 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9724
9725 @item display
9726 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9727 done when your program stops.
9728
9729 @kindex info display
9730 @item info display
9731 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9732 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9733 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9734 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9735 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9736 @end table
9737
9738 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9739 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9740 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9741 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9742 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9743 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9744 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9745 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9746 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9747 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9748 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9749
9750 @node Print Settings
9751 @section Print Settings
9752
9753 @cindex format options
9754 @cindex print settings
9755 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9756 and symbols are printed.
9757
9758 @noindent
9759 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9760
9761 @table @code
9762 @kindex set print
9763 @item set print address
9764 @itemx set print address on
9765 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9766 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9767 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9768 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9769 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9770 @code{set print address on}:
9771
9772 @smallexample
9773 @group
9774 (@value{GDBP}) f
9775 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9776 at input.c:530
9777 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9778 @end group
9779 @end smallexample
9780
9781 @item set print address off
9782 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9783 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9784
9785 @smallexample
9786 @group
9787 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9788 (@value{GDBP}) f
9789 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9790 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9791 @end group
9792 @end smallexample
9793
9794 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9795 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9796 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9797 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9798
9799 @kindex show print
9800 @item show print address
9801 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9802 @end table
9803
9804 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9805 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9806 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9807 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9808 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9809 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9810 it prints a symbolic address:
9811
9812 @table @code
9813 @item set print symbol-filename on
9814 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9815 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9816 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9817 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9818
9819 @item set print symbol-filename off
9820 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9821 default.
9822
9823 @item show print symbol-filename
9824 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9825 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9826 @end table
9827
9828 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9829 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9830 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9831
9832 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9833 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9834
9835 @table @code
9836 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9837 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9838 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9839 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9840 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9841 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9842 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9843 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9844
9845 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9846 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9847 symbolic address.
9848 @end table
9849
9850 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9851 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9852 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9853 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9854 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9855 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9856 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9857 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9858
9859 @smallexample
9860 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9861 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9862 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9863 @end smallexample
9864
9865 @quotation
9866 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9867 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9868 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9869 @end quotation
9870
9871 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9872 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9873
9874 @table @code
9875 @item set print symbol on
9876 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9877 one exists.
9878
9879 @item set print symbol off
9880 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9881 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9882 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9883
9884 @item show print symbol
9885 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9886 address.
9887 @end table
9888
9889 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9890
9891 @table @code
9892 @item set print array
9893 @itemx set print array on
9894 @cindex pretty print arrays
9895 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9896 but uses more space. The default is off.
9897
9898 @item set print array off
9899 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9900
9901 @item show print array
9902 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9903 arrays.
9904
9905 @cindex print array indexes
9906 @item set print array-indexes
9907 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9908 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9909 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9910 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9911
9912 @item set print array-indexes off
9913 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9914
9915 @item show print array-indexes
9916 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9917 arrays.
9918
9919 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9920 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9921 @cindex number of array elements to print
9922 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9923 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9924 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9925 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9926 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9927 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9928 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9929 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9930
9931 @item show print elements
9932 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9933 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9934
9935 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9936 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9937 @cindex printing frame argument values
9938 @cindex print all frame argument values
9939 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9940 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9941 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9942 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9943 values are:
9944
9945 @table @code
9946 @item all
9947 The values of all arguments are printed.
9948
9949 @item scalars
9950 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9951 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9952 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9953 only scalar arguments are shown:
9954
9955 @smallexample
9956 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9957 at frame-args.c:23
9958 @end smallexample
9959
9960 @item none
9961 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9962 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9963
9964 @smallexample
9965 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9966 at frame-args.c:23
9967 @end smallexample
9968 @end table
9969
9970 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9971 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9972 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9973 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9974 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9975 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9976 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9977 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9978 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9979 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9980
9981 @item show print frame-arguments
9982 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9983
9984 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9985 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9986
9987 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9988 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9989 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9990 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9991 This is the default.
9992
9993 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9994 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9995
9996 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9997 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9998 @kindex set print entry-values
9999 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10000 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10001 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10002 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10003 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10004
10005 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10006 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10007 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10008 @code{no} setting.
10009
10010 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10011 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10012 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10013 this information.
10014
10015 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10016
10017 @table @code
10018 @item no
10019 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10020 point.
10021 @smallexample
10022 #0 equal (val=5)
10023 #0 different (val=6)
10024 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10025 #0 born (val=10)
10026 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10027 @end smallexample
10028
10029 @item only
10030 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10031 values are never printed.
10032 @smallexample
10033 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10034 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10035 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10036 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10037 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10038 @end smallexample
10039
10040 @item preferred
10041 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10042 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10043 value for such parameter.
10044 @smallexample
10045 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10046 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10047 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10048 #0 born (val=10)
10049 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10050 @end smallexample
10051
10052 @item if-needed
10053 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10054 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10055 parameter.
10056 @smallexample
10057 #0 equal (val=5)
10058 #0 different (val=6)
10059 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10060 #0 born (val=10)
10061 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10062 @end smallexample
10063
10064 @item both
10065 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10066 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10067 optimizations.
10068 @smallexample
10069 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10070 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10071 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10072 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10073 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10074 @end smallexample
10075
10076 @item compact
10077 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10078 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10079 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10080 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10081 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10082 @smallexample
10083 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10084 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10085 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10086 #0 born (val=10)
10087 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10088 @end smallexample
10089
10090 @item default
10091 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10092 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10093 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10094 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10095 @smallexample
10096 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10097 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10098 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10099 #0 born (val=10)
10100 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10101 @end smallexample
10102 @end table
10103
10104 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10105 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10106
10107 @item show print entry-values
10108 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10109 entry.
10110
10111 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10112 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10113 @cindex repeated array elements
10114 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10115 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10116 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10117 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10118 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10119 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10120 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10121 is 10.
10122
10123 @item show print repeats
10124 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10125 elements.
10126
10127 @item set print null-stop
10128 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10129 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10130 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10131 contain only short strings.
10132 The default is off.
10133
10134 @item show print null-stop
10135 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10136 @sc{null} character.
10137
10138 @item set print pretty on
10139 @cindex print structures in indented form
10140 @cindex indentation in structure display
10141 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10142 per line, like this:
10143
10144 @smallexample
10145 @group
10146 $1 = @{
10147 next = 0x0,
10148 flags = @{
10149 sweet = 1,
10150 sour = 1
10151 @},
10152 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10153 @}
10154 @end group
10155 @end smallexample
10156
10157 @item set print pretty off
10158 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10159
10160 @smallexample
10161 @group
10162 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10163 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10164 @end group
10165 @end smallexample
10166
10167 @noindent
10168 This is the default format.
10169
10170 @item show print pretty
10171 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10172
10173 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10174 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10175 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10176 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10177 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10178 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10179 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10180 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10181
10182 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10183 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10184 international character sets, and is the default.
10185
10186 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10187 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10188
10189 @item set print union on
10190 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10191 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10192 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10193
10194 @item set print union off
10195 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10196 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10197 instead.
10198
10199 @item show print union
10200 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10201 structures and other unions.
10202
10203 For example, given the declarations
10204
10205 @smallexample
10206 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10207 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10208 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10209 Bug_forms;
10210
10211 struct thing @{
10212 Species it;
10213 union @{
10214 Tree_forms tree;
10215 Bug_forms bug;
10216 @} form;
10217 @};
10218
10219 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10220 @end smallexample
10221
10222 @noindent
10223 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10224
10225 @smallexample
10226 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10227 @end smallexample
10228
10229 @noindent
10230 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10231
10232 @smallexample
10233 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10234 @end smallexample
10235
10236 @noindent
10237 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10238 and in Pascal.
10239 @end table
10240
10241 @need 1000
10242 @noindent
10243 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10244
10245 @table @code
10246 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10247 @item set print demangle
10248 @itemx set print demangle on
10249 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10250 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10251 linkage. The default is on.
10252
10253 @item show print demangle
10254 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10255
10256 @item set print asm-demangle
10257 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10258 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10259 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10260 The default is off.
10261
10262 @item show print asm-demangle
10263 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10264 or demangled form.
10265
10266 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10267 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10268 @kindex set demangle-style
10269 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10270 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10271 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10272
10273 @table @code
10274 @item auto
10275 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10276 This is the default.
10277
10278 @item gnu
10279 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10280
10281 @item hp
10282 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10283
10284 @item lucid
10285 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10286
10287 @item arm
10288 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10289 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10290 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10291 require further enhancement to permit that.
10292
10293 @end table
10294 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10295
10296 @item show demangle-style
10297 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10298
10299 @item set print object
10300 @itemx set print object on
10301 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10302 @cindex display derived types
10303 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10304 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10305 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10306 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10307 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10308 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10309 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10310
10311 @item set print object off
10312 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10313 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10314
10315 @item show print object
10316 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10317
10318 @item set print static-members
10319 @itemx set print static-members on
10320 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10321 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10322
10323 @item set print static-members off
10324 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10325
10326 @item show print static-members
10327 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10328
10329 @item set print pascal_static-members
10330 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10331 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10332 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10333 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10334
10335 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10336 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10337
10338 @item show print pascal_static-members
10339 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10340
10341 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10342 @item set print vtbl
10343 @itemx set print vtbl on
10344 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10345 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10346 @cindex VTBL display
10347 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10348 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10349 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10350
10351 @item set print vtbl off
10352 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10353
10354 @item show print vtbl
10355 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10356 @end table
10357
10358 @node Pretty Printing
10359 @section Pretty Printing
10360
10361 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10362 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10363 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10364
10365 @menu
10366 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10367 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10368 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10369 @end menu
10370
10371 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10372 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10373
10374 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10375 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10376 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10377
10378 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10379 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10380 pretty-printers with their names.
10381 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10382 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10383 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10384 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10385
10386 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10387 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10388 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10389 do anything special.
10390
10391 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10392
10393 @itemize @bullet
10394 @item
10395 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10396 all inferiors.
10397
10398 @item
10399 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10400 when debugging that program.
10401 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10402
10403 @item
10404 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10405 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10406 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10407 @end itemize
10408
10409 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10410 pretty-printers are selected,
10411
10412 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10413 for new types.
10414
10415 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10416 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10417
10418 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10419
10420 @smallexample
10421 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10422 $1 = @{
10423 static npos = 4294967295,
10424 _M_dataplus = @{
10425 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10426 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10427 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10428 @},
10429 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10430 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10431 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10432 @}
10433 @}
10434 @end smallexample
10435
10436 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10437
10438 @smallexample
10439 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10440 $2 = "abcd"
10441 @end smallexample
10442
10443 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10444 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10445 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10446
10447 @table @code
10448 @kindex info pretty-printer
10449 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10450 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10451 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10452
10453 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10454 whose pretty-printers to list.
10455 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10456 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10457 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10458 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10459 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10460
10461 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10462 to list.
10463
10464 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10465 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10466 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10467 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10468
10469 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10470 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10471 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10472 @end table
10473
10474 Example:
10475
10476 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10477 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10478 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10479 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10480
10481 @smallexample
10482 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10483 library1.so:
10484 foo
10485 library2.so:
10486 bar
10487 bar1
10488 bar2
10489 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10490 library2.so:
10491 bar
10492 bar1
10493 bar2
10494 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10495 1 printer disabled
10496 2 of 3 printers enabled
10497 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10498 library1.so:
10499 foo [disabled]
10500 library2.so:
10501 bar
10502 bar1
10503 bar2
10504 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10505 1 printer disabled
10506 1 of 3 printers enabled
10507 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10508 library1.so:
10509 foo [disabled]
10510 library2.so:
10511 bar
10512 bar1 [disabled]
10513 bar2
10514 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10515 1 printer disabled
10516 0 of 3 printers enabled
10517 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10518 library1.so:
10519 foo [disabled]
10520 library2.so:
10521 bar [disabled]
10522 bar1 [disabled]
10523 bar2
10524 @end smallexample
10525
10526 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10527 as can each individual subprinter.
10528
10529 @node Value History
10530 @section Value History
10531
10532 @cindex value history
10533 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10534 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10535 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10536 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10537 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10538 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10539 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10540 symbol table.
10541
10542 @cindex @code{$}
10543 @cindex @code{$$}
10544 @cindex history number
10545 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10546 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10547 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10548 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10549 history number.
10550
10551 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10552 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10553 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10554 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10555 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10556 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10557 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10558
10559 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10560 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10561
10562 @smallexample
10563 p *$
10564 @end smallexample
10565
10566 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10567 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10568
10569 @smallexample
10570 p *$.next
10571 @end smallexample
10572
10573 @noindent
10574 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10575 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10576
10577 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10578 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10579
10580 @smallexample
10581 print x
10582 set x=5
10583 @end smallexample
10584
10585 @noindent
10586 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10587 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10588
10589 @table @code
10590 @kindex show values
10591 @item show values
10592 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10593 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10594 values} does not change the history.
10595
10596 @item show values @var{n}
10597 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10598
10599 @item show values +
10600 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10601 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10602 @end table
10603
10604 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10605 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10606
10607 @node Convenience Vars
10608 @section Convenience Variables
10609
10610 @cindex convenience variables
10611 @cindex user-defined variables
10612 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10613 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10614 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10615 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10616 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10617
10618 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10619 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10620 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10621 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10622 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10623
10624 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10625 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10626 For example:
10627
10628 @smallexample
10629 set $foo = *object_ptr
10630 @end smallexample
10631
10632 @noindent
10633 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10634 @code{object_ptr}.
10635
10636 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10637 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10638 value with another assignment at any time.
10639
10640 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10641 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10642 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10643 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10644
10645 @table @code
10646 @kindex show convenience
10647 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10648 @item show convenience
10649 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10650 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10651 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10652
10653 @kindex init-if-undefined
10654 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10655 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10656 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10657 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10658 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10659 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10660 override default values used in a command script.
10661
10662 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10663 any side-effects do not occur.
10664 @end table
10665
10666 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10667 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10668 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10669
10670 @smallexample
10671 set $i = 0
10672 print bar[$i++]->contents
10673 @end smallexample
10674
10675 @noindent
10676 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10677
10678 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10679 values likely to be useful.
10680
10681 @table @code
10682 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10683 @item $_
10684 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10685 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10686 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10687 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10688 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10689 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10690 to the type of @code{$__}.
10691
10692 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10693 @item $__
10694 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10695 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10696 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10697
10698 @item $_exitcode
10699 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10700 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10701 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10702 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10703
10704 @item $_exitsignal
10705 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10706 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10707 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10708 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10709
10710 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10711 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10712 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10713 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10714 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10715
10716 @smallexample
10717 #include <signal.h>
10718
10719 int
10720 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10721 @{
10722 raise (SIGALRM);
10723 return 0;
10724 @}
10725 @end smallexample
10726
10727 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10728 or signalled would be:
10729
10730 @smallexample
10731 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10732 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10733 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10734 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10735 >echo The program has exited\n
10736 >else
10737 >echo The program has signalled\n
10738 >end
10739 >end
10740 (@value{GDBP}) run
10741 Starting program:
10742
10743 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10744 The program no longer exists.
10745 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10746 The program has signalled
10747 @end smallexample
10748
10749 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10750 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10751 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10752 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10753
10754 @smallexample
10755 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10756 The program has exited
10757 @end smallexample
10758
10759 @item $_exception
10760 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10761 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10762
10763 @item $_probe_argc
10764 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10765 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10766
10767 @item $_sdata
10768 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10769 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10770 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10771 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10772 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10773
10774 @item $_siginfo
10775 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10776 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10777 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10778 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10779 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10780
10781 @item $_tlb
10782 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10783 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10784 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10785 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10786 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10787 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10788
10789 @item $_inferior
10790 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10791 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10792
10793 @item $_thread
10794 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10795
10796 @item $_gthread
10797 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10798
10799 @end table
10800
10801 @node Convenience Funs
10802 @section Convenience Functions
10803
10804 @cindex convenience functions
10805 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10806 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10807 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10808 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10809 @value{GDBN}.
10810
10811 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10812 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10813
10814 @table @code
10815
10816 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10817 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10818 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10819 returns zero.
10820
10821 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10822 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10823 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10824 it is @code{void}:
10825
10826 @smallexample
10827 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10828 $1 = void
10829 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10830 $2 = 1
10831 (@value{GDBP}) run
10832 Starting program: ./a.out
10833 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10834 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10835 $3 = 0
10836 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10837 $4 = 0
10838 @end smallexample
10839
10840 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10841 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10842 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10843 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10844 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10845 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10846 anymore.
10847
10848 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10849 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10850
10851 @smallexample
10852 void
10853 foo (void)
10854 @{
10855 @}
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10859
10860 @smallexample
10861 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10862 $1 = void
10863 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10864 $2 = 1
10865 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10866 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10867 $3 = void
10868 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10869 $4 = 1
10870 @end smallexample
10871
10872 @end table
10873
10874 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10875 @code{Python} support.
10876
10877 @table @code
10878
10879 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10880 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10881 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10882 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10883 Otherwise it returns zero.
10884
10885 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10886 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10887 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10888 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10889 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10890 regular expression support.
10891
10892 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10893 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10894 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10895 Otherwise it returns zero.
10896
10897 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10898 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10899 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10900
10901 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10902 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10903 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10904 Otherwise it returns zero.
10905
10906 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10907 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10908 The default is 1.
10909
10910 Example:
10911
10912 @smallexample
10913 (gdb) backtrace
10914 #0 bottom_func ()
10915 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10916 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10917 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10918 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10919 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10920 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10921 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10922 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10923 $1 = 1
10924 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10925 $1 = 1
10926 @end smallexample
10927
10928 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10929 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10930 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10931 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10932
10933 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10934 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10935 The default is 1.
10936
10937 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10938 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10939 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10940 Otherwise it returns zero.
10941
10942 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10943 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10944 The default is 1.
10945
10946 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10947 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10948 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10949 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10950
10951 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10952 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10953 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10954 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10955
10956 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10957 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10958 The default is 1.
10959
10960 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10961 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10962 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10963 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10964
10965 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10966 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10967 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10968
10969 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10970 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10971 an enumerated type:
10972
10973 @smallexample
10974 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10975 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10976 @end smallexample
10977
10978 @end table
10979
10980 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10981 convenience functions.
10982
10983 @table @code
10984 @item help function
10985 @kindex help function
10986 @cindex show all convenience functions
10987 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10988 @end table
10989
10990 @node Registers
10991 @section Registers
10992
10993 @cindex registers
10994 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10995 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10996 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10997 your machine.
10998
10999 @table @code
11000 @kindex info registers
11001 @item info registers
11002 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11003 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11004
11005 @kindex info all-registers
11006 @cindex floating point registers
11007 @item info all-registers
11008 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11009 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11010
11011 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11012 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11013 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11014 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11015 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11016 @end table
11017
11018 @anchor{standard registers}
11019 @cindex stack pointer register
11020 @cindex program counter register
11021 @cindex process status register
11022 @cindex frame pointer register
11023 @cindex standard registers
11024 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11025 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11026 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11027 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11028 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11029 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11030 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11031 you could print the program counter in hex with
11032
11033 @smallexample
11034 p/x $pc
11035 @end smallexample
11036
11037 @noindent
11038 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11039
11040 @smallexample
11041 x/i $pc
11042 @end smallexample
11043
11044 @noindent
11045 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11046 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11047 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11048 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11049 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11050 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11051 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11052
11053 @smallexample
11054 set $sp += 4
11055 @end smallexample
11056
11057 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11058 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11059 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11060 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11061 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11062 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11063 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11064
11065 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11066 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11067 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11068 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11069 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11070 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11071 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11072
11073 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11074 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11075 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11076 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11077 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11078 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11079 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11080 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11081 prints the data in both formats.
11082
11083 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11084 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11085 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11086 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11087 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11088 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11089 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11090
11091 @smallexample
11092 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11093 $1 = @{
11094 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11095 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11096 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11097 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11098 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11099 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11100 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11101 @}
11102 @end smallexample
11103
11104 @noindent
11105 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11106 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11107 value to a @code{struct} member:
11108
11109 @smallexample
11110 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11111 @end smallexample
11112
11113 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11114 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11115 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11116 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11117 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11118 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11119
11120 @cindex caller-saved registers
11121 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11122 @cindex volatile registers
11123 @cindex <not saved> values
11124 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11125 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11126 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11127 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11128 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11129 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11130 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11131 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11132 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11133 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11134 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11135 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11136 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11137 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11138 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11139 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11140 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11141 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11142 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11143 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11144 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11145 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11146 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11147
11148 @node Floating Point Hardware
11149 @section Floating Point Hardware
11150 @cindex floating point
11151
11152 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11153 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11154
11155 @table @code
11156 @kindex info float
11157 @item info float
11158 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11159 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11160 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11161 the ARM and x86 machines.
11162 @end table
11163
11164 @node Vector Unit
11165 @section Vector Unit
11166 @cindex vector unit
11167
11168 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11169 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11170
11171 @table @code
11172 @kindex info vector
11173 @item info vector
11174 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11175 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11176 @end table
11177
11178 @node OS Information
11179 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11180 @cindex OS information
11181
11182 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11183 you debug your program.
11184
11185 @cindex auxiliary vector
11186 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11187 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11188 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11189 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11190 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11191 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11192 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11193 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11194 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11195 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11196 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11197 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11198
11199 @table @code
11200 @kindex info auxv
11201 @item info auxv
11202 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11203 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11204 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11205 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11206 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11207 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11208 an unrecognized tag.
11209 @end table
11210
11211 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11212 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11213 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11214 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11215 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11216 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11217 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11218
11219 @table @code
11220 @kindex info os
11221 @item info os @var{infotype}
11222
11223 Display OS information of the requested type.
11224
11225 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11226
11227 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11228 @table @code
11229 @kindex info os cpus
11230 @item cpus
11231 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11232 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11233 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11234 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11235 kernel initialization.
11236
11237 @kindex info os files
11238 @item files
11239 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11240 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11241 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11242 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11243
11244 @kindex info os modules
11245 @item modules
11246 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11247 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11248 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11249 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11250 in memory.
11251
11252 @kindex info os msg
11253 @item msg
11254 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11255 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11256 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11257 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11258 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11259 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11260 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11261 the message queue was last changed.
11262
11263 @kindex info os processes
11264 @item processes
11265 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11266 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11267 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11268 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11269 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11270 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11271
11272 @kindex info os procgroups
11273 @item procgroups
11274 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11275 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11276 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11277 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11278 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11279 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11280 and the process group leader is listed first.
11281
11282 @kindex info os semaphores
11283 @item semaphores
11284 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11285 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11286 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11287 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11288 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11289
11290 @kindex info os shm
11291 @item shm
11292 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11293 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11294 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11295 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11296 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11297 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11298 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11299
11300 @kindex info os sockets
11301 @item sockets
11302 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11303 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11304 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11305 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11306 connection.
11307
11308 @kindex info os threads
11309 @item threads
11310 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11311 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11312 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11313 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11314 process is not listed.
11315 @end table
11316
11317 @item info os
11318 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11319 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11320 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11321 types, this command will report an error.
11322 @end table
11323
11324 @node Memory Region Attributes
11325 @section Memory Region Attributes
11326 @cindex memory region attributes
11327
11328 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11329 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11330 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11331 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11332 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11333 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11334 user can override the fetched regions.
11335
11336 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11337 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11338 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11339 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11340 all memory.
11341
11342 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11343 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11344
11345 @table @code
11346 @kindex mem
11347 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11348 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11349 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11350 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11351 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11352 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11353
11354 @item mem auto
11355 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11356 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11357
11358 @kindex delete mem
11359 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11360 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11361 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11362
11363 @kindex disable mem
11364 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11365 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11366 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11367 It may be enabled again later.
11368
11369 @kindex enable mem
11370 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11371 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11372
11373 @kindex info mem
11374 @item info mem
11375 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11376 for each region:
11377
11378 @table @emph
11379 @item Memory Region Number
11380 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11381 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11382 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11383
11384 @item Lo Address
11385 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11386
11387 @item Hi Address
11388 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11389
11390 @item Attributes
11391 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11392 @end table
11393 @end table
11394
11395
11396 @subsection Attributes
11397
11398 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11399 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11400 write accesses to a memory region.
11401
11402 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11403 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11404 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11405
11406 @table @code
11407 @item ro
11408 Memory is read only.
11409 @item wo
11410 Memory is write only.
11411 @item rw
11412 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11413 @end table
11414
11415 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11416 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11417 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11418 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11419 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11420
11421 @table @code
11422 @item 8
11423 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11424 @item 16
11425 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11426 @item 32
11427 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11428 @item 64
11429 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11430 @end table
11431
11432 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11433 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11434 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11435 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11436 @c
11437 @c @table @code
11438 @c @item hwbreak
11439 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11440 @c @item swbreak (default)
11441 @c @end table
11442
11443 @subsubsection Data Cache
11444 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11445 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11446 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11447 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11448 registers.
11449
11450 @table @code
11451 @item cache
11452 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11453 @item nocache
11454 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11455 @end table
11456
11457 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11458 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11459 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11460 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11461 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11462
11463 @table @code
11464 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11465 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11466 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11467 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11468 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11469 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11470 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11471 The default value is @code{on}.
11472 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11473 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11474 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11475 @end table
11476
11477
11478 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11479 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11480 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11481 @c
11482 @c @table @code
11483 @c @item verify
11484 @c @item noverify (default)
11485 @c @end table
11486
11487 @node Dump/Restore Files
11488 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11489 @cindex dump/restore files
11490 @cindex append data to a file
11491 @cindex dump data to a file
11492 @cindex restore data from a file
11493
11494 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11495 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11496 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11497 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11498 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11499 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11500 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11501
11502 @table @code
11503
11504 @kindex dump
11505 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11506 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11507 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11508 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11509
11510 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11511 @table @code
11512 @item binary
11513 Raw binary form.
11514 @item ihex
11515 Intel hex format.
11516 @item srec
11517 Motorola S-record format.
11518 @item tekhex
11519 Tektronix Hex format.
11520 @item verilog
11521 Verilog Hex format.
11522 @end table
11523
11524 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11525 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11526 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11527 form.
11528
11529 @kindex append
11530 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11531 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11532 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11533 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11534 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11535
11536 @kindex restore
11537 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11538 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11539 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11540 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11541 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11542
11543 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11544 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11545 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11546 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11547 from that location.
11548
11549 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11550 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11551 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11552 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11553
11554 @end table
11555
11556 @node Core File Generation
11557 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11558 @cindex dump core from inferior
11559
11560 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11561 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11562 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11563 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11564 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11565 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11566 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11567
11568 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11569 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11570 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11571
11572 @table @code
11573 @kindex gcore
11574 @kindex generate-core-file
11575 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11576 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11577 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11578 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11579 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11580 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11581
11582 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11583 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11584
11585 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11586 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11587 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11588
11589 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11590 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11591 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11592 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11593 Enable or disable the use of the file
11594 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11595 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11596 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11597 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11598
11599 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11600 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11601 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11602 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11603 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11604 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11605 about the bits that can be set in the
11606 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11607 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11608
11609 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11610 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11611 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11612 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11613 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11614 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11615 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11616 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11617 @end table
11618
11619 @node Character Sets
11620 @section Character Sets
11621 @cindex character sets
11622 @cindex charset
11623 @cindex translating between character sets
11624 @cindex host character set
11625 @cindex target character set
11626
11627 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11628 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11629 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11630 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11631 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11632 @dfn{target character set}.
11633
11634 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11635 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11636 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11637 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11638 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11639 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11640 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11641 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11642 character and string literals in expressions.
11643
11644 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11645 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11646 target-charset} command, described below.
11647
11648 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11649 support:
11650
11651 @table @code
11652 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11653 @kindex set target-charset
11654 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11655 list of supported target character sets, type
11656 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11657
11658 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11659 @kindex set host-charset
11660 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11661
11662 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11663 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11664 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11665 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11666 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11667
11668 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11669 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11670 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11671
11672 @item set charset @var{charset}
11673 @kindex set charset
11674 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11675 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11676 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11677 for both host and target.
11678
11679 @item show charset
11680 @kindex show charset
11681 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11682
11683 @item show host-charset
11684 @kindex show host-charset
11685 Show the name of the current host character set.
11686
11687 @item show target-charset
11688 @kindex show target-charset
11689 Show the name of the current target character set.
11690
11691 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11692 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11693 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11694 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11695 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11696 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11697
11698 @item show target-wide-charset
11699 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11700 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11701 @end table
11702
11703 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11704 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11705 @file{charset-test.c}:
11706
11707 @smallexample
11708 #include <stdio.h>
11709
11710 char ascii_hello[]
11711 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11712 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11713 char ibm1047_hello[]
11714 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11715 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11716
11717 main ()
11718 @{
11719 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11720 @}
11721 @end smallexample
11722
11723 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11724 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11725 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11726
11727 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11728
11729 @smallexample
11730 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11731 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11732 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11733 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11734 @dots{}
11735 (@value{GDBP})
11736 @end smallexample
11737
11738 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11739 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11740 strings:
11741
11742 @smallexample
11743 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11744 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11745 (@value{GDBP})
11746 @end smallexample
11747
11748 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11749 initial character set:
11750 @smallexample
11751 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11752 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11753 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11754 (@value{GDBP})
11755 @end smallexample
11756
11757 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11758 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11759 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11760 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11761 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11762
11763 @smallexample
11764 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11765 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11766 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11767 $2 = 72 'H'
11768 (@value{GDBP})
11769 @end smallexample
11770
11771 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11772 literals you use in expressions:
11773
11774 @smallexample
11775 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11776 $3 = 43 '+'
11777 (@value{GDBP})
11778 @end smallexample
11779
11780 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11781 character.
11782
11783 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11784 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11785 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11786
11787 @smallexample
11788 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11789 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11790 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11791 $5 = 200 '\310'
11792 (@value{GDBP})
11793 @end smallexample
11794
11795 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11796 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11797
11798 @smallexample
11799 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11800 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11801 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11802 @end smallexample
11803
11804 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11805 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11806 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11807 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11808 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11809
11810 @smallexample
11811 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11812 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11813 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11814 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11815 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11816 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11817 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11818 $7 = 72 '\110'
11819 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11820 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11821 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11822 $9 = 200 'H'
11823 (@value{GDBP})
11824 @end smallexample
11825
11826 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11827 string literals you use in expressions:
11828
11829 @smallexample
11830 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11831 $10 = 78 '+'
11832 (@value{GDBP})
11833 @end smallexample
11834
11835 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11836 character.
11837
11838 @node Caching Target Data
11839 @section Caching Data of Targets
11840 @cindex caching data of targets
11841
11842 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11843 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11844 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11845 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11846 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11847 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11848 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11849 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11850 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11851 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11852 is executing.
11853 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11854 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11855 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11856 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11857 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11858 in the code segment.
11859 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11860 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11861
11862 @table @code
11863 @kindex set remotecache
11864 @item set remotecache on
11865 @itemx set remotecache off
11866 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11867 with old scripts.
11868
11869 @kindex show remotecache
11870 @item show remotecache
11871 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11872
11873 @kindex set stack-cache
11874 @item set stack-cache on
11875 @itemx set stack-cache off
11876 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11877 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11878
11879 @kindex show stack-cache
11880 @item show stack-cache
11881 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11882
11883 @kindex set code-cache
11884 @item set code-cache on
11885 @itemx set code-cache off
11886 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11887 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11888 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11889
11890 @kindex show code-cache
11891 @item show code-cache
11892 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11893 accesses.
11894
11895 @kindex info dcache
11896 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11897 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11898 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11899 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11900 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11901 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11902
11903 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11904 printed in hex.
11905
11906 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11907 @cindex dcache size
11908 @kindex set dcache size
11909 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11910
11911 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11912 @cindex dcache line-size
11913 @kindex set dcache line-size
11914 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11915 Must be a power of 2.
11916
11917 @item show dcache size
11918 @kindex show dcache size
11919 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11920
11921 @item show dcache line-size
11922 @kindex show dcache line-size
11923 Show default size of dcache lines.
11924
11925 @end table
11926
11927 @node Searching Memory
11928 @section Search Memory
11929 @cindex searching memory
11930
11931 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11932 @code{find} command.
11933
11934 @table @code
11935 @kindex find
11936 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11937 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11938 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11939 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11940 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11941 @end table
11942
11943 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11944 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11945
11946 @table @r
11947 @item @var{s}, search query size
11948 The size of each search query value.
11949
11950 @table @code
11951 @item b
11952 bytes
11953 @item h
11954 halfwords (two bytes)
11955 @item w
11956 words (four bytes)
11957 @item g
11958 giant words (eight bytes)
11959 @end table
11960
11961 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11962 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11963 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11964 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
11965 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
11966
11967 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11968 value's type in the current language.
11969 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11970 pattern as a mixture of types.
11971 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11972 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11973 which is typically four bytes.
11974
11975 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11976 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11977 @end table
11978
11979 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11980 (@code{"}).
11981 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11982 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11983
11984 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11985 number of matches found.
11986
11987 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11988 @samp{$_}.
11989 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11990
11991 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11992
11993 @smallexample
11994 void
11995 hello ()
11996 @{
11997 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11998 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11999 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12000 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12001 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12002 @}
12003 @end smallexample
12004
12005 @noindent
12006 you get during debugging:
12007
12008 @smallexample
12009 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12010 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12011 1 pattern found
12012 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12013 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12014 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12015 2 patterns found.
12016 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12017 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12018 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12019 2 patterns found.
12020 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12021 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12022 1 pattern found
12023 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12024 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12025 1 pattern found
12026 (gdb) print $numfound
12027 $1 = 1
12028 (gdb) print $_
12029 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12030 @end smallexample
12031
12032 @node Value Sizes
12033 @section Value Sizes
12034
12035 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12036 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12037 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12038 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12039 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12040
12041 @table @code
12042 @kindex set max-value-size
12043 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12044 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12045 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12046 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12047 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12048
12049 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12050 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12051
12052 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12053 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12054 currently 16 bytes.
12055
12056 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12057 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12058 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12059 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12060 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12061 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12062 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12063 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12064
12065 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12066
12067 @kindex show max-value-size
12068 @item show max-value-size
12069 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12070 allocate for the contents of a value.
12071 @end table
12072
12073 @node Optimized Code
12074 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12075 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12076 @cindex debugging optimized code
12077
12078 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12079 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12080 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12081 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12082 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12083 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12084 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12085
12086 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12087 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12088 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12089 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12090
12091 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12092 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12093 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12094 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12095 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12096 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12097
12098 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12099 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12100 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12101 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12102 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12103
12104 @menu
12105 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12106 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12107 @end menu
12108
12109 @node Inline Functions
12110 @section Inline Functions
12111 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12112
12113 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12114 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12115 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12116 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12117 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12118 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12119 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12120 @code{info frame} command.
12121
12122 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12123 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12124 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12125 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12126 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12127 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12128 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12129 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12130 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12131 local variables in the caller.
12132
12133 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12134 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12135 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12136 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12137 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12138 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12139 instructions are executed.
12140
12141 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12142 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12143 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12144 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12145
12146 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12147 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12148
12149 @itemize @bullet
12150 @item
12151 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12152 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12153 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12154 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12155 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12156 or inside the inlined function instead.
12157
12158 @item
12159 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12160 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12161 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12162 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12163
12164 @end itemize
12165
12166 @node Tail Call Frames
12167 @section Tail Call Frames
12168 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12169
12170 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12171 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12172 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12173 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12174 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12175
12176 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12177 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12178 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12179 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12180 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12181 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12182 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12183
12184 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12185 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12186 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12187 this information.
12188
12189 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12190 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12191
12192 @smallexample
12193 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12194 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12195 (gdb) info frame
12196 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12197 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12198 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12199 source language c++.
12200 Arglist at unknown address.
12201 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12202 @end smallexample
12203
12204 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12205 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12206 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12207 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12208 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12209 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12210
12211 @table @code
12212 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12213 @item set debug entry-values
12214 @kindex set debug entry-values
12215 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12216 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12217 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12218 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12219 result.
12220
12221 @item show debug entry-values
12222 @kindex show debug entry-values
12223 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12224 values at function entry and tail calls.
12225 @end table
12226
12227 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12228 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12229 reference by variable @code{x}):
12230
12231 @smallexample
12232 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12233 void (*x) (void) = c;
12234 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12235 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12236 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12237
12238 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12239 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12240 a () at t.c:3
12241 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12242 (gdb) bt
12243 #0 a () at t.c:3
12244 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12245 @end smallexample
12246
12247 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12248
12249 @smallexample
12250 int i;
12251 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12252 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12253 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12254 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12255 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12256 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12257 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12258 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12259
12260 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12261 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12262 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12263 (gdb) bt
12264 #0 f () at t.c:2
12265 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12266 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12267 @end smallexample
12268
12269 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12270 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12271
12272 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12273 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12274 @set ARROW @click{}
12275 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12276 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12277 @end ifset
12278 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12279 @set ARROW ->
12280 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12281 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12282 @end ifclear
12283
12284 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12285 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12286 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12287
12288 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12289 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12290 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12291 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12292 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12293 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12294
12295 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12296 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12297 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12298 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12299 omitted.
12300
12301 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12302 entry may fail:
12303
12304 @smallexample
12305 int v;
12306 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12307 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12308 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12309 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12310 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12311 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12312
12313 (gdb) bt
12314 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12315 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12316 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12317 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12318 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12319 @end smallexample
12320
12321 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12322 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12323 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12324 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12325 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12326
12327 @node Macros
12328 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12329
12330 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12331 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12332 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12333 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12334 where it was defined.
12335
12336 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12337 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12338 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12339 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12340
12341 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12342 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12343 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12344 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12345 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12346 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12347 see @ref{List}.
12348
12349 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12350 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12351 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12352
12353 @table @code
12354
12355 @kindex macro expand
12356 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12357 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12358 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12359 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12360 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12361 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12362 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12363 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12364 it can be any string of tokens.
12365
12366 @kindex macro exp1
12367 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12368 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12369 @cindex expand macro once
12370 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12371 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12372 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12373 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12374 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12375 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12376 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12377 can be any string of tokens.
12378
12379 @kindex info macro
12380 @cindex macro definition, showing
12381 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12382 @cindex macros, from debug info
12383 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12384 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12385 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12386 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12387 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12388 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12389
12390 @kindex info macros
12391 @item info macros @var{location}
12392 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12393 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12394 command-line where those definitions were established.
12395
12396 @kindex macro define
12397 @cindex user-defined macros
12398 @cindex defining macros interactively
12399 @cindex macros, user-defined
12400 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12401 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12402 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12403 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12404 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12405 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12406 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12407 @var{arglist}.
12408
12409 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12410 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12411 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12412 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12413 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12414
12415 @kindex macro undef
12416 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12417 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12418 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12419 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12420 in the program being debugged.
12421
12422 @kindex macro list
12423 @item macro list
12424 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12425 @end table
12426
12427 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12428 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12429 show our source files:
12430
12431 @smallexample
12432 $ cat sample.c
12433 #include <stdio.h>
12434 #include "sample.h"
12435
12436 #define M 42
12437 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12438
12439 main ()
12440 @{
12441 #define N 28
12442 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12443 #undef N
12444 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12445 #define N 1729
12446 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12447 @}
12448 $ cat sample.h
12449 #define Q <
12450 $
12451 @end smallexample
12452
12453 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12454 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12455 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12456 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12457 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12458 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12459 information.
12460
12461 @smallexample
12462 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12463 $
12464 @end smallexample
12465
12466 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12467
12468 @smallexample
12469 $ gdb -nw sample
12470 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12471 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12472 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12473 (@value{GDBP})
12474 @end smallexample
12475
12476 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12477 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12478 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12479
12480 @smallexample
12481 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12482 3
12483 4 #define M 42
12484 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12485 6
12486 7 main ()
12487 8 @{
12488 9 #define N 28
12489 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12490 11 #undef N
12491 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12492 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12493 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12494 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12495 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12496 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12497 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12498 #define Q <
12499 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12500 expands to: (42 + 1)
12501 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12502 expands to: once (M + 1)
12503 (@value{GDBP})
12504 @end smallexample
12505
12506 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12507 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12508 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12509 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12510
12511 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12512 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12513
12514 @smallexample
12515 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12516 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12517 (@value{GDBP}) run
12518 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12519
12520 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12521 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12522 (@value{GDBP})
12523 @end smallexample
12524
12525 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12526
12527 @smallexample
12528 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12529 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12530 #define N 28
12531 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12532 expands to: 28 < 42
12533 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12534 $1 = 1
12535 (@value{GDBP})
12536 @end smallexample
12537
12538 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12539 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12540 thereof) in force at each point:
12541
12542 @smallexample
12543 (@value{GDBP}) next
12544 Hello, world!
12545 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12546 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12547 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12548 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12549 (@value{GDBP}) next
12550 We're so creative.
12551 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12552 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12553 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12554 #define N 1729
12555 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12556 expands to: 1729 < 42
12557 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12558 $2 = 0
12559 (@value{GDBP})
12560 @end smallexample
12561
12562 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12563 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12564 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12565 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12566
12567 @smallexample
12568 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12569 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12570 -D__STDC__=1
12571 (@value{GDBP})
12572 @end smallexample
12573
12574
12575 @node Tracepoints
12576 @chapter Tracepoints
12577 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12578 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12579
12580 @cindex tracepoints
12581 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12582 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12583 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12584 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12585 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12586 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12587 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12588
12589 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12590 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12591 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12592 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12593 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12594 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12595 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12596 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12597 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12598 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12599 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12600
12601 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12602 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12603 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12604 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12605 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12606 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12607 Packets}.
12608
12609 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12610 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12611 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12612
12613 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12614
12615 @menu
12616 * Set Tracepoints::
12617 * Analyze Collected Data::
12618 * Tracepoint Variables::
12619 * Trace Files::
12620 @end menu
12621
12622 @node Set Tracepoints
12623 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12624
12625 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12626 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12627 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12628 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12629 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12630 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12631 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12632
12633 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12634 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12635 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12636 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12637 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12638 tracepoint was hit.
12639
12640 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12641 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12642 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12643 either.
12644
12645 @cindex fast tracepoints
12646 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12647 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12648 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12649
12650 @cindex static tracepoints
12651 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12652 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12653 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12654 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12655 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12656 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12657 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12658 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12659 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12660 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12661 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12662 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12663 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12664 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12665 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12666 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12667 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12668 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12669 static tracepoint marker.
12670
12671 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12672 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12673
12674 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12675 conditions and actions.
12676
12677 @menu
12678 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12679 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12680 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12681 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12682 * Trace State Variables::
12683 * Tracepoint Actions::
12684 * Listing Tracepoints::
12685 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12686 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12687 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12688 @end menu
12689
12690 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12691 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12692
12693 @table @code
12694 @cindex set tracepoint
12695 @kindex trace
12696 @item trace @var{location}
12697 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12698 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12699 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12700 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12701 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12702 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12703 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12704 in tracing}).
12705 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12706 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12707 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12708 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12709 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12710 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12711 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12712 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12713 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12714 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12715 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12716 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12717
12718 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12719
12720 @smallexample
12721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12722
12723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12724
12725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12726
12727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12728
12729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12730 @end smallexample
12731
12732 @noindent
12733 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12734
12735 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12736 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12737 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12738 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12739 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12740 information on tracepoint conditions.
12741
12742 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12743 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12744 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12745 @kindex ftrace
12746 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12747 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12748 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12749 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12750 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12751 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12752 message.
12753
12754 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12755 @code{trace}.
12756
12757 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12758 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12759 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12760 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12761 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12762 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12763 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12764 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12765
12766 @example
12767 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12768 @end example
12769
12770 @noindent
12771 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12772 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12773
12774 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12775 @cindex set static tracepoint
12776 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12777 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12778 @kindex strace
12779 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12780 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12781 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12782 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12783 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12784
12785 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12786 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12787 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12788 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12789 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12790 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12791 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12792 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12793 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12794 tracing engine:
12795
12796 @smallexample
12797 main ()
12798 @{
12799 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12800 @}
12801 @end smallexample
12802
12803 @noindent
12804 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12805 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12806
12807 @smallexample
12808 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12809 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12810 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12811 Data: "str %s"
12812 [etc...]
12813 @end smallexample
12814
12815 @noindent
12816 so you may probe the marker above with:
12817
12818 @smallexample
12819 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12820 @end smallexample
12821
12822 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12823 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12824 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12825 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12826 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12827 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12828 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12829 the @samp{Data:} field.
12830
12831 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12832 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12833 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12834
12835 @vindex $tpnum
12836 @cindex last tracepoint number
12837 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12838 @cindex tracepoint number
12839 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12840 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12841
12842 @kindex delete tracepoint
12843 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12844 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12845 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12846 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12847 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12848
12849 Examples:
12850
12851 @smallexample
12852 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12853
12854 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12855 @end smallexample
12856
12857 @noindent
12858 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12859 @end table
12860
12861 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12862 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12863
12864 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12865
12866 @table @code
12867 @kindex disable tracepoint
12868 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12869 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12870 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12871 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12872 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12873 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12874 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12875 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12876 next trace experiment.
12877
12878 @kindex enable tracepoint
12879 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12880 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12881 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12882 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12883 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12884 next time a trace experiment is run.
12885 @end table
12886
12887 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12888 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12889
12890 @table @code
12891 @kindex passcount
12892 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12893 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12894 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12895 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12896 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12897 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12898 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12899 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12900 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12901 user.
12902
12903 Examples:
12904
12905 @smallexample
12906 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12907 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12908
12909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12910 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12911 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12912 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12913 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12914 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12915 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12916 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12917 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12918 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12919 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12920 @end smallexample
12921 @end table
12922
12923 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12924 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12925 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12926 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12927
12928 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12929 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12930 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12931 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12932 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12933 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12934 is true.
12935
12936 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12937 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12938 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12939 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12940 just as with breakpoints.
12941
12942 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12943 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12944 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12945 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12946 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12947 accesses, and so forth.
12948
12949 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12950 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12951 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12952 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12953 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12954 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12955 search through.
12956
12957 @smallexample
12958 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12959 @end smallexample
12960
12961 @node Trace State Variables
12962 @subsection Trace State Variables
12963 @cindex trace state variables
12964
12965 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12966 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12967 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12968 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12969 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12970 integers.
12971
12972 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12973 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12974 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12975 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12976
12977 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12978 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12979 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12980 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12981 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12982 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12983 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12984 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12985 variable with the same name.
12986
12987 @table @code
12988
12989 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12990 @kindex tvariable
12991 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12992 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12993 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12994 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12995 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12996 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12997 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12998 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12999 value. The default initial value is 0.
13000
13001 @item info tvariables
13002 @kindex info tvariables
13003 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13004 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13005 currently running.
13006
13007 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13008 @kindex delete tvariable
13009 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13010 are specified.
13011
13012 @end table
13013
13014 @node Tracepoint Actions
13015 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13016
13017 @table @code
13018 @kindex actions
13019 @cindex tracepoint actions
13020 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13021 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13022 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13023 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13024 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13025 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13026 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13027 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13028 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13029 @code{while-stepping}.
13030
13031 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13032 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13033 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13034
13035 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13036 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13037 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13038
13039 @smallexample
13040 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13041
13042 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13043
13044 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13045 @end smallexample
13046
13047 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13048 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13049 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13050 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13051 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13052 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13053 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13054 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13055
13056 @smallexample
13057 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13058 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13059 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13060 > collect bar,baz
13061 > collect $regs
13062 > while-stepping 12
13063 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13064 > end
13065 end
13066 @end smallexample
13067
13068 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13069 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13070 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13071 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13072 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13073 special arguments are supported:
13074
13075 @table @code
13076 @item $regs
13077 Collect all registers.
13078
13079 @item $args
13080 Collect all function arguments.
13081
13082 @item $locals
13083 Collect all local variables.
13084
13085 @item $_ret
13086 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13087 of a backtrace.
13088
13089 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13090 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13091 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13092 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13093 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13094 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13095
13096 @item $_probe_argc
13097 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13098 tracepoint is located.
13099 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13100
13101 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13102 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13103 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13104 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13105
13106 @item $_sdata
13107 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13108 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13109 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13110 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13111 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13112 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13113 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13114 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13115 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13116
13117 @smallexample
13118 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13119 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13120 @end smallexample
13121
13122 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13123 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13124 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13125 @value{GDBN}.
13126 @end table
13127
13128 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13129 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13130 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13131
13132 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13133 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13134 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13135 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13136 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13137 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13138 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13139 @samp{mystr}.
13140
13141 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13142 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13143
13144 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13145 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13146 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13147 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13148 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13149 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13150 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13151 action were used.
13152
13153 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13154 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13155 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13156 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13157 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13158 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13159
13160 @smallexample
13161 > while-stepping 12
13162 > collect $regs, myglobal
13163 > end
13164 >
13165 @end smallexample
13166
13167 @noindent
13168 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13169 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13170 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13171 @code{stepping}.
13172
13173 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13174 @kindex set default-collect
13175 @cindex default collection action
13176 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13177 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13178 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13179 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13180 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13181 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13182
13183 @item show default-collect
13184 @kindex show default-collect
13185 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13186 tracepoint hit.
13187
13188 @end table
13189
13190 @node Listing Tracepoints
13191 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13192
13193 @table @code
13194 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13195 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13196 @cindex information about tracepoints
13197 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13198 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13199 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13200 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13201 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13202 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13203
13204 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13205 tracing:
13206
13207 @itemize @bullet
13208 @item
13209 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13210
13211 @item
13212 the state about installed on target of each location
13213 @end itemize
13214
13215 @smallexample
13216 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13217 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13218 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13219 while-stepping 20
13220 collect globfoo, $regs
13221 end
13222 collect globfoo2
13223 end
13224 pass count 1200
13225 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13226 collect $eip
13227 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13228 installed on target
13229 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13230 installed on target
13231 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13232 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13233 not installed on target
13234 (@value{GDBP})
13235 @end smallexample
13236
13237 @noindent
13238 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13239 @end table
13240
13241 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13242 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13243
13244 @table @code
13245 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13246 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13247 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13248 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13249 program.
13250
13251 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13252
13253 @table @emph
13254 @item Count
13255 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13256 stable identifier.
13257 @item ID
13258 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13259 @item Enabled or Disabled
13260 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13261 that are not enabled.
13262 @item Address
13263 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13264 @item What
13265 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13266 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13267 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13268 will be left blank.
13269 @end table
13270
13271 @noindent
13272 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13273
13274 @table @emph
13275 @item Data
13276 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13277 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13278 marker call.
13279 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13280 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13281 @end table
13282
13283 @smallexample
13284 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13285 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13286 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13287 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13288 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13289 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13290 Data: str %s
13291 (@value{GDBP})
13292 @end smallexample
13293 @end table
13294
13295 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13296 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13297
13298 @table @code
13299 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13300 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13301 @cindex collected data discarded
13302 @item tstart
13303 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13304 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13305 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13306 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13307 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13308 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13309 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13310 information, and so forth.
13311
13312 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13313 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13314 @item tstop
13315 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13316 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13317 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13318 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13319 needs to be stopped quickly.
13320
13321 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13322 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13323 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13324
13325 @kindex tstatus
13326 @cindex status of trace data collection
13327 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13328 @item tstatus
13329 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13330 collection.
13331 @end table
13332
13333 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13334
13335 @smallexample
13336 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13337 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13338 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13339 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13340 > while-stepping 11
13341 > collect $regs
13342 > end
13343 > end
13344 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13345 [time passes @dots{}]
13346 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13347 @end smallexample
13348
13349 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13350 @cindex disconnected tracing
13351 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13352 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13353 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13354 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13355 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13356 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13357 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13358 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13359
13360 @table @code
13361 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13362 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13363 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13364 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13365 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13366 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13367 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13368 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13369
13370 @item show disconnected-tracing
13371 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13372 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13373
13374 @end table
13375
13376 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13377 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13378 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13379 it will continue after reconnection.
13380
13381 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13382 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13383 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13384 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13385 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13386 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13387 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13388 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13389 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13390 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13391
13392 @cindex circular trace buffer
13393 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13394 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13395 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13396 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13397 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13398 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13399 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13400 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13401 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13402 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13403 the next run.
13404
13405 @table @code
13406 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13407 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13408 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13409 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13410 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13411 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13412 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13413
13414 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13415 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13416 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13417 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13418 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13419 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13420
13421 @end table
13422
13423 @table @code
13424 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13425 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13426 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13427 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13428 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13429 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13430 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13431 likes. This is also the default.
13432
13433 @item show trace-buffer-size
13434 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13435 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13436 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13437 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13438 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13439 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13440 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13441 @end table
13442
13443 @table @code
13444 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13445 @kindex set trace-user
13446
13447 @item show trace-user
13448 @kindex show trace-user
13449
13450 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13451 @kindex set trace-notes
13452 Set the trace run's notes.
13453
13454 @item show trace-notes
13455 @kindex show trace-notes
13456 Show the trace run's notes.
13457
13458 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13459 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13460 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13461 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13462 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13463
13464 @item show trace-stop-notes
13465 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13466 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13467
13468 @end table
13469
13470 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13471 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13472
13473 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13474 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13475 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13476 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13477 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13478 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13479 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13480 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13481 mentioned here.
13482
13483 @itemize @bullet
13484
13485 @item
13486 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13487 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13488 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13489 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13490 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13491 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13492 cannot be collected either.
13493
13494 @item
13495 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13496 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13497 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13498 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13499 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13500 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13501 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13502 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13503 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13504 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13505
13506 @item
13507 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13508 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13509 in a misleading way.
13510
13511 @item
13512 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13513 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13514 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13515 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13516 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13517 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13518 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13519 by @code{ptr}.
13520
13521 @item
13522 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13523 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13524 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13525 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13526 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13527 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13528 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13529 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13530 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13531 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13532 invalid address.
13533
13534 @item
13535 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13536 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13537 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13538 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13539 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13540 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13541 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13542 it to zero.
13543
13544 @end itemize
13545
13546 @node Analyze Collected Data
13547 @section Using the Collected Data
13548
13549 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13550 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13551 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13552 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13553 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13554 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13555 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13556 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13557 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13558 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13559 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13560 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13561 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13562 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13563 the buffer will fail.
13564
13565 @menu
13566 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13567 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13568 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13569 @end menu
13570
13571 @node tfind
13572 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13573
13574 @kindex tfind
13575 @cindex select trace snapshot
13576 @cindex find trace snapshot
13577 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13578 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13579 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13580 snapshot is selected.
13581
13582 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13583
13584 @table @code
13585 @item tfind start
13586 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13587 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13588
13589 @item tfind none
13590 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13591
13592 @item tfind end
13593 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13594
13595 @item tfind
13596 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13597 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13598
13599 @item tfind -
13600 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13601 retracing earlier steps.
13602
13603 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13604 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13605 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13606 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13607 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13608
13609 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13610 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13611 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13612 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13613 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13614
13615 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13616 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13617 addresses (exclusive).
13618
13619 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13620 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13621 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13622
13623 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13624 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13625 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13626 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13627 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13628 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13629 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13630 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13631 @end table
13632
13633 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13634 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13635 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13636 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13637 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13638 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13639 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13640 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13641 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13642 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13643 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13644 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13645 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13646 tracepoint as the current one.
13647
13648 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13649 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13650 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13651 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13652 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13653
13654 @smallexample
13655 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13657 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13658 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13659 > tfind
13660 > end
13661
13662 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13663 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13664 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13665 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13666 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13667 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13668 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13669 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13670 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13671 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13672 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13673 @end smallexample
13674
13675 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13676 the buffer:
13677
13678 @smallexample
13679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13681 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13682 > tfind line
13683 > end
13684
13685 Frame 0, X = 1
13686 Frame 7, X = 2
13687 Frame 13, X = 255
13688 @end smallexample
13689
13690 @node tdump
13691 @subsection @code{tdump}
13692 @kindex tdump
13693 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13694 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13695
13696 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13697 the current trace snapshot.
13698
13699 @smallexample
13700 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13702 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13703 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13704 > end
13705
13706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13707
13708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13709 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13710 at gdb_test.c:444
13711 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13712
13713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13714 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13715 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13716 d1 0x18 24
13717 d2 0x80 128
13718 d3 0x33 51
13719 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13720 d5 0x22 34
13721 d6 0xe0 224
13722 d7 0x380035 3670069
13723 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13724 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13725 a2 0x100 256
13726 a3 0x322000 3284992
13727 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13728 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13729 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13730 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13731 ps 0x0 0
13732 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13733 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13734 fpstatus 0x0 0
13735 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13736 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13737 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13738 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13739 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13740 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13741 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13742 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13743 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13744
13745 (@value{GDBP})
13746 @end smallexample
13747
13748 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13749 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13750 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13751 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13752
13753 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13754 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13755 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13756 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13757 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13758 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13759 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13760 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13761 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13762 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13763
13764 @node save tracepoints
13765 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13766 @kindex save tracepoints
13767 @kindex save-tracepoints
13768 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13769
13770 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13771 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13772 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13773 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13774 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13775 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13776
13777 @node Tracepoint Variables
13778 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13779 @cindex tracepoint variables
13780 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13781
13782 @table @code
13783 @vindex $trace_frame
13784 @item (int) $trace_frame
13785 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13786 snapshot is selected.
13787
13788 @vindex $tracepoint
13789 @item (int) $tracepoint
13790 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13791
13792 @vindex $trace_line
13793 @item (int) $trace_line
13794 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13795
13796 @vindex $trace_file
13797 @item (char []) $trace_file
13798 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13799
13800 @vindex $trace_func
13801 @item (char []) $trace_func
13802 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13803 @end table
13804
13805 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13806 use @code{output} instead.
13807
13808 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13809 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13810 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13811 which are managed by the target.
13812
13813 @smallexample
13814 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13815
13816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13817 > output $trace_file
13818 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13819 > tfind
13820 > end
13821 @end smallexample
13822
13823 @node Trace Files
13824 @section Using Trace Files
13825 @cindex trace files
13826
13827 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13828 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13829 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13830 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13831 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13832
13833 @table @code
13834
13835 @kindex tsave
13836 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13837 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13838 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13839 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13840 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13841 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13842 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13843 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13844 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13845 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13846 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13847 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13848 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13849 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13850 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13851
13852 @kindex target tfile
13853 @kindex tfile
13854 @kindex target ctf
13855 @kindex ctf
13856 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13857 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13858 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13859 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13860 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13861 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13862 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13863 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13864 the host.
13865
13866 @smallexample
13867 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13868 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13869 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13870 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13871 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13872 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13873 i = 0
13874 a = 0
13875 b = 1 '\001'
13876 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13877 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13878 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13879 $1 = 1
13880 @end smallexample
13881
13882 @end table
13883
13884 @node Overlays
13885 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13886 @cindex overlays
13887
13888 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13889 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13890 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13891 use overlays.
13892
13893 @menu
13894 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13895 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13896 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13897 mapped by asking the inferior.
13898 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13899 @end menu
13900
13901 @node How Overlays Work
13902 @section How Overlays Work
13903 @cindex mapped overlays
13904 @cindex unmapped overlays
13905 @cindex load address, overlay's
13906 @cindex mapped address
13907 @cindex overlay area
13908
13909 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13910 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13911 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13912 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13913 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13914
13915 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13916 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13917 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13918 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13919 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13920 largest overlay as well.
13921
13922 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13923 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13924 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13925 there.
13926
13927 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13928 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13929 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13930
13931 @smallexample
13932 @group
13933 Data Instruction Larger
13934 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13935 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13936 | | | | | |
13937 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13938 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13939 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13940 | and heap | | | | | |
13941 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13942 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13943 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13944 | | | | | |
13945 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13946 address | | | | | |
13947 | overlay | <-' | | |
13948 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13949 | | <---. | | load address
13950 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13951 | | | |
13952 +-----------+ | |
13953 +-----------+
13954 | |
13955 +-----------+
13956
13957 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13958 @end group
13959 @end smallexample
13960
13961 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13962 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13963 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13964 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13965 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13966 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13967 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13968 program and the overlay area.
13969
13970 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13971 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13972 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13973 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13974 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13975 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13976 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13977
13978 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13979 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13980 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13981
13982 @itemize @bullet
13983
13984 @item
13985 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13986 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13987 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13988 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13989
13990 @item
13991 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13992 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13993 your program's performance.
13994
13995 @item
13996 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13997 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13998 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13999 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14000 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14001 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14002 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14003
14004 @item
14005 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14006 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14007 instruction and data spaces.
14008
14009 @end itemize
14010
14011 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14012 improved in many ways:
14013
14014 @itemize @bullet
14015
14016 @item
14017 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14018 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14019 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14020 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14021 area in the usual way.
14022
14023 @item
14024 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14025 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14026
14027 @item
14028 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14029 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14030 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14031 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14032 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14033 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14034 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14035
14036 @end itemize
14037
14038
14039 @node Overlay Commands
14040 @section Overlay Commands
14041
14042 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14043 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14044 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14045 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14046 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14047 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14048
14049 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14050 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14051
14052 @table @code
14053 @item overlay off
14054 @kindex overlay
14055 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14056 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14057 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14058 overlay support is disabled.
14059
14060 @item overlay manual
14061 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14062 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14063 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14064 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14065 commands described below.
14066
14067 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14068 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14069 @cindex map an overlay
14070 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14071 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14072 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14073 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14074 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14075 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14076
14077 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14078 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14079 @cindex unmap an overlay
14080 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14081 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14082 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14083 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14084
14085 @item overlay auto
14086 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14087 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14088 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14089 Overlay Debugging}.
14090
14091 @item overlay load-target
14092 @itemx overlay load
14093 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14094 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14095 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14096 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14097 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14098 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14099
14100 @item overlay list-overlays
14101 @itemx overlay list
14102 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14103 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14104 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14105
14106 @end table
14107
14108 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14109 of the function the address falls in:
14110
14111 @smallexample
14112 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14113 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14114 @end smallexample
14115 @noindent
14116 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14117 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14118 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14119 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14120
14121 @smallexample
14122 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14123 No sections are mapped.
14124 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14125 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14126 @end smallexample
14127 @noindent
14128 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14129 name normally:
14130
14131 @smallexample
14132 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14133 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14134 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14135 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14136 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14137 @end smallexample
14138
14139 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14140 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14141 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14142 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14143 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14144
14145 @itemize @bullet
14146 @item
14147 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14148 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14149 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14150 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14151 @item
14152 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14153 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14154 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14155 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14156 breakpoints properly.
14157 @end itemize
14158
14159
14160 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14161 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14162 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14163
14164 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14165 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14166 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14167 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14168 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14169 current state of the overlays.
14170
14171 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14172 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14173
14174 @table @asis
14175
14176 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14177 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14178
14179 @smallexample
14180 struct
14181 @{
14182 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14183 unsigned long vma;
14184
14185 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14186 unsigned long size;
14187
14188 /* The overlay's load address. */
14189 unsigned long lma;
14190
14191 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14192 zero otherwise. */
14193 unsigned long mapped;
14194 @}
14195 @end smallexample
14196
14197 @item @code{_novlys}:
14198 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14199 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14200
14201 @end table
14202
14203 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14204 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14205 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14206 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14207 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14208 currently mapped.
14209
14210 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14211 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14212 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14213 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14214 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14215 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14216 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14217 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14218 are not being executed.
14219
14220 @node Overlay Sample Program
14221 @section Overlay Sample Program
14222 @cindex overlay example program
14223
14224 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14225 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14226 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14227 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14228 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14229 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14230 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14231
14232 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14233 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14234 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14235 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14236
14237 @table @file
14238 @item overlays.c
14239 The main program file.
14240 @item ovlymgr.c
14241 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14242 @item foo.c
14243 @itemx bar.c
14244 @itemx baz.c
14245 @itemx grbx.c
14246 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14247 @item d10v.ld
14248 @itemx m32r.ld
14249 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14250 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14251 @end table
14252
14253 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14254 cross-compiler like this:
14255
14256 @smallexample
14257 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14258 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14259 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14260 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14261 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14262 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14263 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14264 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14265 @end smallexample
14266
14267 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14268 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14269 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14270
14271
14272 @node Languages
14273 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14274 @cindex languages
14275
14276 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14277 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14278 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14279 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14280 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14281 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14282
14283 @cindex working language
14284 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14285 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14286 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14287 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14288 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14289 language}.
14290
14291 @menu
14292 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14293 * Show:: Displaying the language
14294 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14295 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14296 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14297 @end menu
14298
14299 @node Setting
14300 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14301
14302 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14303 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14304 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14305 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14306 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14307 are printed, etc.
14308
14309 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14310 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14311 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14312 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14313 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14314 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14315 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14316 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14317 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14318 Displaying the Language}.
14319
14320 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14321 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14322 another language. In that case, make the
14323 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14324 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14325 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14326
14327 @menu
14328 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14329 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14330 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14331 @end menu
14332
14333 @node Filenames
14334 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14335
14336 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14337 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14338
14339 @table @file
14340 @item .ada
14341 @itemx .ads
14342 @itemx .adb
14343 @itemx .a
14344 Ada source file.
14345
14346 @item .c
14347 C source file
14348
14349 @item .C
14350 @itemx .cc
14351 @itemx .cp
14352 @itemx .cpp
14353 @itemx .cxx
14354 @itemx .c++
14355 C@t{++} source file
14356
14357 @item .d
14358 D source file
14359
14360 @item .m
14361 Objective-C source file
14362
14363 @item .f
14364 @itemx .F
14365 Fortran source file
14366
14367 @item .mod
14368 Modula-2 source file
14369
14370 @item .s
14371 @itemx .S
14372 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14373 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14374 @end table
14375
14376 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14377 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14378
14379 @node Manually
14380 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14381
14382 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14383 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14384 your program.
14385
14386 @kindex set language
14387 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14388 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14389 a language, such as
14390 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14391 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14392
14393 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14394 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14395 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14396 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14397 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14398 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14399 command such as:
14400
14401 @smallexample
14402 print a = b + c
14403 @end smallexample
14404
14405 @noindent
14406 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14407 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14408 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14409 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14410
14411 @node Automatically
14412 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14413
14414 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14415 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14416 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14417 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14418 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14419 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14420 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14421 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14422 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14423
14424 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14425 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14426 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14427 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14428 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14429
14430 @node Show
14431 @section Displaying the Language
14432
14433 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14434 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14435
14436 @table @code
14437 @item show language
14438 @anchor{show language}
14439 @kindex show language
14440 Display the current working language. This is the
14441 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14442 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14443
14444 @item info frame
14445 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14446 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14447 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14448 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14449 information listed here.
14450
14451 @item info source
14452 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14453 Display the source language of this source file.
14454 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14455 information listed here.
14456 @end table
14457
14458 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14459 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14460 with a language explicitly:
14461
14462 @table @code
14463 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14464 @kindex set extension-language
14465 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14466 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14467
14468 @item info extensions
14469 @kindex info extensions
14470 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14471 @end table
14472
14473 @node Checks
14474 @section Type and Range Checking
14475
14476 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14477 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14478 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14479 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14480 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14481 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14482 errors when your program is running.
14483
14484 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14485 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14486 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14487 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14488
14489 @menu
14490 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14491 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14492 @end menu
14493
14494 @cindex type checking
14495 @cindex checks, type
14496 @node Type Checking
14497 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14498
14499 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14500 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14501 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14502 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14503
14504 @smallexample
14505 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14506
14507 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14508 $1 = 2
14509 @exdent but
14510 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14511 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14512 @end smallexample
14513
14514 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14515 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14516
14517 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14518 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14519 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14520 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14521 expressions like the second example above.
14522
14523 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14524 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14525 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14526 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14527 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14528 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14529
14530 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14531
14532 @kindex set check type
14533 @kindex show check type
14534 @table @code
14535 @item set check type on
14536 @itemx set check type off
14537 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14538 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14539 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14540
14541 @item show check type
14542 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14543 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14544 @end table
14545
14546 @cindex range checking
14547 @cindex checks, range
14548 @node Range Checking
14549 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14550
14551 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14552 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14553 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14554 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14555 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14556
14557 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14558 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14559 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14560 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14561
14562 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14563 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14564 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14565 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14566 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14567 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14568
14569 @smallexample
14570 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14571 @end smallexample
14572
14573 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14574 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14575 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14576
14577 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14578
14579 @kindex set check range
14580 @kindex show check range
14581 @table @code
14582 @item set check range auto
14583 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14584 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14585 each language.
14586
14587 @item set check range on
14588 @itemx set check range off
14589 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14590 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14591 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14592 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14593
14594 @item set check range warn
14595 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14596 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14597 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14598 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14599 systems).
14600
14601 @item show range
14602 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14603 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14604 @end table
14605
14606 @node Supported Languages
14607 @section Supported Languages
14608
14609 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14610 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14611 @c This is false ...
14612 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14613 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14614 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14615 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14616 language.
14617
14618 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14619 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14620 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14621 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14622 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14623 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14624 language reference or tutorial.
14625
14626 @menu
14627 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14628 * D:: D
14629 * Go:: Go
14630 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14631 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14632 * Fortran:: Fortran
14633 * Pascal:: Pascal
14634 * Rust:: Rust
14635 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14636 * Ada:: Ada
14637 @end menu
14638
14639 @node C
14640 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14641
14642 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14643 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14644
14645 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14646 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14647 together.
14648
14649 @cindex C@t{++}
14650 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14651 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14652 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14653 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14654 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14655 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14656 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14657
14658 @menu
14659 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14660 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14661 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14662 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14663 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14664 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14665 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14666 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14667 @end menu
14668
14669 @node C Operators
14670 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14671
14672 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14673
14674 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14675 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14676 often defined on groups of types.
14677
14678 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14679
14680 @itemize @bullet
14681
14682 @item
14683 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14684 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14685
14686 @item
14687 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14688 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14689
14690 @item
14691 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14692
14693 @item
14694 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14695
14696 @end itemize
14697
14698 @noindent
14699 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14700 in order of increasing precedence:
14701
14702 @table @code
14703 @item ,
14704 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14705 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14706 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14707
14708 @item =
14709 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14710 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14711
14712 @item @var{op}=
14713 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14714 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14715 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14716 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14717 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14718
14719 @item ?:
14720 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14721 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14722 should be of an integral type.
14723
14724 @item ||
14725 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14726
14727 @item &&
14728 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14729
14730 @item |
14731 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14732
14733 @item ^
14734 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14735
14736 @item &
14737 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14738
14739 @item ==@r{, }!=
14740 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14741 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14742
14743 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14744 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14745 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14746 and non-zero for true.
14747
14748 @item <<@r{, }>>
14749 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14750
14751 @item @@
14752 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14753
14754 @item +@r{, }-
14755 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14756 pointer types.
14757
14758 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14759 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14760 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14761 integral types.
14762
14763 @item ++@r{, }--
14764 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14765 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14766 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14767 operation takes place.
14768
14769 @item *
14770 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14771 @code{++}.
14772
14773 @item &
14774 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14775
14776 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14777 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14778 to examine the address
14779 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14780 stored.
14781
14782 @item -
14783 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14784 precedence as @code{++}.
14785
14786 @item !
14787 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14788 @code{++}.
14789
14790 @item ~
14791 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14792 @code{++}.
14793
14794
14795 @item .@r{, }->
14796 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14797 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14798 pointer based on the stored type information.
14799 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14800
14801 @item .*@r{, }->*
14802 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14803
14804 @item []
14805 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14806 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14807
14808 @item ()
14809 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14810
14811 @item ::
14812 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14813 and @code{class} types.
14814
14815 @item ::
14816 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14817 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14818 above.
14819 @end table
14820
14821 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14822 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14823 predefined meaning.
14824
14825 @node C Constants
14826 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14827
14828 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14829
14830 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14831 following ways:
14832
14833 @itemize @bullet
14834 @item
14835 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14836 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14837 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14838 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14839 @code{long} value.
14840
14841 @item
14842 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14843 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14844 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14845 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14846 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14847 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14848 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14849 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14850 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14851 constant.
14852
14853 @item
14854 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14855 integral equivalents.
14856
14857 @item
14858 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14859 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14860 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14861 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14862 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14863 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14864 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14865 @samp{\n} for newline.
14866
14867 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14868 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14869 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14870 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14871
14872 @item
14873 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14874 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14875 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14876 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14877 characters.
14878
14879 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14880 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14881 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14882
14883 @item
14884 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14885 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14886
14887 @item
14888 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14889 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14890 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14891 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14892 @end itemize
14893
14894 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14895 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14896
14897 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14898 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14899
14900 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14901 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14902 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14903 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14904 @quotation
14905 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14906 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14907 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14908 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14909 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14910 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14911 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14912 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14913 @end quotation
14914
14915 @enumerate
14916
14917 @cindex member functions
14918 @item
14919 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14920
14921 @smallexample
14922 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14923 @end smallexample
14924
14925 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14926 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14927 @item
14928 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14929 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14930 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14931 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14932 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14933
14934 @cindex call overloaded functions
14935 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14936 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14937 @item
14938 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14939 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14940 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14941 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14942 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14943 default arguments.
14944
14945 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14946 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14947 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14948 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14949 number of function arguments.
14950
14951 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14952 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14953 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14954
14955 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14956 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14957 @smallexample
14958 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14959 @end smallexample
14960
14961 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14962 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14963
14964 @cindex reference declarations
14965 @item
14966 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14967 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14968 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14969
14970 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14971 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14972 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14973 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14974 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14975
14976 @item
14977 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14978 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14979 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14980 necessary, for example in an expression like
14981 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14982 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14983 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14984
14985 @item
14986 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14987 specification.
14988 @end enumerate
14989
14990 @node C Defaults
14991 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14992
14993 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14994
14995 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14996 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14997 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14998 selects the working language.
14999
15000 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15001 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15002 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15003 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15004 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15005 for further details.
15006
15007 @node C Checks
15008 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15009
15010 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15011
15012 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15013 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15014 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15015 constants to pointers.
15016
15017 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15018 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15019 that is not itself an array.
15020
15021 @node Debugging C
15022 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15023
15024 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15025 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15026 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15027 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15028
15029 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15030 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15031 ,Expressions}.
15032
15033 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15034 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15035
15036 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15037
15038 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15039 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15040
15041 @table @code
15042 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15043 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15044 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15045 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15046 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15047 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15048
15049 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15050 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15051 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15052 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15053 classes.
15054 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15055
15056 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15057 @item catch throw
15058 @itemx catch rethrow
15059 @itemx catch catch
15060 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15061 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15062
15063 @cindex inheritance
15064 @item ptype @var{typename}
15065 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15066 @var{typename}.
15067 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15068
15069 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15070 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15071 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15072 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15073 multiple inheritance is in use.
15074
15075 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15076 @item demangle @var{name}
15077 Demangle @var{name}.
15078 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15079
15080 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15081 @item set print demangle
15082 @itemx show print demangle
15083 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15084 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15085 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15086 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15087 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15088
15089 @item set print object
15090 @itemx show print object
15091 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15092 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15093
15094 @item set print vtbl
15095 @itemx show print vtbl
15096 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15097 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15098 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15099 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15100
15101 @kindex set overload-resolution
15102 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15103 @item set overload-resolution on
15104 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15105 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15106 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15107 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15108 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15109 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15110
15111 @item set overload-resolution off
15112 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15113 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15114 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15115 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15116 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15117 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15118 argument types.
15119
15120 @kindex show overload-resolution
15121 @item show overload-resolution
15122 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15123
15124 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15125 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15126 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15127 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15128 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15129 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15130 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15131 @end table
15132
15133 @node Decimal Floating Point
15134 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15135 @cindex decimal floating point format
15136
15137 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15138 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15139 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15140 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15141
15142 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15143 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15144 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15145 configured target.
15146
15147 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15148 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15149 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15150
15151 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15152 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15153 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15154
15155 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15156 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15157 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15158
15159 @node D
15160 @subsection D
15161
15162 @cindex D
15163 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15164 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15165 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15166
15167 @node Go
15168 @subsection Go
15169
15170 @cindex Go (programming language)
15171 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15172 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15173
15174 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15175
15176 @table @code
15177 @cindex current Go package
15178 @item The current Go package
15179 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15180 specifying global variables and functions.
15181
15182 For example, given the program:
15183
15184 @example
15185 package main
15186 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15187 func main () @{
15188 // ...
15189 @}
15190 @end example
15191
15192 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15193
15194 @example
15195 (gdb) p myglob
15196 (gdb) p main.myglob
15197 @end example
15198
15199 @cindex builtin Go types
15200 @item Builtin Go types
15201 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15202 as a string.
15203
15204 @cindex builtin Go functions
15205 @item Builtin Go functions
15206 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15207 function and handles it internally.
15208
15209 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15210 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15211 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15212 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15213 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15214 @end table
15215
15216 @node Objective-C
15217 @subsection Objective-C
15218
15219 @cindex Objective-C
15220 This section provides information about some commands and command
15221 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15222 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15223 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15224
15225 @menu
15226 * Method Names in Commands::
15227 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15228 @end menu
15229
15230 @node Method Names in Commands
15231 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15232
15233 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15234 names as line specifications:
15235
15236 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15237 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15238 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15239 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15240 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15241 @itemize
15242 @item @code{clear}
15243 @item @code{break}
15244 @item @code{info line}
15245 @item @code{jump}
15246 @item @code{list}
15247 @end itemize
15248
15249 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15250
15251 @smallexample
15252 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15253 @end smallexample
15254
15255 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15256 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15257 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15258 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15259 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15260 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15261 debugged, enter:
15262
15263 @smallexample
15264 break -[Fruit create]
15265 @end smallexample
15266
15267 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15268 enter:
15269
15270 @smallexample
15271 list +[NSText initialize]
15272 @end smallexample
15273
15274 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15275 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15276 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15277 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15278
15279 @smallexample
15280 break create
15281 @end smallexample
15282
15283 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15284 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15285 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15286 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15287 none apply.
15288
15289 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15290 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15291
15292 @smallexample
15293 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15294 @end smallexample
15295
15296 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15297 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15298 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15299 @kindex print-object
15300 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15301
15302 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15303
15304 @smallexample
15305 print -[@var{object} hash]
15306 @end smallexample
15307
15308 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15309 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15310 @noindent
15311 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15312 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15313 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15314 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15315 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15316 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15317
15318 @node OpenCL C
15319 @subsection OpenCL C
15320
15321 @cindex OpenCL C
15322 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15323
15324 @menu
15325 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15326 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15327 * OpenCL C Operators::
15328 @end menu
15329
15330 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15331 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15332
15333 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15334 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15335 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15336 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15337 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15338
15339 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15340 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15341
15342 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15343 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15344 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15345 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15346
15347 @node OpenCL C Operators
15348 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15349
15350 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15351 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15352 vector data types.
15353
15354 @node Fortran
15355 @subsection Fortran
15356 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15357
15358 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15359 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15360
15361 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15362 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15363 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15364 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15365 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15366 underscore.
15367
15368 @menu
15369 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15370 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15371 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15372 @end menu
15373
15374 @node Fortran Operators
15375 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15376
15377 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15378
15379 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15380 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15381 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15382
15383 @table @code
15384 @item **
15385 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15386 of the second one.
15387
15388 @item :
15389 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15390 represent a section of array.
15391
15392 @item %
15393 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15394 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15395 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15396 union type.
15397 @end table
15398
15399 @node Fortran Defaults
15400 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15401
15402 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15403
15404 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15405 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15406 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15407 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15408
15409 @node Special Fortran Commands
15410 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15411
15412 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15413
15414 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15415 such as displaying common blocks.
15416
15417 @table @code
15418 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15419 @kindex info common
15420 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15421 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15422 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15423 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15424 printed.
15425 @end table
15426
15427 @node Pascal
15428 @subsection Pascal
15429
15430 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15431 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15432 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15433 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15434 syntax.
15435
15436 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15437 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15438 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15439
15440 @node Rust
15441 @subsection Rust
15442
15443 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15444 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15445 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15446 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15447
15448 @itemize @bullet
15449 @item
15450 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15451 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15452 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15453
15454 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15455 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15456 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15457 @samp{B}.
15458
15459 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15460 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15461
15462 @item
15463 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15464 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15465 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15466 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15467 @samp{K::x::y}.
15468
15469 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15470 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15471 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15472 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15473 scope.
15474
15475 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15476 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15477
15478 @item
15479 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15480 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15481
15482 @item
15483 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15484
15485 @item
15486 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15487 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15488 never be destroyed.
15489
15490 @item
15491 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15492 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15493 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15494
15495 @item
15496 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15497 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15498 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15499 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15500 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15501 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15502 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15503 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15504
15505 @item
15506 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15507 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15508 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15509 @itemize @bullet
15510
15511 @item
15512 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15513
15514 @item
15515 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15516
15517 @item
15518 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15519
15520 @item
15521 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15522 type names.
15523
15524 @item
15525 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15526
15527 @item
15528 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15529 available in the crate.
15530 @end itemize
15531 @end itemize
15532
15533 @node Modula-2
15534 @subsection Modula-2
15535
15536 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15537
15538 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15539 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15540 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15541 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15542 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15543 table.
15544
15545 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15546 @menu
15547 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15548 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15549 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15550 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15551 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15552 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15553 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15554 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15555 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15556 @end menu
15557
15558 @node M2 Operators
15559 @subsubsection Operators
15560 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15561
15562 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15563 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15564 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15565 following definitions hold:
15566
15567 @itemize @bullet
15568
15569 @item
15570 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15571 their subranges.
15572
15573 @item
15574 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15575
15576 @item
15577 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15578
15579 @item
15580 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15581 @var{type}}.
15582
15583 @item
15584 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15585
15586 @item
15587 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15588
15589 @item
15590 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15591 @end itemize
15592
15593 @noindent
15594 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15595 increasing precedence:
15596
15597 @table @code
15598 @item ,
15599 Function argument or array index separator.
15600
15601 @item :=
15602 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15603 @var{value}.
15604
15605 @item <@r{, }>
15606 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15607 types.
15608
15609 @item <=@r{, }>=
15610 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15611 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15612 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15613
15614 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15615 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15616 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15617 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15618 comment character.
15619
15620 @item IN
15621 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15622 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15623
15624 @item OR
15625 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15626
15627 @item AND@r{, }&
15628 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15629
15630 @item @@
15631 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15632
15633 @item +@r{, }-
15634 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15635 and difference on set types.
15636
15637 @item *
15638 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15639 on set types.
15640
15641 @item /
15642 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15643 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15644
15645 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15646 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15647 precedence as @code{*}.
15648
15649 @item -
15650 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15651
15652 @item ^
15653 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15654
15655 @item NOT
15656 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15657 @code{^}.
15658
15659 @item .
15660 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15661 precedence as @code{^}.
15662
15663 @item []
15664 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15665
15666 @item ()
15667 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15668 as @code{^}.
15669
15670 @item ::@r{, }.
15671 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15672 @end table
15673
15674 @quotation
15675 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15676 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15677 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15678 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15679 @end quotation
15680
15681
15682 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15683 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15684 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15685
15686 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15687 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15688
15689 @table @var
15690
15691 @item a
15692 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15693
15694 @item c
15695 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15696
15697 @item i
15698 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15699
15700 @item m
15701 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15702 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15703 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15704
15705 @item n
15706 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15707
15708 @item r
15709 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15710
15711 @item t
15712 represents a type.
15713
15714 @item v
15715 represents a variable.
15716
15717 @item x
15718 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15719 explanation of the function for details.
15720 @end table
15721
15722 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15723
15724 @table @code
15725 @item ABS(@var{n})
15726 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15727
15728 @item CAP(@var{c})
15729 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15730 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15731
15732 @item CHR(@var{i})
15733 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15734
15735 @item DEC(@var{v})
15736 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15737
15738 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15739 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15740 new value.
15741
15742 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15743 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15744 set.
15745
15746 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15747 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15748
15749 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15750 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15751
15752 @item INC(@var{v})
15753 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15754
15755 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15756 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15757 new value.
15758
15759 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15760 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15761 there. Returns the new set.
15762
15763 @item MAX(@var{t})
15764 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15765
15766 @item MIN(@var{t})
15767 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15768
15769 @item ODD(@var{i})
15770 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15771
15772 @item ORD(@var{x})
15773 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15774 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15775 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15776 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15777
15778 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15779 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15780 variable or a type.
15781
15782 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15783 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15784
15785 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15786 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15787 variable or a type.
15788
15789 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15790 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15791 @end table
15792
15793 @quotation
15794 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15795 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15796 an error.
15797 @end quotation
15798
15799 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15800 @node M2 Constants
15801 @subsubsection Constants
15802
15803 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15804 ways:
15805
15806 @itemize @bullet
15807
15808 @item
15809 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15810 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15811 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15812 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15813
15814 @item
15815 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15816 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15817 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15818 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15819 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15820 digits.
15821
15822 @item
15823 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15824 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15825 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15826 followed by a @samp{C}.
15827
15828 @item
15829 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15830 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15831 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15832 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15833 sequences.
15834
15835 @item
15836 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15837
15838 @item
15839 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15840 @code{FALSE}.
15841
15842 @item
15843 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15844
15845 @item
15846 Set constants are not yet supported.
15847 @end itemize
15848
15849 @node M2 Types
15850 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15851 @cindex Modula-2 types
15852
15853 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15854 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15855 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15856 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15857 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15858 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15859
15860 The first example contains the following section of code:
15861
15862 @smallexample
15863 VAR
15864 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15865 r: [20..40] ;
15866 @end smallexample
15867
15868 @noindent
15869 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15870 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15871
15872 @smallexample
15873 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15874 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15875 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15876 SET OF CHAR
15877 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15878 21
15879 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15880 [20..40]
15881 @end smallexample
15882
15883 @noindent
15884 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15885
15886 @smallexample
15887 VAR
15888 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15889 @end smallexample
15890
15891 @noindent
15892 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15893
15894 @smallexample
15895 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15896 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15897 @end smallexample
15898
15899 @noindent
15900 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15901 expressions using the debugger.
15902
15903 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15904 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15905
15906 @smallexample
15907 VAR
15908 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15909 @end smallexample
15910
15911 @smallexample
15912 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15913 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15914 @end smallexample
15915
15916 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15917 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15918 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15919 above.
15920
15921 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15922
15923 @smallexample
15924 TYPE
15925 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15926 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15927 VAR
15928 s: t ;
15929 BEGIN
15930 s := blue ;
15931 @end smallexample
15932
15933 @noindent
15934 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15935 and value of a variable.
15936
15937 @smallexample
15938 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15939 $1 = blue
15940 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15941 type = [blue..yellow]
15942 @end smallexample
15943
15944 @noindent
15945 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15946 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15947 their @code{C} counterparts.
15948
15949 @smallexample
15950 VAR
15951 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15952 BEGIN
15953 s[1] := 1 ;
15954 @end smallexample
15955
15956 @smallexample
15957 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15958 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15959 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15960 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15961 @end smallexample
15962
15963 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15964 pointer types as shown in this example:
15965
15966 @smallexample
15967 VAR
15968 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15969 BEGIN
15970 NEW(s) ;
15971 s^[1] := 1 ;
15972 @end smallexample
15973
15974 @noindent
15975 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15976
15977 @smallexample
15978 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15979 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15980 @end smallexample
15981
15982 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15983 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15984 types:
15985
15986 @smallexample
15987 TYPE
15988 foo = RECORD
15989 f1: CARDINAL ;
15990 f2: CHAR ;
15991 f3: myarray ;
15992 END ;
15993
15994 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15995 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15996 VAR
15997 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15998 @end smallexample
15999
16000 @noindent
16001 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16002 below.
16003
16004 @smallexample
16005 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16006 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16007 f1 : CARDINAL;
16008 f2 : CHAR;
16009 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16010 END
16011 @end smallexample
16012
16013 @node M2 Defaults
16014 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16015 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16016
16017 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16018 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16019 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16020 selected the working language.
16021
16022 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16023 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16024 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16025 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16026
16027 @node Deviations
16028 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16029 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16030
16031 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16032 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16033
16034 @itemize @bullet
16035 @item
16036 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16037 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16038 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16039 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16040 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16041 returned a pointer.)
16042
16043 @item
16044 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16045 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16046 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16047 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16048
16049 @item
16050 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16051 argument.
16052
16053 @item
16054 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16055 @end itemize
16056
16057 @node M2 Checks
16058 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16059 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16060
16061 @quotation
16062 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16063 range checking.
16064 @end quotation
16065 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16066
16067 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16068
16069 @itemize @bullet
16070 @item
16071 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16072 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16073
16074 @item
16075 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16076 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16077 @end itemize
16078
16079 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16080 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16081
16082 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16083 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16084
16085 @node M2 Scope
16086 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16087 @cindex scope
16088 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16089 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16090 @ifinfo
16091 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16092 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16093 @end ifinfo
16094 @ifnotinfo
16095 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16096 @end ifnotinfo
16097
16098 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16099 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16100 similar syntax:
16101
16102 @smallexample
16103
16104 @var{module} . @var{id}
16105 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16106 @end smallexample
16107
16108 @noindent
16109 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16110 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16111 identifier within your program, except another module.
16112
16113 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16114 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16115 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16116 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16117
16118 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16119 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16120 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16121 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16122 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16123 @var{module}.
16124
16125 @node GDB/M2
16126 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16127
16128 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16129 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16130 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16131 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16132 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16133 analogue in Modula-2.
16134
16135 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16136 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16137 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16138 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16139 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16140 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16141
16142 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16143 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16144 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16145
16146 @node Ada
16147 @subsection Ada
16148 @cindex Ada
16149
16150 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16151 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16152 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16153 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16154 to be difficult.
16155
16156
16157 @cindex expressions in Ada
16158 @menu
16159 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16160 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16161 in @value{GDBN}.
16162 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16163 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16164 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16165 subprograms.
16166 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16167 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16168 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16169 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16170 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16171 Profile
16172 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16173 @end menu
16174
16175 @node Ada Mode Intro
16176 @subsubsection Introduction
16177 @cindex Ada mode, general
16178
16179 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16180 syntax, with some extensions.
16181 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16182
16183 @itemize @bullet
16184 @item
16185 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16186 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16187 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16188 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16189
16190 @item
16191 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16192 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16193
16194 @item
16195 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16196 @end itemize
16197
16198 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16199 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16200 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16201 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16202 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16203
16204 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16205 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16206 was translated from an Ada source file.
16207
16208 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16209 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16210 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16211 middle (to allow based literals).
16212
16213 @node Omissions from Ada
16214 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16215 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16216
16217 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16218
16219 @itemize @bullet
16220 @item
16221 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16222
16223 @itemize @minus
16224 @item
16225 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16226 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16227
16228 @item
16229 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16230
16231 @item
16232 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16233
16234 @item
16235 @t{'Tag}.
16236
16237 @item
16238 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16239 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16240
16241 @item
16242 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16243 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16244
16245 @item
16246 @t{'Address}.
16247 @end itemize
16248
16249 @item
16250 The names in
16251 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16252 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16253 not currently available.
16254
16255 @item
16256 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16257 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16258 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16259 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16260 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16261 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16262 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16263 indeterminate values.
16264
16265 @item
16266 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16267 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16268 are not implemented.
16269
16270 @item
16271 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16272 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16273 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16274 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16275 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16276
16277 @smallexample
16278 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16279 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16280 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16281 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16282 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16283 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16284 @end smallexample
16285
16286 Changing a
16287 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16288 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16289 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16290 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16291 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16292 declared to have a type such as:
16293
16294 @smallexample
16295 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16296 Id : Integer;
16297 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16298 end record;
16299 @end smallexample
16300
16301 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16302 assignments:
16303
16304 @smallexample
16305 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16306 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16307 @end smallexample
16308
16309 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16310 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16311 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16312 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16313 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16314 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16315 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16316 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16317
16318 @item
16319 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16320
16321 @item
16322 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16323 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16324 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16325 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16326 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16327 the proper resolution.
16328
16329 @item
16330 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16331
16332 @item
16333 Entry calls are not implemented.
16334
16335 @item
16336 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16337 formats are not supported.
16338
16339 @item
16340 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16341
16342 @item
16343 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16344 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16345 context.
16346 Should your program
16347 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16348 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16349 @end itemize
16350
16351 @node Additions to Ada
16352 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16353 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16354
16355 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16356 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16357
16358 @itemize @bullet
16359 @item
16360 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16361 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16362 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16363 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16364 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16365 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16366 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16367 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16368
16369 @item
16370 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16371 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16372 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16373
16374 @item
16375 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16376 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16377
16378 @item
16379 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16380 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16381 @end itemize
16382
16383 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16384 additions specific to Ada:
16385
16386 @itemize @bullet
16387 @item
16388 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16389 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16390
16391 @smallexample
16392 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16393 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16394 @end smallexample
16395
16396 @item
16397 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16398 the value of its right-hand operand.
16399 This allows, for example,
16400 complex conditional breaks:
16401
16402 @smallexample
16403 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16404 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16405 @end smallexample
16406
16407 @item
16408 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16409 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16410 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16411 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16412 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16413 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16414 in strings. For example,
16415 @smallexample
16416 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16417 @end smallexample
16418 @noindent
16419 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16420 after each period.
16421
16422 @item
16423 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16424 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16425 to write
16426
16427 @smallexample
16428 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16429 @end smallexample
16430
16431 @item
16432 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16433 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16434 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16435 of 3 might print as
16436
16437 @smallexample
16438 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16439 @end smallexample
16440
16441 @noindent
16442 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16443 clause.
16444
16445 @item
16446 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16447 multi-character subsequence of
16448 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16449 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16450 in place of @t{a'length}.
16451
16452 @item
16453 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16454 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16455 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16456 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16457 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16458 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16459 For example,
16460 @smallexample
16461 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16462 @end smallexample
16463
16464 @item
16465 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16466 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16467 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16468 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16469 object.
16470
16471 @end itemize
16472
16473 @node Overloading support for Ada
16474 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16475 @cindex overloading, Ada
16476
16477 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16478 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16479 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16480 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16481 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16482 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16483
16484 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16485 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16486 use, for instance:
16487
16488 @smallexample
16489 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16490 Multiple matches for f
16491 [0] cancel
16492 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16493 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16494 >
16495 @end smallexample
16496
16497 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16498 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16499 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16500
16501 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16502 case:
16503
16504 @table @code
16505
16506 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16507 @item set ada print-signatures
16508 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16509 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16510 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16511
16512 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16513 @item show ada print-signatures
16514 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16515 overloads selection menu.
16516 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16517
16518 @end table
16519
16520 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16521 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16522
16523 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16524 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16525 before reaching the main procedure.
16526 As defined in the Ada Reference
16527 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16528 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16529 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16530 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16531
16532 @node Ada Exceptions
16533 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16534
16535 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16536
16537 @table @code
16538 @kindex info exceptions
16539 @item info exceptions
16540 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16541 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16542 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16543 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16544 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16545 @end table
16546
16547 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16548 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16549 argument.
16550
16551 @smallexample
16552 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16553 All defined Ada exceptions:
16554 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16555 program_error: 0x613d20
16556 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16557 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16558 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16559 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16560 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16561 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16562 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16563 @end smallexample
16564
16565 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16566 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16567
16568 @node Ada Tasks
16569 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16570 @cindex Ada, tasking
16571
16572 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16573 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16574
16575 @table @code
16576 @kindex info tasks
16577 @item info tasks
16578 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16579
16580
16581 @smallexample
16582 @iftex
16583 @leftskip=0.5cm
16584 @end iftex
16585 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16586 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16587 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16588 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16589 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16590 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16591
16592 @end smallexample
16593
16594 @noindent
16595 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16596 task currently being inspected.
16597
16598 @table @asis
16599 @item ID
16600 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16601
16602 @item TID
16603 The Ada task ID.
16604
16605 @item P-ID
16606 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16607
16608 @item Pri
16609 The base priority of the task.
16610
16611 @item State
16612 Current state of the task.
16613
16614 @table @code
16615 @item Unactivated
16616 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16617 executing.
16618
16619 @item Runnable
16620 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16621 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16622
16623 @item Terminated
16624 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16625 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16626 terminated themselves.
16627
16628 @item Child Activation Wait
16629 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16630
16631 @item Accept Statement
16632 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16633
16634 @item Waiting on entry call
16635 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16636
16637 @item Async Select Wait
16638 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16639 select statement.
16640
16641 @item Delay Sleep
16642 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16643 alternative open.
16644
16645 @item Child Termination Wait
16646 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16647 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16648 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16649
16650 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16651 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16652 finish terminating.
16653
16654 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16655 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16656 @end table
16657
16658 @item Name
16659 Name of the task in the program.
16660
16661 @end table
16662
16663 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16664 @item info task @var{taskno}
16665 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16666 the following example:
16667 @smallexample
16668 @iftex
16669 @leftskip=0.5cm
16670 @end iftex
16671 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16672 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16673 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16674 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16675 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16676 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16677 Name: task_1
16678 Thread: 0x807f378
16679 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16680 Base Priority: 15
16681 State: Runnable
16682 @end smallexample
16683
16684 @item task
16685 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16686 @cindex current Ada task ID
16687 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16688
16689 @smallexample
16690 @iftex
16691 @leftskip=0.5cm
16692 @end iftex
16693 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16694 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16695 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16696 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16697 (@value{GDBP}) task
16698 [Current task is 2]
16699 @end smallexample
16700
16701 @item task @var{taskno}
16702 @cindex Ada task switching
16703 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16704 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16705 from the current task to the given task.
16706
16707 @smallexample
16708 @iftex
16709 @leftskip=0.5cm
16710 @end iftex
16711 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16712 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16713 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16714 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16715 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16716 [Switching to task 1]
16717 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16718 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16719 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16720 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16721 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16722 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16723 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16724 @end smallexample
16725
16726 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16727 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16728 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16729 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16730 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16731 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16732 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16733 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16734 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16735
16736 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16737 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16738 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16739 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16740 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16741
16742 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16743 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16744 program.
16745
16746 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16747 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16748 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16749
16750 For example,
16751
16752 @smallexample
16753 @iftex
16754 @leftskip=0.5cm
16755 @end iftex
16756 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16757 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16758 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16759 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16760 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16761 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16762 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16763 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16764 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16765 Continuing.
16766 task # 1 running
16767 task # 2 running
16768
16769 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16770 15 flush;
16771 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16772 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16773 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16774 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16775 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16776 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16777 @end smallexample
16778 @end table
16779
16780 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16781 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16782 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16783
16784 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16785 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16786 the platform being used.
16787 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16788 switching is not supported.
16789
16790 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16791 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16792 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16793 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16794 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16795 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16796
16797 @node Ravenscar Profile
16798 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16799 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16800
16801 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16802 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16803 requirements.
16804
16805 @table @code
16806 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16807 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16808 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16809 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16810 Profile. This is the default.
16811
16812 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16813 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16814 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16815 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16816 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16817 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16818 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16819
16820 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16821 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16822 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16823 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16824
16825 @end table
16826
16827 @node Ada Glitches
16828 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16829 @cindex Ada, problems
16830
16831 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16832 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16833 @value{GDBN},
16834 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16835 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16836
16837 @itemize @bullet
16838 @item
16839 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16840 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16841
16842 @item
16843 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16844 argument lists are treated as positional).
16845
16846 @item
16847 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16848
16849 @item
16850 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16851 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16852 the host machine.
16853
16854 @item
16855 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16856 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16857 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16858 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16859 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16860 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16861 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16862 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16863 you can usually resolve the confusion
16864 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16865 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16866 @end itemize
16867
16868 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16869 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16870 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16871 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16872 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16873 enabled.
16874
16875 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16876 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16877 @table @code
16878
16879 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16880 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16881 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16882 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16883 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16884 This is the default.
16885
16886 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16887 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16888 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16889 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16890 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16891 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16892 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16893
16894 @end table
16895
16896 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16897 @cindex GNAT encoding
16898 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16899 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16900 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16901 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16902 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16903 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16904
16905 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16906 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16907 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16908 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16909 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16910 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16911 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16912 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16913
16914 @table @code
16915
16916 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16917 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16918 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16919 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16920
16921 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16922 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16923 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16924
16925 @end table
16926
16927 @node Unsupported Languages
16928 @section Unsupported Languages
16929
16930 @cindex unsupported languages
16931 @cindex minimal language
16932 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16933 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16934 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16935 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16936 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16937 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16938
16939 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16940 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16941 language.
16942
16943 @node Symbols
16944 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16945
16946 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16947 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16948 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16949 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16950 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16951 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16952 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16953
16954 @cindex symbol names
16955 @cindex names of symbols
16956 @cindex quoting names
16957 @anchor{quoting names}
16958 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16959 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16960 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16961 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16962 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16963 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16964 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16965 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16966
16967 @smallexample
16968 p 'foo.c'::x
16969 @end smallexample
16970
16971 @noindent
16972 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16973
16974 @table @code
16975 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16976 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16977 @kindex set case-sensitive
16978 @item set case-sensitive on
16979 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16980 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16981 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16982 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16983 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16984 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16985 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16986 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16987 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16988 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16989 case-insensitive matches.
16990
16991 @kindex show case-sensitive
16992 @item show case-sensitive
16993 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16994 lookups.
16995
16996 @kindex set print type methods
16997 @item set print type methods
16998 @itemx set print type methods on
16999 @itemx set print type methods off
17000 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17001 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17002 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17003 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17004 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17005 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17006
17007 @kindex show print type methods
17008 @item show print type methods
17009 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17010 classes.
17011
17012 @kindex set print type typedefs
17013 @item set print type typedefs
17014 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17015 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17016
17017 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17018 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17019 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17020 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17021 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17022 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17023 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17024 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17025 types.
17026
17027 @kindex show print type typedefs
17028 @item show print type typedefs
17029 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17030 printing classes.
17031
17032 @kindex info address
17033 @cindex address of a symbol
17034 @item info address @var{symbol}
17035 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17036 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17037 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17038 is always stored.
17039
17040 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17041 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17042 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17043
17044 @kindex info symbol
17045 @cindex symbol from address
17046 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17047 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17048 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17049 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17050 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17051
17052 @smallexample
17053 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17054 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17055 @end smallexample
17056
17057 @noindent
17058 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17059 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17060
17061 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17062 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17063
17064 @smallexample
17065 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17066 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17067 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17068 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17069 @end smallexample
17070
17071 @kindex demangle
17072 @cindex demangle
17073 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17074 Demangle @var{name}.
17075 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17076 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17077
17078 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17079 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17080
17081 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17082 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17083
17084 @kindex whatis
17085 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17086 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17087 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17088 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17089
17090 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17091 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17092 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17093
17094 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17095 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17096 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17097 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17098 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17099 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17100 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17101 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17102 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17103
17104 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17105 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17106 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17107 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17108 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17109 unroll it.
17110
17111 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17112 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17113 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17114
17115 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17116 Available flags are:
17117
17118 @table @code
17119 @item r
17120 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17121 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17122 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17123
17124 @item m
17125 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17126
17127 @item M
17128 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17129 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17130
17131 @item t
17132 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17133 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17134 names are substituted when printing other types.
17135
17136 @item T
17137 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17138 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17139 @end table
17140
17141 @kindex ptype
17142 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17143 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17144 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17145 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17146
17147 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17148 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17149 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17150 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17151 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17152 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17153 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17154 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17155
17156 For example, for this variable declaration:
17157
17158 @smallexample
17159 typedef double real_t;
17160 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17161 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17162 complex_t var;
17163 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17164 @end smallexample
17165
17166 @noindent
17167 the two commands give this output:
17168
17169 @smallexample
17170 @group
17171 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17172 type = complex_t
17173 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17174 type = struct complex @{
17175 real_t real;
17176 double imag;
17177 @}
17178 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17179 type = struct complex
17180 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17181 type = struct complex
17182 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17183 type = struct complex @{
17184 real_t real;
17185 double imag;
17186 @}
17187 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17188 type = real_t *
17189 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17190 type = double *
17191 @end group
17192 @end smallexample
17193
17194 @noindent
17195 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17196 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17197
17198 @cindex incomplete type
17199 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17200 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17201 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17202 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17203 given these declarations:
17204
17205 @smallexample
17206 struct foo;
17207 struct foo *fooptr;
17208 @end smallexample
17209
17210 @noindent
17211 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17212
17213 @smallexample
17214 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17215 $1 = <incomplete type>
17216 @end smallexample
17217
17218 @noindent
17219 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17220 completely specified.
17221
17222 @cindex unknown type
17223 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17224 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17225 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17226 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17227 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17228 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17229 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17230 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17231
17232 @smallexample
17233 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17234 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17235 @end smallexample
17236
17237 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17238 of such variables.
17239
17240 @kindex info types
17241 @item info types @var{regexp}
17242 @itemx info types
17243 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17244 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17245 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17246 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17247 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17248 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17249 name is @code{value}.
17250
17251 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17252 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17253 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17254
17255 @kindex info type-printers
17256 @item info type-printers
17257 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17258 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17259 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17260 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17261 type printers.
17262
17263 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17264
17265 @kindex enable type-printer
17266 @kindex disable type-printer
17267 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17268 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17269 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17270
17271 @kindex info scope
17272 @cindex local variables
17273 @item info scope @var{location}
17274 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17275 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17276 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17277 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17278 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17279
17280 @smallexample
17281 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17282 Scope for command_line_handler:
17283 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17284 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17285 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17286 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17287 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17288 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17289 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17290 @end smallexample
17291
17292 @noindent
17293 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17294 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17295 collect}.
17296
17297 @kindex info source
17298 @item info source
17299 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17300 the function containing the current point of execution:
17301 @itemize @bullet
17302 @item
17303 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17304 @item
17305 the directory it was compiled in,
17306 @item
17307 its length, in lines,
17308 @item
17309 which programming language it is written in,
17310 @item
17311 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17312 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17313 @item
17314 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17315 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17316 @item
17317 whether the debugging information includes information about
17318 preprocessor macros.
17319 @end itemize
17320
17321
17322 @kindex info sources
17323 @item info sources
17324 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17325 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17326 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17327
17328 @kindex info functions
17329 @item info functions
17330 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17331
17332 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17333 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17334 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17335 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17336 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17337 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17338 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17339 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17340
17341 @kindex info variables
17342 @item info variables
17343 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17344 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17345
17346 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17347 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17348 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17349 @var{regexp}.
17350
17351 @kindex info classes
17352 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17353 @item info classes
17354 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17355 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17356 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17357 expression.
17358
17359 @kindex info selectors
17360 @item info selectors
17361 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17362 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17363 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17364 expression.
17365
17366 @ignore
17367 This was never implemented.
17368 @kindex info methods
17369 @item info methods
17370 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17371 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17372 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17373 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17374 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17375 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17376 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17377 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17378 @end ignore
17379
17380 @cindex opaque data types
17381 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17382 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17383 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17384 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17385 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17386 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17387 another source file. The default is on.
17388
17389 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17390 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17391
17392 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17393 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17394 is printed as follows:
17395 @smallexample
17396 @{<no data fields>@}
17397 @end smallexample
17398
17399 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17400 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17401 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17402
17403 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17404 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17405 @item set print symbol-loading
17406 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17407 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17408 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17409 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17410 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17411 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17412 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17413 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17414 can be annoying.
17415 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17416 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17417 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17418 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17419
17420 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17421 @item show print symbol-loading
17422 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17423 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17424
17425 @kindex maint print symbols
17426 @cindex symbol dump
17427 @kindex maint print psymbols
17428 @cindex partial symbol dump
17429 @kindex maint print msymbols
17430 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17431 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17432 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17433 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17434 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17435 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17436 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17437 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17438 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17439 that objfile.
17440 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17441 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17442 @code{main}.
17443 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17444 source file.
17445
17446 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17447 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17448 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17449 tables.
17450 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17451 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17452 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17453 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17454 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17455 ``ELF symbols''.
17456
17457 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17458 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17459
17460 @kindex maint info symtabs
17461 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17462 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17463 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17464 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17465 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17466 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17467 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17468
17469 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17470 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17471 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17472 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17473 structure in more detail. For example:
17474
17475 @smallexample
17476 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17477 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17478 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17479 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17480 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17481 readin no
17482 fullname (null)
17483 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17484 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17485 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17486 dependencies (none)
17487 @}
17488 @}
17489 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17490 (@value{GDBP})
17491 @end smallexample
17492 @noindent
17493 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17494 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17495 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17496 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17497 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17498
17499 @smallexample
17500 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17501 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17502 line 1574.
17503 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17504 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17505 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17506 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17507 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17508 dirname (null)
17509 fullname (null)
17510 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17511 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17512 debugformat DWARF 2
17513 @}
17514 @}
17515 (@value{GDBP})
17516 @end smallexample
17517
17518 @kindex maint info line-table
17519 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17520 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17521 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17522
17523 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17524 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17525 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17526
17527 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17528 @cindex symbol cache size
17529 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17530 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17531 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17532 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17533 with different sizes.
17534
17535 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17536 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17537 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17538
17539 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17540 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17541 @item maint print symbol-cache
17542 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17543 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17544
17545 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17546 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17547 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17548 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17549 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17550
17551 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17552 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17553 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17554 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17555 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17556 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17557
17558 @end table
17559
17560 @node Altering
17561 @chapter Altering Execution
17562
17563 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17564 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17565 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17566 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17567 program.
17568
17569 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17570 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17571 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17572
17573 @menu
17574 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17575 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17576 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17577 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17578 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17579 * Patching:: Patching your program
17580 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17581 @end menu
17582
17583 @node Assignment
17584 @section Assignment to Variables
17585
17586 @cindex assignment
17587 @cindex setting variables
17588 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17589 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17590
17591 @smallexample
17592 print x=4
17593 @end smallexample
17594
17595 @noindent
17596 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17597 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17598 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17599 information on operators in supported languages.
17600
17601 @kindex set variable
17602 @cindex variables, setting
17603 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17604 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17605 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17606 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17607 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17608
17609 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17610 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17611 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17612 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17613 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17614 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17615 command @code{set width}:
17616
17617 @smallexample
17618 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17619 type = double
17620 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17621 $4 = 13
17622 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17623 Invalid syntax in expression.
17624 @end smallexample
17625
17626 @noindent
17627 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17628 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17629
17630 @smallexample
17631 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17632 @end smallexample
17633
17634 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17635 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17636 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17637 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17638 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17639 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17640
17641 @smallexample
17642 @group
17643 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17644 type = double
17645 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17646 $1 = 1
17647 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17648 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17649 $2 = 1
17650 (@value{GDBP}) r
17651 The program being debugged has been started already.
17652 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17653 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17654 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17655 Invalid bfd target.
17656 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17657 The current BFD target is "=4".
17658 @end group
17659 @end smallexample
17660
17661 @noindent
17662 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17663 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17664 @code{g}, use
17665
17666 @smallexample
17667 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17668 @end smallexample
17669
17670 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17671 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17672 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17673 same length or shorter.
17674 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17675 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17676
17677 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17678 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17679 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17680 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17681 and representation in memory), and
17682
17683 @smallexample
17684 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17685 @end smallexample
17686
17687 @noindent
17688 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17689
17690 @node Jumping
17691 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17692
17693 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17694 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17695 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17696
17697 @table @code
17698 @kindex jump
17699 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17700 @item jump @var{location}
17701 @itemx j @var{location}
17702 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17703 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17704 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17705 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17706 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17707
17708 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17709 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17710 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17711 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17712 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17713 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17714 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17715 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17716 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17717 @end table
17718
17719 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17720 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17721 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17722 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17723 example,
17724
17725 @smallexample
17726 set $pc = 0x485
17727 @end smallexample
17728
17729 @noindent
17730 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17731 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17732 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17733
17734 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17735 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17736 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17737 detail.
17738
17739 @c @group
17740 @node Signaling
17741 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17742 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17743
17744 @table @code
17745 @kindex signal
17746 @item signal @var{signal}
17747 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17748 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17749 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17750 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17751
17752 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17753 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17754 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17755 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17756 signal.
17757
17758 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17759 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17760 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17761 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17762 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17763 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17764 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17765 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17766
17767 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17768 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17769 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17770 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17771 passes the signal directly to your program.
17772
17773 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17774 after executing the command.
17775
17776 @kindex queue-signal
17777 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17778 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17779 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17780 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17781 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17782 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17783 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17784 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17785 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17786
17787 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17788 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17789 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17790 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17791 @code{continue} command.
17792
17793 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17794 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17795 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17796 (@pxref{Signals}).
17797 @end table
17798 @c @end group
17799
17800 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17801 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17802
17803 @node Returning
17804 @section Returning from a Function
17805
17806 @table @code
17807 @cindex returning from a function
17808 @kindex return
17809 @item return
17810 @itemx return @var{expression}
17811 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17812 command. If you give an
17813 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17814 value.
17815 @end table
17816
17817 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17818 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17819 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17820 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17821
17822 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17823 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17824 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17825 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17826 of functions.
17827
17828 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17829 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17830 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17831 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17832 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17833
17834 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17835 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17836 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17837 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17838 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17839 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17840 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17841 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17842 assignment into the right register(s).
17843
17844 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17845 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17846 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17847 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17848 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17849 into a @code{long long int}:
17850
17851 @smallexample
17852 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17853 29 return 31;
17854 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17855 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17856 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17857 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17858 (@value{GDBP})
17859 @end smallexample
17860
17861 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17862 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17863 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17864 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17865 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17866 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17867 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17868 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17869
17870 @smallexample
17871 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17872 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17873 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17874 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17875 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17876 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17877 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17878 (@value{GDBP})
17879 @end smallexample
17880
17881 @node Calling
17882 @section Calling Program Functions
17883
17884 @table @code
17885 @cindex calling functions
17886 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17887 @item print @var{expr}
17888 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17889 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17890 debugged.
17891
17892 @kindex call
17893 @item call @var{expr}
17894 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17895 returned values.
17896
17897 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17898 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17899 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17900 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17901 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17902 value history.
17903 @end table
17904
17905 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17906 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17907 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17908 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17909
17910 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17911 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17912 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17913 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17914 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17915 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17916 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17917 in that case is controlled by the
17918 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17919
17920 @table @code
17921 @item set unwindonsignal
17922 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17923 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17924 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17925 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17926 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17927 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17928 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17929 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17930 received.
17931
17932 @item show unwindonsignal
17933 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17934 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17935 @value{GDBN}.
17936
17937 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17938 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17939 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17940 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17941 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17942 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17943 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17944 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17945 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17946 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17947
17948 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17949 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17950 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17951 @value{GDBN}.
17952
17953 @end table
17954
17955 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
17956
17957 @cindex no debug info functions
17958 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
17959 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
17960 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
17961 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
17962 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
17963 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
17964
17965 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
17966 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
17967 declared return type. For example:
17968
17969 @smallexample
17970 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
17971 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
17972 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
17973 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
17974 @end smallexample
17975
17976 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
17977 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
17978 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
17979 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
17980
17981 @smallexample
17982 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
17983 @end smallexample
17984
17985 @noindent
17986 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
17987
17988 @smallexample
17989 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
17990 @end smallexample
17991
17992 @noindent
17993 these calls are equivalent:
17994
17995 @smallexample
17996 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
17997 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17998 @end smallexample
17999
18000 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18001 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18002 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18003 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18004 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18005 float parameters, and no debug info:
18006
18007 @smallexample
18008 float
18009 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18010 float v1, v2;
18011 @{
18012 return v1 * v2;
18013 @}
18014 @end smallexample
18015
18016 @noindent
18017 you call it like this:
18018
18019 @smallexample
18020 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18021 @end smallexample
18022
18023 @node Patching
18024 @section Patching Programs
18025
18026 @cindex patching binaries
18027 @cindex writing into executables
18028 @cindex writing into corefiles
18029
18030 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18031 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18032 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18033 patching your program's binary.
18034
18035 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18036 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18037 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18038 repairs.
18039
18040 @table @code
18041 @kindex set write
18042 @item set write on
18043 @itemx set write off
18044 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18045 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18046 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18047
18048 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18049 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18050 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18051
18052 @item show write
18053 @kindex show write
18054 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18055 as well as reading.
18056 @end table
18057
18058 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18059 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18060 @cindex injecting code
18061 @cindex writing into executables
18062 @cindex compiling code
18063
18064 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18065 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18066 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18067 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18068
18069 @table @code
18070 @kindex compile code
18071 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18072 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18073 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18074 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18075 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18076 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18077 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18078 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18079 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18080 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18081 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18082 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18083
18084 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18085 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18086 E.g.:
18087
18088 @smallexample
18089 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18090 @end smallexample
18091
18092 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18093 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18094 from actual source code. E.g.:
18095
18096 @smallexample
18097 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18098 @end smallexample
18099
18100 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18101 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18102 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18103 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18104 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18105 editor.
18106
18107 @smallexample
18108 compile code
18109 >printf ("hello\n");
18110 >printf ("world\n");
18111 >end
18112 @end smallexample
18113
18114 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18115 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18116 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18117 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18118 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18119 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18120 inferior symbols otherwise.
18121
18122 @kindex compile file
18123 @item compile file @var{filename}
18124 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18125 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18126
18127 @smallexample
18128 compile file /home/user/example.c
18129 @end smallexample
18130 @end table
18131
18132 @table @code
18133 @item compile print @var{expr}
18134 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18135 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18136 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18137 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18138 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18139 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18140 Formats}.
18141
18142 @item compile print
18143 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18144 @cindex reprint the last value
18145 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18146 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18147 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18148 multiple-line editor.
18149 @end table
18150
18151 @noindent
18152 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18153
18154 @table @code
18155 @anchor{set debug compile}
18156 @item set debug compile
18157 @cindex compile command debugging info
18158 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18159 injecting the code. The default is off.
18160
18161 @item show debug compile
18162 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18163 compiling and injecting the code.
18164 @end table
18165
18166 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18167
18168 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18169 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18170 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18171 injecting process.
18172
18173 @noindent
18174 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18175
18176 @table @asis
18177 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18178 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18179 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18180 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18181
18182 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18183 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18184 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18185 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18186 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18187 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18188 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18189 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18190
18191 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18192 @end table
18193
18194 @noindent
18195 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18196
18197 @table @code
18198 @item set compile-args
18199 @cindex compile command options override
18200 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18201 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18202 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18203 compilation.
18204
18205 @item show compile-args
18206 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18207 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18208 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18209 @end table
18210
18211 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18212
18213 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18214 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18215 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18216
18217 @table @asis
18218 @item C code examples and caveats
18219 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18220 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18221 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18222 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18223 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18224
18225 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18226 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18227 much like any other normal debugging session.
18228
18229 @smallexample
18230 void function1 (void)
18231 @{
18232 int i = 42;
18233 printf ("function 1\n");
18234 @}
18235
18236 void function2 (void)
18237 @{
18238 int j = 12;
18239 function1 ();
18240 @}
18241
18242 int main(void)
18243 @{
18244 int k = 6;
18245 int *p;
18246 function2 ();
18247 return 0;
18248 @}
18249 @end smallexample
18250
18251 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18252 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18253 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18254
18255 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18256 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18257 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18258 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18259 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18260
18261 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18262 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18263 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18264 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18265 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18266 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18267 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18268 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18269 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18270 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18271
18272 @smallexample
18273 compile code k = 3;
18274 @end smallexample
18275
18276 @noindent
18277 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18278 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18279 @code{compile} command changes it.
18280
18281 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18282 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18283 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18284 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18285 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18286
18287 @smallexample
18288 compile code j = 3;
18289 @end smallexample
18290
18291 @noindent
18292 will result in a compilation error message.
18293
18294 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18295 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18296 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18297
18298 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18299 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18300 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18301 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18302
18303 @smallexample
18304 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18305 @end smallexample
18306
18307 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18308 command has completed:
18309
18310 @smallexample
18311 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18312 @end smallexample
18313
18314 @noindent
18315 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18316 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18317 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18318 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18319 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18320
18321 @smallexample
18322 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18323 @end smallexample
18324
18325 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18326 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18327 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18328 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18329 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18330 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18331 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18332 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18333
18334 @smallexample
18335 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18336 @end smallexample
18337
18338 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18339 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18340 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18341 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18342 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18343 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18344 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18345
18346 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18347 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18348 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18349 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18350 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18351 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18352
18353 @smallexample
18354 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18355 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18356 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18357 Compilation failed.
18358 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18359 42
18360 @end smallexample
18361
18362 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18363 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18364 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18365 will print to the console.
18366 @end table
18367
18368 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18369
18370 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18371 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18372 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18373 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18374 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18375 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18376 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18377 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18378
18379
18380 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18381 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18382 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18383 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18384 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18385 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18386 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18387
18388 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18389 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18390 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18391 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18392 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18393 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18394 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18395
18396 @table @code
18397 @item set compile-gcc
18398 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18399 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18400 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18401 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18402 default.
18403
18404 @item show compile-gcc
18405 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18406 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18407 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18408 @end table
18409
18410 @node GDB Files
18411 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18412
18413 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18414 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18415 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18416 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18417
18418 @menu
18419 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18420 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18421 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18422 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18423 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18424 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18425 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18426 @end menu
18427
18428 @node Files
18429 @section Commands to Specify Files
18430
18431 @cindex symbol table
18432 @cindex core dump file
18433
18434 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18435 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18436 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18437 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18438
18439 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18440 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18441 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18442 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18443 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18444 new files are useful.
18445
18446 @table @code
18447 @cindex executable file
18448 @kindex file
18449 @item file @var{filename}
18450 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18451 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18452 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18453 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18454 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18455 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18456 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18457 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18458
18459 @cindex unlinked object files
18460 @cindex patching object files
18461 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18462 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18463 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18464 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18465 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18466 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18467 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18468 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18469
18470 @item file
18471 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18472 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18473
18474 @kindex exec-file
18475 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18476 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18477 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18478 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18479 discard information on the executable file.
18480
18481 @kindex symbol-file
18482 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18483 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18484 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18485 table and program to run from the same file.
18486
18487 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18488 program's symbol table.
18489
18490 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18491 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18492 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18493 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18494 @value{GDBN}.
18495
18496 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18497 executing it once.
18498
18499 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18500 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18501 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18502 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18503 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18504 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18505 optimized code.
18506
18507 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18508 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18509 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18510 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18511 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18512
18513 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18514 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18515 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18516 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18517 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18518 Warnings and Messages}.)
18519
18520 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18521 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18522 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18523 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18524 in stabs format.
18525
18526 @kindex readnow
18527 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18528 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18529 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18530 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18531 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18532 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18533 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18534 entire symbol table available.
18535
18536 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18537 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18538 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18539 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18540 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18541 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18542 @c files.
18543
18544 @kindex core-file
18545 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18546 @itemx core
18547 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18548 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18549 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18550 executable file itself for other parts.
18551
18552 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18553 to be used.
18554
18555 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18556 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18557 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18558 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18559 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18560
18561 @kindex add-symbol-file
18562 @cindex dynamic linking
18563 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18564 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18565 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18566 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18567 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18568 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18569 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18570 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18571 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18572 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18573 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18574 @var{address} as an expression.
18575
18576 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18577 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18578 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18579 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18580
18581 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18582
18583 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18584 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18585 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18586 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18587 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18588 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18589 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18590 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18591 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18592
18593 @itemize @bullet
18594 @item
18595 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18596 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18597 @item
18598 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18599 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18600 @item
18601 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18602 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18603 @end itemize
18604
18605 @noindent
18606 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18607 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18608 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18609 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18610 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18611 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18612 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18613 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18614 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18615 way.
18616
18617 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18618
18619 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18620 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18621 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18622 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18623 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18624 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18625
18626 @smallexample
18627 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18628 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18629 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18630 (y or n) y
18631 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18632 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18633 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18634 (gdb)
18635 @end smallexample
18636
18637
18638 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18639
18640 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18641 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18642 @cindex load symbols from memory
18643 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18644 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18645 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18646 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18647 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18648 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18649 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18650 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18651 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18652
18653 @kindex section
18654 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18655 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18656 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18657 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18658 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18659 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18660 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18661 their addresses.
18662
18663 @kindex info files
18664 @kindex info target
18665 @item info files
18666 @itemx info target
18667 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18668 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18669 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18670 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18671 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18672 current ones.
18673
18674 @kindex maint info sections
18675 @item maint info sections
18676 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18677 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18678 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18679 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18680 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18681 may be arbitrarily combined):
18682
18683 @table @code
18684 @item ALLOBJ
18685 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18686 @item @var{sections}
18687 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18688 @item @var{section-flags}
18689 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18690 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18691 @table @code
18692 @item ALLOC
18693 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18694 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18695 @item LOAD
18696 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18697 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18698 @item RELOC
18699 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18700 @item READONLY
18701 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18702 @item CODE
18703 Section contains executable code only.
18704 @item DATA
18705 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18706 @item ROM
18707 Section will reside in ROM.
18708 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18709 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18710 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18711 Section is not empty.
18712 @item NEVER_LOAD
18713 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18714 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18715 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18716 COFF shared library information.
18717 @item IS_COMMON
18718 Section contains common symbols.
18719 @end table
18720 @end table
18721 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18722 @cindex read-only sections
18723 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18724 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18725 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18726 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18727 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18728 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18729 enhancement to debugging performance.
18730
18731 The default is off.
18732
18733 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18734 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18735 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18736 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18737
18738 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18739 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18740 @end table
18741
18742 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18743 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18744 name and remembers it that way.
18745
18746 @cindex shared libraries
18747 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18748 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18749 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18750 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18751
18752 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18753 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18754
18755 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18756 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18757 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18758 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18759 debugging a core file).
18760
18761 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18762 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18763 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18764
18765 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18766 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18767 particularly large or there are many of them.
18768
18769 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18770 commands:
18771
18772 @table @code
18773 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18774 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18775 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18776 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18777 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18778 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18779 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18780 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18781
18782 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18783 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18784 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18785 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18786 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18787 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18788 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18789 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18790 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18791
18792 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18793 @item show auto-solib-add
18794 Display the current autoloading mode.
18795 @end table
18796
18797 @cindex load shared library
18798 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18799 command:
18800
18801 @table @code
18802 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18803 @kindex info share
18804 @item info share @var{regex}
18805 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18806 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18807 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18808 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18809
18810 @kindex info dll
18811 @item info dll @var{regex}
18812 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18813
18814 @kindex sharedlibrary
18815 @kindex share
18816 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18817 @itemx share @var{regex}
18818 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18819 Unix regular expression.
18820 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18821 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18822 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18823 loaded.
18824
18825 @item nosharedlibrary
18826 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18827 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18828 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18829 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18830 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18831 discarded.
18832 @end table
18833
18834 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18835 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18836 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18837 Catchpoints}).
18838
18839 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18840 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18841 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18842 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18843
18844 @table @code
18845 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18846 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18847 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18848 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18849 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18850 shared library.
18851
18852 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18853 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18854 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18855 library events happen.
18856 @end table
18857
18858 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18859 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18860 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18861 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18862 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18863 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18864 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18865 not.
18866
18867 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18868 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18869 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18870 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18871 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18872
18873 @table @code
18874 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18875 @cindex system root, alternate
18876 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18877 @kindex set sysroot
18878 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18879 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18880 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18881 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18882 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18883 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18884 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18885 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18886 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18887 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18888 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18889 @var{path}.
18890
18891 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18892 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18893 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18894 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18895 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18896 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18897 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18898 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18899 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18900 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18901 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18902 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18903 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18904 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18905
18906 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18907 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18908 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18909 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18910 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18911
18912 @smallexample
18913 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18914 @end smallexample
18915
18916 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18917 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18918 system:
18919
18920 @smallexample
18921 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18922 @end smallexample
18923
18924 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18925 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18926 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18927 colons:
18928
18929 @smallexample
18930 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18931 @end smallexample
18932
18933 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18934 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18935 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18936 @samp{z}):
18937
18938 @smallexample
18939 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18940 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18941 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18942 @end smallexample
18943
18944 @noindent
18945 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18946 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18947 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18948
18949 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18950 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18951
18952 @smallexample
18953 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18954 @end smallexample
18955
18956 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18957 if you don't want or need to.
18958
18959 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18960 sysroot}.
18961
18962 @cindex default system root
18963 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18964 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18965 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18966 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18967 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18968 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18969 location.
18970
18971 @kindex show sysroot
18972 @item show sysroot
18973 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18974
18975 @kindex set solib-search-path
18976 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18977 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18978 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18979 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18980 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18981 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18982 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18983 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18984 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18985 of shared library symbols.
18986
18987 @kindex show solib-search-path
18988 @item show solib-search-path
18989 Display the current shared library search path.
18990
18991 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18992 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18993 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18994 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18995 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18996
18997 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18998 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18999 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19000 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19001 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19002 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19003 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19004 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19005 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19006 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19007 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19008 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19009 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19010 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19011 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19012 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19013 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19014 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19015 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19016 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19017 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19018 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19019
19020 @table @code
19021 @item unix
19022 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19023 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19024 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19025 the forward slash.
19026
19027 @item dos-based
19028 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19029 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19030 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19031 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19032 considered directory separators.
19033
19034 @item auto
19035 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19036 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19037 This is the default.
19038 @end table
19039 @end table
19040
19041 @cindex file name canonicalization
19042 @cindex base name differences
19043 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19044 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19045 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19046 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19047 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19048 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19049 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19050 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19051 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19052 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19053 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19054 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19055 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19056 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19057 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19058
19059 @table @code
19060 @item set basenames-may-differ
19061 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19062 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19063
19064 @item show basenames-may-differ
19065 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19066 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19067 @end table
19068
19069 @node File Caching
19070 @section File Caching
19071 @cindex caching of opened files
19072 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19073
19074 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19075 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19076 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19077 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19078
19079 @table @code
19080 @kindex maint info bfds
19081 @item maint info bfds
19082 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19083 @value{GDBN}.
19084
19085 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19086 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19087 @kindex bfd caching
19088 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19089 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19090 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19091 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19092 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19093 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19094 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19095 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19096 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19097
19098 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19099 @kindex bfd caching
19100 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19101 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19102
19103 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19104 @kindex bfd caching
19105 @item show debug bfd-cache
19106 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19107 @end table
19108
19109 @node Separate Debug Files
19110 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19111 @cindex separate debugging information files
19112 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19113 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19114 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19115 @cindex global debugging information directories
19116 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19117 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19118
19119 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19120 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19121 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19122 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19123 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19124 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19125 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19126
19127 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19128 file:
19129
19130 @itemize @bullet
19131 @item
19132 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19133 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19134 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19135 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19136 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19137 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19138 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19139 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19140
19141 @item
19142 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19143 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19144 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19145 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19146 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19147 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19148 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19149 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19150 below.
19151 @end itemize
19152
19153 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19154 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19155
19156 @itemize @bullet
19157 @item
19158 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19159 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19160 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19161 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19162 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19163
19164 @item
19165 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19166 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19167 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19168 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19169 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19170 hex characters, not 10.)
19171 @end itemize
19172
19173 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19174 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19175 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19176 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19177 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19178 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19179
19180 @itemize @minus
19181 @item
19182 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19183 @item
19184 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19185 @item
19186 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19187 @item
19188 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19189 @end itemize
19190
19191 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19192 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19193 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19194 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19195 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19196
19197 @table @code
19198
19199 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19200 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19201 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19202 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19203 concatenating them by a path separator.
19204
19205 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19206 @item show debug-file-directory
19207 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19208 information files.
19209
19210 @end table
19211
19212 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19213 @cindex debug link sections
19214 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19215 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19216
19217 @itemize
19218 @item
19219 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19220 a zero byte,
19221 @item
19222 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19223 boundary within the section, and
19224 @item
19225 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19226 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19227 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19228 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19229 @end itemize
19230
19231 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19232 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19233 described above.
19234
19235 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19236 @cindex build ID sections
19237 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19238 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19239 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19240 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19241 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19242 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19243 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19244 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19245 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19246
19247 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19248 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19249 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19250 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19251 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19252 in an ordinary executable.
19253
19254 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19255 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19256 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19257 following commands:
19258
19259 @smallexample
19260 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19261 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19262 @end smallexample
19263
19264 @noindent
19265 These commands remove the debugging
19266 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19267 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19268 two files:
19269
19270 @itemize @bullet
19271 @item
19272 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19273 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19274
19275 @smallexample
19276 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19277 @end smallexample
19278
19279 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19280 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19281 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19282 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19283
19284 @item
19285 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19286 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19287 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19288 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19289 @end itemize
19290
19291 @noindent
19292
19293 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19294 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19295 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19296
19297 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19298 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19299 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19300 @c different ways!
19301 @ifhtml
19302 @display
19303 @html
19304 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19305 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19306 @end html
19307 @end display
19308 @end ifhtml
19309 @ifnothtml
19310 @display
19311 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19312 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19313 @end display
19314 @end ifnothtml
19315
19316 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19317 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19318 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19319 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19320 CRC.
19321
19322 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19323 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19324 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19325 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19326 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19327
19328 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19329 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19330 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19331 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19332 @code{0xffffffff}.
19333
19334 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19335 @smallexample
19336 unsigned long
19337 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19338 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19339 @{
19340 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19341 @{
19342 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19343 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19344 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19345 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19346 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19347 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19348 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19349 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19350 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19351 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19352 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19353 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19354 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19355 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19356 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19357 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19358 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19359 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19360 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19361 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19362 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19363 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19364 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19365 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19366 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19367 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19368 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19369 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19370 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19371 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19372 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19373 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19374 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19375 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19376 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19377 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19378 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19379 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19380 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19381 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19382 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19383 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19384 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19385 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19386 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19387 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19388 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19389 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19390 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19391 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19392 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19393 0x2d02ef8d
19394 @};
19395 unsigned char *end;
19396
19397 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19398 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19399 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19400 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19401 @}
19402 @end smallexample
19403
19404 @noindent
19405 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19406
19407 @node MiniDebugInfo
19408 @section Debugging information in a special section
19409 @cindex separate debug sections
19410 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19411
19412 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19413 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19414 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19415 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19416
19417 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19418 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19419 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19420 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19421 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19422 debugging information might be included in the section.
19423
19424 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19425 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19426 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19427
19428 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19429 standard utilities:
19430
19431 @smallexample
19432 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19433 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19434 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19435 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19436
19437 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19438 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19439 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19440 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19441 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19442 | sort > funcsyms
19443
19444 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19445 # table.
19446 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19447
19448 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19449 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19450
19451 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19452 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19453 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19454 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19455
19456 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19457 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19458
19459 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19460 # original binary.
19461 xz mini_debuginfo
19462 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19463 @end smallexample
19464
19465 @node Index Files
19466 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19467 @cindex index files
19468 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19469
19470 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19471 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19472 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19473 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19474 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19475 startup.
19476
19477 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19478 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19479 using @command{objcopy}.
19480
19481 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19482
19483 @table @code
19484 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19485 @kindex save gdb-index
19486 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19487 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19488 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19489 @var{directory}.
19490 @end table
19491
19492 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19493 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19494
19495 @smallexample
19496 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19497 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19498 @end smallexample
19499
19500 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19501 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19502 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19503 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19504 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19505 The default is @code{off}.
19506 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19507 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19508
19509 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19510 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19511
19512 @smallexample
19513 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19514 @end smallexample
19515
19516 Instead you must do, for example,
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19520 @end smallexample
19521
19522 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19523 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19524 currently work for programs using Ada.
19525
19526 @node Symbol Errors
19527 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19528
19529 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19530 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19531 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19532 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19533 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19534 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19535 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19536 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19537 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19538 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19539 Messages}).
19540
19541 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19542
19543 @table @code
19544 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19545
19546 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19547 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19548 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19549 in its outer scope blocks.
19550
19551 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19552 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19553 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19554 function.
19555
19556 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19557
19558 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19559 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19560 do so.
19561
19562 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19563 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19564 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19565 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19566 Messages}.)
19567
19568 @item bad block start address patched
19569
19570 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19571 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19572 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19573
19574 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19575 starting on the previous source line.
19576
19577 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19578
19579 @cindex foo
19580 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19581 larger than the size of the string table.
19582
19583 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19584 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19585 with this name.
19586
19587 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19588
19589 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19590 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19591 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19592
19593 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19594 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19595 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19596 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19597 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19598 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19599
19600 @item stub type has NULL name
19601
19602 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19603
19604 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19605 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19606 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19607 it.
19608
19609 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19610
19611 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19612
19613 @end table
19614
19615 @node Data Files
19616 @section GDB Data Files
19617
19618 @cindex prefix for data files
19619 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19620 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19621
19622 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19623 is currently using.
19624
19625 @table @code
19626 @kindex set data-directory
19627 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19628 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19629 to @var{directory}.
19630
19631 @kindex show data-directory
19632 @item show data-directory
19633 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19634 @end table
19635
19636 @cindex default data directory
19637 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19638 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19639 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19640 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19641 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19642 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19643 location.
19644
19645 The data directory may also be specified with the
19646 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19647 @xref{Mode Options}.
19648
19649 @node Targets
19650 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19651
19652 @cindex debugging target
19653 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19654
19655 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19656 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19657 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19658 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19659 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19660 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19661 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19662 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19663
19664 @cindex target architecture
19665 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19666 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19667 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19668 command.
19669
19670 @table @code
19671 @kindex set architecture
19672 @kindex show architecture
19673 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19674 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19675 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19676 supported architectures.
19677
19678 @item show architecture
19679 Show the current target architecture.
19680
19681 @item set processor
19682 @itemx processor
19683 @kindex set processor
19684 @kindex show processor
19685 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19686 and @code{show architecture}.
19687 @end table
19688
19689 @menu
19690 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19691 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19692 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19693 @end menu
19694
19695 @node Active Targets
19696 @section Active Targets
19697
19698 @cindex stacking targets
19699 @cindex active targets
19700 @cindex multiple targets
19701
19702 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19703 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19704 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19705 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19706 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19707 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19708 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19709 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19710 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19711
19712 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19713 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19714 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19715 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19716
19717 @node Target Commands
19718 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19719
19720 @table @code
19721 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19722 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19723 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19724 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19725 protocol of the target machine.
19726
19727 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19728 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19729 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19730
19731 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19732 after executing the command.
19733
19734 @kindex help target
19735 @item help target
19736 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19737 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19738 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19739
19740 @item help target @var{name}
19741 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19742 select it.
19743
19744 @kindex set gnutarget
19745 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19746 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19747 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19748 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19749 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19750 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19751
19752 @quotation
19753 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19754 you must know the actual BFD name.
19755 @end quotation
19756
19757 @noindent
19758 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19759
19760 @kindex show gnutarget
19761 @item show gnutarget
19762 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19763 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19764 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19765 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19766 @end table
19767
19768 @cindex common targets
19769 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19770 configuration):
19771
19772 @table @code
19773 @kindex target
19774 @item target exec @var{program}
19775 @cindex executable file target
19776 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19777 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19778
19779 @item target core @var{filename}
19780 @cindex core dump file target
19781 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19782 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19783
19784 @item target remote @var{medium}
19785 @cindex remote target
19786 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19787 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19788 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19789
19790 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19791 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19792
19793 @smallexample
19794 target remote /dev/ttya
19795 @end smallexample
19796
19797 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19798 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19799 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19800 clobbered by the download.
19801
19802 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19803 @cindex built-in simulator target
19804 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19805 In general,
19806 @smallexample
19807 target sim
19808 load
19809 run
19810 @end smallexample
19811 @noindent
19812 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19813 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19814 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19815 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19816 Processors}.
19817
19818 @item target native
19819 @cindex native target
19820 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19821 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19822 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19823 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19824
19825 @end table
19826
19827 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19828 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19829
19830 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19831 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19832 various aspects of this process.
19833
19834 @table @code
19835
19836 @item set hash
19837 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19838 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19839 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19840 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19841 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19842 monitor.
19843
19844 @item show hash
19845 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19846 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19847
19848 @item set debug monitor
19849 @kindex set debug monitor
19850 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19851 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19852 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19853
19854 @item show debug monitor
19855 @kindex show debug monitor
19856 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19857 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19858 @end table
19859
19860 @table @code
19861
19862 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19863 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19864 @anchor{load}
19865 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19866 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19867 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19868 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19869 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19870 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19871
19872 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19873 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19874 target is @dots{}}''
19875
19876 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19877 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19878 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19879 specifies a fixed address.
19880 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19881
19882 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19883 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19884 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19885
19886 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19887 load programs into flash memory.
19888
19889 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19890 @end table
19891
19892 @table @code
19893
19894 @kindex flash-erase
19895 @item flash-erase
19896 @anchor{flash-erase}
19897
19898 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19899
19900 @end table
19901
19902 @node Byte Order
19903 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19904
19905 @cindex choosing target byte order
19906 @cindex target byte order
19907
19908 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19909 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19910 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19911 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19912 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19913 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19914
19915 @table @code
19916 @kindex set endian
19917 @item set endian big
19918 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19919
19920 @item set endian little
19921 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19922
19923 @item set endian auto
19924 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19925 executable.
19926
19927 @item show endian
19928 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19929
19930 @end table
19931
19932 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19933 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19934 target system.
19935
19936
19937 @node Remote Debugging
19938 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19939 @cindex remote debugging
19940
19941 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19942 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19943 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19944 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19945 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19946
19947 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19948 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19949 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19950 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19951 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19952 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19953
19954 Other remote targets may be available in your
19955 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19956
19957 @menu
19958 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19959 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19960 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19961 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19962 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19963 @end menu
19964
19965 @node Connecting
19966 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19967 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19968 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19969 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19970 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19971 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19972 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19973
19974 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19975 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19976 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19977 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19978
19979 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19980
19981 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19982 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19983 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19984 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19985
19986 @table @asis
19987
19988 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19989 @item Result of detach or program exit
19990 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19991 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19992 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19993
19994 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19995 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19996 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19997 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19998
19999 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20000 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20001 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20002 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20003
20004 @item Specifying the program to debug
20005 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20006 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20007 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20008 target.
20009
20010 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20011 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20012 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20013
20014 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20015 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20016 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20017 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20018
20019 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20020 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20021 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20022 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20023 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20024 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20025 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20026 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20027 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20028
20029 @item The @code{run} command
20030 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20031 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20032 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20033 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20034 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20035
20036 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20037 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20038 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20039 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20040 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20041
20042 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20043 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20044 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20045 @code{target remote} mode.
20046
20047 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20048 @item Attaching
20049 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20050 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20051 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20052
20053 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20054 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20055 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20056 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20057 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20058
20059 @end table
20060
20061 @anchor{Host and target files}
20062 @subsection Host and Target Files
20063 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20064 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20065
20066 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20067 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20068 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20069 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20070 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20071
20072 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20073 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20074 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20075 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20076 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20077
20078 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20079 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20080 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20081 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20082 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20083 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20084 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20085 target libraries.
20086
20087 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20088 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20089 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20090 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20091 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20092 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20093 programs.
20094
20095 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20096 @cindex remote connection commands
20097 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20098 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20099 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20100 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20101 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20102 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20103 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20104
20105 @table @code
20106
20107 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20108 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20109 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20110 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20111 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20112
20113 @smallexample
20114 target remote /dev/ttyb
20115 @end smallexample
20116
20117 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20118 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20119 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20120 @code{target} command.
20121
20122 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20123 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20124 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20125 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20126 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20127 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20128 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20129 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20130 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20131 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20132 target.
20133
20134 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20135 @code{manyfarms}:
20136
20137 @smallexample
20138 target remote manyfarms:2828
20139 @end smallexample
20140
20141 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20142 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20143 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20144 port 1234 on your local machine:
20145
20146 @smallexample
20147 target remote :1234
20148 @end smallexample
20149 @noindent
20150
20151 Note that the colon is still required here.
20152
20153 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20154 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20155 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20156 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20157 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20158
20159 @smallexample
20160 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20161 @end smallexample
20162
20163 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20164 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20165 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20166 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20167
20168 @item target remote | @var{command}
20169 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20170 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20171 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20172 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20173 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20174 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20175 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20176 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20177 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20178
20179 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20180 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20181 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20182
20183 @end table
20184
20185 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20186 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20187 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20188 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20189 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20190 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20191 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20192
20193 @smallexample
20194 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20195 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20196 @end smallexample
20197
20198 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20199 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20200 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20201 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20202
20203 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20204 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20205
20206 @table @code
20207 @kindex detach (remote)
20208 @item detach
20209 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20210 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20211 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20212 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20213 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20214 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20215 still connected to the target.
20216
20217 @kindex disconnect
20218 @item disconnect
20219 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20220 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20221 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20222 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20223 another target.
20224
20225 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20226 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20227 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20228 @kindex monitor
20229 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20230 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20231 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20232 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20233 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20234 and implement.
20235 @end table
20236
20237 @node File Transfer
20238 @section Sending files to a remote system
20239 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20240 @cindex file transfer
20241 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20242
20243 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20244 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20245 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20246 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20247 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20248 the only way to upload or download files.
20249
20250 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20251
20252 @table @code
20253 @kindex remote put
20254 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20255 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20256 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20257
20258 @kindex remote get
20259 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20260 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20261 on the host system.
20262
20263 @kindex remote delete
20264 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20265 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20266
20267 @end table
20268
20269 @node Server
20270 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20271
20272 @kindex gdbserver
20273 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20274 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20275 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20276 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20277 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20278
20279 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20280 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20281 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20282 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20283 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20284 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20285 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20286 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20287 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20288 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20289 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20290 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20291 choice for debugging.
20292
20293 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20294 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20295 protocol.
20296
20297 @quotation
20298 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20299 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20300 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20301 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20302 @code{gdbserver}.
20303 @end quotation
20304
20305 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20306 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20307 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20308 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20309
20310 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20311 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20312 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20313 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20314 system does all the symbol handling.
20315
20316 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20317 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20318 syntax is:
20319
20320 @smallexample
20321 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20322 @end smallexample
20323
20324 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20325 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20326 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20327 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20328 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20329 @file{/dev/com1}:
20330
20331 @smallexample
20332 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20333 @end smallexample
20334
20335 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20336 with it.
20337
20338 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20339
20340 @smallexample
20341 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20342 @end smallexample
20343
20344 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20345 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20346 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20347 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20348 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20349 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20350 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20351 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20352 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20353 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20354 @code{target remote} command.
20355
20356 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20357 with ssh:
20358
20359 @smallexample
20360 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20361 @end smallexample
20362
20363 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20364 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20365 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20366 You could elide it if you want to.
20367
20368 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20369 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20370 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20371 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20372
20373 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20374 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20375 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20376 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20377
20378 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20379 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20380
20381 @smallexample
20382 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20383 @end smallexample
20384
20385 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20386 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20387
20388 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20389 @value{GDBN} attach command
20390 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20391
20392 @pindex pidof
20393 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20394 @code{pidof} utility:
20395
20396 @smallexample
20397 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20398 @end smallexample
20399
20400 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20401 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20402 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20403
20404 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20405
20406 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20407 port.
20408
20409 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20410 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20411 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20412 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20413 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20414 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20415 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20416 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20417
20418 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20419 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20420 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20421
20422 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20423 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20424 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20425 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20426 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20427 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20428 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20429 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20430 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20431 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20432 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20433 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20434
20435 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20436 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20437
20438 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20439 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20440 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20441 program. For more information,
20442 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20443
20444 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20445 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20446 status information about the debugging process.
20447 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20448 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20449 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20450 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20451
20452 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20453 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20454 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20455 Possible options are:
20456
20457 @table @code
20458 @item none
20459 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20460 @item all
20461 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20462 @item timestamps
20463 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20464 @end table
20465
20466 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20467 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20468
20469 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20470 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20471 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20472 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20473 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20474
20475 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20476 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20477 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20478 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20479
20480 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20481 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20482 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20483 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20484
20485 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20486 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20487 environment:
20488
20489 @smallexample
20490 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20491 @end smallexample
20492
20493 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20494 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20495
20496 @smallexample
20497 $ gdbserver --selftest
20498 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20499 @end smallexample
20500
20501 These tests are disabled in release.
20502 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20503
20504 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20505 @itemize
20506
20507 @item
20508 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20509
20510 @item
20511 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20512 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20513 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20514 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20515 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20516 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20517
20518 @item
20519 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20520 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20521 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20522 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20523 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20524 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20525 program is already on the target.
20526
20527 @end itemize
20528
20529 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20530 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20531 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20532
20533 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20534 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20535 Here are the available commands.
20536
20537 @table @code
20538 @item monitor help
20539 List the available monitor commands.
20540
20541 @item monitor set debug 0
20542 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20543 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20544
20545 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20546 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20547 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20548 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20549
20550 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20551 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20552 Possible options are:
20553
20554 @table @code
20555 @item none
20556 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20557 @item all
20558 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20559 @item timestamps
20560 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20561 @end table
20562
20563 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20564 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20565
20566 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20567 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20568 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20569 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20570 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20571 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20572
20573 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20574 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20575
20576 @item monitor exit
20577 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20578 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20579 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20580 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20581 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20582
20583 @end table
20584
20585 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20586 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20587
20588 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20589 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20590
20591 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20592 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20593 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20594 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20595 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20596 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20597 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20598 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20599 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20600 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20601 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20602 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20603
20604 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20605
20606 @table @code
20607 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20608
20609 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20610 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20611 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20612
20613 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20614
20615 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20616 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20617 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20618 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20619 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20620 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20621
20622 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20623
20624 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20625 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20626 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20627 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20628 command for that. For example:
20629
20630 @smallexample
20631 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20632 @end smallexample
20633
20634 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20635 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20636 @end table
20637
20638 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20639 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20640 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20641 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20642 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20643 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20644 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20645 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20646 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20647 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20648
20649 @smallexample
20650 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20651 @end smallexample
20652
20653 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20654
20655 @smallexample
20656 $ gdb myprogram
20657 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20658 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20659 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20660 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20661 @end smallexample
20662
20663 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20664 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20665 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20666 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20667 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20668 tracing.
20669
20670 @node Remote Configuration
20671 @section Remote Configuration
20672
20673 @kindex set remote
20674 @kindex show remote
20675 This section documents the configuration options available when
20676 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20677 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20678 system-call-allowed}.
20679
20680 @table @code
20681 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20682 @cindex address size for remote targets
20683 @cindex bits in remote address
20684 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20685 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20686 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20687 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20688
20689 @item show remoteaddresssize
20690 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20691
20692 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20693 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20694 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20695 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20696 remote targets.
20697
20698 @item show serial baud
20699 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20700
20701 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20702 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20703 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20704
20705 @item show serial parity
20706 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20707
20708 @item set remotebreak
20709 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20710 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20711 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20712 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20713 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20714 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20715 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20716 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20717
20718 @item show remotebreak
20719 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20720 interrupt the remote program.
20721
20722 @item set remoteflow on
20723 @itemx set remoteflow off
20724 @kindex set remoteflow
20725 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20726 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20727
20728 @item show remoteflow
20729 @kindex show remoteflow
20730 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20731
20732 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20733 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20734 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20735 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20736 @code{ascii}.
20737
20738 @item show remotelogbase
20739 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20740 protocol.
20741
20742 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20743 @cindex record serial communications on file
20744 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20745 default is not to record at all.
20746
20747 @item show remotelogfile.
20748 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20749 serial communications.
20750
20751 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20752 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20753 @cindex remote timeout
20754 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20755 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20756
20757 @item show remotetimeout
20758 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20759 responses.
20760
20761 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20762 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20763 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20764 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20765 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20766 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20767 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20768 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20769
20770 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20771 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20772 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20773 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20774 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20775 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20776 as unlimited.
20777
20778 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20779 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20780 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20781
20782 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20783 @itemx show remote exec-file
20784 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20785 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20786 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20787 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20788 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20789 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20790
20791 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20792 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20793 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20794 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20795 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20796 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20797 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20798 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20799 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20800 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20801
20802 @item show interrupt-sequence
20803 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20804 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20805 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20806 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20807
20808 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20809 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20810 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20811 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20812 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20813 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20814
20815 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20816 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20817 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20818
20819 @kindex set tcp
20820 @kindex show tcp
20821 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20822 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20823 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20824 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20825 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20826 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20827 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20828 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20829 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20830
20831 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20832 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20833
20834 @item show tcp auto-retry
20835 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20836
20837 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20838 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20839 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20840 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20841 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20842 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20843 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20844 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20845 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20846 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20847 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20848
20849 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20850 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20851 @end table
20852
20853 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20854 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20855 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20856 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20857 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20858 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20859 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20860 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20861 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20862
20863 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20864 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20865 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20866 @value{GDBN} developers.
20867
20868 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20869 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20870 are:
20871
20872 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20873 @item Command Name
20874 @tab Remote Packet
20875 @tab Related Features
20876
20877 @item @code{fetch-register}
20878 @tab @code{p}
20879 @tab @code{info registers}
20880
20881 @item @code{set-register}
20882 @tab @code{P}
20883 @tab @code{set}
20884
20885 @item @code{binary-download}
20886 @tab @code{X}
20887 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20888
20889 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20890 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20891 @tab @code{info auxv}
20892
20893 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20894 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20895 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20896
20897 @item @code{attach}
20898 @tab @code{vAttach}
20899 @tab @code{attach}
20900
20901 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20902 @tab @code{vCont}
20903 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20904
20905 @item @code{run}
20906 @tab @code{vRun}
20907 @tab @code{run}
20908
20909 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20910 @tab @code{Z0}
20911 @tab @code{break}
20912
20913 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20914 @tab @code{Z1}
20915 @tab @code{hbreak}
20916
20917 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20918 @tab @code{Z2}
20919 @tab @code{watch}
20920
20921 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20922 @tab @code{Z3}
20923 @tab @code{rwatch}
20924
20925 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20926 @tab @code{Z4}
20927 @tab @code{awatch}
20928
20929 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20930 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20931 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20932
20933 @item @code{target-features}
20934 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20935 @tab @code{set architecture}
20936
20937 @item @code{library-info}
20938 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20939 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20940
20941 @item @code{memory-map}
20942 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20943 @tab @code{info mem}
20944
20945 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20946 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20947 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20948
20949 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20950 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20951 @tab @code{info spu}
20952
20953 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20954 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20955 @tab @code{info spu}
20956
20957 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20958 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20959 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20960
20961 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20962 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20963 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20964
20965 @item @code{threads}
20966 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20967 @tab @code{info threads}
20968
20969 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20970 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20971 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20972
20973 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20974 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20975 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20976
20977 @item @code{search-memory}
20978 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20979 @tab @code{find}
20980
20981 @item @code{supported-packets}
20982 @tab @code{qSupported}
20983 @tab Remote communications parameters
20984
20985 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20986 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20987 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20988
20989 @item @code{pass-signals}
20990 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20991 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20992
20993 @item @code{program-signals}
20994 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20995 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20996
20997 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20998 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20999 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21000
21001 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21002 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21003 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21004
21005 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21006 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21007 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21008
21009 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21010 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21011 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21012
21013 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21014 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21015 @tab @code{remote delete}
21016
21017 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21018 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21019 @tab Host I/O
21020
21021 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21022 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21023 @tab Host I/O
21024
21025 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21026 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21027 @tab Host I/O
21028
21029 @item @code{noack-packet}
21030 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21031 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21032
21033 @item @code{osdata}
21034 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21035 @tab @code{info os}
21036
21037 @item @code{query-attached}
21038 @tab @code{qAttached}
21039 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21040
21041 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21042 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21043 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21044
21045 @item @code{trace-status}
21046 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21047 @tab @code{tstatus}
21048
21049 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21050 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21051 @tab Traceframe info
21052
21053 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21054 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21055 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21056
21057 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21058 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21059 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21060
21061 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21062 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21063 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21064
21065 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21066 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21067 @tab @code{set environment}
21068
21069 @item @code{environment-unset}
21070 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21071 @tab @code{unset environment}
21072
21073 @item @code{environment-reset}
21074 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21075 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21076
21077 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21078 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21079 @tab @code{set cwd}
21080
21081 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21082 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21083 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21084
21085 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21086 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21087 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21088
21089 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21090 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21091 @tab @code{break}
21092
21093 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21094 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21095 @tab @code{hbreak}
21096
21097 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21098 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21099 @tab @code{fork}
21100
21101 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21102 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21103 @tab @code{vfork}
21104
21105 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21106 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21107 @tab @code{exec}
21108
21109 @item @code{thread-events}
21110 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21111 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21112
21113 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21114 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21115 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21116
21117 @end multitable
21118
21119 @node Remote Stub
21120 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21121
21122 @cindex debugging stub, example
21123 @cindex remote stub, example
21124 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21125 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21126 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21127 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21128 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21129 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21130 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21131 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21132
21133 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21134 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21135 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21136 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21137 program, you need:
21138
21139 @enumerate
21140 @item
21141 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21142 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21143 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21144
21145 @item
21146 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21147 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21148
21149 @item
21150 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21151 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21152 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21153 documentation.
21154 @end enumerate
21155
21156 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21157 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21158 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21159
21160 @table @emph
21161 @item On the host,
21162 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21163 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21164 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21165
21166 @item On the target,
21167 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21168 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21169 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21170
21171 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21172 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21173 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21174 @end table
21175
21176 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21177 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21178 @sc{sparc} boards.
21179
21180 @cindex remote serial stub list
21181 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21182
21183 @table @code
21184
21185 @item i386-stub.c
21186 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21187 @cindex Intel
21188 @cindex i386
21189 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21190
21191 @item m68k-stub.c
21192 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21193 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21194 @cindex m680x0
21195 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21196
21197 @item sh-stub.c
21198 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21199 @cindex Renesas
21200 @cindex SH
21201 For Renesas SH architectures.
21202
21203 @item sparc-stub.c
21204 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21205 @cindex Sparc
21206 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21207
21208 @item sparcl-stub.c
21209 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21210 @cindex Fujitsu
21211 @cindex SparcLite
21212 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21213
21214 @end table
21215
21216 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21217 recently added stubs.
21218
21219 @menu
21220 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21221 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21222 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21223 @end menu
21224
21225 @node Stub Contents
21226 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21227
21228 @cindex remote serial stub
21229 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21230 subroutines:
21231
21232 @table @code
21233 @item set_debug_traps
21234 @findex set_debug_traps
21235 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21236 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21237 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21238 program's startup code.
21239
21240 @item handle_exception
21241 @findex handle_exception
21242 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21243 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21244 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21245 run when a trap is triggered.
21246
21247 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21248 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21249 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21250 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21251 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21252 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21253 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21254 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21255 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21256 machine.
21257
21258 @item breakpoint
21259 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21260 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21261 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21262 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21263 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21264 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21265 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21266 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21267 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21268 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21269 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21270
21271 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21272 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21273 start of your debugging session.
21274 @end table
21275
21276 @node Bootstrapping
21277 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21278
21279 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21280 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21281 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21282 debugging target machine.
21283
21284 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21285 serial port.
21286
21287 @table @code
21288 @item int getDebugChar()
21289 @findex getDebugChar
21290 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21291 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21292 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21293
21294 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21295 @findex putDebugChar
21296 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21297 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21298 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21299 @end table
21300
21301 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21302 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21303 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21304 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21305 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21306 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21307 remote system to stop.
21308
21309 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21310 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21311 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21312 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21313
21314 Other routines you need to supply are:
21315
21316 @table @code
21317 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21318 @findex exceptionHandler
21319 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21320 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21321 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21322 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21323 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21324 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21325 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21326 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21327 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21328 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21329 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21330 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21331 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21332
21333 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21334 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21335 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21336 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21337 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21338
21339 @item void flush_i_cache()
21340 @findex flush_i_cache
21341 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21342 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21343 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21344
21345 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21346 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21347 @end table
21348
21349 @noindent
21350 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21351
21352 @table @code
21353 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21354 @findex memset
21355 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21356 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21357 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21358 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21359 @end table
21360
21361 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21362 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21363 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21364 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21365
21366
21367 @node Debug Session
21368 @subsection Putting it All Together
21369
21370 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21371 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21372 steps.
21373
21374 @enumerate
21375 @item
21376 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21377 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21378 @display
21379 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21380 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21381 @end display
21382
21383 @item
21384 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21385 procedure is called:
21386
21387 @smallexample
21388 set_debug_traps();
21389 breakpoint();
21390 @end smallexample
21391
21392 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21393 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21394 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21395 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21396 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21397 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21398 progress.
21399
21400 @item
21401 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21402 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21403
21404 @smallexample
21405 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21406 @end smallexample
21407
21408 @noindent
21409 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21410 function in your program, that function is called when
21411 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21412 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21413 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21414
21415 @item
21416 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21417 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21418
21419 @item
21420 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21421 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21422
21423 @item
21424 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21425 @c document that. FIXME.
21426 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21427 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21428
21429 @item
21430 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21431 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21432
21433 @end enumerate
21434
21435 @node Configurations
21436 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21437
21438 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21439 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21440 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21441
21442 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21443 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21444 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21445 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21446 are quite different from each other.
21447
21448 @menu
21449 * Native::
21450 * Embedded OS::
21451 * Embedded Processors::
21452 * Architectures::
21453 @end menu
21454
21455 @node Native
21456 @section Native
21457
21458 This section describes details specific to particular native
21459 configurations.
21460
21461 @menu
21462 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21463 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21464 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21465 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21466 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21467 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21468 @end menu
21469
21470 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21471 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21472
21473 @cindex libkvm
21474 @cindex kernel memory image
21475 @cindex kernel crash dump
21476
21477 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21478 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21479 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21480 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21481 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21482 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21483 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21484 @code{kvm} target:
21485
21486 @smallexample
21487 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21488 @end smallexample
21489
21490 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21491 argument:
21492
21493 @smallexample
21494 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21495 @end smallexample
21496
21497 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21498 available:
21499
21500 @table @code
21501 @kindex kvm
21502 @item kvm pcb
21503 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21504
21505 @item kvm proc
21506 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21507 modern FreeBSD systems.
21508 @end table
21509
21510 @node SVR4 Process Information
21511 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21512 @cindex /proc
21513 @cindex examine process image
21514 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21515
21516 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21517 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21518 process using file-system subroutines.
21519
21520 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21521 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21522 information about the process running your program, or about any
21523 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21524 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21525
21526 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21527 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21528
21529 @table @code
21530 @kindex info proc
21531 @cindex process ID
21532 @item info proc
21533 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21534 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21535 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21536 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21537 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21538 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21539 executable file's absolute file name.
21540
21541 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21542 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21543 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21544 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21545 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21546 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21547
21548 @item info proc cmdline
21549 @cindex info proc cmdline
21550 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21551 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21552
21553 @item info proc cwd
21554 @cindex info proc cwd
21555 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21556 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21557
21558 @item info proc exe
21559 @cindex info proc exe
21560 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21561 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21562
21563 @item info proc mappings
21564 @cindex memory address space mappings
21565 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21566 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21567 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21568 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21569 memory access rights to that range.
21570
21571 @item info proc stat
21572 @itemx info proc status
21573 @cindex process detailed status information
21574 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21575 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21576 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21577 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21578 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21579 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21580 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21581
21582 @item info proc all
21583 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21584 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21585
21586 @ignore
21587 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21588 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21589 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21590 @kindex info proc times
21591 @item info proc times
21592 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21593 its children.
21594
21595 @kindex info proc id
21596 @item info proc id
21597 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21598 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21599 @end ignore
21600
21601 @item set procfs-trace
21602 @kindex set procfs-trace
21603 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21604 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21605
21606 @item show procfs-trace
21607 @kindex show procfs-trace
21608 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21609
21610 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21611 @kindex set procfs-file
21612 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21613 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21614 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21615 standard output.
21616
21617 @item show procfs-file
21618 @kindex show procfs-file
21619 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21620
21621 @item proc-trace-entry
21622 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21623 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21624 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21625 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21626 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21627 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21628 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21629 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21630 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21631
21632 @item info pidlist
21633 @kindex info pidlist
21634 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21635 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21636 processes and all the threads within each process.
21637
21638 @item info meminfo
21639 @kindex info meminfo
21640 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21641 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21642 @end table
21643
21644 @node DJGPP Native
21645 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21646 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21647 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21648 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21649
21650 @cindex DPMI
21651 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21652 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21653 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21654 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21655
21656 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21657 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21658 subsection describes those commands.
21659
21660 @table @code
21661 @kindex info dos
21662 @item info dos
21663 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21664 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21665
21666 @kindex sysinfo
21667 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21668 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21669 @item info dos sysinfo
21670 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21671 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21672 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21673
21674 @cindex GDT
21675 @cindex LDT
21676 @cindex IDT
21677 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21678 @cindex descriptor tables display
21679 @item info dos gdt
21680 @itemx info dos ldt
21681 @itemx info dos idt
21682 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21683 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21684 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21685 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21686 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21687 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21688 rights.
21689
21690 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21691 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21692 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21693 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21694 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21695
21696 @cindex garbled pointers
21697 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21698 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21699 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21700 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21701 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21702 debugged program's data segment:
21703
21704 @smallexample
21705 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21706 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21707 @end smallexample
21708
21709 @noindent
21710 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21711 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21712
21713 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21714 @item info dos pde
21715 @itemx info dos pte
21716 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21717 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21718 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21719 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21720 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21721 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21722 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21723 that is currently in use.
21724
21725 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21726 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21727 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21728 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21729 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21730 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21731 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21732
21733 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21734 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21735 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21736 controller.
21737
21738 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21739
21740 @cindex physical address from linear address
21741 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21742 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21743 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21744 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21745 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21746 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21747 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21748
21749 @smallexample
21750 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21751 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21752 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21753 @end smallexample
21754
21755 @noindent
21756 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21757 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21758 attributes of that page.
21759
21760 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21761 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21762 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21763 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21764 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21765 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21766
21767 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21768 transfer buffer:
21769
21770 @smallexample
21771 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21772 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21773 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21774 @end smallexample
21775
21776 @noindent
21777 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21778 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21779 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21780 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21781 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21782
21783 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21784 @end table
21785
21786 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21787 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21788 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21789 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21790
21791 @table @code
21792 @kindex set com1base
21793 @kindex set com1irq
21794 @kindex set com2base
21795 @kindex set com2irq
21796 @kindex set com3base
21797 @kindex set com3irq
21798 @kindex set com4base
21799 @kindex set com4irq
21800 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21801 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21802 port.
21803
21804 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21805 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21806 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21807
21808 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21809 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21810 other 3 COM ports.
21811
21812 @kindex show com1base
21813 @kindex show com1irq
21814 @kindex show com2base
21815 @kindex show com2irq
21816 @kindex show com3base
21817 @kindex show com3irq
21818 @kindex show com4base
21819 @kindex show com4irq
21820 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21821 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21822 lines used by the COM ports.
21823
21824 @item info serial
21825 @kindex info serial
21826 @cindex DOS serial port status
21827 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21828 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21829 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21830 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21831 @end table
21832
21833
21834 @node Cygwin Native
21835 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21836 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21837 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21838 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21839
21840 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21841 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21842
21843 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21844 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21845 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21846 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21847 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21848 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21849 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21850 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21851
21852 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21853 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21854 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21855
21856 @table @code
21857 @kindex info w32
21858 @item info w32
21859 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21860 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21861
21862 @item info w32 selector
21863 This command displays information returned by
21864 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21865 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21866 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21867 Without argument, this command displays information
21868 about the six segment registers.
21869
21870 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21871 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21872 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21873 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21874
21875 @kindex signal-event
21876 @item signal-event @var{id}
21877 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21878 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21879
21880 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21881 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21882 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21883 (for x86_64 versions):
21884
21885 @itemize @minus
21886 @item
21887 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21888 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21889 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21890
21891 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21892 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21893 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21894 to attach.
21895
21896 @item
21897 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21898 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21899 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21900 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21901 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21902 @end itemize
21903
21904 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21905 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21906 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21907 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21908 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21909 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21910 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21911 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21912 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21913 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21914 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21915
21916 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21917 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21918 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21919 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21920
21921 @kindex set new-console
21922 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21923 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21924 be started in a new console on next start.
21925 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21926 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21927
21928 @kindex show new-console
21929 @item show new-console
21930 Displays whether a new console is used
21931 when the debuggee is started.
21932
21933 @kindex set new-group
21934 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21935 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21936 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21937 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21938 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21939
21940 @kindex show new-group
21941 @item show new-group
21942 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21943
21944 @kindex set debugevents
21945 @item set debugevents
21946 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21947 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21948 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21949 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21950 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21951
21952 @kindex set debugexec
21953 @item set debugexec
21954 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21955 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21956
21957 @kindex set debugexceptions
21958 @item set debugexceptions
21959 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21960 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21961
21962 @kindex set debugmemory
21963 @item set debugmemory
21964 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21965 and writes by the debugger.
21966
21967 @kindex set shell
21968 @item set shell
21969 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21970 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21971
21972 @kindex show shell
21973 @item show shell
21974 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21975
21976 @end table
21977
21978 @menu
21979 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21980 @end menu
21981
21982 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21983 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21984 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21985 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21986
21987 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21988 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21989 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21990 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21991 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21992 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21993 ``minimal symbols''.
21994
21995 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21996 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21997 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21998 program run once to completion.
21999
22000 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22001
22002 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22003 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22004 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22005 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22006 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22007 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22008 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22009 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22010 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22011
22012 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22013 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22014 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22015 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22016 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22017 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22018
22019 @smallexample
22020 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22021 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22022
22023 Non-debugging symbols:
22024 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22025 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22026 @end smallexample
22027
22028 @smallexample
22029 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22030 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22031
22032 Non-debugging symbols:
22033 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22034 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22035 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22036 [etc...]
22037 @end smallexample
22038
22039 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22040
22041 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22042 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22043 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22044 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22045 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22046 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22047 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22048
22049 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22050 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22051 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22052 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22053 problem:
22054
22055 @smallexample
22056 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22057 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22058 @end smallexample
22059
22060 @smallexample
22061 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22062 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22063 @end smallexample
22064
22065 And two possible solutions:
22066
22067 @smallexample
22068 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22069 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22070 @end smallexample
22071
22072 @smallexample
22073 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22074 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22075 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22076 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22077 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22078 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22079 @end smallexample
22080
22081 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22082 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22083 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22084 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22085 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22086
22087 @smallexample
22088 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22089 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22090 @end smallexample
22091
22092 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22093 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22094 safe.
22095
22096 @node Hurd Native
22097 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22098 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22099
22100 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22101 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22102
22103 @table @code
22104 @item set signals
22105 @itemx set sigs
22106 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22107 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22108 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22109 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22110 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22111 @code{signals}.
22112
22113 @item show signals
22114 @itemx show sigs
22115 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22116 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22117 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22118
22119 @item set signal-thread
22120 @itemx set sigthread
22121 @kindex set signal-thread
22122 @kindex set sigthread
22123 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22124 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22125 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22126 signal-thread}.
22127
22128 @item show signal-thread
22129 @itemx show sigthread
22130 @kindex show signal-thread
22131 @kindex show sigthread
22132 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22133 delivered a signal.
22134
22135 @item set stopped
22136 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22137 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22138 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22139 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22140
22141 @item show stopped
22142 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22143 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22144 stopped.
22145
22146 @item set exceptions
22147 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22148 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22149 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22150 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22151 trapping on.
22152
22153 @item show exceptions
22154 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22155 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22156
22157 @item set task pause
22158 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22159 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22160 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22161 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22162 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22163 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22164 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22165 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22166 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22167
22168 @item show task pause
22169 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22170 Show the current state of task suspension.
22171
22172 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22173 @cindex task suspend count
22174 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22175 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22176 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22177
22178 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22179 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22180
22181 @item set task exception-port
22182 @itemx set task excp
22183 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22184 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22185 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22186 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22187
22188 @item set noninvasive
22189 @cindex noninvasive task options
22190 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22191 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22192 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22193 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22194
22195 @item info send-rights
22196 @itemx info receive-rights
22197 @itemx info port-rights
22198 @itemx info port-sets
22199 @itemx info dead-names
22200 @itemx info ports
22201 @itemx info psets
22202 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22203 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22204 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22205 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22206 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22207 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22208 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22209 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22210 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22211
22212 @item set thread pause
22213 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22214 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22215 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22216 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22217 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22218 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22219 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22220 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22221 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22222 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22223 only the current thread.
22224
22225 @item show thread pause
22226 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22227 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22228
22229 @item set thread run
22230 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22231
22232 @item show thread run
22233 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22234
22235 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22236 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22237 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22238 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22239 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22240 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22241 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22242
22243 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22244 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22245 detaching.
22246
22247 @item set thread exception-port
22248 @itemx set thread excp
22249 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22250 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22251 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22252
22253 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22254 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22255 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22256 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22257
22258 @item set thread default
22259 @itemx show thread default
22260 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22261 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22262 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22263 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22264 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22265 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22266 the non-default commands.
22267 @end table
22268
22269 @node Darwin
22270 @subsection Darwin
22271 @cindex Darwin
22272
22273 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22274
22275 @table @code
22276 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22277 @kindex set debug darwin
22278 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22279 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22280
22281 @item show debug darwin
22282 @kindex show debug darwin
22283 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22284
22285 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22286 @kindex set debug mach-o
22287 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22288 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22289 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22290 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22291 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22292 usage.
22293
22294 @item show debug mach-o
22295 @kindex show debug mach-o
22296 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22297
22298 @item set mach-exceptions on
22299 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22300 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22301 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22302 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22303 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22304 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22305
22306 @item show mach-exceptions
22307 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22308 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22309 @end table
22310
22311
22312 @node Embedded OS
22313 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22314
22315 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22316 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22317 architectures.
22318
22319 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22320 various real-time operating systems.
22321
22322 @node Embedded Processors
22323 @section Embedded Processors
22324
22325 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22326 configurations.
22327
22328 @cindex send command to simulator
22329 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22330 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22331
22332 @table @code
22333 @item sim @var{command}
22334 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22335 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22336 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22337 acceptable commands.
22338 @end table
22339
22340
22341 @menu
22342 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22343 * ARM:: ARM
22344 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22345 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22346 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22347 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22348 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22349 * CRIS:: CRIS
22350 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22351 @end menu
22352
22353 @node ARC
22354 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22355 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22356 @cindex ARC specific commands
22357 @cindex ARC600
22358 @cindex ARC700
22359 @cindex ARC EM
22360 @cindex ARC HS
22361
22362 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22363
22364 @table @code
22365 @item set debug arc
22366 @kindex set debug arc
22367 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22368 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22369
22370 @item show debug arc
22371 @kindex show debug arc
22372 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22373
22374 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22375 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22376 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22377
22378 @end table
22379
22380 @node ARM
22381 @subsection ARM
22382
22383 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22384
22385 @table @code
22386 @item set arm disassembler
22387 @kindex set arm
22388 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22389 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22390
22391 @item show arm disassembler
22392 @kindex show arm
22393 Show the current disassembly style.
22394
22395 @item set arm apcs32
22396 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22397 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22398
22399 @item show arm apcs32
22400 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22401
22402 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22403 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22404 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22405
22406 @table @code
22407 @item auto
22408 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22409 @item softfpa
22410 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22411 processors.
22412 @item fpa
22413 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22414 @item softvfp
22415 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22416 @item vfp
22417 VFP co-processor.
22418 @end table
22419
22420 @item show arm fpu
22421 Show the current type of the FPU.
22422
22423 @item set arm abi
22424 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22425
22426 @item show arm abi
22427 Show the currently used ABI.
22428
22429 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22430 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22431 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22432 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22433 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22434 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22435 register).
22436
22437 @item show arm fallback-mode
22438 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22439
22440 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22441 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22442 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22443 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22444 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22445
22446 @item show arm force-mode
22447 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22448
22449 @item set debug arm
22450 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22451 target support subsystem.
22452
22453 @item show debug arm
22454 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22455 @end table
22456
22457 @table @code
22458 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22459 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22460
22461 @table @code
22462 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22463 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22464 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22465 The default value is @code{all}.
22466
22467 @table @code
22468 @item none
22469 @item demon
22470 @item angel
22471 @item redboot
22472 @item all
22473 @end table
22474 @end table
22475 @end table
22476
22477 @node M68K
22478 @subsection M68k
22479
22480 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22481
22482 @node MicroBlaze
22483 @subsection MicroBlaze
22484 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22485 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22486
22487 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22488 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22489 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22490 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22491 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22492 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22493 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22494 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22495 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22496 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22497 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22498
22499 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22500
22501 @table @code
22502 @item target remote :1234
22503 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22504 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22505
22506 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22507 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22508 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22509
22510 @item load
22511 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22512
22513 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22514 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22515
22516 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22517 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22518 @end table
22519
22520 @node MIPS Embedded
22521 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22522
22523 @noindent
22524 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22525
22526 @table @code
22527 @item set mipsfpu double
22528 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22529 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22530 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22531 @itemx show mipsfpu
22532 @kindex set mipsfpu
22533 @kindex show mipsfpu
22534 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22535 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22536 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22537 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22538 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22539 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22540 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22541 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22542 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22543 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22544 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22545 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22546 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22547
22548 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22549 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22550 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22551
22552 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22553 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22554 @end table
22555
22556 @node PowerPC Embedded
22557 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22558
22559 @cindex DVC register
22560 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22561 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22562
22563 @smallexample
22564 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22565 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22566 @end smallexample
22567
22568 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22569 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22570 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22571 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22572 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22573 or newer.
22574
22575 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22576 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22577 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22578 watching variables of scalar types.
22579
22580 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22581 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22582
22583 @smallexample
22584 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22585 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22586 @end smallexample
22587
22588 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22589 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22590
22591 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22592 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22593 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22594 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22595 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22596 use the @code{break-range} command.
22597
22598 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22599
22600 @table @code
22601 @kindex break-range
22602 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22603 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22604 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22605 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22606 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22607 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22608 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22609 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22610 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22611
22612 @kindex set powerpc
22613 @item set powerpc soft-float
22614 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22615 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22616 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22617 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22618
22619 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22620 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22621 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22622 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22623 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22624 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22625 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22626 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22627
22628 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22629 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22630 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22631 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22632 address of its first byte.
22633
22634 @end table
22635
22636 @node AVR
22637 @subsection Atmel AVR
22638 @cindex AVR
22639
22640 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22641 following AVR-specific commands:
22642
22643 @table @code
22644 @item info io_registers
22645 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22646 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22647 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22648 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22649 @end table
22650
22651 @node CRIS
22652 @subsection CRIS
22653 @cindex CRIS
22654
22655 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22656 following CRIS-specific commands:
22657
22658 @table @code
22659 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22660 @cindex CRIS version
22661 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22662 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22663 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22664
22665 @item show cris-version
22666 Show the current CRIS version.
22667
22668 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22669 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22670 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22671 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22672 @code{R59}.
22673
22674 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22675 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22676
22677 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22678 @cindex CRIS mode
22679 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22680 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22681 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22682
22683 @item show cris-mode
22684 Show the current CRIS mode.
22685 @end table
22686
22687 @node Super-H
22688 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22689 @cindex Super-H
22690
22691 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22692 commands:
22693
22694 @table @code
22695 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22696 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22697 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22698 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22699 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22700 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22701 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22702 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22703 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22704 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22705 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22706 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22707
22708 @item show sh calling-convention
22709 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22710 Show the current calling convention setting.
22711
22712 @end table
22713
22714
22715 @node Architectures
22716 @section Architectures
22717
22718 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22719 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22720
22721 @menu
22722 * AArch64::
22723 * i386::
22724 * Alpha::
22725 * MIPS::
22726 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22727 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22728 * PowerPC::
22729 * Nios II::
22730 * Sparc64::
22731 @end menu
22732
22733 @node AArch64
22734 @subsection AArch64
22735 @cindex AArch64 support
22736
22737 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22738 following special commands:
22739
22740 @table @code
22741 @item set debug aarch64
22742 @kindex set debug aarch64
22743 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22744 messages are to be displayed.
22745
22746 @item show debug aarch64
22747 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22748
22749 @end table
22750
22751 @node i386
22752 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22753
22754 @table @code
22755 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22756 @kindex set struct-convention
22757 @cindex struct return convention
22758 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22759 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22760 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22761 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22762 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22763 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22764 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22765 be returned in a register.
22766
22767 @item show struct-convention
22768 @kindex show struct-convention
22769 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22770 from functions.
22771 @end table
22772
22773
22774 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22775 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22776
22777 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22778 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22779 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22780 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22781 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22782 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22783 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22784
22785 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22786 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22787 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22788 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22789 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22790 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22791
22792 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22793 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22794 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22795
22796 @smallexample
22797 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22798 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22799 @end smallexample
22800
22801 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22802 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22803 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22804 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22805 the pointer.
22806
22807 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22808 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22809 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22810 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22811 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22812
22813 @table @code
22814 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22815 @kindex show mpx bound
22816 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22817
22818 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22819 @kindex set mpx bound
22820 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22821 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22822 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22823 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22824 @end table
22825
22826 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22827 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22828 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22829 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22830
22831 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22832 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22833 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22834 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22835 function.
22836
22837 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22838 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22839 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22840 continuing the execution. For example:
22841
22842 @smallexample
22843 $ break *upper
22844 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22845 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22846 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22847 $ print $bnd0
22848 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22849 @end smallexample
22850
22851 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22852 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22853 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22854
22855 @node Alpha
22856 @subsection Alpha
22857
22858 See the following section.
22859
22860 @node MIPS
22861 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22862
22863 @cindex stack on Alpha
22864 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22865 @cindex Alpha stack
22866 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22867 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22868 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22869 find the beginning of a function.
22870
22871 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22872 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22873 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22874 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22875 commands:
22876
22877 @table @code
22878 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22879 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22880 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22881 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22882 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22883 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22884 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22885 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22886
22887 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22888 Display the current limit.
22889 @end table
22890
22891 @noindent
22892 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22893 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22894
22895 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22896 programs:
22897
22898 @table @code
22899 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22900 @kindex set mips abi
22901 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22902 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22903 values of @var{arg} are:
22904
22905 @table @samp
22906 @item auto
22907 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22908 default).
22909 @item o32
22910 @item o64
22911 @item n32
22912 @item n64
22913 @item eabi32
22914 @item eabi64
22915 @end table
22916
22917 @item show mips abi
22918 @kindex show mips abi
22919 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22920
22921 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22922 @kindex set mips compression
22923 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22924 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22925 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22926 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22927 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22928 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22929 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22930 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22931 provided by the executable.
22932
22933 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22934 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22935 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22936 identified as such.
22937
22938 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22939 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22940 implicitly from an executable.
22941
22942 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22943 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22944 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22945 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22946 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22947
22948 @item show mips compression
22949 @kindex show mips compression
22950 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22951 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22952
22953 @item set mipsfpu
22954 @itemx show mipsfpu
22955 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22956
22957 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22958 @kindex set mips mask-address
22959 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22960 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22961 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22962 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22963 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22964
22965 @item show mips mask-address
22966 @kindex show mips mask-address
22967 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22968 not.
22969
22970 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22971 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22972 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22973 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22974 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22975 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22976
22977 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22978 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22979 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22980
22981 @item set debug mips
22982 @kindex set debug mips
22983 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22984 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22985
22986 @item show debug mips
22987 @kindex show debug mips
22988 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22989 @end table
22990
22991
22992 @node HPPA
22993 @subsection HPPA
22994 @cindex HPPA support
22995
22996 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22997 following special commands:
22998
22999 @table @code
23000 @item set debug hppa
23001 @kindex set debug hppa
23002 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23003 messages are to be displayed.
23004
23005 @item show debug hppa
23006 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23007
23008 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23009 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23010 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23011 given @var{address}.
23012
23013 @end table
23014
23015
23016 @node SPU
23017 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23018 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23019 @cindex SPU
23020
23021 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23022 it provides the following special commands:
23023
23024 @table @code
23025 @item info spu event
23026 @kindex info spu
23027 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23028 and pending event status.
23029
23030 @item info spu signal
23031 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23032 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23033 notification channels.
23034
23035 @item info spu mailbox
23036 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23037 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23038 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23039
23040 @item info spu dma
23041 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23042 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23043 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23044
23045 @item info spu proxydma
23046 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23047 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23048 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23049
23050 @end table
23051
23052 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23053 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23054 special commands:
23055
23056 @table @code
23057 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23058 @kindex set spu
23059 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23060 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23061 function. The default is @code{off}.
23062
23063 @item show spu stop-on-load
23064 @kindex show spu
23065 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23066
23067 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23068 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23069 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23070 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23071 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23072 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23073
23074 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23075 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23076
23077 @end table
23078
23079 @node PowerPC
23080 @subsection PowerPC
23081 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23082
23083 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23084 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23085 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23086 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23087 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23088
23089 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23090 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23091 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23092
23093 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23094 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23095
23096 @node Nios II
23097 @subsection Nios II
23098 @cindex Nios II architecture
23099
23100 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23101 it provides the following special commands:
23102
23103 @table @code
23104
23105 @item set debug nios2
23106 @kindex set debug nios2
23107 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23108 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23109
23110 @item show debug nios2
23111 @kindex show debug nios2
23112 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23113 @end table
23114
23115 @node Sparc64
23116 @subsection Sparc64
23117 @cindex Sparc64 support
23118 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23119 @subsubsection ADI Support
23120
23121 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23122 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23123 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23124 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23125 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23126 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23127 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23128 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23129 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23130 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23131 signal.
23132
23133 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23134 ADI-enabled.
23135
23136 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23137 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23138
23139
23140 @table @code
23141 @kindex adi examine
23142 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23143
23144 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23145 cacheline.
23146
23147 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23148 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23149 block size, to display.
23150
23151 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23152 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23153
23154 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23155
23156 @smallexample
23157 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23158 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23159 @end smallexample
23160
23161 @kindex adi assign
23162 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23163
23164 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23165 to an address.
23166
23167 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23168 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23169 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23170
23171 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23172 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23173
23174 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23175
23176 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23177 variable "shmaddr":
23178
23179 @smallexample
23180 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23181 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23182 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23183 @end smallexample
23184
23185 @end table
23186
23187 @node Controlling GDB
23188 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23189
23190 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23191 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23192 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23193 described here.
23194
23195 @menu
23196 * Prompt:: Prompt
23197 * Editing:: Command editing
23198 * Command History:: Command history
23199 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23200 * Numbers:: Numbers
23201 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23202 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23203 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23204 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23205 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23206 @end menu
23207
23208 @node Prompt
23209 @section Prompt
23210
23211 @cindex prompt
23212
23213 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23214 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23215 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23216 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23217 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23218 which one you are talking to.
23219
23220 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23221 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23222 or a prompt that does not.
23223
23224 @table @code
23225 @kindex set prompt
23226 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23227 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23228
23229 @kindex show prompt
23230 @item show prompt
23231 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23232 @end table
23233
23234 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23235 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23236 are:
23237
23238 @table @code
23239 @kindex set extended-prompt
23240 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23241 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23242 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23243 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23244 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23245 is displayed.
23246
23247 For example:
23248
23249 @smallexample
23250 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23251 @end smallexample
23252
23253 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23254 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23255
23256 @kindex show extended-prompt
23257 @item show extended-prompt
23258 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23259 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23260 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23261 @end table
23262
23263 @node Editing
23264 @section Command Editing
23265 @cindex readline
23266 @cindex command line editing
23267
23268 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23269 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23270 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23271 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23272 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23273 debugging sessions.
23274
23275 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23276 command @code{set}.
23277
23278 @table @code
23279 @kindex set editing
23280 @cindex editing
23281 @item set editing
23282 @itemx set editing on
23283 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23284
23285 @item set editing off
23286 Disable command line editing.
23287
23288 @kindex show editing
23289 @item show editing
23290 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23291 @end table
23292
23293 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23294 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23295 @end ifset
23296 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23297 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23298 @end ifclear
23299 for more details about the Readline
23300 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23301 encouraged to read that chapter.
23302
23303 @node Command History
23304 @section Command History
23305 @cindex command history
23306
23307 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23308 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23309 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23310 history facility.
23311
23312 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23313 package, to provide the history facility.
23314 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23315 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23316 @end ifset
23317 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23318 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23319 @end ifclear
23320 for the detailed description of the History library.
23321
23322 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23323 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23324 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23325 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23326 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23327 pressed on a line by itself.
23328
23329 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23330 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23331 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23332 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23333
23334 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23335 history.
23336
23337 @table @code
23338 @cindex history substitution
23339 @cindex history file
23340 @kindex set history filename
23341 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23342 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23343 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23344 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23345 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23346 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23347 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23348 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23349 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23350 is not set.
23351
23352 @cindex save command history
23353 @kindex set history save
23354 @item set history save
23355 @itemx set history save on
23356 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23357 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23358
23359 @item set history save off
23360 Stop recording command history in a file.
23361
23362 @cindex history size
23363 @kindex set history size
23364 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23365 @item set history size @var{size}
23366 @itemx set history size unlimited
23367 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23368 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23369 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23370 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23371 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23372 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23373
23374 @cindex remove duplicate history
23375 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23376 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23377 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23378 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23379 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23380 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23381 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23382 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23383 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23384
23385 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23386 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23387
23388 @end table
23389
23390 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23391 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23392 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23393 @end ifset
23394 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23395 @xref{Event Designators},
23396 @end ifclear
23397 for more details.
23398
23399 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23400 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23401 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23402 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23403 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23404 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23405 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23406 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23407
23408 The commands to control history expansion are:
23409
23410 @table @code
23411 @item set history expansion on
23412 @itemx set history expansion
23413 @kindex set history expansion
23414 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23415
23416 @item set history expansion off
23417 Disable history expansion.
23418
23419 @c @group
23420 @kindex show history
23421 @item show history
23422 @itemx show history filename
23423 @itemx show history save
23424 @itemx show history size
23425 @itemx show history expansion
23426 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23427 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23428 @c @end group
23429 @end table
23430
23431 @table @code
23432 @kindex show commands
23433 @cindex show last commands
23434 @cindex display command history
23435 @item show commands
23436 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23437
23438 @item show commands @var{n}
23439 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23440
23441 @item show commands +
23442 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23443 @end table
23444
23445 @node Screen Size
23446 @section Screen Size
23447 @cindex size of screen
23448 @cindex screen size
23449 @cindex pagination
23450 @cindex page size
23451 @cindex pauses in output
23452
23453 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23454 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23455 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23456 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23457 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23458 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23459 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23460 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23461
23462 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23463 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23464 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23465 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23466 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23467 width} commands:
23468
23469 @table @code
23470 @kindex set height
23471 @kindex set width
23472 @kindex show width
23473 @kindex show height
23474 @item set height @var{lpp}
23475 @itemx set height unlimited
23476 @itemx show height
23477 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23478 @itemx set width unlimited
23479 @itemx show width
23480 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23481 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23482 commands display the current settings.
23483
23484 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23485 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23486 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23487 buffer.
23488
23489 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23490 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23491
23492 @item set pagination on
23493 @itemx set pagination off
23494 @kindex set pagination
23495 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23496 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23497 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23498 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23499
23500 @item show pagination
23501 @kindex show pagination
23502 Show the current pagination mode.
23503 @end table
23504
23505 @node Numbers
23506 @section Numbers
23507 @cindex number representation
23508 @cindex entering numbers
23509
23510 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23511 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23512 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23513 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23514 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23515 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23516 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23517 both input and output with the commands described below.
23518
23519 @table @code
23520 @kindex set input-radix
23521 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23522 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23523 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23524 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23525 example, any of
23526
23527 @smallexample
23528 set input-radix 012
23529 set input-radix 10.
23530 set input-radix 0xa
23531 @end smallexample
23532
23533 @noindent
23534 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23535 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23536 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23537 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23538 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23539 change the radix.
23540
23541 @kindex set output-radix
23542 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23543 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23544 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23545 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23546
23547 @kindex show input-radix
23548 @item show input-radix
23549 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23550
23551 @kindex show output-radix
23552 @item show output-radix
23553 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23554
23555 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23556 @itemx show radix
23557 @kindex set radix
23558 @kindex show radix
23559 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23560 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23561 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23562 default value of 10.
23563
23564 @end table
23565
23566 @node ABI
23567 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23568
23569 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23570 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23571 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23572 current ABI.
23573
23574 @cindex OS ABI
23575 @kindex set osabi
23576 @kindex show osabi
23577 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23578
23579 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23580 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23581 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23582 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23583 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23584 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23585 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23586 platform provides.
23587
23588 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23589 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23590 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23591 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23592
23593 @table @code
23594 @item show osabi
23595 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23596
23597 @item set osabi
23598 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23599
23600 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23601 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23602 @end table
23603
23604 @cindex float promotion
23605
23606 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23607 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23608 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23609 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23610 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23611 @code{double} and then passed.
23612
23613 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23614 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23615 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23616
23617 @table @code
23618 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23619 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23620 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23621 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23622 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23623
23624 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23625 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23626 functions.
23627
23628 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23629 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23630 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23631 @end table
23632
23633 @kindex set cp-abi
23634 @kindex show cp-abi
23635 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23636 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23637 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23638 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23639 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23640 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23641 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23642 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23643 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23644 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23645 ``auto''.
23646
23647 @table @code
23648 @item show cp-abi
23649 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23650
23651 @item set cp-abi
23652 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23653
23654 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23655 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23656 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23657 @end table
23658
23659 @node Auto-loading
23660 @section Automatically loading associated files
23661 @cindex auto-loading
23662
23663 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23664 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23665 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23666 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23667 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23668 sources).
23669
23670 @menu
23671 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23672 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23673
23674 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23675 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23676 @end menu
23677
23678 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23679 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23680 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23681
23682 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23683 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23684 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23685
23686 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23687 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23688
23689 @table @code
23690 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23691 @kindex set auto-load off
23692 @item set auto-load off
23693 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23694 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23695 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23696 @smallexample
23697 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23698 @end smallexample
23699
23700 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23701 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23702 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23703 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23704 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23705 @code{set auto-load no}.
23706
23707 @anchor{show auto-load}
23708 @kindex show auto-load
23709 @item show auto-load
23710 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23711 or disabled.
23712
23713 @smallexample
23714 (gdb) show auto-load
23715 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23716 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23717 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23718 is on.
23719 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23720 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23721 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23722 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23723 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23724 @end smallexample
23725
23726 @anchor{info auto-load}
23727 @kindex info auto-load
23728 @item info auto-load
23729 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23730 not.
23731
23732 @smallexample
23733 (gdb) info auto-load
23734 gdb-scripts:
23735 Loaded Script
23736 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23737 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23738 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23739 loaded.
23740 python-scripts:
23741 Loaded Script
23742 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23743 @end smallexample
23744 @end table
23745
23746 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23747
23748 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23749 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23750 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23751 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23752 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23753 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23754 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23755 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23756 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23757 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23758 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23759 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23760 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23761 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23762 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23763 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23764 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23765 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23766 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23767 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23768 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23769 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23770 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23771 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23772 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23773 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23774 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23775 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23776 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23777 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23778 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23779 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23780 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23781 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23782 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23783 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23784 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23785 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23786 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23787 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23788 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23789 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23790 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23791 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23792 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23793 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23794 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23795 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23796 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23797 @end multitable
23798
23799 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23800 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23801 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23802
23803 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23804 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23805 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23806
23807 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23808 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23809
23810 @table @code
23811 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23812 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23813 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23814 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23815 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23816
23817 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23818 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23819 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23820 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23821 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23822
23823 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23824 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23825 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23826 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23827 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23828 @end table
23829
23830 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23831 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23832 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23833
23834 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23835
23836 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23837 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23838
23839 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23840 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23841 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23842 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23843 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23844 library.
23845
23846 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23847 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23848
23849 @table @code
23850 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23851 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23852 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23853 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23854
23855 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23856 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23857 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23858 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23859 enabled or disabled.
23860
23861 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23862 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23863 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23864 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23865 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23866 @end table
23867
23868 @node Auto-loading safe path
23869 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23870 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23871
23872 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23873 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23874 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23875 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23876 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23877
23878 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23879 get loaded:
23880
23881 @smallexample
23882 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23883 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23884 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23885 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23886 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23887 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23888 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23889 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23890 @end smallexample
23891
23892 @noindent
23893 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23894 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23895
23896 @smallexample
23897 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23898 @end smallexample
23899
23900 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23901
23902 @table @code
23903 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23904 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23905 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23906 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23907 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23908 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23909 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23910 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23911 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23912 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23913
23914 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23915 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23916 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23917
23918 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23919 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23920 @item show auto-load safe-path
23921 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23922 scripts.
23923
23924 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23925 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23926 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23927 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23928 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23929 by the host platform path separator in use.
23930 @end table
23931
23932 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23933 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23934 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23935 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23936 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23937
23938 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23939 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23940 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23941 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23942 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23943 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23944 init file in the current directory
23945 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23946
23947 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23948 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23949
23950 @table @asis
23951 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23952 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23953 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23954 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23955
23956 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23957 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23958 @value{GDBN} session.
23959
23960 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23961 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23962 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23963 from trusted sources.
23964
23965 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23966 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23967 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23968 trusted sources.
23969 @end table
23970
23971 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23972 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23973
23974 @table @asis
23975 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23976 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23977
23978 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23979 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23980 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23981 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23982 @end table
23983
23984 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23985 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23986 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23987 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23988 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23989 recommended to be entered.
23990
23991 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23992 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23993 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23994
23995 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23996 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23997 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23998 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23999 be printed.
24000
24001 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24002 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24003 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24004
24005 @smallexample
24006 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24007 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24008 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24009 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24010 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24011 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24012 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24013 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24014 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24015 @end smallexample
24016
24017 @table @code
24018 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24019 @kindex set debug auto-load
24020 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24021 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24022
24023 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24024 @kindex show debug auto-load
24025 @item show debug auto-load
24026 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24027 on or off.
24028 @end table
24029
24030 @node Messages/Warnings
24031 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24032
24033 @cindex verbose operation
24034 @cindex optional warnings
24035 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24036 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24037 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24038 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24039
24040 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24041 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24042 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24043
24044 @table @code
24045 @kindex set verbose
24046 @item set verbose on
24047 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24048
24049 @item set verbose off
24050 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24051
24052 @kindex show verbose
24053 @item show verbose
24054 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24055 @end table
24056
24057 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24058 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24059 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24060 Symbol Files}).
24061
24062 @table @code
24063
24064 @kindex set complaints
24065 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24066 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24067 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24068 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24069 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24070
24071 @kindex show complaints
24072 @item show complaints
24073 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24074
24075 @end table
24076
24077 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24078 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24079 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24080 you try to run a program which is already running:
24081
24082 @smallexample
24083 (@value{GDBP}) run
24084 The program being debugged has been started already.
24085 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24086 @end smallexample
24087
24088 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24089 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24090
24091 @table @code
24092
24093 @kindex set confirm
24094 @cindex flinching
24095 @cindex confirmation
24096 @cindex stupid questions
24097 @item set confirm off
24098 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24099 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24100 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24101
24102 @item set confirm on
24103 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24104
24105 @kindex show confirm
24106 @item show confirm
24107 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24108
24109 @end table
24110
24111 @cindex command tracing
24112 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24113 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24114 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24115 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24116
24117 @table @code
24118 @kindex set trace-commands
24119 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24120 @item set trace-commands on
24121 Enable command tracing.
24122 @item set trace-commands off
24123 Disable command tracing.
24124 @item show trace-commands
24125 Display the current state of command tracing.
24126 @end table
24127
24128 @node Debugging Output
24129 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24130 @cindex optional debugging messages
24131
24132 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24133 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24134 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24135 section documents those commands.
24136
24137 @table @code
24138 @kindex set exec-done-display
24139 @item set exec-done-display
24140 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24141 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24142 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24143 @kindex show exec-done-display
24144 @item show exec-done-display
24145 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24146 notification.
24147 @kindex set debug
24148 @cindex ARM AArch64
24149 @item set debug aarch64
24150 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24151 The default is off.
24152 @kindex show debug
24153 @item show debug aarch64
24154 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24155 ARM AArch64.
24156 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24157 @cindex architecture debugging info
24158 @item set debug arch
24159 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24160 @item show debug arch
24161 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24162 @item set debug aix-solib
24163 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24164 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24165 support module. The default is off.
24166 @item show debug aix-thread
24167 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24168 @item set debug aix-thread
24169 @cindex AIX threads
24170 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24171 module.
24172 @item show debug aix-thread
24173 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24174 @item set debug check-physname
24175 @cindex physname
24176 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24177 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24178 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24179 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24180 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24181 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24182 @item show debug check-physname
24183 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24184 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24185 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24186 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24187 exported symbols. The default is off.
24188 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24189 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24190 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24191 @item set debug dwarf-die
24192 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24193 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24194 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24195 A value of zero turns off the display.
24196 @item show debug dwarf-die
24197 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24198 @item set debug dwarf-line
24199 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24200 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24201 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24202 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24203 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24204 @item show debug dwarf-line
24205 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24206 @item set debug dwarf-read
24207 @cindex DWARF Reading
24208 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24209 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24210 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24211 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24212 @item show debug dwarf-read
24213 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24214 @item set debug displaced
24215 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24216 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24217 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24218 @item show debug displaced
24219 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24220 related to displaced stepping.
24221 @item set debug event
24222 @cindex event debugging info
24223 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24224 default is off.
24225 @item show debug event
24226 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24227 info.
24228 @item set debug expression
24229 @cindex expression debugging info
24230 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24231 expression parsing. The default is off.
24232 @item show debug expression
24233 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24234 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24235 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24236 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24237 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24238 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24239 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24240 @item set debug frame
24241 @cindex frame debugging info
24242 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24243 default is off.
24244 @item show debug frame
24245 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24246 info.
24247 @item set debug gnu-nat
24248 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24249 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24250 @item show debug gnu-nat
24251 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24252 @item set debug infrun
24253 @cindex inferior debugging info
24254 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24255 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24256 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24257 @item show debug infrun
24258 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24259 @item set debug jit
24260 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24261 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24262 @item show debug jit
24263 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24264 @item set debug lin-lwp
24265 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24266 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24267 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24268 @item show debug lin-lwp
24269 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24270 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24271 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24272 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24273 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24274 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24275 @item set debug mach-o
24276 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24277 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24278 processing. The default is off.
24279 @item show debug mach-o
24280 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24281 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24282 @item set debug notification
24283 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24284 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24285 The default is off.
24286 @item show debug notification
24287 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24288 @item set debug observer
24289 @cindex observer debugging info
24290 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24291 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24292 @item show debug observer
24293 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24294 @item set debug overload
24295 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24296 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24297 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24298 is off.
24299 @item show debug overload
24300 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24301 debugging info.
24302 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24303 @cindex debug expression parser
24304 @item set debug parser
24305 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24306 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24307 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24308 details. The default is off.
24309 @item show debug parser
24310 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24311 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24312 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24313 @cindex debug remote protocol
24314 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24315 @cindex display remote packets
24316 @item set debug remote
24317 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24318 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24319 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24320 @item show debug remote
24321 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24322
24323 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24324 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24325 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24326 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24327
24328 @item set debug serial
24329 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24330 default is off.
24331 @item show debug serial
24332 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24333 info.
24334 @item set debug solib-frv
24335 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24336 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24337 @item show debug solib-frv
24338 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24339 messages.
24340 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24341 @cindex symbol lookup
24342 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24343 The default is 0 (off).
24344 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24345 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24346 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24347 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24348 @item set debug symfile
24349 @cindex symbol file functions
24350 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24351 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24352 @item show debug symfile
24353 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24354 @item set debug symtab-create
24355 @cindex symbol table creation
24356 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24357 The default is 0 (off).
24358 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24359 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24360 @item show debug symtab-create
24361 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24362 @item set debug target
24363 @cindex target debugging info
24364 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24365 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24366 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24367 value of large memory transfers.
24368 @item show debug target
24369 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24370 info.
24371 @item set debug timestamp
24372 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24373 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24374 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24375 message.
24376 @item show debug timestamp
24377 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24378 debugging info.
24379 @item set debug varobj
24380 @cindex variable object debugging info
24381 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24382 info. The default is off.
24383 @item show debug varobj
24384 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24385 debugging info.
24386 @item set debug xml
24387 @cindex XML parser debugging
24388 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24389 @item show debug xml
24390 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24391 @end table
24392
24393 @node Other Misc Settings
24394 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24395 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24396
24397 @table @code
24398 @kindex set interactive-mode
24399 @item set interactive-mode
24400 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24401 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24402 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24403 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24404 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24405 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24406 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24407 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24408
24409 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24410 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24411 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24412 inside a cygwin window.
24413
24414 @kindex show interactive-mode
24415 @item show interactive-mode
24416 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24417 @end table
24418
24419 @node Extending GDB
24420 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24421 @cindex extending GDB
24422
24423 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24424 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24425 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24426 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24427 being debugged.
24428
24429 @menu
24430 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24431 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24432 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24433 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24434 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24435 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24436 @end menu
24437
24438 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24439 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24440 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24441 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24442 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24443 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24444
24445 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24446 setting:
24447
24448 @table @code
24449 @kindex set script-extension
24450 @kindex show script-extension
24451 @item set script-extension off
24452 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24453
24454 @item set script-extension soft
24455 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24456 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24457 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24458 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24459
24460 @item set script-extension strict
24461 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24462 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24463 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24464
24465 @item show script-extension
24466 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24467
24468 @end table
24469
24470 @node Sequences
24471 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24472
24473 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24474 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24475 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24476 files.
24477
24478 @menu
24479 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24480 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24481 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24482 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24483 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24484 @end menu
24485
24486 @node Define
24487 @subsection User-defined Commands
24488
24489 @cindex user-defined command
24490 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24491 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24492 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24493 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24494 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24495 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24496
24497 @smallexample
24498 define adder
24499 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24500 end
24501 @end smallexample
24502
24503 @noindent
24504 To execute the command use:
24505
24506 @smallexample
24507 adder 1 2 3
24508 @end smallexample
24509
24510 @noindent
24511 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24512 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24513 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24514 functions calls.
24515
24516 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24517 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24518 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24519 been passed.
24520
24521 @smallexample
24522 define adder
24523 if $argc == 2
24524 print $arg0 + $arg1
24525 end
24526 if $argc == 3
24527 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24528 end
24529 end
24530 @end smallexample
24531
24532 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24533 to process a variable number of arguments:
24534
24535 @smallexample
24536 define adder
24537 set $i = 0
24538 set $sum = 0
24539 while $i < $argc
24540 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24541 set $i = $i + 1
24542 end
24543 print $sum
24544 end
24545 @end smallexample
24546
24547 @table @code
24548
24549 @kindex define
24550 @item define @var{commandname}
24551 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24552 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24553 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24554 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24555 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24556 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24557
24558 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24559 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24560 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24561
24562 @kindex document
24563 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24564 @item document @var{commandname}
24565 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24566 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24567 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24568 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24569 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24570 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24571
24572 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24573 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24574 does not change the documentation.
24575
24576 @kindex dont-repeat
24577 @cindex don't repeat command
24578 @item dont-repeat
24579 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24580 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24581 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24582
24583 @kindex help user-defined
24584 @item help user-defined
24585 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24586 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24587 included (if any).
24588
24589 @kindex show user
24590 @item show user
24591 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24592 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24593 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24594 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24595 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24596
24597 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24598 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24599 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24600 @item show max-user-call-depth
24601 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24602 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24603 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24604 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24605 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24606 @end table
24607
24608 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24609 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24610
24611 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24612 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24613 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24614
24615 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24616 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24617 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24618 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24619
24620 @node Hooks
24621 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24622 @cindex command hooks
24623 @cindex hooks, for commands
24624 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24625
24626 @kindex hook
24627 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24628 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24629 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24630 before that command.
24631
24632 @cindex hooks, post-command
24633 @kindex hookpost
24634 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24635 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24636 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24637 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24638 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24639
24640 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24641 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24642
24643 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24644 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24645
24646 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24647 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24648 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24649 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24650 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24651
24652 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24653 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24654 you could define:
24655
24656 @smallexample
24657 define hook-stop
24658 handle SIGALRM nopass
24659 end
24660
24661 define hook-run
24662 handle SIGALRM pass
24663 end
24664
24665 define hook-continue
24666 handle SIGALRM pass
24667 end
24668 @end smallexample
24669
24670 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24671 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24672 you could define:
24673
24674 @smallexample
24675 define hook-echo
24676 echo <<<---
24677 end
24678
24679 define hookpost-echo
24680 echo --->>>\n
24681 end
24682
24683 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24684 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24685 (@value{GDBP})
24686
24687 @end smallexample
24688
24689 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24690 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24691 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24692 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24693 @c or not?
24694 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24695 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24696 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24697
24698 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24699 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24700 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24701
24702 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24703 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24704
24705 @node Command Files
24706 @subsection Command Files
24707
24708 @cindex command files
24709 @cindex scripting commands
24710 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24711 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24712 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24713 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24714 terminal.
24715
24716 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24717 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24718 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24719 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24720 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24721
24722 @table @code
24723 @kindex source
24724 @cindex execute commands from a file
24725 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24726 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24727 @end table
24728
24729 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24730 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24731 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24732 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24733 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24734
24735 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24736 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24737 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24738 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24739 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24740 is not relevant to scripts.
24741
24742 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24743 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24744 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24745 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24746 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24747 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24748 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24749 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24750 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24751 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24752 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24753 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24754 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24755 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24756
24757 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24758 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24759 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24760
24761 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24762 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24763 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24764 when called from command files.
24765
24766 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24767 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24768 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24769 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24770 the next command.
24771
24772 @smallexample
24773 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24774 @end smallexample
24775
24776 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24777 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24778 would be directed to @file{log}.
24779
24780 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24781 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24782 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24783 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24784 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24785 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24786 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24787 conditionally, etc.
24788
24789 @table @code
24790 @kindex if
24791 @kindex else
24792 @item if
24793 @itemx else
24794 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24795 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24796 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24797 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24798 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24799 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24800 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24801
24802 @kindex while
24803 @item while
24804 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24805 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24806 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24807 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24808 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24809 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24810
24811 @kindex loop_break
24812 @item loop_break
24813 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24814 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24815 line.
24816
24817 @kindex loop_continue
24818 @item loop_continue
24819 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24820 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24821 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24822 the controlling expression.
24823
24824 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24825 @item end
24826 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24827 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24828 @end table
24829
24830
24831 @node Output
24832 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24833
24834 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24835 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24836 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24837 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24838 want.
24839
24840 @table @code
24841 @kindex echo
24842 @item echo @var{text}
24843 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24844 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24845 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24846 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24847 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24848 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24849 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24850 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24851 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24852 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24853 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24854
24855 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24856 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24857
24858 @smallexample
24859 echo This is some text\n\
24860 which is continued\n\
24861 onto several lines.\n
24862 @end smallexample
24863
24864 produces the same output as
24865
24866 @smallexample
24867 echo This is some text\n
24868 echo which is continued\n
24869 echo onto several lines.\n
24870 @end smallexample
24871
24872 @kindex output
24873 @item output @var{expression}
24874 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24875 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24876 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24877 on expressions.
24878
24879 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24880 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24881 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24882 Formats}, for more information.
24883
24884 @kindex printf
24885 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24886 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24887 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24888 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24889 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24890 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24891 executing the code below:
24892
24893 @smallexample
24894 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24895 @end smallexample
24896
24897 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24898 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24899 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24900 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24901 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24902 printed.
24903
24904 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24905
24906 @smallexample
24907 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24908 @end smallexample
24909
24910 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24911 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24912 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24913
24914 @itemize @bullet
24915 @item
24916 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24917
24918 @item
24919 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24920 width.
24921
24922 @item
24923 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24924 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24925
24926 @item
24927 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24928 supported.
24929
24930 @item
24931 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24932
24933 @item
24934 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24935 @end itemize
24936
24937 @noindent
24938 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24939 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24940 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24941 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24942
24943 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24944 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24945 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24946 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24947 supported.
24948
24949 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24950 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24951 together with a floating point specifier.
24952 letters:
24953
24954 @itemize @bullet
24955 @item
24956 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24957
24958 @item
24959 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24960
24961 @item
24962 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24963 @end itemize
24964
24965 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24966 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24967 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24968
24969 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24970 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24971
24972 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24973 @smallexample
24974 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24975 @end smallexample
24976
24977 @anchor{eval}
24978 @kindex eval
24979 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24980 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24981 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24982
24983 @end table
24984
24985 @node Auto-loading sequences
24986 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24987 @cindex native script auto-loading
24988
24989 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24990 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24991 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24992 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24993
24994 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24995 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24996
24997 @table @code
24998 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24999 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25000 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25001 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25002
25003 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25004 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25005 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25006 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25007 disabled.
25008
25009 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25010 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25011 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25012 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25013 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25014 auto-loaded.
25015 @end table
25016
25017 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25018 matching names are printed.
25019
25020 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25021 @include python.texi
25022
25023 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25024 @include guile.texi
25025
25026 @node Auto-loading extensions
25027 @section Auto-loading extensions
25028 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25029
25030 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25031 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25032 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25033 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25034 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25035
25036 @menu
25037 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25038 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25039 * Which flavor to choose?::
25040 @end menu
25041
25042 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25043 debugging commands and features.
25044
25045 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25046 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25047 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25048 for more information.
25049 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25050 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25051
25052 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25053 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25054
25055 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25056 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25057 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25058 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25059 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25060
25061 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25062 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25063 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25064 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25065
25066 @table @code
25067 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25068 GDB's own command language
25069 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25070 Python
25071 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25072 Guile
25073 @end table
25074
25075 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25076 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25077 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25078 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25079 script in the specified extension language.
25080
25081 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25082 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25083
25084 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25085 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25086
25087 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25088 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25089 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25090 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25091 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25092 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25093
25094 @table @code
25095 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25096 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25097 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25098 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25099 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25100 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25101
25102 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25103 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25104
25105 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25106 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25107 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25108 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25109
25110 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25111 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25112 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25113 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25114 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25115 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25116 platform.
25117
25118 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25119 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25120 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25121
25122 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25123 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25124 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25125 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25126
25127 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25128 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25129 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25130 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25131 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25132 @end table
25133
25134 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25135 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25136 @var{objfile} is opened.
25137 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25138 is evaluated more than once.
25139
25140 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25141 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25142 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25143
25144 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25145 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25146 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25147 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25148 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25149 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25150 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25151
25152 The following entries are supported:
25153
25154 @table @code
25155 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25156 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25157 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25158 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25159 @end table
25160
25161 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25162
25163 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25164 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25165 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25166 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25167 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25168
25169 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25170 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25171
25172 @example
25173 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25174 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25175 asm("\
25176 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25177 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25178 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25179 .popsection \n\
25180 ");
25181 @end example
25182
25183 @noindent
25184 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25185 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25186
25187 @example
25188 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25189 @end example
25190
25191 The script name may include directories if desired.
25192
25193 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25194 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25195
25196 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25197 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25198 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25199 will remove duplicates.
25200
25201 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25202
25203 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25204 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25205 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25206 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25207 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25208 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25209 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25210 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25211 on its name.
25212
25213 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25214 testsuite.
25215
25216 @example
25217 #include "symcat.h"
25218 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25219 asm(
25220 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25221 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25222 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25223 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25224 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25225 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25226 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25227 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25228 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25229 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25230 ".byte 0\n"
25231 ".popsection\n"
25232 );
25233 @end example
25234
25235 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25236 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25237 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25238 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25239
25240 @node Which flavor to choose?
25241 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25242
25243 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25244 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25245
25246 @noindent
25247 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25248
25249 @itemize @bullet
25250 @item
25251 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25252
25253 @item
25254 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25255
25256 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25257 in the source search path.
25258 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25259 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25260
25261 @item
25262 Doesn't require source code additions.
25263 @end itemize
25264
25265 @noindent
25266 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25267
25268 @itemize @bullet
25269 @item
25270 Works with static linking.
25271
25272 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25273 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25274 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25275 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25276 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25277
25278 @item
25279 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25280
25281 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25282 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25283
25284 @item
25285 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25286
25287 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25288 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25289 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25290 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25291 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25292 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25293 @end itemize
25294
25295 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25296 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25297
25298 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25299 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25300 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25301
25302 @subsection Python comes first
25303
25304 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25305 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25306 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25307 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25308 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25309 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25310 pretty-printed form of a value).
25311 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25312 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25313 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25314
25315 @node Aliases
25316 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25317 @cindex aliases for commands
25318
25319 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25320 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25321 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25322 that involves less typing.
25323
25324 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25325 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25326 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25327
25328 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25329 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25330 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25331
25332 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25333
25334 @table @code
25335
25336 @kindex alias
25337 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25338
25339 @end table
25340
25341 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25342 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25343 underscores.
25344
25345 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25346 that is being aliased.
25347
25348 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25349 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25350 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25351
25352 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25353 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25354
25355 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25356 of a command so that there is less to type.
25357 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25358 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25359 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25360 The following will accomplish this.
25361
25362 @smallexample
25363 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25364 @end smallexample
25365
25366 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25367 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25368 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25369 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25370
25371 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25372 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25373 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25374 of a command.
25375
25376 @smallexample
25377 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25378 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25379 (gdb) set p elms 20
25380 (gdb) show p elms
25381 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25382 @end smallexample
25383
25384 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25385 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25386 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25387
25388 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25389 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25390
25391 @smallexample
25392 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25393 @end smallexample
25394
25395 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25396 alias for a more complex command.
25397 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25398
25399 @smallexample
25400 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25401 (gdb) spe 20
25402 @end smallexample
25403
25404 @node Interpreters
25405 @chapter Command Interpreters
25406 @cindex command interpreters
25407
25408 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25409 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25410 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25411
25412 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25413 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25414 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25415 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25416
25417 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25418 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25419 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25420 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25421
25422 @table @code
25423 @item console
25424 @cindex console interpreter
25425 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25426 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25427 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25428
25429 @item mi
25430 @cindex mi interpreter
25431 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25432 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25433 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25434 Interface}.
25435
25436 @item mi2
25437 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25438 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25439
25440 @item mi1
25441 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25442 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25443
25444 @end table
25445
25446 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25447
25448 @kindex interpreter-exec
25449 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25450 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25451 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25452
25453 @smallexample
25454 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25455 @end smallexample
25456
25457 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25458 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25459
25460 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25461 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25462 permanently.
25463
25464 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25465
25466 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25467 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25468 device (usually a tty).
25469
25470 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25471 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25472 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25473 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25474 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25475 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25476 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25477 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25478 the separate MI interpreter.
25479
25480 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25481 @code{new-ui} command:
25482
25483 @kindex new-ui
25484 @cindex new user interface
25485 @smallexample
25486 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25487 @end smallexample
25488
25489 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25490 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25491 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25492 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25493 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25494 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25495
25496 @smallexample
25497 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25498 @end smallexample
25499
25500 @noindent
25501 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25502
25503 @node TUI
25504 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25505 @cindex TUI
25506 @cindex Text User Interface
25507
25508 @menu
25509 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25510 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25511 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25512 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25513 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25514 @end menu
25515
25516 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25517 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25518 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25519 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25520 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25521 is available.
25522
25523 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25524 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25525 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25526 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25527 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25528 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25529
25530 @node TUI Overview
25531 @section TUI Overview
25532
25533 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25534
25535 @table @emph
25536 @item command
25537 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25538 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25539 managed using readline.
25540
25541 @item source
25542 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25543 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25544
25545 @item assembly
25546 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25547
25548 @item register
25549 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25550 when their values change.
25551 @end table
25552
25553 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25554 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25555 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25556 indicates the breakpoint type:
25557
25558 @table @code
25559 @item B
25560 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25561
25562 @item b
25563 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25564
25565 @item H
25566 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25567
25568 @item h
25569 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25570 @end table
25571
25572 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25573
25574 @table @code
25575 @item +
25576 Breakpoint is enabled.
25577
25578 @item -
25579 Breakpoint is disabled.
25580 @end table
25581
25582 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25583 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25584 changes.
25585
25586 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25587 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25588 layouts:
25589
25590 @itemize @bullet
25591 @item
25592 source only,
25593
25594 @item
25595 assembly only,
25596
25597 @item
25598 source and assembly,
25599
25600 @item
25601 source and registers, or
25602
25603 @item
25604 assembly and registers.
25605 @end itemize
25606
25607 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25608
25609 @table @emph
25610 @item target
25611 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25612 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25613
25614 @item process
25615 Gives the current process or thread number.
25616 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25617
25618 @item function
25619 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25620 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25621 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25622 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25623
25624 @item line
25625 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25626 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25627
25628 @item pc
25629 Indicates the current program counter address.
25630 @end table
25631
25632 @node TUI Keys
25633 @section TUI Key Bindings
25634 @cindex TUI key bindings
25635
25636 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25637 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25638 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25639 @end ifset
25640 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25641 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25642 @end ifclear
25643 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25644 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25645
25646 @table @kbd
25647 @kindex C-x C-a
25648 @item C-x C-a
25649 @kindex C-x a
25650 @itemx C-x a
25651 @kindex C-x A
25652 @itemx C-x A
25653 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25654 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25655 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25656 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25657 The screen is then refreshed.
25658
25659 @kindex C-x 1
25660 @item C-x 1
25661 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25662 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25663 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25664
25665 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25666
25667 @kindex C-x 2
25668 @item C-x 2
25669 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25670 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25671 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25672 previous layout and the new one.
25673
25674 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25675
25676 @kindex C-x o
25677 @item C-x o
25678 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25679 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25680 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25681
25682 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25683
25684 @kindex C-x s
25685 @item C-x s
25686 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25687 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25688 @end table
25689
25690 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25691
25692 @table @asis
25693 @kindex PgUp
25694 @item @key{PgUp}
25695 Scroll the active window one page up.
25696
25697 @kindex PgDn
25698 @item @key{PgDn}
25699 Scroll the active window one page down.
25700
25701 @kindex Up
25702 @item @key{Up}
25703 Scroll the active window one line up.
25704
25705 @kindex Down
25706 @item @key{Down}
25707 Scroll the active window one line down.
25708
25709 @kindex Left
25710 @item @key{Left}
25711 Scroll the active window one column left.
25712
25713 @kindex Right
25714 @item @key{Right}
25715 Scroll the active window one column right.
25716
25717 @kindex C-L
25718 @item @kbd{C-L}
25719 Refresh the screen.
25720 @end table
25721
25722 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25723 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25724 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25725 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25726 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25727
25728 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25729 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25730 @cindex TUI single key mode
25731
25732 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25733 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25734 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25735
25736 @table @kbd
25737 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25738 @item c
25739 continue
25740
25741 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25742 @item d
25743 down
25744
25745 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25746 @item f
25747 finish
25748
25749 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25750 @item n
25751 next
25752
25753 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25754 @item o
25755 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25756
25757 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25758 @item q
25759 exit the SingleKey mode.
25760
25761 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25762 @item r
25763 run
25764
25765 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25766 @item s
25767 step
25768
25769 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25770 @item i
25771 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25772
25773 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25774 @item u
25775 up
25776
25777 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25778 @item v
25779 info locals
25780
25781 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25782 @item w
25783 where
25784 @end table
25785
25786 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25787 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25788 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25789 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25790 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25791 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25792
25793
25794 @node TUI Commands
25795 @section TUI-specific Commands
25796 @cindex TUI commands
25797
25798 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25799 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25800 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25801 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25802
25803 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25804 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25805 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25806 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25807 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25808
25809 @table @code
25810 @item tui enable
25811 @kindex tui enable
25812 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25813 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25814 otherwise a default layout is used.
25815
25816 @item tui disable
25817 @kindex tui disable
25818 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25819
25820 @item info win
25821 @kindex info win
25822 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25823
25824 @item layout @var{name}
25825 @kindex layout
25826 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25827 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25828 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25829
25830 @table @code
25831 @item next
25832 Display the next layout.
25833
25834 @item prev
25835 Display the previous layout.
25836
25837 @item src
25838 Display the source and command windows.
25839
25840 @item asm
25841 Display the assembly and command windows.
25842
25843 @item split
25844 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25845
25846 @item regs
25847 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25848 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25849 register, assembler, and command windows.
25850 @end table
25851
25852 @item focus @var{name}
25853 @kindex focus
25854 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25855 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25856
25857 @table @code
25858 @item next
25859 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25860
25861 @item prev
25862 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25863
25864 @item src
25865 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25866
25867 @item asm
25868 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25869
25870 @item regs
25871 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25872
25873 @item cmd
25874 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25875 @end table
25876
25877 @item refresh
25878 @kindex refresh
25879 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25880
25881 @item tui reg @var{group}
25882 @kindex tui reg
25883 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25884 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25885 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25886 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25887 following groups are available on most targets:
25888 @table @code
25889 @item next
25890 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25891 through all of the available register groups.
25892
25893 @item prev
25894 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25895 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25896 @var{next}.
25897
25898 @item general
25899 Display the general registers.
25900 @item float
25901 Display the floating point registers.
25902 @item system
25903 Display the system registers.
25904 @item vector
25905 Display the vector registers.
25906 @item all
25907 Display all registers.
25908 @end table
25909
25910 @item update
25911 @kindex update
25912 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25913
25914 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25915 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25916 @kindex winheight
25917 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25918 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25919 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25920 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25921 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25922
25923 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25924 @kindex tabset
25925 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25926 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25927 assembly windows.
25928 @end table
25929
25930 @node TUI Configuration
25931 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25932 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25933
25934 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25935
25936 @table @code
25937 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25938 @kindex set tui border-kind
25939 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25940 The possible values are the following:
25941 @table @code
25942 @item space
25943 Use a space character to draw the border.
25944
25945 @item ascii
25946 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25947
25948 @item acs
25949 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25950 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25951 @end table
25952
25953 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25954 @kindex set tui border-mode
25955 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25956 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25957 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25958 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25959 @table @code
25960 @item normal
25961 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25962
25963 @item standout
25964 Use standout mode.
25965
25966 @item reverse
25967 Use reverse video mode.
25968
25969 @item half
25970 Use half bright mode.
25971
25972 @item half-standout
25973 Use half bright and standout mode.
25974
25975 @item bold
25976 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25977
25978 @item bold-standout
25979 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25980 @end table
25981 @end table
25982
25983 @node Emacs
25984 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25985
25986 @cindex Emacs
25987 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25988 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25989 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25990 @value{GDBN}.
25991
25992 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25993 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25994 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25995 created Emacs buffer.
25996 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25997
25998 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25999 things:
26000
26001 @itemize @bullet
26002 @item
26003 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26004 the GUD buffer.
26005
26006 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26007 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26008
26009 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26010 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26011 in this way.
26012
26013 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26014 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26015 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26016 stop.
26017
26018 @item
26019 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26020
26021 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26022 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26023 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26024 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26025 and the source.
26026
26027 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26028 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26029 @end itemize
26030
26031 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26032 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26033 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26034 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26035
26036 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26037 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26038 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26039 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26040 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26041 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26042 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26043 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26044 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26045
26046 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26047 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26048 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26049 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26050
26051 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26052 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26053 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26054 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26055 one you want.
26056
26057 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26058 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26059
26060 @table @kbd
26061 @item C-h m
26062 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26063
26064 @item C-c C-s
26065 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26066 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26067
26068 @item C-c C-n
26069 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26070 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26071 to show the current file and location.
26072
26073 @item C-c C-i
26074 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26075 display window accordingly.
26076
26077 @item C-c C-f
26078 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26079 @code{finish} command.
26080
26081 @item C-c C-r
26082 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26083 command.
26084
26085 @item C-c <
26086 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26087 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26088 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26089
26090 @item C-c >
26091 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26092 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26093 @end table
26094
26095 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26096 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26097
26098 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26099 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26100 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26101 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26102 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26103 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26104 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26105
26106 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26107 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26108 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26109 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26110 frame.
26111
26112 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26113 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26114 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26115 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26116 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26117 to correspond properly with the code.
26118
26119 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26120 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26121 Emacs Manual}).
26122
26123 @node GDB/MI
26124 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26125
26126 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26127
26128 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26129 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26130 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26131 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26132 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26133 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26134
26135 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26136 in the form of a reference manual.
26137
26138 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26139 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26140 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26141
26142 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26143
26144 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26145 This chapter uses the following notation:
26146
26147 @itemize @bullet
26148 @item
26149 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26150
26151 @item
26152 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26153 it may or may not be given.
26154
26155 @item
26156 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26157 may repeat zero or more times.
26158
26159 @item
26160 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26161 may repeat one or more times.
26162
26163 @item
26164 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26165 @end itemize
26166
26167 @ignore
26168 @heading Dependencies
26169 @end ignore
26170
26171 @menu
26172 * GDB/MI General Design::
26173 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26174 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26175 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26176 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26177 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26178 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26179 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26180 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26181 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26182 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26183 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26184 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26185 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26186 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26187 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26188 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26189 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26190 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26191 @ignore
26192 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26193 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26194 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26195 @end ignore
26196 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26197 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26198 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26199 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26200 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26201 @end menu
26202
26203 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26204 @node GDB/MI General Design
26205 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26206 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26207
26208 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26209 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26210 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26211 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26212 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26213 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26214 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26215 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26216 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26217 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26218
26219 The important examples of notifications are:
26220 @itemize @bullet
26221
26222 @item
26223 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26224 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26225 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26226 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26227 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26228 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26229 command itself was successfully executed.
26230
26231 @item
26232 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26233 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26234 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26235 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26236 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26237 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26238
26239 @item
26240 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26241 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26242 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26243 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26244 orthogonal frontend design.
26245
26246 @end itemize
26247
26248 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26249 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26250 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26251 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26252 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26253 the user interface.
26254
26255
26256 @menu
26257 * Context management::
26258 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26259 * Thread groups::
26260 @end menu
26261
26262 @node Context management
26263 @subsection Context management
26264
26265 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26266
26267 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26268 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26269 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26270 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26271 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26272 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26273 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26274 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26275 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26276
26277 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26278 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26279 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26280 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26281 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26282 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26283 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26284 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26285 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26286 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26287 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26288
26289 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26290 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26291 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26292 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26293 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26294 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26295 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26296 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26297 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26298 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26299
26300 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26301 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26302 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26303 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26304 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26305 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26306 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26307 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26308 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26309 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26310 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26311 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26312 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26313 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26314 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26315 @samp{--frame} options.
26316
26317 @subsubsection Language
26318
26319 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26320 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26321 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26322 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26323 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26324 For instance:
26325
26326 @smallexample
26327 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26328 ^done,value="4"
26329 (gdb)
26330 @end smallexample
26331
26332 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26333 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26334 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26335
26336 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26337 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26338
26339 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26340 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26341 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26342 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26343 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26344 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26345 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26346 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26347 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26348
26349 @table @code
26350 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26351 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26352 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26353
26354 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26355 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26356 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26357
26358 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26359 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26360 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26361 MI commands even while the target is running.
26362
26363 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26364 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26365 @end table
26366
26367 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26368 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26369 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26370 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26371 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26372 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26373
26374 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26375 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26376 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26377 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26378 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26379 are running.
26380
26381 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26382 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26383 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26384 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26385 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26386 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26387 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26388 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26389 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26390 @samp{--thread} option).
26391
26392 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26393 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26394 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26395 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26396
26397 @node Thread groups
26398 @subsection Thread groups
26399 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26400 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26401 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26402 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26403 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26404
26405 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26406 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26407 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26408 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26409 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26410 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26411 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26412 into processes.
26413
26414 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26415 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26416 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26417 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26418 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26419 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26420 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26421 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26422 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26423 the members of specific thread group.
26424
26425 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26426 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26427 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26428 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26429 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26430 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26431 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26432 after attaching to that thread group.
26433
26434 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26435 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26436 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26437 such thread groups.
26438
26439 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26440 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26441 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26442
26443 @menu
26444 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26445 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26446 @end menu
26447
26448 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26449 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26450
26451 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26452 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26453 @table @code
26454 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26455 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26456
26457 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26458 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26459 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26460
26461 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26462 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26463 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26464
26465 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26466 "any sequence of digits"
26467
26468 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26469 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26470
26471 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26472 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26473
26474 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26475 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26476
26477 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26478 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26479 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26480
26481 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26482 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26483
26484 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26485 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26486 @end table
26487
26488 @noindent
26489 Notes:
26490
26491 @itemize @bullet
26492 @item
26493 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26494 output is described below.
26495
26496 @item
26497 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26498 finishes.
26499
26500 @item
26501 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26502 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26503 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26504 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26505 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26506 @end itemize
26507
26508 Pragmatics:
26509
26510 @itemize @bullet
26511 @item
26512 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26513
26514 @item
26515 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26516 @end itemize
26517
26518 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26519 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26520
26521 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26522 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26523 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26524 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26525 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26526 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26527
26528 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26529 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26530 @var{token}.
26531
26532 @table @code
26533 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26534 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26535
26536 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26537 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26538
26539 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26540 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26541
26542 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26543 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26544
26545 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26546 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26547
26548 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26549 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26550
26551 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26552 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26553
26554 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26555 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26556
26557 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26558 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26559
26560 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26561 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26562 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26563
26564 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26565 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26566
26567 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26568 @code{ @var{string} }
26569
26570 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26571 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26572
26573 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26574 @code{@var{c-string}}
26575
26576 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26577 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26578
26579 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26580 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26581 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26582
26583 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26584 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26585
26586 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26587 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26588
26589 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26590 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26591
26592 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26593 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26594
26595 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26596 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26597
26598 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26599 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26600 @end table
26601
26602 @noindent
26603 Notes:
26604
26605 @itemize @bullet
26606 @item
26607 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26608
26609 @item
26610 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26611 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26612 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26613 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26614 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26615 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26616 prior command.
26617
26618 @item
26619 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26620 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26621 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26622 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26623
26624 @item
26625 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26626 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26627 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26628 @samp{*}.
26629
26630 @item
26631 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26632 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26633 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26634 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26635
26636 @item
26637 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26638 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26639 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26640 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26641
26642 @item
26643 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26644 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26645 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26646
26647 @item
26648 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26649 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26650 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26651 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26652
26653 @item
26654 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26655 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26656 @var{values}.
26657
26658
26659 @end itemize
26660
26661 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26662 details about the various output records.
26663
26664 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26665 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26666 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26667
26668 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26669 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26670
26671 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26672 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26673 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26674 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26675 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26676 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26677
26678 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26679 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26680 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26681
26682 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26683 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26684 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26685 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26686
26687 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26688 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26689
26690 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26691 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26692 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26693 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26694 might change.
26695
26696 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26697 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26698 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26699 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26700
26701 @itemize @bullet
26702 @item
26703 New MI commands may be added.
26704
26705 @item
26706 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26707
26708 @item
26709 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26710 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26711
26712 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26713 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26714
26715 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26716 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26717 @end itemize
26718
26719 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26720 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26721 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26722 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26723 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26724
26725 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26726 @c version?
26727
26728 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26729 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26730 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26731 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26732 @cindex mailing lists
26733
26734 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26735 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26736 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26737
26738 @menu
26739 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26740 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26741 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26742 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26743 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26744 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26745 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26746 @end menu
26747
26748 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26749 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26750
26751 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26752 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26753 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26754 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26755
26756 @table @code
26757 @findex ^done
26758 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26759 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26760 values.
26761
26762 @item "^running"
26763 @findex ^running
26764 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26765 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26766 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26767 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26768 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26769 which threads are resumed.
26770
26771 @item "^connected"
26772 @findex ^connected
26773 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26774
26775 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26776 @findex ^error
26777 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26778 the corresponding error message.
26779
26780 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26781 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26782 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26783
26784 @table @samp
26785 @item "undefined-command"
26786 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26787 @end table
26788
26789 @item "^exit"
26790 @findex ^exit
26791 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26792
26793 @end table
26794
26795 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26796 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26797
26798 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26799 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26800 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26801 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26802 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26803
26804 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26805 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26806 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26807 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26808 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26809
26810 @table @code
26811 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26812 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26813 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26814
26815 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26816 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26817 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26818 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26819
26820 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26821 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26822 internals.
26823 @end table
26824
26825 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26826 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26827
26828 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26829 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26830 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26831 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26832 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26833 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26834
26835 The following is the list of possible async records:
26836
26837 @table @code
26838
26839 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26840 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26841 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26842 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26843 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26844 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26845 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26846 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26847 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26848 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26849 it run freely.
26850
26851 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26852 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26853 following values:
26854
26855 @table @code
26856 @item breakpoint-hit
26857 A breakpoint was reached.
26858 @item watchpoint-trigger
26859 A watchpoint was triggered.
26860 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26861 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26862 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26863 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26864 @item function-finished
26865 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26866 @item location-reached
26867 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26868 @item watchpoint-scope
26869 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26870 @item end-stepping-range
26871 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26872 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26873 @item exited-signalled
26874 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26875 @item exited
26876 The inferior exited.
26877 @item exited-normally
26878 The inferior exited normally.
26879 @item signal-received
26880 A signal was received by the inferior.
26881 @item solib-event
26882 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26883 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26884 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26885 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26886 @item fork
26887 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26888 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26889 @item vfork
26890 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26891 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26892 @item syscall-entry
26893 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26894 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26895 @item syscall-return
26896 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26897 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26898 @item exec
26899 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26900 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26901 @end table
26902
26903 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26904 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26905 Depending on whether all-stop
26906 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26907 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26908 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26909 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26910 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26911 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26912 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26913 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26914 if such information is not available.
26915
26916 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26917 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26918 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26919 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26920 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26921 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26922 cannot be used in any way.
26923
26924 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26925 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26926 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26927 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26928 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26929 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26930
26931 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26932 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26933 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26934 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26935 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26936 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26937
26938 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26939 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26940 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26941 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26942 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26943
26944 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26945 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26946 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26947 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26948 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26949 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26950 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26951 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26952 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26953
26954 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26955 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26956
26957 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26958 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26959 that thread.
26960
26961 @item =library-loaded,...
26962 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26963 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26964 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26965 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26966 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26967 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26968 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26969 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26970 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26971 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26972 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26973 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26974 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26975 to this library.
26976
26977 @item =library-unloaded,...
26978 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26979 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26980 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26981 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26982 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26983 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26984 thread groups.
26985
26986 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26987 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26988 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26989 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26990 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26991
26992 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26993 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26994 initial value @var{initial}.
26995
26996 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26997 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26998 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26999 trace state variables are deleted.
27000
27001 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27002 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27003 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27004 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27005 value of trace state variable is known.
27006
27007 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27008 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27009 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27010 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27011 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27012 user.
27013
27014 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27015 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27016 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27017
27018 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27019 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27020
27021 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27022 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27023 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27024 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27025 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27026
27027 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27028 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27029 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27030 for existing method and format values.
27031
27032 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27033 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27034 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27035 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27036 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27037 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27038
27039 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27040 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27041 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27042 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27043 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27044 executable code.
27045 @end table
27046
27047 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27048 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27049
27050 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27051 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27052 following fields:
27053
27054 @table @code
27055 @item number
27056 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27057 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27058 @samp{1.2}.
27059
27060 @item type
27061 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27062 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27063
27064 @item catch-type
27065 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27066 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27067
27068 @item disp
27069 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27070 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27071 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27072
27073 @item enabled
27074 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27075 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27076 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27077
27078 @item addr
27079 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27080 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27081 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27082 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27083 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27084
27085 @item func
27086 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27087 If not known, this field is not present.
27088
27089 @item filename
27090 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27091 If not known, this field is not present.
27092
27093 @item fullname
27094 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27095 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27096
27097 @item line
27098 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27099 If not known, this field is not present.
27100
27101 @item at
27102 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27103 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27104 by a symbol name.
27105
27106 @item pending
27107 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27108 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27109
27110 @item evaluated-by
27111 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27112 @samp{target}.
27113
27114 @item thread
27115 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27116 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27117
27118 @item task
27119 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27120 field will hold the task identifier.
27121
27122 @item cond
27123 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27124
27125 @item ignore
27126 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27127
27128 @item enable
27129 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27130
27131 @item traceframe-usage
27132 FIXME.
27133
27134 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27135 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27136
27137 @item mask
27138 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27139
27140 @item pass
27141 A tracepoint's pass count.
27142
27143 @item original-location
27144 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27145 This field is optional.
27146
27147 @item times
27148 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27149
27150 @item installed
27151 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27152 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27153 is not.
27154
27155 @item what
27156 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27157
27158 @end table
27159
27160 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27161 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27162
27163 @smallexample
27164 -> -break-insert main
27165 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27166 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27167 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27168 times="0"@}
27169 <- (gdb)
27170 @end smallexample
27171
27172 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27173 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27174
27175 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27176 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27177 fields:
27178
27179 @table @code
27180 @item level
27181 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27182 zero. This field is always present.
27183
27184 @item func
27185 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27186 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27187
27188 @item addr
27189 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27190
27191 @item file
27192 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27193 address. This field may be absent.
27194
27195 @item line
27196 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27197 may be absent.
27198
27199 @item from
27200 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27201 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27202
27203 @end table
27204
27205 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27206 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27207
27208 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27209 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27210 stated otherwise.
27211
27212 @table @code
27213 @item id
27214 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27215
27216 @item target-id
27217 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27218
27219 @item details
27220 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27221 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27222 frontend. This field is optional.
27223
27224 @item name
27225 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27226 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27227 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27228 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27229 field is omitted.
27230
27231 @item state
27232 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27233 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27234
27235 @item frame
27236 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27237 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27238 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27239
27240 @item core
27241 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27242 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27243 @end table
27244
27245 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27246 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27247
27248 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27249 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27250 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27251 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
27252 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
27253 the @code{exception-message} field.
27254
27255 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27256 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27257 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27258 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27259
27260 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27261 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27262 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27263 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27264
27265 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27266 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27267
27268 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27269
27270 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27271 information of the breakpoint.
27272
27273 @smallexample
27274 -> -break-insert main
27275 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27276 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27277 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27278 times="0"@}
27279 <- (gdb)
27280 @end smallexample
27281
27282 @subheading Program Execution
27283
27284 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27285 reason that execution stopped.
27286
27287 @smallexample
27288 -> -exec-run
27289 <- ^running
27290 <- (gdb)
27291 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27292 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27293 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27294 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27295 <- (gdb)
27296 -> -exec-continue
27297 <- ^running
27298 <- (gdb)
27299 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27300 <- (gdb)
27301 @end smallexample
27302
27303 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27304
27305 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27306
27307 @smallexample
27308 -> (gdb)
27309 <- -gdb-exit
27310 <- ^exit
27311 @end smallexample
27312
27313 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27314 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27315 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27316 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27317 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27318 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27319
27320 @subheading A Bad Command
27321
27322 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27323
27324 @smallexample
27325 -> -rubbish
27326 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27327 <- (gdb)
27328 @end smallexample
27329
27330
27331 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27332 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27333 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27334
27335 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27336 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27337
27338 @subheading Motivation
27339
27340 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27341
27342 @subheading Introduction
27343
27344 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27345
27346 @subheading Commands
27347
27348 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27349
27350 @subsubheading Synopsis
27351
27352 @smallexample
27353 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27354 @end smallexample
27355
27356 @subsubheading Result
27357
27358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27359
27360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27361
27362 @subsubheading Example
27363
27364 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27365 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27366
27367
27368 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27369 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27370 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27371
27372 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27373 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27374 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27375 breakpoints.
27376
27377 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27378 @findex -break-after
27379
27380 @subsubheading Synopsis
27381
27382 @smallexample
27383 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27384 @end smallexample
27385
27386 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27387 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27388 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27389 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27390
27391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27392
27393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27394
27395 @subsubheading Example
27396
27397 @smallexample
27398 (gdb)
27399 -break-insert main
27400 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27401 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27402 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27403 times="0"@}
27404 (gdb)
27405 -break-after 1 3
27406 ~
27407 ^done
27408 (gdb)
27409 -break-list
27410 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27411 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27412 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27413 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27414 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27415 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27416 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27417 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27418 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27419 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27420 (gdb)
27421 @end smallexample
27422
27423 @ignore
27424 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27425 @findex -break-catch
27426 @end ignore
27427
27428 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27429 @findex -break-commands
27430
27431 @subsubheading Synopsis
27432
27433 @smallexample
27434 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27435 @end smallexample
27436
27437 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27438 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27439 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27440 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27441 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27442 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27443
27444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27445
27446 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27447
27448 @subsubheading Example
27449
27450 @smallexample
27451 (gdb)
27452 -break-insert main
27453 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27454 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27455 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27456 times="0"@}
27457 (gdb)
27458 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27459 ^done
27460 (gdb)
27461 @end smallexample
27462
27463 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27464 @findex -break-condition
27465
27466 @subsubheading Synopsis
27467
27468 @smallexample
27469 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27470 @end smallexample
27471
27472 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27473 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27474 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27475 command below).
27476
27477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27478
27479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27480
27481 @subsubheading Example
27482
27483 @smallexample
27484 (gdb)
27485 -break-condition 1 1
27486 ^done
27487 (gdb)
27488 -break-list
27489 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27490 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27491 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27492 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27493 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27494 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27495 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27496 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27497 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27498 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27499 (gdb)
27500 @end smallexample
27501
27502 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27503 @findex -break-delete
27504
27505 @subsubheading Synopsis
27506
27507 @smallexample
27508 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27509 @end smallexample
27510
27511 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27512 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27513
27514 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27515
27516 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27517
27518 @subsubheading Example
27519
27520 @smallexample
27521 (gdb)
27522 -break-delete 1
27523 ^done
27524 (gdb)
27525 -break-list
27526 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27527 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27528 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27529 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27530 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27531 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27532 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27533 body=[]@}
27534 (gdb)
27535 @end smallexample
27536
27537 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27538 @findex -break-disable
27539
27540 @subsubheading Synopsis
27541
27542 @smallexample
27543 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27544 @end smallexample
27545
27546 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27547 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27548
27549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27550
27551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27552
27553 @subsubheading Example
27554
27555 @smallexample
27556 (gdb)
27557 -break-disable 2
27558 ^done
27559 (gdb)
27560 -break-list
27561 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27562 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27563 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27564 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27565 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27566 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27567 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27568 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27569 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27570 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27571 (gdb)
27572 @end smallexample
27573
27574 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27575 @findex -break-enable
27576
27577 @subsubheading Synopsis
27578
27579 @smallexample
27580 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27581 @end smallexample
27582
27583 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27584
27585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27586
27587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27588
27589 @subsubheading Example
27590
27591 @smallexample
27592 (gdb)
27593 -break-enable 2
27594 ^done
27595 (gdb)
27596 -break-list
27597 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27598 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27599 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27600 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27601 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27602 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27603 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27604 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27605 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27606 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27607 (gdb)
27608 @end smallexample
27609
27610 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27611 @findex -break-info
27612
27613 @subsubheading Synopsis
27614
27615 @smallexample
27616 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27617 @end smallexample
27618
27619 @c REDUNDANT???
27620 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27621
27622 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27623 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27624 table.
27625
27626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27627
27628 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27629
27630 @subsubheading Example
27631 N.A.
27632
27633 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27634 @findex -break-insert
27635 @anchor{-break-insert}
27636
27637 @subsubheading Synopsis
27638
27639 @smallexample
27640 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27641 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27642 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27643 @end smallexample
27644
27645 @noindent
27646 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27647
27648 @table @var
27649 @item linespec location
27650 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27651
27652 @item explicit location
27653 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27654 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27655 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27656
27657 @table @samp
27658 @item --source @var{filename}
27659 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27660 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27661
27662 @item --function @var{function}
27663 The name of a function or method.
27664
27665 @item --label @var{label}
27666 The name of a label.
27667
27668 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27669 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27670 @end table
27671
27672 @item address location
27673 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27674 @end table
27675
27676 @noindent
27677 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27678
27679 @table @samp
27680 @item -t
27681 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27682 @item -h
27683 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27684 @item -f
27685 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27686 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27687 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27688 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27689 cannot be parsed.
27690 @item -d
27691 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27692 @item -a
27693 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27694 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27695 @item -c @var{condition}
27696 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27697 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27698 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27699 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27700 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27701 @var{thread-id}.
27702 @end table
27703
27704 @subsubheading Result
27705
27706 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27707 resulting breakpoint.
27708
27709 Note: this format is open to change.
27710 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27711
27712 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27713
27714 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27715 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27716
27717 @subsubheading Example
27718
27719 @smallexample
27720 (gdb)
27721 -break-insert main
27722 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27723 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27724 times="0"@}
27725 (gdb)
27726 -break-insert -t foo
27727 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27728 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27729 times="0"@}
27730 (gdb)
27731 -break-list
27732 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27733 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27734 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27735 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27736 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27737 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27738 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27739 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27740 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27741 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27742 times="0"@},
27743 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27744 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27745 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27746 times="0"@}]@}
27747 (gdb)
27748 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27749 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27750 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27751 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27752 @c times="0"@}
27753 @c (gdb)
27754 @end smallexample
27755
27756 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27757 @findex -dprintf-insert
27758
27759 @subsubheading Synopsis
27760
27761 @smallexample
27762 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27763 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27764 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27765 [ @var{argument} ]
27766 @end smallexample
27767
27768 @noindent
27769 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27770 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27771
27772 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27773
27774 @table @samp
27775 @item -t
27776 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27777 @item -f
27778 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27779 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27780 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27781 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27782 cannot be parsed.
27783 @item -d
27784 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27785 @item -c @var{condition}
27786 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27787 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27788 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27789 to @var{ignore-count}.
27790 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27791 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27792 @var{thread-id}.
27793 @end table
27794
27795 @subsubheading Result
27796
27797 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27798 resulting breakpoint.
27799
27800 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27801
27802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27803
27804 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27805
27806 @subsubheading Example
27807
27808 @smallexample
27809 (gdb)
27810 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27811 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27812 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27813 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27814 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27815 original-location="foo"@}
27816 (gdb)
27817 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27818 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27819 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27820 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27821 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27822 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27823 (gdb)
27824 @end smallexample
27825
27826 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27827 @findex -break-list
27828
27829 @subsubheading Synopsis
27830
27831 @smallexample
27832 -break-list
27833 @end smallexample
27834
27835 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27836
27837 @table @samp
27838 @item Number
27839 number of the breakpoint
27840 @item Type
27841 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27842 @item Disposition
27843 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27844 or @samp{nokeep}
27845 @item Enabled
27846 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27847 @item Address
27848 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27849 @item What
27850 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27851 name, line number
27852 @item Thread-groups
27853 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27854 @item Times
27855 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27856 @end table
27857
27858 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27859 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27860
27861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27862
27863 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27864
27865 @subsubheading Example
27866
27867 @smallexample
27868 (gdb)
27869 -break-list
27870 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27871 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27872 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27873 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27874 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27875 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27876 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27877 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27878 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27879 times="0"@},
27880 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27881 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27882 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27883 (gdb)
27884 @end smallexample
27885
27886 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27887
27888 @smallexample
27889 (gdb)
27890 -break-list
27891 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27892 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27893 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27894 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27895 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27896 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27897 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27898 body=[]@}
27899 (gdb)
27900 @end smallexample
27901
27902 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27903 @findex -break-passcount
27904
27905 @subsubheading Synopsis
27906
27907 @smallexample
27908 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27909 @end smallexample
27910
27911 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27912 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27913 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27914 command @samp{passcount}.
27915
27916 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27917 @findex -break-watch
27918
27919 @subsubheading Synopsis
27920
27921 @smallexample
27922 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27923 @end smallexample
27924
27925 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27926 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27927 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27928 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27929 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27930 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27931 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27932 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27933
27934 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27935 breakpoints inserted.
27936
27937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27938
27939 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27940 @samp{rwatch}.
27941
27942 @subsubheading Example
27943
27944 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27945
27946 @smallexample
27947 (gdb)
27948 -break-watch x
27949 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27950 (gdb)
27951 -exec-continue
27952 ^running
27953 (gdb)
27954 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27955 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27956 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27957 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27958 (gdb)
27959 @end smallexample
27960
27961 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27962 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27963 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27964
27965 @smallexample
27966 (gdb)
27967 -break-watch C
27968 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27969 (gdb)
27970 -exec-continue
27971 ^running
27972 (gdb)
27973 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27974 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27975 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27976 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27978 (gdb)
27979 -exec-continue
27980 ^running
27981 (gdb)
27982 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27983 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27984 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27985 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27986 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27987 (gdb)
27988 @end smallexample
27989
27990 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27991 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27992 deleted.
27993
27994 @smallexample
27995 (gdb)
27996 -break-watch C
27997 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27998 (gdb)
27999 -break-list
28000 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28001 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28002 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28003 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28004 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28005 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28006 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28007 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28008 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28009 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28010 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28011 times="1"@},
28012 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28013 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28014 (gdb)
28015 -exec-continue
28016 ^running
28017 (gdb)
28018 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28019 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28020 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28021 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28022 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28023 (gdb)
28024 -break-list
28025 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28026 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28027 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28028 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28029 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28030 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28031 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28032 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28033 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28034 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28035 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28036 times="1"@},
28037 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28038 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28039 (gdb)
28040 -exec-continue
28041 ^running
28042 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28043 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28044 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28045 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28046 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28047 (gdb)
28048 -break-list
28049 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28050 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28051 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28052 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28053 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28054 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28055 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28056 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28057 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28058 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28059 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28060 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28061 (gdb)
28062 @end smallexample
28063
28064
28065 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28066 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28067 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28068
28069 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28070 catchpoints.
28071
28072 @menu
28073 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28074 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28075 @end menu
28076
28077 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28078 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28079
28080 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28081 @findex -catch-load
28082
28083 @subsubheading Synopsis
28084
28085 @smallexample
28086 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28087 @end smallexample
28088
28089 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28090 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28091 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28092 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28093 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28094
28095
28096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28097
28098 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28099
28100 @subsubheading Example
28101
28102 @smallexample
28103 -catch-load -t foo.so
28104 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28105 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28106 (gdb)
28107 @end smallexample
28108
28109
28110 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28111 @findex -catch-unload
28112
28113 @subsubheading Synopsis
28114
28115 @smallexample
28116 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28117 @end smallexample
28118
28119 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28120 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28121 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28122 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28123 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28124
28125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28126
28127 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28128
28129 @subsubheading Example
28130
28131 @smallexample
28132 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28133 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28134 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28135 (gdb)
28136 @end smallexample
28137
28138 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28139 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28140
28141 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28142 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28143
28144 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28145 @findex -catch-assert
28146
28147 @subsubheading Synopsis
28148
28149 @smallexample
28150 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28151 @end smallexample
28152
28153 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28154
28155 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28156
28157 @table @samp
28158 @item -c @var{condition}
28159 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28160 @item -d
28161 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28162 @item -t
28163 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28164 @end table
28165
28166 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28167
28168 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28169
28170 @subsubheading Example
28171
28172 @smallexample
28173 -catch-assert
28174 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28175 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28176 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28177 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28178 (gdb)
28179 @end smallexample
28180
28181 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28182 @findex -catch-exception
28183
28184 @subsubheading Synopsis
28185
28186 @smallexample
28187 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28188 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28189 @end smallexample
28190
28191 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28192 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28193 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28194 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28195 catchpoints.
28196
28197 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28198
28199 @table @samp
28200 @item -c @var{condition}
28201 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28202 @item -d
28203 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28204 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28205 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28206 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28207 @item -t
28208 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28209 @item -u
28210 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28211 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28212 @end table
28213
28214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28215
28216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28217 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28218
28219 @subsubheading Example
28220
28221 @smallexample
28222 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28223 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28224 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28225 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28226 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28227 (gdb)
28228 @end smallexample
28229
28230 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28231 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28232 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28233
28234 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28235 @findex -exec-arguments
28236
28237
28238 @subsubheading Synopsis
28239
28240 @smallexample
28241 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28242 @end smallexample
28243
28244 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28245 @samp{-exec-run}.
28246
28247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28248
28249 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28250
28251 @subsubheading Example
28252
28253 @smallexample
28254 (gdb)
28255 -exec-arguments -v word
28256 ^done
28257 (gdb)
28258 @end smallexample
28259
28260
28261 @ignore
28262 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28263 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28264
28265 @subsubheading Synopsis
28266
28267 @smallexample
28268 -exec-show-arguments
28269 @end smallexample
28270
28271 Print the arguments of the program.
28272
28273 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28274
28275 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28276
28277 @subsubheading Example
28278 N.A.
28279 @end ignore
28280
28281
28282 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28283 @findex -environment-cd
28284
28285 @subsubheading Synopsis
28286
28287 @smallexample
28288 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28289 @end smallexample
28290
28291 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28292
28293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28294
28295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28296
28297 @subsubheading Example
28298
28299 @smallexample
28300 (gdb)
28301 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28302 ^done
28303 (gdb)
28304 @end smallexample
28305
28306
28307 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28308 @findex -environment-directory
28309
28310 @subsubheading Synopsis
28311
28312 @smallexample
28313 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28314 @end smallexample
28315
28316 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28317 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28318 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28319 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28320 occurs as normal.
28321 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28322 multiple directories in a single command
28323 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28324 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28325 If blanks are needed as
28326 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28327 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28328 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28329 character must not be used
28330 in any directory name.
28331 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28332
28333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28334
28335 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28336
28337 @subsubheading Example
28338
28339 @smallexample
28340 (gdb)
28341 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28342 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28343 (gdb)
28344 -environment-directory ""
28345 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28346 (gdb)
28347 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28348 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28349 (gdb)
28350 -environment-directory -r
28351 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28352 (gdb)
28353 @end smallexample
28354
28355
28356 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28357 @findex -environment-path
28358
28359 @subsubheading Synopsis
28360
28361 @smallexample
28362 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28363 @end smallexample
28364
28365 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28366 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28367 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28368 supplied in addition to the
28369 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28370 occurs as normal.
28371 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28372 multiple directories in a single command
28373 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28374 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28375 If blanks are needed as
28376 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28377 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28378 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28379 character must not be used
28380 in any directory name.
28381 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28382
28383
28384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28385
28386 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28387
28388 @subsubheading Example
28389
28390 @smallexample
28391 (gdb)
28392 -environment-path
28393 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28394 (gdb)
28395 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28396 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28397 (gdb)
28398 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28399 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28400 (gdb)
28401 @end smallexample
28402
28403
28404 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28405 @findex -environment-pwd
28406
28407 @subsubheading Synopsis
28408
28409 @smallexample
28410 -environment-pwd
28411 @end smallexample
28412
28413 Show the current working directory.
28414
28415 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28416
28417 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28418
28419 @subsubheading Example
28420
28421 @smallexample
28422 (gdb)
28423 -environment-pwd
28424 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28425 (gdb)
28426 @end smallexample
28427
28428 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28429 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28430 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28431
28432
28433 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28434 @findex -thread-info
28435
28436 @subsubheading Synopsis
28437
28438 @smallexample
28439 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28440 @end smallexample
28441
28442 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28443 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28444 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28445 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28446 current thread.
28447
28448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28449
28450 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28451 about all threads.
28452
28453 @subsubheading Result
28454
28455 The result contains the following attributes:
28456
28457 @table @samp
28458 @item threads
28459 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28460 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28461
28462 @item current-thread-id
28463 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28464 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28465 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28466 the command.
28467
28468 @end table
28469
28470 @subsubheading Example
28471
28472 @smallexample
28473 -thread-info
28474 ^done,threads=[
28475 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28476 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28477 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28478 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28479 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28480 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28481 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28482 state="running"@}],
28483 current-thread-id="1"
28484 (gdb)
28485 @end smallexample
28486
28487 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28488 @findex -thread-list-ids
28489
28490 @subsubheading Synopsis
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 -thread-list-ids
28494 @end smallexample
28495
28496 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28497 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28498 threads.
28499
28500 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28501 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28502
28503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28504
28505 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28506
28507 @subsubheading Example
28508
28509 @smallexample
28510 (gdb)
28511 -thread-list-ids
28512 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28513 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28514 (gdb)
28515 @end smallexample
28516
28517
28518 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28519 @findex -thread-select
28520
28521 @subsubheading Synopsis
28522
28523 @smallexample
28524 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28525 @end smallexample
28526
28527 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28528 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28529 topmost frame for that thread.
28530
28531 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28532 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28533
28534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28535
28536 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28537
28538 @subsubheading Example
28539
28540 @smallexample
28541 (gdb)
28542 -exec-next
28543 ^running
28544 (gdb)
28545 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28546 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28547 (gdb)
28548 -thread-list-ids
28549 ^done,
28550 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28551 number-of-threads="3"
28552 (gdb)
28553 -thread-select 3
28554 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28555 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28556 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28557 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28558 (gdb)
28559 @end smallexample
28560
28561 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28562 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28563 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28564
28565 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28566 @findex -ada-task-info
28567
28568 @subsubheading Synopsis
28569
28570 @smallexample
28571 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28572 @end smallexample
28573
28574 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28575 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28576
28577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28578
28579 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28580 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28581
28582 @subsubheading Result
28583
28584 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28585 defined for each Ada task:
28586
28587 @table @samp
28588 @item current
28589 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28590
28591 @item id
28592 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28593
28594 @item task-id
28595 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28596
28597 @item thread-id
28598 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28599 task.
28600
28601 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28602 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28603 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28604
28605 @item parent-id
28606 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28607 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28608
28609 @item priority
28610 The base priority of the task.
28611
28612 @item state
28613 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28614 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28615
28616 @item name
28617 The name of the task.
28618
28619 @end table
28620
28621 @subsubheading Example
28622
28623 @smallexample
28624 -ada-task-info
28625 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28626 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28627 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28628 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28629 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28630 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28631 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28632 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28633 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28634 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28635 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28636 (gdb)
28637 @end smallexample
28638
28639 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28640 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28641 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28642
28643 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28644 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28645 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28646 other cases.
28647
28648 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28649 @findex -exec-continue
28650
28651 @subsubheading Synopsis
28652
28653 @smallexample
28654 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28655 @end smallexample
28656
28657 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28658 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28659 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28660 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28661 @itemize @bullet
28662 @item
28663 breakpoints or watchpoints
28664 @item
28665 signals or exceptions
28666 @item
28667 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28668 @item
28669 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28670 @end itemize
28671 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28672 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28673 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28674 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28675 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28676 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28677
28678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28679
28680 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28681
28682 @subsubheading Example
28683
28684 @smallexample
28685 -exec-continue
28686 ^running
28687 (gdb)
28688 @@Hello world
28689 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28690 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28691 line="13"@}
28692 (gdb)
28693 @end smallexample
28694
28695
28696 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28697 @findex -exec-finish
28698
28699 @subsubheading Synopsis
28700
28701 @smallexample
28702 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28703 @end smallexample
28704
28705 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28706 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28707 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28708 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28709 function was called.
28710
28711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28712
28713 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28714
28715 @subsubheading Example
28716
28717 Function returning @code{void}.
28718
28719 @smallexample
28720 -exec-finish
28721 ^running
28722 (gdb)
28723 @@hello from foo
28724 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28725 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28726 (gdb)
28727 @end smallexample
28728
28729 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28730 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28731 value itself.
28732
28733 @smallexample
28734 -exec-finish
28735 ^running
28736 (gdb)
28737 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28738 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28739 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28740 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28741 (gdb)
28742 @end smallexample
28743
28744
28745 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28746 @findex -exec-interrupt
28747
28748 @subsubheading Synopsis
28749
28750 @smallexample
28751 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28752 @end smallexample
28753
28754 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28755 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28756 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28757 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28758 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28759
28760 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28761 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28762 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28763 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28764
28765 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28766 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28767 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28768 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28769
28770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28771
28772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28773
28774 @subsubheading Example
28775
28776 @smallexample
28777 (gdb)
28778 111-exec-continue
28779 111^running
28780
28781 (gdb)
28782 222-exec-interrupt
28783 222^done
28784 (gdb)
28785 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28786 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28787 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28788 (gdb)
28789
28790 (gdb)
28791 -exec-interrupt
28792 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28793 (gdb)
28794 @end smallexample
28795
28796 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28797 @findex -exec-jump
28798
28799 @subsubheading Synopsis
28800
28801 @smallexample
28802 -exec-jump @var{location}
28803 @end smallexample
28804
28805 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28806 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28807 different forms of @var{location}.
28808
28809 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28810
28811 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28812
28813 @subsubheading Example
28814
28815 @smallexample
28816 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28817 *running,thread-id="all"
28818 ^running
28819 @end smallexample
28820
28821
28822 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28823 @findex -exec-next
28824
28825 @subsubheading Synopsis
28826
28827 @smallexample
28828 -exec-next [--reverse]
28829 @end smallexample
28830
28831 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28832 of the next source line is reached.
28833
28834 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28835 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28836 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28837 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28838 source line where the function was called.
28839
28840
28841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28842
28843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28844
28845 @subsubheading Example
28846
28847 @smallexample
28848 -exec-next
28849 ^running
28850 (gdb)
28851 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28852 (gdb)
28853 @end smallexample
28854
28855
28856 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28857 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28858
28859 @subsubheading Synopsis
28860
28861 @smallexample
28862 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28863 @end smallexample
28864
28865 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28866 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28867 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28868 printed as well.
28869
28870 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28871 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28872 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28873 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28874 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28875
28876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28877
28878 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28879
28880 @subsubheading Example
28881
28882 @smallexample
28883 (gdb)
28884 -exec-next-instruction
28885 ^running
28886
28887 (gdb)
28888 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28889 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28890 (gdb)
28891 @end smallexample
28892
28893
28894 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28895 @findex -exec-return
28896
28897 @subsubheading Synopsis
28898
28899 @smallexample
28900 -exec-return
28901 @end smallexample
28902
28903 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28904 Displays the new current frame.
28905
28906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28907
28908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28909
28910 @subsubheading Example
28911
28912 @smallexample
28913 (gdb)
28914 200-break-insert callee4
28915 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28916 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28917 (gdb)
28918 000-exec-run
28919 000^running
28920 (gdb)
28921 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28922 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28923 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28924 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28925 (gdb)
28926 205-break-delete
28927 205^done
28928 (gdb)
28929 111-exec-return
28930 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28931 args=[@{name="strarg",
28932 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28933 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28934 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28935 (gdb)
28936 @end smallexample
28937
28938
28939 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28940 @findex -exec-run
28941
28942 @subsubheading Synopsis
28943
28944 @smallexample
28945 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28946 @end smallexample
28947
28948 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28949 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28950 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28951 the program has exited exceptionally.
28952
28953 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28954 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28955 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28956 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28957 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28958
28959 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28960 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28961 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28962 (@pxref{Starting}).
28963
28964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28965
28966 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28967
28968 @subsubheading Examples
28969
28970 @smallexample
28971 (gdb)
28972 -break-insert main
28973 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28974 (gdb)
28975 -exec-run
28976 ^running
28977 (gdb)
28978 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28979 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28980 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28981 (gdb)
28982 @end smallexample
28983
28984 @noindent
28985 Program exited normally:
28986
28987 @smallexample
28988 (gdb)
28989 -exec-run
28990 ^running
28991 (gdb)
28992 x = 55
28993 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28994 (gdb)
28995 @end smallexample
28996
28997 @noindent
28998 Program exited exceptionally:
28999
29000 @smallexample
29001 (gdb)
29002 -exec-run
29003 ^running
29004 (gdb)
29005 x = 55
29006 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29007 (gdb)
29008 @end smallexample
29009
29010 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29011 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29012
29013 @smallexample
29014 (gdb)
29015 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29016 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29017 @end smallexample
29018
29019
29020 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29021
29022
29023 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29024 @findex -exec-step
29025
29026 @subsubheading Synopsis
29027
29028 @smallexample
29029 -exec-step [--reverse]
29030 @end smallexample
29031
29032 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29033 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29034 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29035 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29036 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29037 previously executed source line.
29038
29039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29040
29041 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29042
29043 @subsubheading Example
29044
29045 Stepping into a function:
29046
29047 @smallexample
29048 -exec-step
29049 ^running
29050 (gdb)
29051 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29052 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29053 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29054 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
29055 (gdb)
29056 @end smallexample
29057
29058 Regular stepping:
29059
29060 @smallexample
29061 -exec-step
29062 ^running
29063 (gdb)
29064 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29065 (gdb)
29066 @end smallexample
29067
29068
29069 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29070 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29071
29072 @subsubheading Synopsis
29073
29074 @smallexample
29075 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29076 @end smallexample
29077
29078 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29079 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29080 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29081 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29082 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29083 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29084 as well.
29085
29086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29087
29088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29089
29090 @subsubheading Example
29091
29092 @smallexample
29093 (gdb)
29094 -exec-step-instruction
29095 ^running
29096
29097 (gdb)
29098 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29099 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29100 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29101 (gdb)
29102 -exec-step-instruction
29103 ^running
29104
29105 (gdb)
29106 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29107 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29108 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29109 (gdb)
29110 @end smallexample
29111
29112
29113 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29114 @findex -exec-until
29115
29116 @subsubheading Synopsis
29117
29118 @smallexample
29119 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29120 @end smallexample
29121
29122 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29123 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29124 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29125 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29126
29127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29128
29129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29130
29131 @subsubheading Example
29132
29133 @smallexample
29134 (gdb)
29135 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29136 ^running
29137 (gdb)
29138 x = 55
29139 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29140 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29141 (gdb)
29142 @end smallexample
29143
29144 @ignore
29145 @subheading -file-clear
29146 Is this going away????
29147 @end ignore
29148
29149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29150 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29151 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29152
29153 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29154 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29155
29156 @smallexample
29157 -enable-frame-filters
29158 @end smallexample
29159
29160 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29161 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29162 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29163 request that this functionality be enabled.
29164
29165 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29166
29167 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29168 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29169
29170 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29171 @findex -stack-info-frame
29172
29173 @subsubheading Synopsis
29174
29175 @smallexample
29176 -stack-info-frame
29177 @end smallexample
29178
29179 Get info on the selected frame.
29180
29181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29182
29183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29184 (without arguments).
29185
29186 @subsubheading Example
29187
29188 @smallexample
29189 (gdb)
29190 -stack-info-frame
29191 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29192 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29193 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29194 (gdb)
29195 @end smallexample
29196
29197 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29198 @findex -stack-info-depth
29199
29200 @subsubheading Synopsis
29201
29202 @smallexample
29203 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29204 @end smallexample
29205
29206 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29207 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29208
29209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29210
29211 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29212
29213 @subsubheading Example
29214
29215 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 (gdb)
29219 -stack-info-depth
29220 ^done,depth="12"
29221 (gdb)
29222 -stack-info-depth 4
29223 ^done,depth="4"
29224 (gdb)
29225 -stack-info-depth 12
29226 ^done,depth="12"
29227 (gdb)
29228 -stack-info-depth 11
29229 ^done,depth="11"
29230 (gdb)
29231 -stack-info-depth 13
29232 ^done,depth="12"
29233 (gdb)
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29237 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29238 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29239
29240 @subsubheading Synopsis
29241
29242 @smallexample
29243 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29244 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29245 @end smallexample
29246
29247 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29248 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29249 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29250 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29251 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29252 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29253 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29254 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29255
29256 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29257 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29258 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29259 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29260 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29261 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29262
29263 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29264 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29265 are still displayed, however.
29266
29267 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29268 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29269
29270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29271
29272 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29273 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29274 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29275
29276 @subsubheading Example
29277
29278 @smallexample
29279 (gdb)
29280 -stack-list-frames
29281 ^done,
29282 stack=[
29283 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29284 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29285 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29286 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29288 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29289 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29290 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29291 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29292 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29293 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29294 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29295 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29296 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29297 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29298 (gdb)
29299 -stack-list-arguments 0
29300 ^done,
29301 stack-args=[
29302 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29303 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29304 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29305 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29306 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29307 (gdb)
29308 -stack-list-arguments 1
29309 ^done,
29310 stack-args=[
29311 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29312 frame=@{level="1",
29313 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29314 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29315 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29316 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29317 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29318 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29319 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29320 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29321 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29322 (gdb)
29323 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29324 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29325 (gdb)
29326 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29327 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29328 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29329 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29330 (gdb)
29331 @end smallexample
29332
29333 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29334
29335
29336 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29337 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29338 @findex -stack-list-frames
29339
29340 @subsubheading Synopsis
29341
29342 @smallexample
29343 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29344 @end smallexample
29345
29346 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29347 following info:
29348
29349 @table @samp
29350 @item @var{level}
29351 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29352 @item @var{addr}
29353 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29354 @item @var{func}
29355 Function name.
29356 @item @var{file}
29357 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29358 @item @var{fullname}
29359 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29360 @item @var{line}
29361 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29362 @item @var{from}
29363 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29364 if the frame's function is not known.
29365 @end table
29366
29367 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29368 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29369 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29370 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29371 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29372 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29373 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29374 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29375 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29376
29377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29378
29379 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29380
29381 @subsubheading Example
29382
29383 Full stack backtrace:
29384
29385 @smallexample
29386 (gdb)
29387 -stack-list-frames
29388 ^done,stack=
29389 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29390 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29391 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29392 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29393 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29394 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29395 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29396 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29397 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29398 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29399 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29400 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29401 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29402 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29403 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29404 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29405 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29406 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29407 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29408 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29409 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29410 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29411 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29412 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29413 (gdb)
29414 @end smallexample
29415
29416 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29417
29418 @smallexample
29419 (gdb)
29420 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29421 ^done,stack=
29422 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29423 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29424 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29425 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29426 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29427 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29428 (gdb)
29429 @end smallexample
29430
29431 Show a single frame:
29432
29433 @smallexample
29434 (gdb)
29435 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29436 ^done,stack=
29437 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29438 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29439 (gdb)
29440 @end smallexample
29441
29442
29443 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29444 @findex -stack-list-locals
29445 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29446
29447 @subsubheading Synopsis
29448
29449 @smallexample
29450 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29451 @end smallexample
29452
29453 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29454 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29455 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29456 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29457 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29458 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29459 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29460 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29461 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29462 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29463
29464 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29465 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29466 variables are still displayed, however.
29467
29468 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29469 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29470
29471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29472
29473 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29474
29475 @subsubheading Example
29476
29477 @smallexample
29478 (gdb)
29479 -stack-list-locals 0
29480 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29481 (gdb)
29482 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29483 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29484 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29485 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29486 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29487 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29488 (gdb)
29489 @end smallexample
29490
29491 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29492 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29493 @findex -stack-list-variables
29494
29495 @subsubheading Synopsis
29496
29497 @smallexample
29498 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29499 @end smallexample
29500
29501 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29502 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29503 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29504 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29505 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29506 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29507 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29508
29509 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29510 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29511 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29512
29513 @subsubheading Example
29514
29515 @smallexample
29516 (gdb)
29517 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29518 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522
29523 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29524 @findex -stack-select-frame
29525
29526 @subsubheading Synopsis
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29533 the stack.
29534
29535 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29536 option to every command.
29537
29538 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29539
29540 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29541 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29542
29543 @subsubheading Example
29544
29545 @smallexample
29546 (gdb)
29547 -stack-select-frame 2
29548 ^done
29549 (gdb)
29550 @end smallexample
29551
29552 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29553 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29554 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29555
29556 @ignore
29557
29558 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29559
29560 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29561 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29562 used by @code{Insight}.
29563
29564 The two main reasons for that are:
29565
29566 @enumerate 1
29567 @item
29568 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29569
29570 @item
29571 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29572 now).
29573 @end enumerate
29574
29575 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29576 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29577 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29578 hints about their use.
29579
29580 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29581 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29582 least, the following operations:
29583
29584 @itemize @bullet
29585 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29586 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29587 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29588 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29589 @end itemize
29590
29591 @end ignore
29592
29593 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29594
29595 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29596
29597 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29598 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29599 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29600 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29601 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29602 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29603 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29604 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29605 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29606 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29607 object, or to change display format.
29608
29609 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29610 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29611 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29612 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29613 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29614 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29615 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29616 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29617 child will be created.
29618
29619 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29620 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29621 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29622 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29623 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29624
29625 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29626 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29627 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29628 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29629 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29630 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29631 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29632 variables that frontend has created.
29633
29634 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29635 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29636 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29637 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29638 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29639 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29640 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29641 implicitly updated.
29642
29643 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29644 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29645 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29646 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29647 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29648 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29649 frame. Consider this example:
29650
29651 @smallexample
29652 void do_work(...)
29653 @{
29654 struct work_state state;
29655
29656 if (...)
29657 do_work(...);
29658 @}
29659 @end smallexample
29660
29661 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29662 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29663 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29664 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29665 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29666
29667 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29668 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29669 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29670 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29671 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29672 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29673
29674 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29675 access this functionality:
29676
29677 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29678 @item @strong{Operation}
29679 @tab @strong{Description}
29680
29681 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29682 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29683 @item @code{-var-create}
29684 @tab create a variable object
29685 @item @code{-var-delete}
29686 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29687 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29688 @tab set the display format of this variable
29689 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29690 @tab show the display format of this variable
29691 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29692 @tab tells how many children this object has
29693 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29694 @tab return a list of the object's children
29695 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29696 @tab show the type of this variable object
29697 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29698 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29699 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29700 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29701 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29702 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29703 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29704 @tab get the value of this variable
29705 @item @code{-var-assign}
29706 @tab set the value of this variable
29707 @item @code{-var-update}
29708 @tab update the variable and its children
29709 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29710 @tab set frozeness attribute
29711 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29712 @tab set range of children to display on update
29713 @end multitable
29714
29715 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29716 how it can be used.
29717
29718 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29719
29720 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29721 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29722
29723 @smallexample
29724 -enable-pretty-printing
29725 @end smallexample
29726
29727 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29728 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29729 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29730 request that this functionality be enabled.
29731
29732 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29733
29734 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29735 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29736
29737 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29738 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29739
29740 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29741 @findex -var-create
29742
29743 @subsubheading Synopsis
29744
29745 @smallexample
29746 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29747 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29748 @end smallexample
29749
29750 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29751 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29752 register.
29753
29754 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29755 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29756 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29757 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29758 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29759
29760 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29761 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29762 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29763 object must be created.
29764
29765 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29766 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29767
29768 @itemize @bullet
29769 @item
29770 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29771
29772 @item
29773 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29774
29775 @item
29776 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29777 @end itemize
29778
29779 @cindex dynamic varobj
29780 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29781 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29782 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29783 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29784 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29785 compatibility for existing clients.
29786
29787 @subsubheading Result
29788
29789 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29790 are:
29791
29792 @table @samp
29793 @item name
29794 The name of the varobj.
29795
29796 @item numchild
29797 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29798 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29799 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29800
29801 @item value
29802 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29803 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29804 will not be interesting.
29805
29806 @item type
29807 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29808 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29809 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29810 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29811 @emph{declared} one.
29812
29813 @item thread-id
29814 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29815 thread's global identifier.
29816
29817 @item has_more
29818 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29819 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29820
29821 @item dynamic
29822 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29823 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29824 then this attribute will not be present.
29825
29826 @item displayhint
29827 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29828 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29829 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29830 @end table
29831
29832 Typical output will look like this:
29833
29834 @smallexample
29835 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29836 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29837 @end smallexample
29838
29839
29840 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29841 @findex -var-delete
29842
29843 @subsubheading Synopsis
29844
29845 @smallexample
29846 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29847 @end smallexample
29848
29849 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29850 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29851
29852 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29853
29854
29855 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29856 @findex -var-set-format
29857
29858 @subsubheading Synopsis
29859
29860 @smallexample
29861 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29862 @end smallexample
29863
29864 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29865 @var{format-spec}.
29866
29867 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29868 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29869
29870 @smallexample
29871 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29872 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29873 @end smallexample
29874
29875 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29876 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29877 for pointers, etc.).
29878
29879 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29880 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29881 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29882 zero-hexadecimal format.
29883
29884 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29885 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29886
29887 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29888 @findex -var-show-format
29889
29890 @subsubheading Synopsis
29891
29892 @smallexample
29893 -var-show-format @var{name}
29894 @end smallexample
29895
29896 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29897
29898 @smallexample
29899 @var{format} @expansion{}
29900 @var{format-spec}
29901 @end smallexample
29902
29903
29904 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29905 @findex -var-info-num-children
29906
29907 @subsubheading Synopsis
29908
29909 @smallexample
29910 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29911 @end smallexample
29912
29913 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 numchild=@var{n}
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29920 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29921 be available.
29922
29923
29924 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29925 @findex -var-list-children
29926
29927 @subsubheading Synopsis
29928
29929 @smallexample
29930 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29931 @end smallexample
29932 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29933
29934 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29935 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29936 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29937 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29938 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29939 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29940 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29941 and unions.
29942
29943 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29944 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29945 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29946 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29947 reported.
29948
29949 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29950 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29951 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29952 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29953 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29954 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29955 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29956 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29957 the visible items.
29958
29959 For each child the following results are returned:
29960
29961 @table @var
29962
29963 @item name
29964 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29965
29966 @item exp
29967 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29968 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29969
29970 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29971 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29972
29973 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29974 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29975 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29976 type and value are not present.
29977
29978 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29979 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29980 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29981
29982 @item numchild
29983 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29984 0.
29985
29986 @item type
29987 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29988 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29989 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29990 @emph{declared} one.
29991
29992 @item value
29993 If values were requested, this is the value.
29994
29995 @item thread-id
29996 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29997 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29998
29999 @item frozen
30000 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30001
30002 @item displayhint
30003 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30004 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30005 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30006
30007 @item dynamic
30008 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30009 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30010 then this attribute will not be present.
30011
30012 @end table
30013
30014 The result may have its own attributes:
30015
30016 @table @samp
30017 @item displayhint
30018 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30019 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30020 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30021
30022 @item has_more
30023 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30024 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30025 @end table
30026
30027 @subsubheading Example
30028
30029 @smallexample
30030 (gdb)
30031 -var-list-children n
30032 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30033 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30034 (gdb)
30035 -var-list-children --all-values n
30036 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30037 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30038 @end smallexample
30039
30040
30041 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30042 @findex -var-info-type
30043
30044 @subsubheading Synopsis
30045
30046 @smallexample
30047 -var-info-type @var{name}
30048 @end smallexample
30049
30050 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30051 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30052 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30053
30054 @smallexample
30055 type=@var{typename}
30056 @end smallexample
30057
30058
30059 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30060 @findex -var-info-expression
30061
30062 @subsubheading Synopsis
30063
30064 @smallexample
30065 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30069 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30070 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30071
30072 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30073 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30074
30075 @smallexample
30076 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30077 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30078 @end smallexample
30079
30080 @noindent
30081 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30082 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30083
30084 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30085 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30086 is of limited use.
30087
30088 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30089 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30090
30091 @subsubheading Synopsis
30092
30093 @smallexample
30094 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30095 @end smallexample
30096
30097 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30098 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30099 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30100 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30101 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30102 watchpoint from a variable object.
30103
30104 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30105 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30106
30107 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30108 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30109 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30110 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30111 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30112 @smallexample
30113 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30114 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30115 @end smallexample
30116
30117 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30118 @findex -var-show-attributes
30119
30120 @subsubheading Synopsis
30121
30122 @smallexample
30123 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30124 @end smallexample
30125
30126 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30127
30128 @smallexample
30129 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30130 @end smallexample
30131
30132 @noindent
30133 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30134
30135 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30136 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30137
30138 @subsubheading Synopsis
30139
30140 @smallexample
30141 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30142 @end smallexample
30143
30144 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30145 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30146 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30147 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30148 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30149 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30150 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30151
30152 @smallexample
30153 value=@var{value}
30154 @end smallexample
30155
30156 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30157 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30158
30159 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30160 @findex -var-assign
30161
30162 @subsubheading Synopsis
30163
30164 @smallexample
30165 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30166 @end smallexample
30167
30168 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30169 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30170 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30171 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30172
30173 @subsubheading Example
30174
30175 @smallexample
30176 (gdb)
30177 -var-assign var1 3
30178 ^done,value="3"
30179 (gdb)
30180 -var-update *
30181 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30182 (gdb)
30183 @end smallexample
30184
30185 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30186 @findex -var-update
30187
30188 @subsubheading Synopsis
30189
30190 @smallexample
30191 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30192 @end smallexample
30193
30194 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30195 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30196 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30197 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30198 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30199 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30200 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30201 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30202 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30203 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30204 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30205 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30206 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30207
30208 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30209 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30210 diagnostic.
30211
30212 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30213 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30214
30215 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30216 @samp{changelist}.
30217
30218 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30219
30220 @table @samp
30221 @item name
30222 The name of the varobj.
30223
30224 @item value
30225 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30226 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30227
30228 @item in_scope
30229 @anchor{-var-update}
30230 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30231
30232 @table @code
30233 @item "true"
30234 The variable object's current value is valid.
30235
30236 @item "false"
30237 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30238 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30239 scope.
30240
30241 @item "invalid"
30242 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30243 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30244 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30245 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30246 objects.
30247 @end table
30248
30249 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30250 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30251
30252 @item type_changed
30253 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30254 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30255 be @samp{false}.
30256
30257 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30258 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30259 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30260 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30261 unset.
30262
30263 @item new_type
30264 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30265 hold the new type.
30266
30267 @item new_num_children
30268 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30269 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30270
30271 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30272 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30273 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30274 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30275 children which may be available.
30276
30277 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30278 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30279 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30280 only happen at the end of the update range).
30281
30282 @item displayhint
30283 The display hint, if any.
30284
30285 @item has_more
30286 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30287 available outside the varobj's update range.
30288
30289 @item dynamic
30290 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30291 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30292 then this attribute will not be present.
30293
30294 @item new_children
30295 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30296 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30297 be listed in this attribute.
30298 @end table
30299
30300 @subsubheading Example
30301
30302 @smallexample
30303 (gdb)
30304 -var-assign var1 3
30305 ^done,value="3"
30306 (gdb)
30307 -var-update --all-values var1
30308 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30309 type_changed="false"@}]
30310 (gdb)
30311 @end smallexample
30312
30313 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30314 @findex -var-set-frozen
30315 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30316
30317 @subsubheading Synopsis
30318
30319 @smallexample
30320 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30321 @end smallexample
30322
30323 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30324 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30325 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30326 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30327 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30328 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30329 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30330 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30331 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30332 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30333 @code{-var-update} does.
30334
30335 @subsubheading Example
30336
30337 @smallexample
30338 (gdb)
30339 -var-set-frozen V 1
30340 ^done
30341 (gdb)
30342 @end smallexample
30343
30344 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30345 @findex -var-set-update-range
30346 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30347
30348 @subsubheading Synopsis
30349
30350 @smallexample
30351 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30352 @end smallexample
30353
30354 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30355 @code{-var-update}.
30356
30357 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30358 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30359 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30360 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30361
30362 @subsubheading Example
30363
30364 @smallexample
30365 (gdb)
30366 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30367 ^done
30368 @end smallexample
30369
30370 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30371 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30372 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30373
30374 @subsubheading Synopsis
30375
30376 @smallexample
30377 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30378 @end smallexample
30379
30380 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30381
30382 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30383 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30384
30385 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30386 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30387 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30388 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30389 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30390 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30391 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30392
30393 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30394 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30395 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30396 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30397
30398 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30399 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30400 can be used to check this.
30401
30402 @subsubheading Example
30403
30404 Resetting the visualizer:
30405
30406 @smallexample
30407 (gdb)
30408 -var-set-visualizer V None
30409 ^done
30410 @end smallexample
30411
30412 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30413
30414 @smallexample
30415 (gdb)
30416 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30417 ^done
30418 @end smallexample
30419
30420 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30421 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30422
30423 @smallexample
30424 (gdb)
30425 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30426 ^done
30427 @end smallexample
30428
30429 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30430 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30431 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30432
30433 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30434 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30435 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30436 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30437
30438 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30439 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30440
30441 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30442 @c @subheading -data-assign
30443 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30444 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30445 @c set variable
30446 @c @subsubheading Example
30447 @c N.A.
30448
30449 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30450 @findex -data-disassemble
30451
30452 @subsubheading Synopsis
30453
30454 @smallexample
30455 -data-disassemble
30456 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30457 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30458 -- @var{mode}
30459 @end smallexample
30460
30461 @noindent
30462 Where:
30463
30464 @table @samp
30465 @item @var{start-addr}
30466 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30467 @item @var{end-addr}
30468 is the end address
30469 @item @var{filename}
30470 is the name of the file to disassemble
30471 @item @var{linenum}
30472 is the line number to disassemble around
30473 @item @var{lines}
30474 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30475 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30476 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30477 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30478 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30479 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30480 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30481 are displayed.
30482 @item @var{mode}
30483 is one of:
30484 @itemize @bullet
30485 @item 0 disassembly only
30486 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30487 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30488 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30489 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30490 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30491 @end itemize
30492
30493 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30494 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30495 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30496 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30497 @end table
30498
30499 @subsubheading Result
30500
30501 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30502 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30503 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30504
30505 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30506 following fields:
30507
30508 @table @code
30509 @item address
30510 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30511
30512 @item func-name
30513 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30514
30515 @item offset
30516 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30517
30518 @item inst
30519 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30520
30521 @item opcodes
30522 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30523 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30524
30525 @end table
30526
30527 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30528 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30529
30530 @table @code
30531 @item line
30532 The line number within @samp{file}.
30533
30534 @item file
30535 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30536 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30537 used.
30538
30539 @item fullname
30540 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30541 using the source file search path
30542 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30543 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30544
30545 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30546 present in the debug information.
30547
30548 @item line_asm_insn
30549 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30550 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30551 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30552 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30553 @samp{opcodes}.
30554
30555 @end table
30556
30557 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30558 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30559 adjust its format.
30560
30561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30562
30563 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30564
30565 @subsubheading Example
30566
30567 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30568
30569 @smallexample
30570 (gdb)
30571 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30572 ^done,
30573 asm_insns=[
30574 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30575 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30576 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30577 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30578 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30579 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30580 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30581 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30582 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30583 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30584 (gdb)
30585 @end smallexample
30586
30587 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30588 @code{main}.
30589
30590 @smallexample
30591 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30592 ^done,asm_insns=[
30593 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30594 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30595 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30596 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30597 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30598 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30599 [@dots{}]
30600 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30601 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30602 (gdb)
30603 @end smallexample
30604
30605 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30606
30607 @smallexample
30608 (gdb)
30609 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30610 ^done,asm_insns=[
30611 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30612 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30613 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30614 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30615 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30616 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30617 (gdb)
30618 @end smallexample
30619
30620 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30621
30622 @smallexample
30623 (gdb)
30624 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30625 ^done,asm_insns=[
30626 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30627 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30628 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30629 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30630 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30631 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30632 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30633 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30634 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30635 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30636 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30637 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30638 (gdb)
30639 @end smallexample
30640
30641
30642 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30643 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30644
30645 @subsubheading Synopsis
30646
30647 @smallexample
30648 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30649 @end smallexample
30650
30651 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30652 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30653 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30654
30655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30656
30657 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30658 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30659 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30660
30661 @subsubheading Example
30662
30663 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30664 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30665 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30666 output.
30667
30668 @smallexample
30669 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30670 211^done,value="1"
30671 (gdb)
30672 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30673 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30674 (gdb)
30675 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30676 411^done,value="4"
30677 (gdb)
30678 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30679 511^done,value="4"
30680 (gdb)
30681 @end smallexample
30682
30683
30684 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30685 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30686
30687 @subsubheading Synopsis
30688
30689 @smallexample
30690 -data-list-changed-registers
30691 @end smallexample
30692
30693 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30694
30695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30696
30697 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30698 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30699
30700 @subsubheading Example
30701
30702 On a PPC MBX board:
30703
30704 @smallexample
30705 (gdb)
30706 -exec-continue
30707 ^running
30708
30709 (gdb)
30710 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30711 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30712 line="5"@}
30713 (gdb)
30714 -data-list-changed-registers
30715 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30716 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30717 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30718 (gdb)
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721
30722 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30723 @findex -data-list-register-names
30724
30725 @subsubheading Synopsis
30726
30727 @smallexample
30728 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30729 @end smallexample
30730
30731 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30732 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30733 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30734 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30735 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30736 include empty register names.
30737
30738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30739
30740 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30741 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30742 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30743
30744 @subsubheading Example
30745
30746 For the PPC MBX board:
30747 @smallexample
30748 (gdb)
30749 -data-list-register-names
30750 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30751 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30752 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30753 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30754 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30755 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30756 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30757 (gdb)
30758 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30759 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30760 (gdb)
30761 @end smallexample
30762
30763 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30764 @findex -data-list-register-values
30765
30766 @subsubheading Synopsis
30767
30768 @smallexample
30769 -data-list-register-values
30770 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30771 @end smallexample
30772
30773 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30774 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30775 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30776 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30777 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30778 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30779
30780 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30781
30782 @table @code
30783 @item x
30784 Hexadecimal
30785 @item o
30786 Octal
30787 @item t
30788 Binary
30789 @item d
30790 Decimal
30791 @item r
30792 Raw
30793 @item N
30794 Natural
30795 @end table
30796
30797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30798
30799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30800 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30801
30802 @subsubheading Example
30803
30804 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30805 don't appear in the actual output):
30806
30807 @smallexample
30808 (gdb)
30809 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30810 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30811 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30812 (gdb)
30813 -data-list-register-values x
30814 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30815 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30816 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30817 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30818 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30819 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30820 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30821 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30822 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30823 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30824 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30825 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30826 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30827 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30828 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30829 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30830 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30831 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30832 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30833 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30834 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30835 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30836 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30837 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30838 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30839 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30840 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30841 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30842 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30843 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30844 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30845 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30846 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30847 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30848 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30849 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30850 (gdb)
30851 @end smallexample
30852
30853
30854 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30855 @findex -data-read-memory
30856
30857 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30858
30859 @subsubheading Synopsis
30860
30861 @smallexample
30862 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30863 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30864 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30865 @end smallexample
30866
30867 @noindent
30868 where:
30869
30870 @table @samp
30871 @item @var{address}
30872 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30873 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30874 quoted using the C convention.
30875
30876 @item @var{word-format}
30877 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30878 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30879 ,Output Formats}).
30880
30881 @item @var{word-size}
30882 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30883
30884 @item @var{nr-rows}
30885 The number of rows in the output table.
30886
30887 @item @var{nr-cols}
30888 The number of columns in the output table.
30889
30890 @item @var{aschar}
30891 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30892 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30893 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30894 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30895
30896 @item @var{byte-offset}
30897 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30898 @end table
30899
30900 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30901 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30902 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30903 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30904 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30905 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30906 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30907 @samp{addr}.
30908
30909 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30910 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30911 @samp{prev-page}.
30912
30913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30914
30915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30916 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30917
30918 @subsubheading Example
30919
30920 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30921 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30922 word. Display each word in hex.
30923
30924 @smallexample
30925 (gdb)
30926 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30927 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30928 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30929 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30930 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30931 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30932 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30933 (gdb)
30934 @end smallexample
30935
30936 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30937 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30938
30939 @smallexample
30940 (gdb)
30941 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30942 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30943 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30944 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30945 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30946 (gdb)
30947 @end smallexample
30948
30949 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30950 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30951 used as the non-printable character.
30952
30953 @smallexample
30954 (gdb)
30955 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30956 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30957 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30958 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30959 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30960 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30961 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30962 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30963 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30964 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30965 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30966 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30967 (gdb)
30968 @end smallexample
30969
30970 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30971 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30972
30973 @subsubheading Synopsis
30974
30975 @smallexample
30976 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30977 @var{address} @var{count}
30978 @end smallexample
30979
30980 @noindent
30981 where:
30982
30983 @table @samp
30984 @item @var{address}
30985 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30986 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30987 quoted using the C convention.
30988
30989 @item @var{count}
30990 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30991 literal.
30992
30993 @item @var{offset}
30994 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30995 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30996 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30997 arithmetics itself.
30998
30999 @end table
31000
31001 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31002 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31003 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31004 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31005 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31006 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31007
31008 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31009 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31010 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31011 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31012 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31013 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31014 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31015 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31016
31017 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31018 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31019 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31020 and has the following fields:
31021
31022 @table @code
31023 @item begin
31024 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31025
31026 @item end
31027 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31028
31029 @item offset
31030 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31031 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31032
31033 @item contents
31034 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31035
31036 @end table
31037
31038
31039
31040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31041
31042 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31043
31044 @subsubheading Example
31045
31046 @smallexample
31047 (gdb)
31048 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31049 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31050 end="0xbffff15e",
31051 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31052 (gdb)
31053 @end smallexample
31054
31055
31056 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31057 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31058
31059 @subsubheading Synopsis
31060
31061 @smallexample
31062 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31063 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31064 @end smallexample
31065
31066 @noindent
31067 where:
31068
31069 @table @samp
31070 @item @var{address}
31071 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31072 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31073 be quoted using the C convention.
31074
31075 @item @var{contents}
31076 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31077 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31078
31079 @item @var{count}
31080 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31081 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31082 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31083 @var{count} memory units.
31084
31085 @end table
31086
31087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31088
31089 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31090
31091 @subsubheading Example
31092
31093 @smallexample
31094 (gdb)
31095 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31096 ^done
31097 (gdb)
31098 @end smallexample
31099
31100 @smallexample
31101 (gdb)
31102 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31103 ^done
31104 (gdb)
31105 @end smallexample
31106
31107 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31108 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31109 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31110
31111 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31112 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31113
31114 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31115 @findex -trace-find
31116
31117 @subsubheading Synopsis
31118
31119 @smallexample
31120 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31121 @end smallexample
31122
31123 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31124 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31125 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31126
31127 @table @samp
31128
31129 @item none
31130 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31131
31132 @item frame-number
31133 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31134 that index.
31135
31136 @item tracepoint-number
31137 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31138 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31139
31140 @item pc
31141 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31142 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31143 address.
31144
31145 @item pc-inside-range
31146 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31147 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31148 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31149
31150 @item pc-outside-range
31151 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31152 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31153 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31154
31155 @item line
31156 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31157 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31158 the specified location.
31159
31160 @end table
31161
31162 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31163 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31164
31165 @table @samp
31166 @item found
31167 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31168 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31169
31170 @item traceframe
31171 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31172 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31173
31174 @item tracepoint
31175 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31176 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31177
31178 @item frame
31179 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31180 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31181 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31182
31183 @end table
31184
31185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31186
31187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31188
31189 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31190 @findex -trace-define-variable
31191
31192 @subsubheading Synopsis
31193
31194 @smallexample
31195 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31196 @end smallexample
31197
31198 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31199 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31200 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31201 with the @samp{$} character.
31202
31203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31204
31205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31206
31207 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31208 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31209
31210 @subsubheading Synopsis
31211
31212 @smallexample
31213 -trace-frame-collected
31214 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31215 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31216 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31217 [--memory-contents]
31218 @end smallexample
31219
31220 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31221 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31222 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31223 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31224 See the output description table below for more details.
31225
31226 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31227 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31228 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31229 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31230 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31231
31232 For instance, if the actions were
31233 @smallexample
31234 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31235 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31236 @end smallexample
31237
31238 @noindent
31239 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31240 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31241 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31242 objects would be computed expressions.
31243
31244 An example output would be:
31245
31246 @smallexample
31247 (gdb)
31248 -trace-frame-collected
31249 ^done,
31250 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31251 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31252 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31253 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31254 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31255 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31256 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31257 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31258 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31259 ...
31260 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31261 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31262 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31263 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31264 (gdb)
31265 @end smallexample
31266
31267 Where:
31268
31269 @table @code
31270 @item explicit-variables
31271 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31272 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31273 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31274 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31275 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31276 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31277 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31278 arrays, structures and unions.
31279
31280 @item computed-expressions
31281 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31282 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31283 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31284 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31285
31286 @item registers
31287 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31288 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31289 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31290 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31291 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31292
31293 @item tvars
31294 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31295 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31296 current value are returned.
31297
31298 @item memory
31299 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31300 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31301 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31302
31303 @table @code
31304 @item address
31305 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31306
31307 @item length
31308 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31309
31310 @item contents
31311 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31312 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31313
31314 @end table
31315
31316 @end table
31317
31318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31319
31320 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31321
31322 @subsubheading Example
31323
31324 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31325 @findex -trace-list-variables
31326
31327 @subsubheading Synopsis
31328
31329 @smallexample
31330 -trace-list-variables
31331 @end smallexample
31332
31333 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31334 table has the following fields:
31335
31336 @table @samp
31337 @item name
31338 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31339
31340 @item initial
31341 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31342 field is always present.
31343
31344 @item current
31345 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31346 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31347 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31348 presently running.
31349
31350 @end table
31351
31352 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31353
31354 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31355
31356 @subsubheading Example
31357
31358 @smallexample
31359 (gdb)
31360 -trace-list-variables
31361 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31362 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31363 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31364 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31365 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31366 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31367 (gdb)
31368 @end smallexample
31369
31370 @subheading -trace-save
31371 @findex -trace-save
31372
31373 @subsubheading Synopsis
31374
31375 @smallexample
31376 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31377 @end smallexample
31378
31379 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31380 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31381 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31382 to perform the save.
31383
31384 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31385 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31386 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31387
31388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31389
31390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31391
31392
31393 @subheading -trace-start
31394 @findex -trace-start
31395
31396 @subsubheading Synopsis
31397
31398 @smallexample
31399 -trace-start
31400 @end smallexample
31401
31402 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31403 have any fields.
31404
31405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31406
31407 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31408
31409 @subheading -trace-status
31410 @findex -trace-status
31411
31412 @subsubheading Synopsis
31413
31414 @smallexample
31415 -trace-status
31416 @end smallexample
31417
31418 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31419 the following fields:
31420
31421 @table @samp
31422
31423 @item supported
31424 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31425 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31426 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31427 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31428 started. This field is always present.
31429
31430 @item running
31431 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31432 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31433 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31434
31435 @item stop-reason
31436 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31437 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31438 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31439 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31440 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31441 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31442 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31443 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31444 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31445
31446 @item stopping-tracepoint
31447 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31448 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31449 @samp{passcount}.
31450
31451 @item frames
31452 @itemx frames-created
31453 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31454 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31455 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31456 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31457
31458 @item buffer-size
31459 @itemx buffer-free
31460 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31461 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31462
31463 @item circular
31464 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31465 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31466 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31467 and may fill up.
31468
31469 @item disconnected
31470 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31471 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31472 that the trace run will stop.
31473
31474 @item trace-file
31475 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31476 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31477
31478 @end table
31479
31480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31481
31482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31483
31484 @subheading -trace-stop
31485 @findex -trace-stop
31486
31487 @subsubheading Synopsis
31488
31489 @smallexample
31490 -trace-stop
31491 @end smallexample
31492
31493 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31494 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31495 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31496
31497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31498
31499 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31500
31501
31502 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31503 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31504 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31505
31506
31507 @ignore
31508 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31509 @findex -symbol-info-address
31510
31511 @subsubheading Synopsis
31512
31513 @smallexample
31514 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31515 @end smallexample
31516
31517 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31518
31519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31520
31521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31522
31523 @subsubheading Example
31524 N.A.
31525
31526
31527 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31528 @findex -symbol-info-file
31529
31530 @subsubheading Synopsis
31531
31532 @smallexample
31533 -symbol-info-file
31534 @end smallexample
31535
31536 Show the file for the symbol.
31537
31538 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31539
31540 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31541 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31542
31543 @subsubheading Example
31544 N.A.
31545
31546
31547 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31548 @findex -symbol-info-function
31549
31550 @subsubheading Synopsis
31551
31552 @smallexample
31553 -symbol-info-function
31554 @end smallexample
31555
31556 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31557
31558 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31559
31560 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31561
31562 @subsubheading Example
31563 N.A.
31564
31565
31566 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31567 @findex -symbol-info-line
31568
31569 @subsubheading Synopsis
31570
31571 @smallexample
31572 -symbol-info-line
31573 @end smallexample
31574
31575 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31576
31577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31578
31579 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31580 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31581
31582 @subsubheading Example
31583 N.A.
31584
31585
31586 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31587 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31588
31589 @subsubheading Synopsis
31590
31591 @smallexample
31592 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31593 @end smallexample
31594
31595 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31596
31597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31598
31599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31600
31601 @subsubheading Example
31602 N.A.
31603
31604
31605 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31606 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31607
31608 @subsubheading Synopsis
31609
31610 @smallexample
31611 -symbol-list-functions
31612 @end smallexample
31613
31614 List the functions in the executable.
31615
31616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31617
31618 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31619 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31620
31621 @subsubheading Example
31622 N.A.
31623 @end ignore
31624
31625
31626 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31627 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31628
31629 @subsubheading Synopsis
31630
31631 @smallexample
31632 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31633 @end smallexample
31634
31635 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31636 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31637 ascending PC order.
31638
31639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31640
31641 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31642
31643 @subsubheading Example
31644 @smallexample
31645 (gdb)
31646 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31647 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31648 (gdb)
31649 @end smallexample
31650
31651
31652 @ignore
31653 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31654 @findex -symbol-list-types
31655
31656 @subsubheading Synopsis
31657
31658 @smallexample
31659 -symbol-list-types
31660 @end smallexample
31661
31662 List all the type names.
31663
31664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31665
31666 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31667 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31668
31669 @subsubheading Example
31670 N.A.
31671
31672
31673 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31674 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31675
31676 @subsubheading Synopsis
31677
31678 @smallexample
31679 -symbol-list-variables
31680 @end smallexample
31681
31682 List all the global and static variable names.
31683
31684 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31685
31686 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31687
31688 @subsubheading Example
31689 N.A.
31690
31691
31692 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31693 @findex -symbol-locate
31694
31695 @subsubheading Synopsis
31696
31697 @smallexample
31698 -symbol-locate
31699 @end smallexample
31700
31701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31702
31703 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31704
31705 @subsubheading Example
31706 N.A.
31707
31708
31709 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31710 @findex -symbol-type
31711
31712 @subsubheading Synopsis
31713
31714 @smallexample
31715 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31716 @end smallexample
31717
31718 Show type of @var{variable}.
31719
31720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31721
31722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31723 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31724
31725 @subsubheading Example
31726 N.A.
31727 @end ignore
31728
31729
31730 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31731 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31732 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31733
31734 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31735 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31736
31737 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31738 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31739
31740 @subsubheading Synopsis
31741
31742 @smallexample
31743 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31744 @end smallexample
31745
31746 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31747 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31748 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31749 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31750 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31751 notification.
31752
31753 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31754
31755 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31756
31757 @subsubheading Example
31758
31759 @smallexample
31760 (gdb)
31761 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31762 ^done
31763 (gdb)
31764 @end smallexample
31765
31766
31767 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31768 @findex -file-exec-file
31769
31770 @subsubheading Synopsis
31771
31772 @smallexample
31773 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31774 @end smallexample
31775
31776 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31777 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31778 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31779 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31780 notification.
31781
31782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31783
31784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31785
31786 @subsubheading Example
31787
31788 @smallexample
31789 (gdb)
31790 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31791 ^done
31792 (gdb)
31793 @end smallexample
31794
31795
31796 @ignore
31797 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31798 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31799
31800 @subsubheading Synopsis
31801
31802 @smallexample
31803 -file-list-exec-sections
31804 @end smallexample
31805
31806 List the sections of the current executable file.
31807
31808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31809
31810 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31811 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31812 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31813
31814 @subsubheading Example
31815 N.A.
31816 @end ignore
31817
31818
31819 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31820 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31821
31822 @subsubheading Synopsis
31823
31824 @smallexample
31825 -file-list-exec-source-file
31826 @end smallexample
31827
31828 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31829 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31830 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31831 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31832
31833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31834
31835 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31836
31837 @subsubheading Example
31838
31839 @smallexample
31840 (gdb)
31841 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31842 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31843 (gdb)
31844 @end smallexample
31845
31846
31847 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31848 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31849
31850 @subsubheading Synopsis
31851
31852 @smallexample
31853 -file-list-exec-source-files
31854 @end smallexample
31855
31856 List the source files for the current executable.
31857
31858 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31859 name) of a source file.
31860
31861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31862
31863 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31864 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31865
31866 @subsubheading Example
31867 @smallexample
31868 (gdb)
31869 -file-list-exec-source-files
31870 ^done,files=[
31871 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31872 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31873 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31874 (gdb)
31875 @end smallexample
31876
31877 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31878 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31879
31880 @subsubheading Synopsis
31881
31882 @smallexample
31883 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31884 @end smallexample
31885
31886 List the shared libraries in the program.
31887 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31888 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31889
31890 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31891
31892 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31893 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31894 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31895 library. Each range has the following fields:
31896
31897 @table @samp
31898 @item from
31899 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31900 @item to
31901 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31902 @end table
31903
31904 @subsubheading Example
31905 @smallexample
31906 (gdb)
31907 -file-list-exec-source-files
31908 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31909 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31910 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31911 (gdb)
31912 @end smallexample
31913
31914
31915 @ignore
31916 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31917 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31918
31919 @subsubheading Synopsis
31920
31921 @smallexample
31922 -file-list-symbol-files
31923 @end smallexample
31924
31925 List symbol files.
31926
31927 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31928
31929 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31930
31931 @subsubheading Example
31932 N.A.
31933 @end ignore
31934
31935
31936 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31937 @findex -file-symbol-file
31938
31939 @subsubheading Synopsis
31940
31941 @smallexample
31942 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31943 @end smallexample
31944
31945 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31946 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31947 produced, except for a completion notification.
31948
31949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31950
31951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31952
31953 @subsubheading Example
31954
31955 @smallexample
31956 (gdb)
31957 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31958 ^done
31959 (gdb)
31960 @end smallexample
31961
31962 @ignore
31963 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31964 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31965 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31966
31967 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31968
31969 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31970
31971 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31972
31973 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31974
31975 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31976
31977 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31978
31979 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31980
31981 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31982
31983 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31984 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31985 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31986
31987 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31988
31989 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31990
31991 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31992
31993 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31994 @end ignore
31995
31996
31997 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31998 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31999 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32000
32001
32002 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32003 @findex -target-attach
32004
32005 @subsubheading Synopsis
32006
32007 @smallexample
32008 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32009 @end smallexample
32010
32011 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32012 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32013 group, the id previously returned by
32014 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32015
32016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32017
32018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32019
32020 @subsubheading Example
32021 @smallexample
32022 (gdb)
32023 -target-attach 34
32024 =thread-created,id="1"
32025 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32026 ^done
32027 (gdb)
32028 @end smallexample
32029
32030 @ignore
32031 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32032 @findex -target-compare-sections
32033
32034 @subsubheading Synopsis
32035
32036 @smallexample
32037 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32038 @end smallexample
32039
32040 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32041 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32042
32043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32044
32045 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32046
32047 @subsubheading Example
32048 N.A.
32049 @end ignore
32050
32051
32052 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32053 @findex -target-detach
32054
32055 @subsubheading Synopsis
32056
32057 @smallexample
32058 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32059 @end smallexample
32060
32061 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32062 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32063 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32064
32065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32066
32067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32068
32069 @subsubheading Example
32070
32071 @smallexample
32072 (gdb)
32073 -target-detach
32074 ^done
32075 (gdb)
32076 @end smallexample
32077
32078
32079 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32080 @findex -target-disconnect
32081
32082 @subsubheading Synopsis
32083
32084 @smallexample
32085 -target-disconnect
32086 @end smallexample
32087
32088 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32089 generally not resumed.
32090
32091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32092
32093 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32094
32095 @subsubheading Example
32096
32097 @smallexample
32098 (gdb)
32099 -target-disconnect
32100 ^done
32101 (gdb)
32102 @end smallexample
32103
32104
32105 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32106 @findex -target-download
32107
32108 @subsubheading Synopsis
32109
32110 @smallexample
32111 -target-download
32112 @end smallexample
32113
32114 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32115 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32116
32117 @table @samp
32118 @item section
32119 The name of the section.
32120 @item section-sent
32121 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32122 @item section-size
32123 The size of the section.
32124 @item total-sent
32125 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32126 @item total-size
32127 The size of the overall executable to download.
32128 @end table
32129
32130 @noindent
32131 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32132 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32133
32134 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32135 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32136
32137 @table @samp
32138 @item section
32139 The name of the section.
32140 @item section-size
32141 The size of the section.
32142 @item total-size
32143 The size of the overall executable to download.
32144 @end table
32145
32146 @noindent
32147 At the end, a summary is printed.
32148
32149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32150
32151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32152
32153 @subsubheading Example
32154
32155 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32156 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 (gdb)
32160 -target-download
32161 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32162 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32163 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32164 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32165 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32166 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32167 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32168 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32169 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32170 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32171 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32172 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32173 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32174 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32175 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32176 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32177 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32178 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32179 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32180 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32181 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32182 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32183 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32184 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32185 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32186 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32187 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32188 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32189 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32190 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32191 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32192 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32193 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32194 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32195 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32196 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32197 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32198 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32199 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32200 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32201 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32202 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32203 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32204 write-rate="429"
32205 (gdb)
32206 @end smallexample
32207
32208
32209 @ignore
32210 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32211 @findex -target-exec-status
32212
32213 @subsubheading Synopsis
32214
32215 @smallexample
32216 -target-exec-status
32217 @end smallexample
32218
32219 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32220 not, for instance).
32221
32222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32223
32224 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32225
32226 @subsubheading Example
32227 N.A.
32228
32229
32230 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32231 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32232
32233 @subsubheading Synopsis
32234
32235 @smallexample
32236 -target-list-available-targets
32237 @end smallexample
32238
32239 List the possible targets to connect to.
32240
32241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32242
32243 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32244
32245 @subsubheading Example
32246 N.A.
32247
32248
32249 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32250 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32251
32252 @subsubheading Synopsis
32253
32254 @smallexample
32255 -target-list-current-targets
32256 @end smallexample
32257
32258 Describe the current target.
32259
32260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32261
32262 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32263 other things).
32264
32265 @subsubheading Example
32266 N.A.
32267
32268
32269 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32270 @findex -target-list-parameters
32271
32272 @subsubheading Synopsis
32273
32274 @smallexample
32275 -target-list-parameters
32276 @end smallexample
32277
32278 @c ????
32279 @end ignore
32280
32281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32282
32283 No equivalent.
32284
32285 @subsubheading Example
32286 N.A.
32287
32288 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32289 @findex -target-flash-erase
32290
32291 @subsubheading Synopsis
32292
32293 @smallexample
32294 -target-flash-erase
32295 @end smallexample
32296
32297 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32298
32299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32300
32301 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32302 addresses and memory region sizes.
32303
32304 @smallexample
32305 (gdb)
32306 -target-flash-erase
32307 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32308 (gdb)
32309 @end smallexample
32310
32311 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32312 @findex -target-select
32313
32314 @subsubheading Synopsis
32315
32316 @smallexample
32317 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32318 @end smallexample
32319
32320 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32321
32322 @table @samp
32323 @item @var{type}
32324 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32325 @item @var{parameters}
32326 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32327 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32328 @end table
32329
32330 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32331 which the target program is, in the following form:
32332
32333 @smallexample
32334 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32335 args=[@var{arg list}]
32336 @end smallexample
32337
32338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32339
32340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32341
32342 @subsubheading Example
32343
32344 @smallexample
32345 (gdb)
32346 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32347 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32348 (gdb)
32349 @end smallexample
32350
32351 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32352 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32353 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32354
32355
32356 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32357 @findex -target-file-put
32358
32359 @subsubheading Synopsis
32360
32361 @smallexample
32362 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32363 @end smallexample
32364
32365 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32366 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32367
32368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32369
32370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32371
32372 @subsubheading Example
32373
32374 @smallexample
32375 (gdb)
32376 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32377 ^done
32378 (gdb)
32379 @end smallexample
32380
32381
32382 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32383 @findex -target-file-get
32384
32385 @subsubheading Synopsis
32386
32387 @smallexample
32388 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32389 @end smallexample
32390
32391 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32392 on the host system.
32393
32394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32395
32396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32397
32398 @subsubheading Example
32399
32400 @smallexample
32401 (gdb)
32402 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32403 ^done
32404 (gdb)
32405 @end smallexample
32406
32407
32408 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32409 @findex -target-file-delete
32410
32411 @subsubheading Synopsis
32412
32413 @smallexample
32414 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32415 @end smallexample
32416
32417 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32418
32419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32420
32421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32422
32423 @subsubheading Example
32424
32425 @smallexample
32426 (gdb)
32427 -target-file-delete remotefile
32428 ^done
32429 (gdb)
32430 @end smallexample
32431
32432
32433 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32434 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32435 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32436
32437 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32438 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32439
32440 @subsubheading Synopsis
32441
32442 @smallexample
32443 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32444 @end smallexample
32445
32446 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32447 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32448 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32449
32450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32451
32452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32453
32454 @subsubheading Result
32455
32456 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32457 defined for each exception:
32458
32459 @table @samp
32460 @item name
32461 The name of the exception.
32462
32463 @item address
32464 The address of the exception.
32465
32466 @end table
32467
32468 @subsubheading Example
32469
32470 @smallexample
32471 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32472 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32473 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32474 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32475 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32476 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32477 @end smallexample
32478
32479 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32480
32481 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32482 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32483 Catchpoint Commands}.
32484
32485
32486 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32487 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32488 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32489
32490 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32491 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32492 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32493 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32494
32495 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32496 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32497 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32498
32499 @subsubheading Synopsis
32500
32501 @smallexample
32502 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32503 @end smallexample
32504
32505 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32506
32507 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32508 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32509 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32510 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32511 dash.
32512
32513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32514
32515 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32516
32517 @subsubheading Result
32518
32519 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32520
32521 @table @samp
32522 @item exists
32523 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32524 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32525
32526 @end table
32527
32528 @subsubheading Example
32529
32530 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32531
32532 @smallexample
32533 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32534 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32535 @end smallexample
32536
32537 @noindent
32538 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32539 to the debugger:
32540
32541 @smallexample
32542 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32543 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32544 @end smallexample
32545
32546 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32547 @findex -list-features
32548 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32549
32550 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32551 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32552 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32553 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32554 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32555 startup.
32556
32557 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32558 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32559 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32560 is given below.
32561
32562 Example output:
32563
32564 @smallexample
32565 (gdb) -list-features
32566 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32567 @end smallexample
32568
32569 The current list of features is:
32570
32571 @ftable @samp
32572 @item frozen-varobjs
32573 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32574 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32575 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32576 @item pending-breakpoints
32577 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32578 command.
32579 @item python
32580 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32581 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32582 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32583 @item thread-info
32584 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32585 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32586 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32587 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32588 @item breakpoint-notifications
32589 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32590 CLI will be announced via async records.
32591 @item ada-task-info
32592 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32593 @item language-option
32594 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32595 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32596 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32597 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32598 @item undefined-command-error-code
32599 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32600 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32601 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32602 @item exec-run-start-option
32603 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32604 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32605 @end ftable
32606
32607 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32608 @findex -list-target-features
32609
32610 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32611 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32612 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32613 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32614 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32615 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32616 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32617 Example output:
32618
32619 @smallexample
32620 (gdb) -list-target-features
32621 ^done,result=["async"]
32622 @end smallexample
32623
32624 The current list of features is:
32625
32626 @table @samp
32627 @item async
32628 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32629 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32630 while the target is running.
32631
32632 @item reverse
32633 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32634 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32635
32636 @end table
32637
32638 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32639 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32640 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32641
32642 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32643
32644 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32645 @findex -gdb-exit
32646
32647 @subsubheading Synopsis
32648
32649 @smallexample
32650 -gdb-exit
32651 @end smallexample
32652
32653 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32654
32655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32656
32657 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32658
32659 @subsubheading Example
32660
32661 @smallexample
32662 (gdb)
32663 -gdb-exit
32664 ^exit
32665 @end smallexample
32666
32667
32668 @ignore
32669 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32670 @findex -exec-abort
32671
32672 @subsubheading Synopsis
32673
32674 @smallexample
32675 -exec-abort
32676 @end smallexample
32677
32678 Kill the inferior running program.
32679
32680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32681
32682 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32683
32684 @subsubheading Example
32685 N.A.
32686 @end ignore
32687
32688
32689 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32690 @findex -gdb-set
32691
32692 @subsubheading Synopsis
32693
32694 @smallexample
32695 -gdb-set
32696 @end smallexample
32697
32698 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32699 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32700
32701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32702
32703 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32704
32705 @subsubheading Example
32706
32707 @smallexample
32708 (gdb)
32709 -gdb-set $foo=3
32710 ^done
32711 (gdb)
32712 @end smallexample
32713
32714
32715 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32716 @findex -gdb-show
32717
32718 @subsubheading Synopsis
32719
32720 @smallexample
32721 -gdb-show
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32725
32726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32727
32728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32729
32730 @subsubheading Example
32731
32732 @smallexample
32733 (gdb)
32734 -gdb-show annotate
32735 ^done,value="0"
32736 (gdb)
32737 @end smallexample
32738
32739 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32740
32741
32742 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32743 @findex -gdb-version
32744
32745 @subsubheading Synopsis
32746
32747 @smallexample
32748 -gdb-version
32749 @end smallexample
32750
32751 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32752
32753 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32754
32755 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32756 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32757
32758 @subsubheading Example
32759
32760 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32761 @c box in TeX.
32762 @smallexample
32763 (gdb)
32764 -gdb-version
32765 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32766 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32767 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32768 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32769 ~ certain conditions.
32770 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32771 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32772 ~ details.
32773 ~This GDB was configured as
32774 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32775 ^done
32776 (gdb)
32777 @end smallexample
32778
32779 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32780 @findex -list-thread-groups
32781
32782 @subheading Synopsis
32783
32784 @smallexample
32785 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32786 @end smallexample
32787
32788 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32789 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32790 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32791 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32792 top-level thread groups.
32793
32794 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32795 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32796 available on the target.
32797
32798 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32799 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32800 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32801 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32802 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32803 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32804 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32805 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32806
32807 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32808 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32809 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32810 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32811 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32812 @samp{threads} field.
32813
32814 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32815 the following caveats:
32816
32817 @itemize @bullet
32818 @item
32819 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32820 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32821 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32822
32823 @item
32824 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32825 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32826 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32827 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32828 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32829 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32830
32831 @end itemize
32832
32833 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32834 have the following fields:
32835
32836 @table @code
32837 @item id
32838 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32839 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32840 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32841
32842 @item type
32843 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32844 valid type.
32845
32846 @item pid
32847 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32848 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32849
32850 @item exit-code
32851 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32852 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32853 only if the process is not running.
32854
32855 @item num_children
32856 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32857 absent for an available thread group.
32858
32859 @item threads
32860 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32861 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32862 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32863
32864 @item cores
32865 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32866 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32867 such information is not available.
32868
32869 @item executable
32870 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32871 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32872 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32873
32874 @end table
32875
32876 @subheading Example
32877
32878 @smallexample
32879 @value{GDBP}
32880 -list-thread-groups
32881 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32882 -list-thread-groups 17
32883 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32884 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32885 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32886 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32887 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32888 -list-thread-groups --available
32889 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32890 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32891 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32892 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32893 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32894 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32895 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32896 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32897 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32898 @end smallexample
32899
32900 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32901 @findex -info-os
32902
32903 @subsubheading Synopsis
32904
32905 @smallexample
32906 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32907 @end smallexample
32908
32909 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32910 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32911 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32912 of data of that type.
32913
32914 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32915 system.
32916
32917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32918
32919 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32920
32921 @subsubheading Example
32922
32923 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32924 like this:
32925
32926 @smallexample
32927 @value{GDBP}
32928 -info-os
32929 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32930 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32931 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32932 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32933 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32934 col2="CPUs"@},
32935 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32936 col2="File descriptors"@},
32937 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32938 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32939 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32940 col2="Message queues"@},
32941 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32942 col2="Processes"@},
32943 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32944 col2="Process groups"@},
32945 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32946 col2="Semaphores"@},
32947 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32948 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32949 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32950 col2="Sockets"@},
32951 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32952 col2="Threads"@}]
32953 @value{GDBP}
32954 -info-os processes
32955 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32956 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32957 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32958 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32959 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32960 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32961 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32962 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32963 ...
32964 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32965 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32966 (gdb)
32967 @end smallexample
32968
32969 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32970 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32971 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32972 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32973 @code{info os} omits it.)
32974
32975 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32976 @findex -add-inferior
32977
32978 @subheading Synopsis
32979
32980 @smallexample
32981 -add-inferior
32982 @end smallexample
32983
32984 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32985 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32986 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32987 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32988 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32989 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32990
32991 @subheading Example
32992
32993 @smallexample
32994 @value{GDBP}
32995 -add-inferior
32996 ^done,inferior="i3"
32997 @end smallexample
32998
32999 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33000 @findex -interpreter-exec
33001
33002 @subheading Synopsis
33003
33004 @smallexample
33005 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33006 @end smallexample
33007 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33008
33009 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33010
33011 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33012
33013 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33014
33015 @subheading Example
33016
33017 @smallexample
33018 (gdb)
33019 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33020 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33021 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33022 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33023 ^done
33024 (gdb)
33025 @end smallexample
33026
33027 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33028 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33029
33030 @subheading Synopsis
33031
33032 @smallexample
33033 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33034 @end smallexample
33035
33036 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33037
33038 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33039
33040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33041
33042 @subheading Example
33043
33044 @smallexample
33045 (gdb)
33046 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33047 ^done
33048 (gdb)
33049 @end smallexample
33050
33051 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33052 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33053
33054 @subheading Synopsis
33055
33056 @smallexample
33057 -inferior-tty-show
33058 @end smallexample
33059
33060 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33061
33062 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33063
33064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33065
33066 @subheading Example
33067
33068 @smallexample
33069 (gdb)
33070 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33071 ^done
33072 (gdb)
33073 -inferior-tty-show
33074 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33075 (gdb)
33076 @end smallexample
33077
33078 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33079 @findex -enable-timings
33080
33081 @subheading Synopsis
33082
33083 @smallexample
33084 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33085 @end smallexample
33086
33087 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33088 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33089 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33090 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33091
33092 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33093
33094 No equivalent.
33095
33096 @subheading Example
33097
33098 @smallexample
33099 (gdb)
33100 -enable-timings
33101 ^done
33102 (gdb)
33103 -break-insert main
33104 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33105 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33106 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33107 times="0"@},
33108 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33109 (gdb)
33110 -enable-timings no
33111 ^done
33112 (gdb)
33113 -exec-run
33114 ^running
33115 (gdb)
33116 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33117 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33118 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33119 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33120 (gdb)
33121 @end smallexample
33122
33123 @node Annotations
33124 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33125
33126 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33127 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33128 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33129 relatively high level.
33130
33131 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33132 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33133
33134 @ignore
33135 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33136 @end ignore
33137
33138 @menu
33139 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33140 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33141 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33142 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33143 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33144 * Annotations for Running::
33145 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33146 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33147 @end menu
33148
33149 @node Annotations Overview
33150 @section What is an Annotation?
33151 @cindex annotations
33152
33153 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33154 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33155 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33156 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33157 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33158 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33159 cannot contain newline characters.
33160
33161 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33162 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33163 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33164 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33165 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33166 means those three characters as output.
33167
33168 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33169 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33170 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33171 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33172 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33173 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33174 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33175 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33176 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33177
33178 @table @code
33179 @kindex set annotate
33180 @item set annotate @var{level}
33181 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33182 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33183
33184 @item show annotate
33185 @kindex show annotate
33186 Show the current annotation level.
33187 @end table
33188
33189 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33190
33191 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33192
33193 @smallexample
33194 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33195 GNU gdb 6.0
33196 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33197 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33198 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33199 under certain conditions.
33200 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33201 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33202 for details.
33203 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33204
33205 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33206 (@value{GDBP})
33207 ^Z^Zprompt
33208 @kbd{quit}
33209
33210 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33211 $
33212 @end smallexample
33213
33214 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33215 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33216 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33217 output from @value{GDBN}.
33218
33219 @node Server Prefix
33220 @section The Server Prefix
33221 @cindex server prefix
33222
33223 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33224 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33225 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33226 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33227 a transparent manner.
33228
33229 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33230 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33231 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33232 @code{print} command.
33233
33234 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33235 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33236
33237 @node Prompting
33238 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33239
33240 @cindex annotations for prompts
33241 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33242 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33243 over, etc.
33244
33245 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33246 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33247 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33248 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33249 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33250 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33251 features the following annotations:
33252
33253 @smallexample
33254 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33255 ^Z^Zprompt
33256 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33257 @end smallexample
33258
33259 The input types are
33260
33261 @table @code
33262 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33263 @findex prompt annotation
33264 @findex post-prompt annotation
33265 @item prompt
33266 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33267
33268 @findex pre-commands annotation
33269 @findex commands annotation
33270 @findex post-commands annotation
33271 @item commands
33272 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33273 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33274
33275 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33276 @findex overload-choice annotation
33277 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33278 @item overload-choice
33279 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33280
33281 @findex pre-query annotation
33282 @findex query annotation
33283 @findex post-query annotation
33284 @item query
33285 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33286
33287 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33288 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33289 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33290 @item prompt-for-continue
33291 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33292 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33293 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33294 presence of annotations.
33295 @end table
33296
33297 @node Errors
33298 @section Errors
33299 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33300
33301 @findex quit annotation
33302 @smallexample
33303 ^Z^Zquit
33304 @end smallexample
33305
33306 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33307
33308 @findex error annotation
33309 @smallexample
33310 ^Z^Zerror
33311 @end smallexample
33312
33313 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33314
33315 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33316 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33317 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33318 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33319 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33320 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33321 to the top level.
33322
33323 @findex error-begin annotation
33324 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33325
33326 @smallexample
33327 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33328 @end smallexample
33329
33330 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33331 message.
33332
33333 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33334 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33335 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33336
33337 @node Invalidation
33338 @section Invalidation Notices
33339
33340 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33341 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33342 changed.
33343
33344 @table @code
33345 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33346 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33347
33348 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33349 have changed.
33350
33351 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33352 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33353
33354 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33355 deleted a breakpoint.
33356 @end table
33357
33358 @node Annotations for Running
33359 @section Running the Program
33360 @cindex annotations for running programs
33361
33362 @findex starting annotation
33363 @findex stopping annotation
33364 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33365 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33366
33367 @smallexample
33368 ^Z^Zstarting
33369 @end smallexample
33370
33371 is output. When the program stops,
33372
33373 @smallexample
33374 ^Z^Zstopped
33375 @end smallexample
33376
33377 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33378 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33379
33380 @table @code
33381 @findex exited annotation
33382 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33383 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33384 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33385
33386 @findex signalled annotation
33387 @findex signal-name annotation
33388 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33389 @findex signal-string annotation
33390 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33391 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33392 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33393 annotation continues:
33394
33395 @smallexample
33396 @var{intro-text}
33397 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33398 @var{name}
33399 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33400 @var{middle-text}
33401 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33402 @var{string}
33403 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33404 @var{end-text}
33405 @end smallexample
33406
33407 @noindent
33408 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33409 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33410 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33411 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33412 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33413
33414 @findex signal annotation
33415 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33416 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33417 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33418 terminated with it.
33419
33420 @findex breakpoint annotation
33421 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33422 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33423
33424 @findex watchpoint annotation
33425 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33426 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33427 @end table
33428
33429 @node Source Annotations
33430 @section Displaying Source
33431 @cindex annotations for source display
33432
33433 @findex source annotation
33434 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33435
33436 @smallexample
33437 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33438 @end smallexample
33439
33440 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33441 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33442 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33443 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33444 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33445 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33446 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33447 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33448 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33449 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33450 depend on the language).
33451
33452 @node JIT Interface
33453 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33454 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33455 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33456
33457 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33458 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33459 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33460 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33461
33462 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33463 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33464 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33465 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33466 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33467 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33468
33469 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33470 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33471 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33472 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33473 LLVM JIT.
33474
33475 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33476 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33477 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33478 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33479 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33480 out about additional code.
33481
33482 @menu
33483 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33484 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33485 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33486 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33487 @end menu
33488
33489 @node Declarations
33490 @section JIT Declarations
33491
33492 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33493 implement the interface:
33494
33495 @smallexample
33496 typedef enum
33497 @{
33498 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33499 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33500 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33501 @} jit_actions_t;
33502
33503 struct jit_code_entry
33504 @{
33505 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33506 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33507 const char *symfile_addr;
33508 uint64_t symfile_size;
33509 @};
33510
33511 struct jit_descriptor
33512 @{
33513 uint32_t version;
33514 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33515 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33516 uint32_t action_flag;
33517 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33518 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33519 @};
33520
33521 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33522 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33523
33524 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33525 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33526 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33527 @end smallexample
33528
33529 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33530 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33531 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33532
33533 @node Registering Code
33534 @section Registering Code
33535
33536 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33537
33538 @itemize @bullet
33539 @item
33540 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33541 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33542
33543 @item
33544 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33545 file.
33546
33547 @item
33548 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33549
33550 @item
33551 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33552
33553 @item
33554 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33555 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33556 @end itemize
33557
33558 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33559 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33560 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33561 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33562
33563 @node Unregistering Code
33564 @section Unregistering Code
33565
33566 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33567
33568 @itemize @bullet
33569 @item
33570 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33571
33572 @item
33573 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33574
33575 @item
33576 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33577 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33578 @end itemize
33579
33580 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33581 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33582
33583 @node Custom Debug Info
33584 @section Custom Debug Info
33585 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33586 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33587
33588 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33589 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33590 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33591 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33592 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33593 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33594 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33595 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33596 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33597
33598 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33599 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33600 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33601 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33602 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33603 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33604 compiler.
33605
33606 @menu
33607 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33608 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33609 @end menu
33610
33611 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33612 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33613 @kindex jit-reader-load
33614 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33615
33616 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33617 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33618
33619 @table @code
33620 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33621 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33622 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33623 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33624 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33625 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33626 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33627
33628 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33629 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33630 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33631 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33632 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33633
33634 @item jit-reader-unload
33635 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33636
33637 @end table
33638
33639 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33640 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33641 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33642
33643 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33644 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33645
33646 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33647 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33648 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33649 the system include directory.
33650
33651 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33652 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33653 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33654
33655 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33656 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33657
33658 @findex gdb_init_reader
33659 @smallexample
33660 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33661 @end smallexample
33662
33663 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33664
33665 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33666 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33667 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33668 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33669 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33670 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33671
33672 @smallexample
33673 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33674 @{
33675 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33676 int reader_version;
33677
33678 /* For use by the reader. */
33679 void *priv_data;
33680
33681 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33682 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33683 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33684 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33685 @};
33686 @end smallexample
33687
33688 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33689 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33690
33691 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33692 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33693 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33694 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33695 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33696 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33697 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33698 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33699 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33700 target's address space.
33701
33702 @node In-Process Agent
33703 @chapter In-Process Agent
33704 @cindex debugging agent
33705 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33706 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33707 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33708 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33709 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33710 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33711 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33712 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33713 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33714 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33715 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33716 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33717 behavior without interrupting it.
33718
33719 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33720 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33721 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33722 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33723 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33724 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33725 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33726 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33727 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33728
33729 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33730 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33731 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33732 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33733
33734 @anchor{Control Agent}
33735 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33736 debugging with the following commands:
33737
33738 @table @code
33739 @kindex set agent on
33740 @item set agent on
33741 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33742 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33743 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33744 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33745 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33746 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33747
33748 @kindex set agent off
33749 @item set agent off
33750 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33751 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33752
33753 @kindex show agent
33754 @item show agent
33755 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33756 the in-process agent.
33757 @end table
33758
33759 @menu
33760 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33761 @end menu
33762
33763 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33764 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33765 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33766
33767 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33768 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33769 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33770 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33771 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33772 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33773 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33774 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33775 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33776
33777 @menu
33778 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33779 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33780 @end menu
33781
33782 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33783 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33784 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33785
33786 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33787 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33788
33789 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33790 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33791 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33792 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33793
33794 @enumerate
33795 @item
33796 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33797 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33798 @item
33799 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33800 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33801 the other one.
33802 @end enumerate
33803
33804 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33805
33806 @enumerate
33807 @item
33808 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33809 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33810 @anchor{agent expression object}
33811 @item
33812 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33813 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33814 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33815 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33816 @item
33817 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33818 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33819
33820 @end enumerate
33821
33822 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33823 object:
33824
33825 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33826 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33827 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33828 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33829 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33830 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33831 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33832 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33833 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33834 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33835 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33836 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33837 memory address for collecting.
33838 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33839 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33840 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33841 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33842 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33843 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33844 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33845 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33846 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33847 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33848 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33849 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33850 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33851 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33852 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33853 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33854 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33855 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33856 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33857 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33858 @ref{agent expression object}
33859 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33860 @ref{agent expression object}
33861 @item actions @tab variable
33862 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33863 @end multitable
33864
33865 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33866 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33867 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33868
33869 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33870 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33871
33872 @table @samp
33873
33874 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33875 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33876 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33877 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33878 in IPA finally.
33879
33880 Replies:
33881 @table @samp
33882 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33883 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33884 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33885 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33886 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33887 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33888 @item E @var{NN}
33889 for an error
33890
33891 @end table
33892
33893 @item close
33894 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33895 is about to kill inferiors.
33896
33897 @item qTfSTM
33898 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33899 @item qTsSTM
33900 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33901 @item qTSTMat
33902 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33903 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33904 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33905
33906 Replies:
33907 @table @samp
33908 @item E @var{NN}
33909 for an error
33910 @end table
33911 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33912 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33913 @end table
33914
33915 @node GDB Bugs
33916 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33917 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33918 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33919
33920 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33921
33922 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33923 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33924 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33925 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33926
33927 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33928 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33929
33930 @menu
33931 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33932 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33933 @end menu
33934
33935 @node Bug Criteria
33936 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33937 @cindex bug criteria
33938
33939 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33940
33941 @itemize @bullet
33942 @cindex fatal signal
33943 @cindex debugger crash
33944 @cindex crash of debugger
33945 @item
33946 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33947 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33948
33949 @cindex error on valid input
33950 @item
33951 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33952 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33953 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33954
33955 @cindex invalid input
33956 @item
33957 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33958 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33959 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33960 for traditional practice''.
33961
33962 @item
33963 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33964 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33965 @end itemize
33966
33967 @node Bug Reporting
33968 @section How to Report Bugs
33969 @cindex bug reports
33970 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33971
33972 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33973 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33974 contact that organization first.
33975
33976 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33977 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33978 distribution.
33979 @c should add a web page ref...
33980
33981 @ifset BUGURL
33982 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33983 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33984 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33985 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33986 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33987 be used.
33988
33989 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33990 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33991 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33992 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33993
33994 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33995 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33996 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33997 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33998 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33999 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34000 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34001 bug reports to the mailing list.
34002 @end ifset
34003 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34004 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34005 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34006 @end ifclear
34007 @end ifset
34008
34009 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34010 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34011 fact or leave it out, state it!
34012
34013 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34014 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34015 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34016 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34017 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34018 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34019 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34020 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34021 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34022
34023 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34024 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34025 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34026 self-contained.
34027
34028 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34029 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34030 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34031 bugs properly.
34032
34033 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34034
34035 @itemize @bullet
34036 @item
34037 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34038 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34039 version}.
34040
34041 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34042 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34043
34044 @item
34045 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34046 version number.
34047
34048 @item
34049 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34050 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34051 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34052 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34053
34054 @item
34055 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34056 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34057
34058 @item
34059 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34060 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34061 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34062 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34063 those compilers.
34064
34065 @item
34066 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34067 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34068 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34069 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34070
34071 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34072 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34073
34074 @item
34075 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34076 reproduce the bug.
34077
34078 @item
34079 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34080 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34081
34082 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34083 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34084 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34085 a chance to make a mistake.
34086
34087 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34088 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34089 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34090 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34091 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34092 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34093 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34094 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34095
34096 @pindex script
34097 @cindex recording a session script
34098 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34099 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34100 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34101 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34102
34103 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34104 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34105
34106 @item
34107 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34108 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34109 it by context, not by line number.
34110
34111 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34112 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34113
34114 @end itemize
34115
34116 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34117
34118 @itemize @bullet
34119 @item
34120 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34121
34122 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34123 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34124 changes will not affect it.
34125
34126 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34127 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34128 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34129 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34130
34131 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34132 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34133 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34134 less time, and so on.
34135
34136 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34137 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34138
34139 @item
34140 A patch for the bug.
34141
34142 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34143 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34144 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34145 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34146
34147 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34148 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34149 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34150 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34151
34152 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34153 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34154 help us to understand.
34155
34156 @item
34157 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34158
34159 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34160 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34161 @end itemize
34162
34163 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34164 @c and consists of the two following files:
34165 @c rluser.texi
34166 @c hsuser.texi
34167 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34168 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34169 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34170 @include rluser.texi
34171 @include hsuser.texi
34172 @end ifclear
34173
34174 @node In Memoriam
34175 @appendix In Memoriam
34176
34177 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34178 contributors:
34179
34180 @table @code
34181 @item Fred Fish
34182 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34183 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34184 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34185
34186 @item Michael Snyder
34187 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34188 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34189 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34190 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34191 @end table
34192
34193 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34194 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34195
34196 @node Formatting Documentation
34197 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34198
34199 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34200 @cindex reference card
34201 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34202 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34203 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34204 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34205 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34206 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34207
34208 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34209 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34210
34211 @smallexample
34212 make refcard.dvi
34213 @end smallexample
34214
34215 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34216 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34217 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34218 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34219 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34220
34221 @cindex documentation
34222
34223 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34224 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34225 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34226 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34227 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34228 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34229
34230 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34231 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34232 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34233 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34234 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34235 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34236 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34237 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34238
34239 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34240 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34241 @code{makeinfo}.
34242
34243 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34244 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34245 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34246
34247 @smallexample
34248 cd gdb
34249 make gdb.info
34250 @end smallexample
34251
34252 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34253 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34254 Texinfo definitions file.
34255
34256 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34257 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34258 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34259 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34260 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34261 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34262 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34263
34264 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34265 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34266 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34267 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34268 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34269 directory.
34270
34271 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34272 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34273 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34274 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34275
34276 @smallexample
34277 make gdb.dvi
34278 @end smallexample
34279
34280 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34281
34282 @node Installing GDB
34283 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34284 @cindex installation
34285
34286 @menu
34287 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34288 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34289 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34290 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34291 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34292 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34293 @end menu
34294
34295 @node Requirements
34296 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34297 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34298
34299 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34300 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34301
34302 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34303 @table @asis
34304 @item ISO C90 compiler
34305 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34306 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34307
34308 @end table
34309
34310 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34311 @table @asis
34312 @item Expat
34313 @anchor{Expat}
34314 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34315 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34316 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34317 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34318 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34319 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34320
34321 Expat is used for:
34322
34323 @itemize @bullet
34324 @item
34325 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34326 @item
34327 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34328 @item
34329 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34330 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34331 @item
34332 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34333 @item
34334 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34335 @item
34336 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34337 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34338 @end itemize
34339
34340 @item MPFR
34341 @anchor{MPFR}
34342 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
34343 library. This library may be included with your operating system
34344 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34345 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
34346 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
34347 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
34348 option to specify its location.
34349
34350 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
34351 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
34352 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
34353 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
34354
34355 @item zlib
34356 @cindex compressed debug sections
34357 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34358 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34359 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34360 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34361 information in such binaries.
34362
34363 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34364 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34365 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34366
34367 @item iconv
34368 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34369 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34370 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34371 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34372
34373 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34374 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34375 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34376 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34377
34378 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34379 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34380 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34381
34382 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34383 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34384 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34385 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34386 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34387 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34388 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34389 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34390 @end table
34391
34392 @node Running Configure
34393 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34394 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34395 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34396 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34397 build the @code{gdb} program.
34398 @iftex
34399 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34400 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34401 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34402 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34403 @end iftex
34404
34405 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34406 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34407 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34408
34409 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34410 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34411
34412 @table @code
34413 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34414 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34415
34416 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34417 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34418
34419 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34420 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34421
34422 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34423 @sc{gnu} include files
34424
34425 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34426 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34427
34428 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34429 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34430
34431 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34432 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34433
34434 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34435 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34436
34437 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34438 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34439 @end table
34440
34441 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34442 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34443 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34444
34445 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34446 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34447 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34448 argument.
34449
34450 For example:
34451
34452 @smallexample
34453 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34454 ./configure @var{host}
34455 make
34456 @end smallexample
34457
34458 @noindent
34459 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34460 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34461 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34462 correct value by examining your system.)
34463
34464 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34465 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34466 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34467 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34468
34469 @need 750
34470 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34471 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34472 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34473
34474 @smallexample
34475 sh configure @var{host}
34476 @end smallexample
34477
34478 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34479 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34480 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34481 @file{configure}
34482 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34483 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34484
34485 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34486 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34487 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34488 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34489 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34490 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34491 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34492 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34493 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34494
34495 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34496 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34497 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34498 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34499 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34500
34501 @node Separate Objdir
34502 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34503
34504 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34505 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34506 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34507 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34508 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34509 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34510 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34511 program specified there.
34512
34513 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34514 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34515 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34516 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34517 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34518 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34519
34520 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34521 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34522
34523 @smallexample
34524 @group
34525 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34526 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34527 cd ../gdb-sun4
34528 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34529 make
34530 @end group
34531 @end smallexample
34532
34533 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34534 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34535 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34536 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34537 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34538 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34539
34540 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34541 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34542 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34543 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34544 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34545
34546 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34547 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34548 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34549 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34550 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34551 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34552
34553 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34554 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34555 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34556
34557 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34558 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34559 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34560 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34561 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34562
34563 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34564 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34565 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34566 with each other.
34567
34568 @node Config Names
34569 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34570
34571 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34572 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34573 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34574 of information in the following pattern:
34575
34576 @smallexample
34577 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34578 @end smallexample
34579
34580 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34581 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34582 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34583
34584 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34585 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34586 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34587 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34588 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34589 abbreviations---for example:
34590
34591 @smallexample
34592 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34593 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34594 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34595 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34596 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34597 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34598 % sh config.sub sun4
34599 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34600 % sh config.sub sun3
34601 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34602 % sh config.sub i986v
34603 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34604 @end smallexample
34605
34606 @noindent
34607 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34608 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34609
34610 @node Configure Options
34611 @section @file{configure} Options
34612
34613 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34614 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34615 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34616 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34617
34618 @smallexample
34619 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34620 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34621 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34622 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34623 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34624 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34625 @var{host}
34626 @end smallexample
34627
34628 @noindent
34629 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34630 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34631 @samp{--}.
34632
34633 @table @code
34634 @item --help
34635 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34636
34637 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34638 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34639 @file{@var{dir}}.
34640
34641 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34642 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34643 @file{@var{dir}}.
34644
34645 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34646 @need 2000
34647 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34648 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34649 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34650 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34651 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34652 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34653 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34654 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34655 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34656 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34657 @var{dirname}.
34658
34659 @item --norecursion
34660 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34661 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34662
34663 @item --target=@var{target}
34664 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34665 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34666 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34667
34668 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34669
34670 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34671 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34672
34673 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34674 @end table
34675
34676 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34677 needed for special purposes only.
34678
34679 @node System-wide configuration
34680 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34681 @cindex system-wide init file
34682
34683 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34684 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34685 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34686
34687 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34688
34689 @table @code
34690 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34691 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34692 @var{file}.
34693 @end table
34694
34695 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34696 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34697
34698 @itemize @bullet
34699 @item
34700 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34701 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34702 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34703 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34704 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34705 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34706
34707 @item
34708 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34709 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34710 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34711 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34712 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34713 @end itemize
34714
34715 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34716 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34717 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34718 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34719 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34720 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34721 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34722 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34723 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34724 reread.
34725
34726 @menu
34727 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34728 @end menu
34729
34730 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34731 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34732 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34733
34734 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34735 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34736 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34737 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34738 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34739 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34740
34741 The following scripts are currently available:
34742 @itemize @bullet
34743
34744 @item @file{elinos.py}
34745 @pindex elinos.py
34746 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34747 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34748 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34749 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34750 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34751 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34752
34753 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34754 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34755 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34756 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34757 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34758 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34759
34760 @end itemize
34761
34762 @node Maintenance Commands
34763 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34764 @cindex maintenance commands
34765 @cindex internal commands
34766
34767 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34768 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34769 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34770 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34771 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34772
34773 @table @code
34774 @kindex maint agent
34775 @kindex maint agent-eval
34776 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34777 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34778 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34779 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34780 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34781 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34782 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34783 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34784 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34785 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34786 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34787 addition and return the sum.
34788 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34789 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34790
34791 @kindex maint agent-printf
34792 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34793 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34794 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34795 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34796 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34797
34798 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34799 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34800 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34801 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34802 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34803 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34804 is shown:
34805
34806 @table @code
34807 @item breakpoint
34808 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34809
34810 @item watchpoint
34811 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34812
34813 @item longjmp
34814 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34815 @code{longjmp} calls.
34816
34817 @item longjmp resume
34818 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34819
34820 @item until
34821 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34822
34823 @item finish
34824 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34825
34826 @item shlib events
34827 Shared library events.
34828
34829 @end table
34830
34831 @kindex maint info btrace
34832 @item maint info btrace
34833 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34834
34835 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34836 @item maint btrace packet-history
34837 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34838 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34839 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34840 recording format.
34841
34842 @table @code
34843 @item bts
34844 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34845 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34846
34847 @table @asis
34848 @item Block number
34849 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34850 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34851 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34852 @end table
34853
34854 @item pt
34855 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34856 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34857 information is printed:
34858
34859 @table @asis
34860 @item Packet number
34861 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34862 @item Trace offset
34863 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34864 @item Packet opcode and payload
34865 @end table
34866 @end table
34867
34868 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34869 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34870 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34871 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34872 needed.
34873
34874 @kindex maint btrace clear
34875 @item maint btrace clear
34876 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34877 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34878
34879 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34880 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34881 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34882 buffer.
34883
34884 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34885 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34886 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34887 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34888 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34889 packet history.
34890
34891 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34892 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34893 @cindex displaced stepping support
34894 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34895 @item set displaced-stepping
34896 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34897 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34898 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34899 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34900 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34901 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34902
34903 @table @code
34904 @item set displaced-stepping on
34905 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34906 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34907
34908 @item set displaced-stepping off
34909 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34910 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34911
34912 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34913 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34914 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34915 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34916 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34917 @end table
34918
34919 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34920 @item maint check-psymtabs
34921 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34922 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34923
34924 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34925 @item maint check-symtabs
34926 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34927
34928 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34929 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34930 Expand symbol tables.
34931 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34932 names matching @var{regexp}.
34933
34934 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34935 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34936 @cindex demangler crashes
34937 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34938 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34939 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34940 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34941 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34942 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34943 option to terminate the current session.
34944
34945 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34946 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34947 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34948
34949 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34950 @item maint cplus namespace
34951 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34952
34953 @kindex maint deprecate
34954 @kindex maint undeprecate
34955 @cindex deprecated commands
34956 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34957 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34958 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34959 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34960 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34961 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34962 the replacement as part of the warning.
34963
34964 @kindex maint dump-me
34965 @item maint dump-me
34966 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34967 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34968 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34969 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34970
34971 @kindex maint internal-error
34972 @kindex maint internal-warning
34973 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34974 @cindex demangler crashes
34975 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34976 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34977 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34978
34979 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34980 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34981 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34982 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34983 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34984 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34985 @value{GDBN} session.
34986
34987 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34988 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34989
34990 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34991
34992 @smallexample
34993 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34994 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34995 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34996 debugging may prove unreliable.
34997 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34998 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34999 (@value{GDBP})
35000 @end smallexample
35001
35002 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35003 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35004 @cindex demangler crashes
35005
35006 @kindex maint set internal-error
35007 @kindex maint show internal-error
35008 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35009 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35010 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35011 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35012 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35013 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35014 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35015 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35016 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35017 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35018 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35019 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35020 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35021 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35022 described in the table below.
35023
35024 @table @samp
35025 @item quit
35026 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35027 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35028
35029 @item corefile
35030 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35031 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35032 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35033 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35034 disabled.
35035 @end table
35036
35037 @kindex maint packet
35038 @item maint packet @var{text}
35039 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35040 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35041 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35042 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35043 checksum.
35044
35045 @kindex maint print architecture
35046 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35047 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35048 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35049
35050 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35051 @item maint print c-tdesc
35052 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35053 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35054 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35055 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35056 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35057 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35058 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35059 modify XML target descriptions.
35060
35061 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35062 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35063 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35064 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35065
35066 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35067 @item maint print dummy-frames
35068 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35069
35070 @smallexample
35071 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35072 @dots{}
35073 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35074 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35075 58 return (a + b);
35076 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35077 @dots{}
35078 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35079 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35080 (@value{GDBP})
35081 @end smallexample
35082
35083 Takes an optional file parameter.
35084
35085 @kindex maint print registers
35086 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35087 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35088 @kindex maint print register-groups
35089 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35090 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35091 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35092 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35093 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35094 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35095 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35096
35097 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35098 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35099 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35100 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35101 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35102 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35103 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35104 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35105
35106 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35107 write the information.
35108
35109 @kindex maint print reggroups
35110 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35111 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35112 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35113 information.
35114
35115 The register groups info looks like this:
35116
35117 @smallexample
35118 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35119 Group Type
35120 general user
35121 float user
35122 all user
35123 vector user
35124 system user
35125 save internal
35126 restore internal
35127 @end smallexample
35128
35129 @kindex flushregs
35130 @item flushregs
35131 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35132
35133 @kindex maint print objfiles
35134 @cindex info for known object files
35135 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35136 Print a dump of all known object files.
35137 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35138 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35139 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35140
35141 @kindex maint print user-registers
35142 @cindex user registers
35143 @item maint print user-registers
35144 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35145 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35146 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35147 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35148 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35149 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35150 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35151
35152 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35153 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35154 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35155 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35156 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35157 matching @var{regexp}.
35158 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35159 and the full path if known.
35160 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35161
35162 @kindex maint print statistics
35163 @cindex bcache statistics
35164 @item maint print statistics
35165 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35166 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35167 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35168 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35169 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35170 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35171 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35172 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35173 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35174 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35175 lengths.
35176
35177 @kindex maint print target-stack
35178 @cindex target stack description
35179 @item maint print target-stack
35180 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35181 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35182 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35183 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35184 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35185 address.
35186
35187 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35188 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35189
35190 @kindex maint print type
35191 @cindex type chain of a data type
35192 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35193 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35194 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35195 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35196 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35197 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35198
35199 @kindex maint selftest
35200 @cindex self tests
35201 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35202 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35203 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35204 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35205 name will by ran.
35206
35207 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35208 @cindex self tests
35209 @item maint info selftests
35210 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35211
35212 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35213 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35214 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35215 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35216 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35217 information.
35218
35219 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35220 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35221 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35222 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35223 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35224 always see the disassembly form.
35225
35226 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35227
35228 @smallexample
35229 (gdb) info addr argc
35230 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35231 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35232 @end smallexample
35233
35234 For more information on these expressions, see
35235 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35236
35237 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35238 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35239 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35240 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35241 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35242
35243 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35244 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35245 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35246 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35247 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35248 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35249 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35250 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35251 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35252
35253 @kindex maint set profile
35254 @kindex maint show profile
35255 @cindex profiling GDB
35256 @item maint set profile
35257 @itemx maint show profile
35258 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35259
35260 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35261 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35262 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35263 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35264 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35265 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35266 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35267
35268 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35269 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35270
35271 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35272 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35273 @cindex hardware debug registers
35274 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35275 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35276 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35277 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35278 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35279 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35280 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35281
35282 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35283 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35284 @item maint set show-all-tib
35285 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35286 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35287 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35288 command.
35289
35290 @kindex maint set target-async
35291 @kindex maint show target-async
35292 @item maint set target-async
35293 @itemx maint show target-async
35294 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35295 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35296 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35297 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35298
35299 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35300 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35301 @item maint set target-non-stop
35302 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35303
35304 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35305 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35306 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35307 if supported by the target.
35308
35309 @table @code
35310 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35311 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35312 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35313
35314 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35315 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35316 does not indicate support.
35317
35318 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35319 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35320 target supports it.
35321 @end table
35322
35323 @kindex maint set per-command
35324 @kindex maint show per-command
35325 @item maint set per-command
35326 @itemx maint show per-command
35327 @cindex resources used by commands
35328
35329 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35330 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35331
35332 @table @code
35333 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35334 @itemx maint show per-command space
35335 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35336 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35337 took, following the command's own output.
35338 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35339 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35340
35341 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35342 @itemx maint show per-command time
35343 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35344 for each command.
35345 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35346 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35347 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35348 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35349 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35350 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35351 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35352 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35353 spent by the program been debugged.
35354 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35355 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35356
35357 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35358 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35359 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35360 for each command.
35361 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35362
35363 @enumerate a
35364 @item
35365 number of symbol tables
35366 @item
35367 number of primary symbol tables
35368 @item
35369 number of blocks in the blockvector
35370 @end enumerate
35371 @end table
35372
35373 @kindex maint space
35374 @cindex memory used by commands
35375 @item maint space @var{value}
35376 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35377 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35378
35379 @kindex maint time
35380 @cindex time of command execution
35381 @item maint time @var{value}
35382 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35383 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35384
35385 @kindex maint translate-address
35386 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35387 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35388 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35389 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35390 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35391 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35392 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35393
35394 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35395 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35396 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35397
35398 @end table
35399
35400 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35401 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35402
35403 @table @code
35404 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35405 @kindex set watchdog
35406 @cindex watchdog timer
35407 @cindex timeout for commands
35408 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35409 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35410 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35411
35412 @item show watchdog
35413 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35414 @end table
35415
35416 @node Remote Protocol
35417 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35418
35419 @menu
35420 * Overview::
35421 * Packets::
35422 * Stop Reply Packets::
35423 * General Query Packets::
35424 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35425 * Tracepoint Packets::
35426 * Host I/O Packets::
35427 * Interrupts::
35428 * Notification Packets::
35429 * Remote Non-Stop::
35430 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35431 * Examples::
35432 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35433 * Library List Format::
35434 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35435 * Memory Map Format::
35436 * Thread List Format::
35437 * Traceframe Info Format::
35438 * Branch Trace Format::
35439 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35440 @end menu
35441
35442 @node Overview
35443 @section Overview
35444
35445 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35446 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35447 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35448 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35449
35450 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35451 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35452
35453 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35454 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35455 @cindex remote serial protocol
35456 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35457 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35458 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35459 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35460 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35461
35462 @smallexample
35463 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35464 @end smallexample
35465 @noindent
35466
35467 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35468 @noindent
35469 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35470 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35471 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35472
35473 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35474 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35475
35476 @smallexample
35477 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35478 @end smallexample
35479
35480 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35481 @noindent
35482 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35483 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35484 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35485
35486 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35487 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35488 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35489 retransmission):
35490
35491 @smallexample
35492 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35493 <- @code{+}
35494 @end smallexample
35495 @noindent
35496
35497 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35498 once a connection is established.
35499 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35500
35501 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35502 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35503 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35504 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35505 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35506 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35507 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35508
35509 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35510 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35511 exceptions).
35512
35513 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35514 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35515 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35516 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35517
35518 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35519 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35520 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35521
35522 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35523 @anchor{Binary Data}
35524 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35525 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35526 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35527 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35528 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35529 binary data.
35530
35531 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35532 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35533 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35534 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35535 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35536 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35537 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35538 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35539 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35540 (described next).
35541
35542 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35543 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35544 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35545 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35546 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35547 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35548 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35549 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35550 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35551 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35552 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35553 3}} more times.
35554
35555 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35556 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35557 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35558 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35559 @samp{0*"00}.
35560
35561 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35562 error number. That number is not well defined.
35563
35564 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35565 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35566 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35567 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35568 on that response.
35569
35570 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35571 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35572 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35573 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35574 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35575 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35576
35577 @node Packets
35578 @section Packets
35579
35580 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35581 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35582 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35583 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35584
35585 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35586 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35587 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35588 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35589 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35590 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35591 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35592 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35593 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35594 @var{baz}.
35595
35596 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35597 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35598 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35599 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35600 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35601 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35602 pick any thread.
35603
35604 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35605 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35606 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35607 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35608 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35609 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35610 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35611 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35612 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35613 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35614 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35615 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35616 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35617
35618 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35619 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35620 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35621 more information.
35622
35623 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35624 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35625
35626 Here are the packet descriptions.
35627
35628 @table @samp
35629
35630 @item !
35631 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35632 @anchor{extended mode}
35633 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35634 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35635 debugged.
35636
35637 Reply:
35638 @table @samp
35639 @item OK
35640 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35641 @end table
35642
35643 @item ?
35644 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35645 @anchor{? packet}
35646 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35647 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35648 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35649
35650 Reply:
35651 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35652
35653 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35654 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35655 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35656 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35657 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35658
35659 Reply:
35660 @table @samp
35661 @item OK
35662 The arguments were set.
35663 @item E @var{NN}
35664 An error occurred.
35665 @end table
35666
35667 @item b @var{baud}
35668 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35669 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35670 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35671
35672 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35673 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35674 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35675
35676 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35677 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35678 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35679 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35680 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35681
35682 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35683 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35684 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35685 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35686
35687 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35688 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35689
35690 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35691 @anchor{bc}
35692 @item bc
35693 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35694 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35695
35696 Reply:
35697 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35698
35699 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35700 @anchor{bs}
35701 @item bs
35702 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35703 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35704
35705 Reply:
35706 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35707
35708 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35709 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35710 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35711 is omitted, resume at current address.
35712
35713 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35714 packet}.
35715
35716 Reply:
35717 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35718
35719 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35720 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35721 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35722 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35723
35724 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35725 packet}.
35726
35727 Reply:
35728 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35729
35730 @item d
35731 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35732 Toggle debug flag.
35733
35734 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35735 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35736
35737 @item D
35738 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35739 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35740 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35741 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35742 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35743
35744 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35745 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35746 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35747 big-endian hex string.
35748
35749 Reply:
35750 @table @samp
35751 @item OK
35752 for success
35753 @item E @var{NN}
35754 for an error
35755 @end table
35756
35757 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35758 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35759 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35760 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35761 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35762
35763 @item g
35764 @anchor{read registers packet}
35765 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35766 Read general registers.
35767
35768 Reply:
35769 @table @samp
35770 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35771 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35772 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35773 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35774 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35775 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35776
35777 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35778 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35779 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35780 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35781 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35782 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35783 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35784 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35785
35786 @smallexample
35787 -> @code{g}
35788 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35789 @end smallexample
35790
35791 @item E @var{NN}
35792 for an error.
35793 @end table
35794
35795 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35796 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35797 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35798 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35799
35800 Reply:
35801 @table @samp
35802 @item OK
35803 for success
35804 @item E @var{NN}
35805 for an error
35806 @end table
35807
35808 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35809 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35810 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35811 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35812 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35813 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35814 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35815 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35816 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35817
35818 Reply:
35819 @table @samp
35820 @item OK
35821 for success
35822 @item E @var{NN}
35823 for an error
35824 @end table
35825
35826 @c FIXME: JTC:
35827 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35828 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35829 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35830 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35831 @c described. For example:
35832 @c
35833 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35834 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35835 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35836 @c
35837 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35838 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35839 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35840
35841 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35842 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35843 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35844 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35845 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35846 step starting at that address.
35847
35848 @item I
35849 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35850 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35851 step packet}.
35852
35853 @item k
35854 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35855 Kill request.
35856
35857 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35858
35859 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35860 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35861
35862 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35863
35864 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35865 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35866 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35867
35868 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35869 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35870 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35871
35872 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35873 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35874 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35875 (@pxref{? packet}).
35876
35877 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35878 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35879 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35880 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35881 any particular boundary.
35882
35883 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35884 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35885 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35886 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35887 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35888 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35889 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35890 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35891
35892 Reply:
35893 @table @samp
35894 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35895 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35896 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35897 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35898 @item E @var{NN}
35899 @var{NN} is errno
35900 @end table
35901
35902 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35903 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35904 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35905 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35906 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35907
35908 Reply:
35909 @table @samp
35910 @item OK
35911 for success
35912 @item E @var{NN}
35913 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35914 written).
35915 @end table
35916
35917 @item p @var{n}
35918 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35919 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35920 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35921 register value is encoded.
35922
35923 Reply:
35924 @table @samp
35925 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35926 the register's value
35927 @item E @var{NN}
35928 for an error
35929 @item @w{}
35930 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35931 @end table
35932
35933 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35934 @anchor{write register packet}
35935 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35936 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35937 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35938 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35939
35940 Reply:
35941 @table @samp
35942 @item OK
35943 for success
35944 @item E @var{NN}
35945 for an error
35946 @end table
35947
35948 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35949 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35950 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35951 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35952 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35953 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35954
35955 @item r
35956 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35957 Reset the entire system.
35958
35959 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35960
35961 @item R @var{XX}
35962 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35963 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35964 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35965
35966 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35967
35968 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35969 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35970 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35971 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35972
35973 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35974 packet}.
35975
35976 Reply:
35977 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35978
35979 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35980 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35981 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35982 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35983 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35984
35985 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35986 packet}.
35987
35988 Reply:
35989 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35990
35991 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35992 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35993 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35994 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35995 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35996
35997 @item T @var{thread-id}
35998 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35999 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36000
36001 Reply:
36002 @table @samp
36003 @item OK
36004 thread is still alive
36005 @item E @var{NN}
36006 thread is dead
36007 @end table
36008
36009 @item v
36010 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36011 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36012
36013 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36014 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36015 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36016 The process ID is a
36017 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36018 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36019 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36020
36021 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36022 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36023 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36024 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36025 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36026 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36027 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36028 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36029
36030 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36031
36032 Reply:
36033 @table @samp
36034 @item E @var{nn}
36035 for an error
36036 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36037 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36038 @item OK
36039 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36040 @end table
36041
36042 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36043 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36044 @anchor{vCont packet}
36045 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36046
36047 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36048 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36049 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36050 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36051 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36052 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36053 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36054 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36055 error.
36056
36057 Currently supported actions are:
36058
36059 @table @samp
36060 @item c
36061 Continue.
36062 @item C @var{sig}
36063 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36064 @item s
36065 Step.
36066 @item S @var{sig}
36067 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36068 @item t
36069 Stop.
36070 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36071 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36072 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36073 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36074 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36075 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36076
36077 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36078 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36079 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36080 jumps to @var{start}).
36081
36082 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36083 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36084 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36085
36086 @end table
36087
36088 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36089 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36090 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36091
36092 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36093 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36094 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36095 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36096 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36097 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36098 as an implementation detail.
36099
36100 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36101 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36102 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36103 stopped.
36104
36105 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36106 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36107 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36108
36109 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36110 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36111
36112 Reply:
36113 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36114
36115 @item vCont?
36116 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36117 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36118
36119 Reply:
36120 @table @samp
36121 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36122 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36123 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36124 @item @w{}
36125 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36126 @end table
36127
36128 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36129 @item vCtrlC
36130 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36131 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36132 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36133 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36134 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36135 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36136 variant.
36137
36138 Reply:
36139 @table @samp
36140 @item E @var{nn}
36141 for an error
36142 @item OK
36143 for success
36144 @end table
36145
36146 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36147 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36148 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36149 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36150
36151 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36152 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36153 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36154 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36155 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36156 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36157 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36158 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36159 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36160 packet is received.
36161
36162 Reply:
36163 @table @samp
36164 @item OK
36165 for success
36166 @item E @var{NN}
36167 for an error
36168 @end table
36169
36170 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36171 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36172 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36173 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36174 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36175 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36176 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36177 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36178 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36179 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36180 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36181 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36182
36183
36184 Reply:
36185 @table @samp
36186 @item OK
36187 for success
36188 @item E.memtype
36189 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36190 @item E @var{NN}
36191 for an error
36192 @end table
36193
36194 @item vFlashDone
36195 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36196 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36197 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36198 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36199 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36200 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36201 request is completed.
36202
36203 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36204 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36205 @anchor{vKill packet}
36206 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36207 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36208 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36209 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36210
36211 Reply:
36212 @table @samp
36213 @item E @var{nn}
36214 for an error
36215 @item OK
36216 for success
36217 @end table
36218
36219 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36220 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36221 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36222 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36223 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36224
36225 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36226 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36227 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36228 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36229 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36230 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36231
36232 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36233 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36234 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36235 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36236 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36237 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36238 state.
36239
36240 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36241
36242 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36243
36244 Reply:
36245 @table @samp
36246 @item E @var{nn}
36247 for an error
36248 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36249 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36250 @end table
36251
36252 @item vStopped
36253 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36254 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36255
36256 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36257 @anchor{X packet}
36258 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36259 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36260 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36261 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36262 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36263
36264 Reply:
36265 @table @samp
36266 @item OK
36267 for success
36268 @item E @var{NN}
36269 for an error
36270 @end table
36271
36272 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36273 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36274 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36275 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36276 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36277 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36278 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36279
36280 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36281 separately.
36282
36283 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36284 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36285 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36286 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36287 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36288 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36289
36290 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36291 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36292 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36293 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36294 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36295 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36296
36297 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36298 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36299 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36300 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36301 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36302 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36303 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36304 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36305 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36306 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36307 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36308 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36309 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36310
36311 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36312 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36313
36314 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36315 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36316
36317 @table @samp
36318
36319 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36320 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36321 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36322
36323 @end table
36324
36325 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36326 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36327 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36328 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36329 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36330 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36331 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36332
36333 @table @samp
36334
36335 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36336 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36337 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36338
36339 @end table
36340
36341 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36342 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36343 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36344 target, is not defined.}
36345
36346 Reply:
36347 @table @samp
36348 @item OK
36349 success
36350 @item @w{}
36351 not supported
36352 @item E @var{NN}
36353 for an error
36354 @end table
36355
36356 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36357 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36358 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36359 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36360 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36361 address @var{addr}.
36362
36363 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36364 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36365 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36366 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36367
36368 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36369 movement.}
36370
36371 Reply:
36372 @table @samp
36373 @item OK
36374 success
36375 @item @w{}
36376 not supported
36377 @item E @var{NN}
36378 for an error
36379 @end table
36380
36381 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36382 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36383 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36384 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36385 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36386 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36387
36388 Reply:
36389 @table @samp
36390 @item OK
36391 success
36392 @item @w{}
36393 not supported
36394 @item E @var{NN}
36395 for an error
36396 @end table
36397
36398 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36399 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36400 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36401 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36402 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36403 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36404
36405 Reply:
36406 @table @samp
36407 @item OK
36408 success
36409 @item @w{}
36410 not supported
36411 @item E @var{NN}
36412 for an error
36413 @end table
36414
36415 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36416 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36417 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36418 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36419 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36420 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36421
36422 Reply:
36423 @table @samp
36424 @item OK
36425 success
36426 @item @w{}
36427 not supported
36428 @item E @var{NN}
36429 for an error
36430 @end table
36431
36432 @end table
36433
36434 @node Stop Reply Packets
36435 @section Stop Reply Packets
36436 @cindex stop reply packets
36437
36438 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36439 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36440 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36441 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36442 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36443 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36444 @value{GDBN} source code.
36445
36446 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36447 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36448 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36449
36450 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36451 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36452 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36453 components.
36454
36455 @table @samp
36456
36457 @item S @var{AA}
36458 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36459 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36460 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36461
36462 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36463 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36464 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36465 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36466 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36467 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36468 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36469 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36470
36471 @itemize @bullet
36472 @item
36473 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36474 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36475 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36476 two-digit hex number.
36477
36478 @item
36479 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36480 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36481
36482 @item
36483 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36484 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36485
36486 @item
36487 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36488 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36489 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36490 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36491
36492 @item
36493 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36494 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36495 future.
36496 @end itemize
36497
36498 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36499
36500 @table @samp
36501 @item watch
36502 @itemx rwatch
36503 @itemx awatch
36504 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36505 hex.
36506
36507 @item syscall_entry
36508 @itemx syscall_return
36509 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36510 syscall number, in hex.
36511
36512 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36513 @item library
36514 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36515 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36516 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36517
36518 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36519 @item replaylog
36520 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36521 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36522 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36523 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36524 for more information.
36525
36526 @item swbreak
36527 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36528 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36529 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36530 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36531 part must be left empty.
36532
36533 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36534 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36535 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36536 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36537 address.
36538
36539 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36540 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36541 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36542 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36543 indicating support.
36544
36545 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36546
36547 @item hwbreak
36548 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36549 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36550
36551 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36552 apply.
36553
36554 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36555 @item fork
36556 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36557 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36558 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36559 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36560 fork events.
36561
36562 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36563 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36564 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36565 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36566 indicating support.
36567
36568 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36569 @item vfork
36570 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36571 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36572 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36573 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36574 vfork events.
36575
36576 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36577 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36578 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36579 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36580 indicating support.
36581
36582 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36583 @item vforkdone
36584 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36585 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36586 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36587 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36588 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36589
36590 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36591 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36592 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36593 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36594 indicating support.
36595
36596 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36597 @item exec
36598 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36599 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36600 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36601
36602 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36603 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36604 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36605 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36606 indicating support.
36607
36608 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36609 @anchor{thread create event}
36610 @item create
36611 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36612 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36613 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36614 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36615 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36616 @var{r} part is ignored.
36617
36618 @end table
36619
36620 @item W @var{AA}
36621 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36622 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36623 applicable to certain targets.
36624
36625 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36626 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36627 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36628 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36629 hex strings.
36630
36631 @item X @var{AA}
36632 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36633 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36634
36635 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36636 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36637 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36638 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36639 hex strings.
36640
36641 @anchor{thread exit event}
36642 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36643 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36644
36645 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36646 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36647 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36648 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36649
36650 @item N
36651 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36652 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36653 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36654 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36655 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36656 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36657 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36658 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36659 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36660 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36661 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36662 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36663 support.
36664
36665 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36666 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36667 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36668 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36669 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36670
36671 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36672 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36673 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36674 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36675 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36676 system calls.
36677
36678 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36679 this very system call.
36680
36681 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36682 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36683 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36684 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36685 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36686 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36687
36688 @end table
36689
36690 @node General Query Packets
36691 @section General Query Packets
36692 @cindex remote query requests
36693
36694 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36695 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36696 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36697 sending information to and from the stub.
36698
36699 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36700 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36701 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36702 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36703 conventions:
36704
36705 @itemize @bullet
36706 @item
36707 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36708 @item
36709 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36710 letter.
36711 @item
36712 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36713 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36714 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36715 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36716 @end itemize
36717
36718 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36719 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36720 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36721 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36722 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36723 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36724 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36725 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36726 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36727 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36728 packet.}.
36729
36730 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36731 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36732 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36733 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36734 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36735
36736 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36737
36738 @table @samp
36739
36740 @item QAgent:1
36741 @itemx QAgent:0
36742 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36743 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36744
36745 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36746 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36747 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36748 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36749 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36750 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36751 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36752 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36753 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36754 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36755 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36756
36757 @item qC
36758 @cindex current thread, remote request
36759 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36760 Return the current thread ID.
36761
36762 Reply:
36763 @table @samp
36764 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36765 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36766 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36767 @item @r{(anything else)}
36768 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36769 @end table
36770
36771 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36772 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36773 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36774 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36775 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36776 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36777 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36778 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36779
36780 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36781 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36782 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36783 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36784 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36785 detect trailing zeros.
36786
36787 Reply:
36788 @table @samp
36789 @item E @var{NN}
36790 An error (such as memory fault)
36791 @item C @var{crc32}
36792 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36793 @end table
36794
36795 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36796 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36797 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36798 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36799 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36800 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36801 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36802 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36803 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36804 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36805 randomization.
36806
36807 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36808
36809 Reply:
36810 @table @samp
36811 @item OK
36812 The request succeeded.
36813
36814 @item E @var{nn}
36815 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36816
36817 @item @w{}
36818 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36819 by the stub.
36820 @end table
36821
36822 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36823 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36824 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36825 address space randomization.
36826
36827 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36828 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
36829 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36830 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36831 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36832 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36833 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36834 inferior using a shell or not.
36835
36836 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36837 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36838 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36839 values are considered an error.
36840
36841 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36842 mode}).
36843
36844 Reply:
36845 @table @samp
36846 @item OK
36847 The request succeeded.
36848
36849 @item E @var{nn}
36850 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36851 @end table
36852
36853 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36854 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36855 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36856 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36857
36858 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36859 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36860
36861 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
36862 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36863 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
36864 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
36865 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
36866 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
36867 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
36868 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
36869 environment}).
36870
36871 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36872 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
36873 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
36874 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
36875 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
36876 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
36877 not be present.
36878
36879 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36880 mode}).
36881
36882 Reply:
36883 @table @samp
36884 @item OK
36885 The request succeeded.
36886 @end table
36887
36888 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36889 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36890 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36891 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36892 inferior.
36893
36894 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
36895 @pxref{set environment}.
36896
36897 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
36898 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
36899 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
36900 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
36901 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
36902 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
36903 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
36904 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
36905
36906 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36907 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
36908
36909 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36910 mode}).
36911
36912 Reply:
36913 @table @samp
36914 @item OK
36915 The request succeeded.
36916 @end table
36917
36918 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36919 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36920 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36921 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36922 inferior.
36923
36924 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
36925 @pxref{unset environment}.
36926
36927 @item QEnvironmentReset
36928 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
36929 @cindex reset environment, remote request
36930 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
36931 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
36932 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
36933 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
36934 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
36935 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
36936 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36937 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
36938 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
36939
36940 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36941 mode}).
36942
36943 Reply:
36944 @table @samp
36945 @item OK
36946 The request succeeded.
36947 @end table
36948
36949 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36950 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36951 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36952 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36953 inferior.
36954
36955 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
36956 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
36957 @cindex set working directory, remote request
36958 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
36959 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
36960 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
36961
36962 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
36963 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
36964 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
36965 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
36966 directory to its original, empty value.
36967
36968 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36969 mode}).
36970
36971 Reply:
36972 @table @samp
36973 @item OK
36974 The request succeeded.
36975 @end table
36976
36977 @item qfThreadInfo
36978 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36979 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36980 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36981 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36982 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36983 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36984 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36985 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36986 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36987 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36988
36989 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36990
36991 Reply:
36992 @table @samp
36993 @item m @var{thread-id}
36994 A single thread ID
36995 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36996 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36997 @item l
36998 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36999 @end table
37000
37001 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37002 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37003 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37004 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37005 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37006 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37007 fields.
37008
37009 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37010 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37011 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37012 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37013 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37014
37015 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37016 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37017 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37018 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37019 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37020
37021 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37022 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37023
37024 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37025 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37026 information associated with the variable.)
37027
37028 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37029 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37030 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37031 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37032 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37033 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37034
37035 Reply:
37036 @table @samp
37037 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37038 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37039 local storage requested.
37040
37041 @item E @var{nn}
37042 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37043
37044 @item @w{}
37045 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37046 @end table
37047
37048 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37049 @cindex get thread information block address
37050 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37051 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37052
37053 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37054
37055 Reply:
37056 @table @samp
37057 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37058 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37059 thread information block.
37060
37061 @item E @var{nn}
37062 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37063 address could not be retrieved.
37064
37065 @item @w{}
37066 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37067 @end table
37068
37069 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37070 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37071 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37072 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37073 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37074 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37075 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37076
37077 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37078
37079 Reply:
37080 @table @samp
37081 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37082 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37083 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37084 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37085 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37086 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37087 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37088 @end table
37089
37090 @item qOffsets
37091 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37092 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37093 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37094 image.
37095
37096 Reply:
37097 @table @samp
37098 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37099 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37100 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37101 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37102 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37103 segments by the supplied offsets.
37104
37105 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37106 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37107 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37108
37109 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37110 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37111 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37112 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37113 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37114 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37115 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37116 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37117 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37118 @end table
37119
37120 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37121 @cindex thread information, remote request
37122 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37123 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37124 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37125 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37126
37127 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37128 (see below).
37129
37130 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37131
37132 @item QNonStop:1
37133 @itemx QNonStop:0
37134 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37135 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37136 @anchor{QNonStop}
37137 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37138 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37139
37140 Reply:
37141 @table @samp
37142 @item OK
37143 The request succeeded.
37144
37145 @item E @var{nn}
37146 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37147
37148 @item @w{}
37149 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37150 the stub.
37151 @end table
37152
37153 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37154 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37155 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37156 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37157
37158 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37159 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37160 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37161 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37162 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37163 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37164 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37165
37166 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37167 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37168 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37169
37170 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37171 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37172 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37173 report the requested syscalls.
37174
37175 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37176 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37177
37178 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37179 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37180 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37181 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37182
37183 Reply:
37184 @table @samp
37185 @item OK
37186 The request succeeded.
37187
37188 @item E @var{nn}
37189 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37190
37191 @item @w{}
37192 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37193 the stub.
37194 @end table
37195
37196 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37197 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37198 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37199 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37200
37201 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37202 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37203 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37204 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37205 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37206 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37207 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37208 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37209 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37210 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37211 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37212 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37213 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37214
37215 Reply:
37216 @table @samp
37217 @item OK
37218 The request succeeded.
37219
37220 @item E @var{nn}
37221 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37222
37223 @item @w{}
37224 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37225 the stub.
37226 @end table
37227
37228 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37229 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37230 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37231 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37232
37233 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37234 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37235 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37236 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37237 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37238 Others should be silently discarded.
37239
37240 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37241 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37242 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37243 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37244 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37245 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37246 signals.
37247
37248 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37249 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37250
37251 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37252 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37253 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37254 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37255 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37256
37257 Reply:
37258 @table @samp
37259 @item OK
37260 The request succeeded.
37261
37262 @item E @var{nn}
37263 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37264
37265 @item @w{}
37266 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37267 by the stub.
37268 @end table
37269
37270 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37271 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37272 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37273 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37274
37275 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37276 @item QThreadEvents:1
37277 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37278 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37279 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37280
37281 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37282 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37283 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37284 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37285 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37286 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37287 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37288 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37289 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37290 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37291
37292 Reply:
37293 @table @samp
37294 @item OK
37295 The request succeeded.
37296
37297 @item E @var{nn}
37298 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37299
37300 @item @w{}
37301 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37302 the stub.
37303 @end table
37304
37305 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37306 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37307
37308 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37309 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37310 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37311 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37312 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37313 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37314 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37315 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37316 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37317
37318 Reply:
37319 @table @samp
37320 @item OK
37321 A command response with no output.
37322 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37323 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37324 @item E @var{NN}
37325 Indicate a badly formed request.
37326 @item @w{}
37327 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37328 @end table
37329
37330 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37331 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37332 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37333 packets.)
37334
37335 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37336 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37337 @ifnotinfo
37338 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37339 @end ifnotinfo
37340 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37341 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37342 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37343 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37344 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37345
37346 Reply:
37347 @table @samp
37348 @item 0
37349 The pattern was not found.
37350 @item 1,address
37351 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37352 @item E @var{NN}
37353 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37354 @item @w{}
37355 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37356 @end table
37357
37358 @item QStartNoAckMode
37359 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37360 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37361 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37362 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37363
37364 Reply:
37365 @table @samp
37366 @item OK
37367 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37368 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37369 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37370 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37371 @item @w{}
37372 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37373 @end table
37374
37375 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37376 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37377 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37378 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37379 @anchor{qSupported}
37380 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37381 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37382 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37383 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37384 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37385 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37386 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37387 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37388 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37389 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37390 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37391 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37392 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37393 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37394
37395 Reply:
37396 @table @samp
37397 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37398 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37399 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37400 possible forms).
37401 @item @w{}
37402 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37403 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37404 @end table
37405
37406 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37407 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37408 are:
37409
37410 @table @samp
37411 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37412 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37413 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37414 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37415 @item @var{name}+
37416 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37417 need an associated value.
37418 @item @var{name}-
37419 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37420 @item @var{name}?
37421 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37422 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37423 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37424 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37425 @end table
37426
37427 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37428 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37429 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37430 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37431 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37432
37433 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37434 are defined:
37435
37436 @table @samp
37437 @item multiprocess
37438 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37439 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37440 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37441 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37442 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37443
37444 @item xmlRegisters
37445 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37446 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37447 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37448 description.
37449
37450 @item qRelocInsn
37451 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37452 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37453 instruction reply packet}).
37454
37455 @item swbreak
37456 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37457 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37458
37459 @item hwbreak
37460 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37461 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37462
37463 @item fork-events
37464 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37465 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37466 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37467 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37468
37469 @item vfork-events
37470 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37471 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37472 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37473 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37474
37475 @item exec-events
37476 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37477 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37478 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37479 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37480
37481 @item vContSupported
37482 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37483 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37484 @end table
37485
37486 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37487 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37488 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37489 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37490 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37491 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37492 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37493 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37494 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37495 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37496 all the features it supports.
37497
37498 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37499 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37500
37501 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37502 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37503 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37504 form response.
37505
37506 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37507 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37508 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37509 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37510
37511 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37512 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37513 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37514 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37515 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37516
37517 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37518
37519 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37520 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37521 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37522 @item Feature Name
37523 @tab Value Required
37524 @tab Default
37525 @tab Probe Allowed
37526
37527 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37528 @tab Yes
37529 @tab @samp{-}
37530 @tab No
37531
37532 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37533 @tab No
37534 @tab @samp{-}
37535 @tab Yes
37536
37537 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37538 @tab No
37539 @tab @samp{-}
37540 @tab Yes
37541
37542 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37543 @tab No
37544 @tab @samp{-}
37545 @tab Yes
37546
37547 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37548 @tab No
37549 @tab @samp{-}
37550 @tab Yes
37551
37552 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37553 @tab No
37554 @tab @samp{-}
37555 @tab Yes
37556
37557 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37558 @tab No
37559 @tab @samp{-}
37560 @tab Yes
37561
37562 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37563 @tab No
37564 @tab @samp{-}
37565 @tab Yes
37566
37567 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37568 @tab No
37569 @tab @samp{-}
37570 @tab No
37571
37572 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37573 @tab No
37574 @tab @samp{-}
37575 @tab Yes
37576
37577 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37578 @tab No
37579 @tab @samp{-}
37580 @tab Yes
37581
37582 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37583 @tab No
37584 @tab @samp{-}
37585 @tab Yes
37586
37587 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37588 @tab No
37589 @tab @samp{-}
37590 @tab Yes
37591
37592 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37593 @tab No
37594 @tab @samp{-}
37595 @tab Yes
37596
37597 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37598 @tab No
37599 @tab @samp{-}
37600 @tab Yes
37601
37602 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37603 @tab No
37604 @tab @samp{-}
37605 @tab Yes
37606
37607 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37608 @tab No
37609 @tab @samp{-}
37610 @tab Yes
37611
37612 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37613 @tab No
37614 @tab @samp{-}
37615 @tab Yes
37616
37617 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37618 @tab No
37619 @tab @samp{-}
37620 @tab Yes
37621
37622 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37623 @tab Yes
37624 @tab @samp{-}
37625 @tab Yes
37626
37627 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37628 @tab Yes
37629 @tab @samp{-}
37630 @tab Yes
37631
37632 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37633 @tab Yes
37634 @tab @samp{-}
37635 @tab Yes
37636
37637 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37638 @tab Yes
37639 @tab @samp{-}
37640 @tab Yes
37641
37642 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37643 @tab Yes
37644 @tab @samp{-}
37645 @tab Yes
37646
37647 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37648 @tab No
37649 @tab @samp{-}
37650 @tab Yes
37651
37652 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37653 @tab No
37654 @tab @samp{-}
37655 @tab Yes
37656
37657 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37658 @tab No
37659 @tab @samp{-}
37660 @tab Yes
37661
37662 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37663 @tab No
37664 @tab @samp{-}
37665 @tab Yes
37666
37667 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37668 @tab No
37669 @tab @samp{-}
37670 @tab No
37671
37672 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37673 @tab No
37674 @tab @samp{-}
37675 @tab No
37676
37677 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37678 @tab No
37679 @tab @samp{-}
37680 @tab No
37681
37682 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37683 @tab No
37684 @tab @samp{-}
37685 @tab No
37686
37687 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37688 @tab No
37689 @tab @samp{-}
37690 @tab No
37691
37692 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37693 @tab No
37694 @tab @samp{-}
37695 @tab No
37696
37697 @item @samp{QAgent}
37698 @tab No
37699 @tab @samp{-}
37700 @tab No
37701
37702 @item @samp{QAllow}
37703 @tab No
37704 @tab @samp{-}
37705 @tab No
37706
37707 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37708 @tab No
37709 @tab @samp{-}
37710 @tab No
37711
37712 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37713 @tab No
37714 @tab @samp{-}
37715 @tab No
37716
37717 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37718 @tab No
37719 @tab @samp{-}
37720 @tab No
37721
37722 @item @samp{tracenz}
37723 @tab No
37724 @tab @samp{-}
37725 @tab No
37726
37727 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37728 @tab No
37729 @tab @samp{-}
37730 @tab No
37731
37732 @item @samp{swbreak}
37733 @tab No
37734 @tab @samp{-}
37735 @tab No
37736
37737 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37738 @tab No
37739 @tab @samp{-}
37740 @tab No
37741
37742 @item @samp{fork-events}
37743 @tab No
37744 @tab @samp{-}
37745 @tab No
37746
37747 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37748 @tab No
37749 @tab @samp{-}
37750 @tab No
37751
37752 @item @samp{exec-events}
37753 @tab No
37754 @tab @samp{-}
37755 @tab No
37756
37757 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37758 @tab No
37759 @tab @samp{-}
37760 @tab No
37761
37762 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37763 @tab No
37764 @tab @samp{-}
37765 @tab No
37766
37767 @end multitable
37768
37769 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37770
37771 @table @samp
37772 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37773 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37774 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37775 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37776 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37777 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37778 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37779 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37780 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37781 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37782
37783 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37784 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37785 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37786
37787 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37788 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37789 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37790
37791 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37792 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37793 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37794
37795 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37796 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37797 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37798
37799 @item qXfer:features:read
37800 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37801 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37802
37803 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37804 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37805 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37806
37807 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37808 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37809 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37810
37811 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37812 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37813 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37814 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37815
37816 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37817 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37818 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37819
37820 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37821 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37822 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37823
37824 @item qXfer:spu:read
37825 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37826 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37827
37828 @item qXfer:spu:write
37829 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37830 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37831
37832 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37833 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37834 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37835
37836 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37837 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37838 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37839
37840 @item qXfer:threads:read
37841 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37842 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37843
37844 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37845 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37846 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37847
37848 @item qXfer:uib:read
37849 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37850 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37851
37852 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37853 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37854 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37855
37856 @item QNonStop
37857 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37858 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37859
37860 @item QCatchSyscalls
37861 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37862 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37863
37864 @item QPassSignals
37865 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37866 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37867
37868 @item QStartNoAckMode
37869 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37870 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37871
37872 @item multiprocess
37873 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37874 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37875 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37876 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37877 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37878 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37879 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37880 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37881 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37882 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37883 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37884
37885 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37886 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37887 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37888
37889 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37890 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37891 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37892 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37893
37894 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37895 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37896 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37897
37898 @item ReverseContinue
37899 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37900 (@pxref{bc}).
37901
37902 @item ReverseStep
37903 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37904 (@pxref{bs}).
37905
37906 @item TracepointSource
37907 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37908 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37909
37910 @item QAgent
37911 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37912
37913 @item QAllow
37914 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37915
37916 @item QDisableRandomization
37917 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37918
37919 @item StaticTracepoint
37920 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37921 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37922
37923 @item InstallInTrace
37924 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37925 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37926
37927 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37928 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37929 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37930 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37931
37932 @item QTBuffer:size
37933 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37934 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37935
37936 @item tracenz
37937 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37938 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37939 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37940
37941 @item BreakpointCommands
37942 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37943 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37944 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37945
37946 @item Qbtrace:off
37947 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37948
37949 @item Qbtrace:bts
37950 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37951
37952 @item Qbtrace:pt
37953 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37954
37955 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37956 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37957
37958 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37959 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37960
37961 @item swbreak
37962 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37963 breakpoints.
37964
37965 @item hwbreak
37966 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37967 breakpoints.
37968
37969 @item fork-events
37970 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37971
37972 @item vfork-events
37973 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37974 and vforkdone events.
37975
37976 @item exec-events
37977 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37978
37979 @item vContSupported
37980 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37981 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37982
37983 @item QThreadEvents
37984 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37985
37986 @item no-resumed
37987 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37988
37989 @end table
37990
37991 @item qSymbol::
37992 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37993 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37994 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37995 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37996
37997 Reply:
37998 @table @samp
37999 @item OK
38000 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38001 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38002 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38003 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38004 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38005 below.
38006 @end table
38007
38008 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38009 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38010
38011 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38012 target has previously requested.
38013
38014 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38015 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38016 will be empty.
38017
38018 Reply:
38019 @table @samp
38020 @item OK
38021 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38022 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38023 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38024 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38025 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38026 @end table
38027
38028 @item qTBuffer
38029 @itemx QTBuffer
38030 @itemx QTDisconnected
38031 @itemx QTDP
38032 @itemx QTDPsrc
38033 @itemx QTDV
38034 @itemx qTfP
38035 @itemx qTfV
38036 @itemx QTFrame
38037 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38038
38039 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38040
38041 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38042 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38043 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38044 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38045 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38046 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38047 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38048 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38049 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38050 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38051 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38052
38053 Reply:
38054 @table @samp
38055 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38056 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38057 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38058 the thread's attributes.
38059 @end table
38060
38061 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38062 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38063 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38064 packets.)
38065
38066 @item QTNotes
38067 @itemx qTP
38068 @itemx QTSave
38069 @itemx qTsP
38070 @itemx qTsV
38071 @itemx QTStart
38072 @itemx QTStop
38073 @itemx QTEnable
38074 @itemx QTDisable
38075 @itemx QTinit
38076 @itemx QTro
38077 @itemx qTStatus
38078 @itemx qTV
38079 @itemx qTfSTM
38080 @itemx qTsSTM
38081 @itemx qTSTMat
38082 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38083
38084 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38085 @cindex read special object, remote request
38086 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38087 @anchor{qXfer read}
38088 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38089 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38090 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38091 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38092 additional details about what data to access.
38093
38094 Reply:
38095 @table @samp
38096 @item m @var{data}
38097 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38098 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38099 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38100 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38101 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38102 request.
38103
38104 @item l @var{data}
38105 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38106 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38107 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38108
38109 @item l
38110 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38111 There is no more data to be read.
38112
38113 @item E00
38114 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38115
38116 @item E @var{nn}
38117 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38118 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38119
38120 @item @w{}
38121 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38122 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38123 @end table
38124
38125 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38126 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38127 formats, listed above.
38128
38129 @table @samp
38130 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38131 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38132 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38133 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38134
38135 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38136 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38137
38138 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38139 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38140
38141 Return a description of the current branch trace.
38142 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38143 packet may have one of the following values:
38144
38145 @table @code
38146 @item all
38147 Returns all available branch trace.
38148
38149 @item new
38150 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38151 the last read request.
38152
38153 @item delta
38154 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38155 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38156 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38157 used to stitch traces together.
38158
38159 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38160 @end table
38161
38162 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38163 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38164
38165 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38166 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38167
38168 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38169 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38170
38171 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38172 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38173
38174 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38175 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38176 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38177 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38178 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38179 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38180 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38181
38182 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38183 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38184
38185 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38186 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38187 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38188 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38189 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38190
38191 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38192 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38193
38194 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38195 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38196 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38197 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38198 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38199
38200 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38201 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38202 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38203
38204 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38205 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38206
38207 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38208 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38209 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38210 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38211 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38212 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38213 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38214 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38215
38216 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38217 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38218
38219 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38220 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38221
38222 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38223 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38224 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38225 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38226
38227 @table @code
38228 @item start=@var{address}
38229 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38230 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38231 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38232 chosen as the starting point.
38233
38234 @item prev=@var{address}
38235 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38236 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38237 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38238 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38239 exists prior to the starting point.
38240
38241 @end table
38242
38243 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38244 ignored.
38245
38246 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38247 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38248 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38249 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38250 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38251
38252 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38253 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38254
38255 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38256 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38257
38258 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38259 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38260 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38261 Action Lists}.
38262
38263 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38264 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38265 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38266
38267 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38268 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38269 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38270 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38271 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38272
38273 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38274 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38275 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38276
38277 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38278 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38279 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38280 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38281 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38282 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38283 in that context to be accessed.
38284
38285 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38286 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38287 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38288
38289 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38290 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38291 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38292 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38293 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38294
38295 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38296 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38297
38298 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38299 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38300
38301 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38302 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38303 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38304
38305 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38306 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38307
38308 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38309 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38310
38311 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38312 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38313
38314 This packet is not probed by default.
38315
38316 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38317 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38318 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38319 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38320 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38321
38322 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38323 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38324
38325 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38326 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38327 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38328 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38329
38330 @end table
38331
38332 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38333 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38334 @anchor{qXfer write}
38335 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38336 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38337 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38338 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38339 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38340 to access.
38341
38342 Reply:
38343 @table @samp
38344 @item @var{nn}
38345 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38346 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38347
38348 @item E00
38349 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38350
38351 @item E @var{nn}
38352 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38353 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38354
38355 @item @w{}
38356 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38357 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38358 @end table
38359
38360 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38361 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38362 formats, listed above.
38363
38364 @table @samp
38365 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38366 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38367 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38368 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38369 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38370
38371 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38372 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38373 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38374
38375 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38376 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38377 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38378 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38379 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38380 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38381 in that context to be accessed.
38382
38383 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38384 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38385 @end table
38386
38387 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38388 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38389 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38390 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38391 must respond with an empty packet.
38392
38393 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38394 @cindex query attached, remote request
38395 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38396 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38397 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38398 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38399 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38400 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38401 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38402
38403 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38404 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38405 the @code{quit} command.
38406
38407 Reply:
38408 @table @samp
38409 @item 1
38410 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38411 @item 0
38412 The remote server created a new process.
38413 @item E @var{NN}
38414 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38415 @end table
38416
38417 @item Qbtrace:bts
38418 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38419
38420 Reply:
38421 @table @samp
38422 @item OK
38423 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38424 @item E.errtext
38425 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38426 @end table
38427
38428 @item Qbtrace:pt
38429 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38430
38431 Reply:
38432 @table @samp
38433 @item OK
38434 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38435 @item E.errtext
38436 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38437 @end table
38438
38439 @item Qbtrace:off
38440 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38441
38442 Reply:
38443 @table @samp
38444 @item OK
38445 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38446 @item E.errtext
38447 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38448 @end table
38449
38450 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38451 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38452 btrace recording method in bts format.
38453
38454 Reply:
38455 @table @samp
38456 @item OK
38457 The ring buffer size has been set.
38458 @item E.errtext
38459 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38460 @end table
38461
38462 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38463 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38464 btrace recording method in pt format.
38465
38466 Reply:
38467 @table @samp
38468 @item OK
38469 The ring buffer size has been set.
38470 @item E.errtext
38471 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38472 @end table
38473
38474 @end table
38475
38476 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38477 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38478
38479 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38480 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38481 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38482
38483 @menu
38484 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38485 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38486 @end menu
38487
38488 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38489 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38490
38491 @menu
38492 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38493 @end menu
38494
38495 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38496 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38497 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38498
38499 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38500
38501 @table @r
38502
38503 @item 2
38504 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38505
38506 @item 3
38507 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38508
38509 @item 4
38510 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38511
38512 @end table
38513
38514 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38515 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38516
38517 @menu
38518 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38519 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38520 @end menu
38521
38522 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38523 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38524 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38525
38526 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38527 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38528 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38529 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38530 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38531 most-significant -- least-significant.
38532
38533 @table @r
38534
38535 @item MIPS32
38536 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38537 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38538 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38539
38540 @item MIPS64
38541 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38542 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38543 as @code{MIPS32}.
38544
38545 @end table
38546
38547 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38548 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38549 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38550
38551 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38552
38553 @table @r
38554
38555 @item 2
38556 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38557
38558 @item 3
38559 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38560
38561 @item 4
38562 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38563
38564 @item 5
38565 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38566
38567 @end table
38568
38569 @node Tracepoint Packets
38570 @section Tracepoint Packets
38571 @cindex tracepoint packets
38572 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38573
38574 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38575 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38576
38577 @table @samp
38578
38579 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38580 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38581 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38582 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38583 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38584 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38585 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38586 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38587 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38588 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38589 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38590 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38591 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38592 actions.
38593
38594 Replies:
38595 @table @samp
38596 @item OK
38597 The packet was understood and carried out.
38598 @item qRelocInsn
38599 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38600 @item @w{}
38601 The packet was not recognized.
38602 @end table
38603
38604 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38605 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38606 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38607 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38608 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38609 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38610 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38611
38612 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38613 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38614 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38615 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38616 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38617 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38618 tracepoint actions.
38619
38620 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38621 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38622 following forms:
38623
38624 @table @samp
38625
38626 @item R @var{mask}
38627 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38628 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38629 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38630 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38631 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38632
38633 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38634 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38635 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38636 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38637 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38638 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38639 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38640
38641 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38642 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38643 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38644 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38645 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38646 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38647 packet).
38648
38649 @end table
38650
38651 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38652 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38653 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38654 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38655 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38656 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38657 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38658 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38659
38660 Replies:
38661 @table @samp
38662 @item OK
38663 The packet was understood and carried out.
38664 @item qRelocInsn
38665 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38666 @item @w{}
38667 The packet was not recognized.
38668 @end table
38669
38670 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38671 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38672 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38673 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38674 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38675 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38676 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38677 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38678
38679 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38680 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38681 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38682 fit in a single packet.
38683 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38684 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38685
38686 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38687 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38688 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38689 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38690
38691 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38692 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38693 query packets.
38694
38695 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38696 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38697 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38698 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38699 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38700 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38701 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38702 be found.
38703
38704 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38705 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38706 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38707 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38708 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38709 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38710 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38711 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38712 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38713 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38714 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38715 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38716 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38717 variable.
38718
38719 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38720 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38721 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38722 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38723 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38724
38725 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38726 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38727 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38728 one of the following forms:
38729
38730 @table @samp
38731 @item F @var{f}
38732 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38733 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38734 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38735
38736 @item T @var{t}
38737 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38738 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38739
38740 @end table
38741
38742 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38743 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38744 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38745 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38746
38747 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38748 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38749 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38750 is a hexadecimal number.
38751
38752 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38753 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38754 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38755 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38756 numbers.
38757
38758 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38759 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38760 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38761
38762 @item qTMinFTPILen
38763 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38764 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38765 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38766 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38767 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38768 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38769 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38770 arrange for that.
38771
38772 Replies:
38773
38774 @table @samp
38775 @item 0
38776 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38777 @item @var{length}
38778 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38779 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38780 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38781 regardless of size.
38782 @item E
38783 An error has occurred.
38784 @item @w{}
38785 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38786 @end table
38787
38788 @item QTStart
38789 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38790 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38791 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38792 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38793 instruction reply packet}).
38794
38795 @item QTStop
38796 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38797 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38798
38799 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38800 @anchor{QTEnable}
38801 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38802 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38803 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38804 of data from it will resume.
38805
38806 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38807 @anchor{QTDisable}
38808 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38809 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38810 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38811 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38812
38813 @item QTinit
38814 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38815 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38816
38817 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38818 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38819 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38820 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38821 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38822
38823 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38824 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38825 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38826 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38827
38828 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38829 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38830 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38831 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38832 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38833 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38834
38835 @item qTStatus
38836 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38837 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38838
38839 The reply has the form:
38840
38841 @table @samp
38842
38843 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38844 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38845 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38846 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38847
38848 @end table
38849
38850 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38851 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38852
38853 @table @samp
38854
38855 @item tnotrun:0
38856 No trace has been run yet.
38857
38858 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38859 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38860 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38861 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38862 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38863
38864 @item tfull:0
38865 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38866
38867 @item tdisconnected:0
38868 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38869
38870 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38871 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38872
38873 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38874 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38875 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38876 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38877 is hex encoded.
38878
38879 @item tunknown:0
38880 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38881
38882 @end table
38883
38884 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38885 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38886 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38887 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38888 trace.
38889
38890 @table @samp
38891
38892 @item tframes:@var{n}
38893 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38894
38895 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38896 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38897 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38898
38899 @item tsize:@var{n}
38900 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38901
38902 @item tfree:@var{n}
38903 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38904
38905 @item circular:@var{n}
38906 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38907 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38908 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38909 and may fill up.
38910
38911 @item disconn:@var{n}
38912 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38913 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38914 that the trace run will stop.
38915
38916 @end table
38917
38918 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38919 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38920 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38921 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38922 address @var{addr}.
38923
38924 Replies:
38925 @table @samp
38926 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38927 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38928 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38929 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38930 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38931
38932 @end table
38933
38934 @item qTV:@var{var}
38935 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38936 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38937 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38938
38939 Replies:
38940 @table @samp
38941 @item V@var{value}
38942 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38943 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38944 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38945 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38946 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38947 program is running.
38948
38949 @item U
38950 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38951 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38952 was not collected.
38953 @end table
38954
38955 @item qTfP
38956 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38957 @itemx qTsP
38958 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38959 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38960 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38961 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38962 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38963 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38964
38965 @item qTfV
38966 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38967 @itemx qTsV
38968 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38969 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38970 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38971 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38972 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38973 trace state variables.
38974
38975 @item qTfSTM
38976 @itemx qTsSTM
38977 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38978 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38979 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38980 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38981 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38982 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38983 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38984 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38985
38986 Reply:
38987 @table @samp
38988 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38989 A single marker
38990 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38991 a comma-separated list of markers
38992 @item l
38993 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38994 @item E @var{nn}
38995 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38996 @item @w{}
38997 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38998 stub.
38999 @end table
39000
39001 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39002 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39003
39004 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39005 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39006 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39007 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39008 @dfn{last}).
39009
39010 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39011 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39012 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39013 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39014 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39015 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39016 tracepoint markers.
39017
39018 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39019 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39020 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39021 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39022 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39023 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39024
39025 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39026 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39027 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39028 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39029 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39030 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39031 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39032 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39033 available.
39034
39035 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39036 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39037 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39038
39039 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39040 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39041 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39042 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39043 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39044 use whatever size it prefers.
39045
39046 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39047 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39048 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39049 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39050 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39051
39052 @end table
39053
39054 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39055 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39056 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39057 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39058 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39059 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39060 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39061 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39062 it had executed in the original location.
39063
39064 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39065 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39066 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39067 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39068 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39069 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39070 format of the request is:
39071
39072 @table @samp
39073 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39074
39075 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39076 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39077 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39078 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39079 memory starting at @var{to}.
39080 @end table
39081
39082 Replies:
39083 @table @samp
39084 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39085 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39086 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39087 @item E @var{NN}
39088 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39089 relocating the instruction.
39090 @end table
39091
39092 @node Host I/O Packets
39093 @section Host I/O Packets
39094 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39095 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39096
39097 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39098 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39099 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39100 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39101 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39102 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39103 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39104 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39105 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39106 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39107
39108 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39109 its arguments. They have this format:
39110
39111 @table @samp
39112
39113 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39114 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39115 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39116 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39117 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39118 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39119 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39120 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39121 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39122
39123 @end table
39124
39125 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39126
39127 @table @samp
39128
39129 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39130 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39131 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39132 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39133 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39134 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39135 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39136 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39137 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39138 @var{attachment}.
39139
39140 @item @w{}
39141 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39142
39143 @end table
39144
39145 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39146
39147 @table @samp
39148 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39149 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39150 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39151 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39152 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39153 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39154 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39155
39156 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39157 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39158 -1 if an error occurs.
39159
39160 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39161 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39162 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39163 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39164 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39165 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39166 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39167 @var{count} was zero.
39168
39169 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39170 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39171 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39172 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39173 some characters were escaped.
39174
39175 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39176 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39177 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39178 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39179 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39180 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39181 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39182 error occurred.
39183
39184 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39185 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39186 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39187 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39188 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39189 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39190
39191 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39192 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39193 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39194
39195 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39196 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39197 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39198
39199 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39200 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39201 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39202 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39203 some characters were escaped.
39204
39205 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39206 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39207 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39208 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39209 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39210 inferior(s).
39211
39212 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39213 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39214 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39215 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39216 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39217 operation.
39218
39219 @end table
39220
39221 @node Interrupts
39222 @section Interrupts
39223 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39224 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39225
39226 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39227 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39228 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39229 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39230
39231 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39232 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39233 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39234 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39235 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39236
39237 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39238 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39239 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39240 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39241 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39242 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39243 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39244 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39245
39246 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39247 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39248 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39249
39250 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39251 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39252 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39253 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39254 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39255 @code{0x03}.
39256
39257 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39258 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39259 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39260 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39261 currently-executing threads and processes.
39262 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39263 running program, it should send one of the stop
39264 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39265 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39266 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39267 Interrupts received while the
39268 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39269 it is resumed next time.
39270
39271 @node Notification Packets
39272 @section Notification Packets
39273 @cindex notification packets
39274 @cindex packets, notification
39275
39276 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39277 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39278 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39279 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39280 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39281 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39282 is not a problem.
39283
39284 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39285 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39286 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39287 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39288 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39289 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39290 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39291
39292 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39293 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39294
39295 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39296 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39297 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39298 not they understand it.
39299
39300 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39301 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39302 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39303 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39304 recipients.
39305
39306 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39307 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39308 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39309 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39310 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39311
39312 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39313 @table @samp
39314 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39315 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39316 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39317 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39318 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39319 @item @var{ack}
39320 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39321 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39322 @end table
39323
39324 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39325 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39326
39327 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39328 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39329 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39330 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39331 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39332 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39333 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39334 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39335 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39336 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39337
39338 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39339 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39340 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39341 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39342 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39343 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39344
39345 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39346 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39347 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39348 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39349 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39350
39351 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39352 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39353 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39354 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39355 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39356 normally.
39357
39358 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39359 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39360 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39361 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39362 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39363 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39364 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39365 the process shall be repeated.
39366
39367 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39368 following example:
39369 @smallexample
39370 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39371 @code{...}
39372 -> @code{vStopped}
39373 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39374 -> @code{vStopped}
39375 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39376 -> @code{vStopped}
39377 <- @code{OK}
39378 @end smallexample
39379
39380 The following notifications are defined:
39381 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39382
39383 @item Notification
39384 @tab Ack
39385 @tab Event
39386 @tab Description
39387
39388 @item Stop
39389 @tab vStopped
39390 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39391 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39392 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39393 @value{GDBN}.
39394 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39395
39396 @end multitable
39397
39398 @node Remote Non-Stop
39399 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39400
39401 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39402 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39403 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39404 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39405
39406 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39407 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39408 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39409 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39410 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39411 probe the target state after a mode change.
39412
39413 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39414 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39415 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39416 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39417 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39418 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39419 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39420 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39421 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39422 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39423 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39424
39425 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39426 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39427 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39428 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39429 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39430 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39431 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39432 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39433 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39434 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39435 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39436 @samp{OK}.
39437
39438 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39439 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39440 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39441 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39442 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39443 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39444 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39445 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39446 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39447 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39448 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39449 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39450 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39451
39452 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39453 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39454
39455 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39456 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39457 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39458 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39459 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39460 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39461 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39462
39463 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39464 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39465 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39466 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39467 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39468
39469 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39470 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39471 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39472 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39473
39474 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39475 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39476 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39477 @pxref{qSupported}.
39478 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39479 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39480 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39481 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39482 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39483 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39484 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39485
39486 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39487 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39488 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39489 connection.
39490 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39491 new connection is established,
39492 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39493 for the current connection, once disabled.
39494
39495 @node Examples
39496 @section Examples
39497
39498 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39499 does not get any direct output:
39500
39501 @smallexample
39502 -> @code{R00}
39503 <- @code{+}
39504 @emph{target restarts}
39505 -> @code{?}
39506 <- @code{+}
39507 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39508 -> @code{+}
39509 @end smallexample
39510
39511 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39512
39513 @smallexample
39514 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39515 <- @code{+}
39516 -> @code{s}
39517 <- @code{+}
39518 @emph{time passes}
39519 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39520 -> @code{+}
39521 -> @code{g}
39522 <- @code{+}
39523 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39524 -> @code{+}
39525 @end smallexample
39526
39527 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39528 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39529 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39530
39531 @menu
39532 * File-I/O Overview::
39533 * Protocol Basics::
39534 * The F Request Packet::
39535 * The F Reply Packet::
39536 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39537 * Console I/O::
39538 * List of Supported Calls::
39539 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39540 * Constants::
39541 * File-I/O Examples::
39542 @end menu
39543
39544 @node File-I/O Overview
39545 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39546 @cindex file-i/o overview
39547
39548 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39549 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39550 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39551 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39552 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39553 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39554
39555 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39556 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39557 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39558 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39559 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39560
39561 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39562 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39563 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39564 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39565 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39566 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39567 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39568
39569 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39570 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39571 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39572 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39573 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39574
39575 @smallexample
39576 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39577 <- target requests 'system call X'
39578 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39579 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39580 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39581 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39582 @end smallexample
39583
39584 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39585 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39586 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39587 system are not supported by this protocol.
39588
39589 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39590
39591 @node Protocol Basics
39592 @subsection Protocol Basics
39593 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39594
39595 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39596 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39597 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39598 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39599 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39600 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39601 to call the appropriate host system call:
39602
39603 @itemize @bullet
39604 @item
39605 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39606
39607 @item
39608 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39609 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39610 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39611 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39612
39613 @end itemize
39614
39615 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39616
39617 @itemize @bullet
39618 @item
39619 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39620 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39621 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39622 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39623 packet.
39624
39625 @item
39626 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39627 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39628
39629 @item
39630 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39631
39632 @item
39633 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39634
39635 @item
39636 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39637 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39638 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39639 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39640 packet.
39641
39642 @end itemize
39643
39644 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39645 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39646
39647 @itemize @bullet
39648 @item
39649 Return value.
39650
39651 @item
39652 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39653
39654 @item
39655 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39656
39657 @end itemize
39658
39659 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39660 the latest continue or step action.
39661
39662 @node The F Request Packet
39663 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39664 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39665 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39666
39667 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39668
39669 @table @samp
39670 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39671
39672 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39673 This is just the name of the function.
39674
39675 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39676 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39677 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39678 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39679 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39680 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39681 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39682
39683 @end table
39684
39685
39686
39687 @node The F Reply Packet
39688 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39689 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39690 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39691
39692 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39693
39694 @table @samp
39695
39696 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39697
39698 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39699
39700 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39701 representation.
39702 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39703
39704 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39705 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39706 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39707
39708 @smallexample
39709 F0,0,C
39710 @end smallexample
39711
39712 @noindent
39713 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39714
39715 @smallexample
39716 F-1,4,C
39717 @end smallexample
39718
39719 @noindent
39720 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39721
39722 @end table
39723
39724
39725 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39726 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39727 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39728
39729 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39730 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39731 the target should behave as if it had
39732 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39733 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39734 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39735 packet.
39736
39737 It's important for the target to know in which
39738 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39739
39740 @itemize @bullet
39741 @item
39742 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39743
39744 @item
39745 The system call on the host has been finished.
39746
39747 @end itemize
39748
39749 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39750 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39751 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39752 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39753 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39754 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39755
39756 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39757 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39758 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39759 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39760 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39761 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39762 or the full action has been completed.
39763
39764 @node Console I/O
39765 @subsection Console I/O
39766 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39767
39768 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39769 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39770 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39771 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39772 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39773 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39774 conditions is met:
39775
39776 @itemize @bullet
39777 @item
39778 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39779 @code{read}
39780 system call is treated as finished.
39781
39782 @item
39783 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39784 newline.
39785
39786 @item
39787 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39788 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39789
39790 @end itemize
39791
39792 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39793 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39794 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39795 is stopped at the user's request.
39796
39797
39798 @node List of Supported Calls
39799 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39800 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39801
39802 @menu
39803 * open::
39804 * close::
39805 * read::
39806 * write::
39807 * lseek::
39808 * rename::
39809 * unlink::
39810 * stat/fstat::
39811 * gettimeofday::
39812 * isatty::
39813 * system::
39814 @end menu
39815
39816 @node open
39817 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39818 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39819
39820 @table @asis
39821 @item Synopsis:
39822 @smallexample
39823 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39824 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39825 @end smallexample
39826
39827 @item Request:
39828 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39829
39830 @noindent
39831 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39832
39833 @table @code
39834 @item O_CREAT
39835 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39836 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39837 are concerned.
39838
39839 @item O_EXCL
39840 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39841 an error and open() fails.
39842
39843 @item O_TRUNC
39844 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39845 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39846 truncated to zero length.
39847
39848 @item O_APPEND
39849 The file is opened in append mode.
39850
39851 @item O_RDONLY
39852 The file is opened for reading only.
39853
39854 @item O_WRONLY
39855 The file is opened for writing only.
39856
39857 @item O_RDWR
39858 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39859 @end table
39860
39861 @noindent
39862 Other bits are silently ignored.
39863
39864
39865 @noindent
39866 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39867
39868 @table @code
39869 @item S_IRUSR
39870 User has read permission.
39871
39872 @item S_IWUSR
39873 User has write permission.
39874
39875 @item S_IRGRP
39876 Group has read permission.
39877
39878 @item S_IWGRP
39879 Group has write permission.
39880
39881 @item S_IROTH
39882 Others have read permission.
39883
39884 @item S_IWOTH
39885 Others have write permission.
39886 @end table
39887
39888 @noindent
39889 Other bits are silently ignored.
39890
39891
39892 @item Return value:
39893 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39894 occurred.
39895
39896 @item Errors:
39897
39898 @table @code
39899 @item EEXIST
39900 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39901
39902 @item EISDIR
39903 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39904
39905 @item EACCES
39906 The requested access is not allowed.
39907
39908 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39909 @var{pathname} was too long.
39910
39911 @item ENOENT
39912 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39913
39914 @item ENODEV
39915 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39916
39917 @item EROFS
39918 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39919 write access was requested.
39920
39921 @item EFAULT
39922 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39923
39924 @item ENOSPC
39925 No space on device to create the file.
39926
39927 @item EMFILE
39928 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39929
39930 @item ENFILE
39931 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39932 has been reached.
39933
39934 @item EINTR
39935 The call was interrupted by the user.
39936 @end table
39937
39938 @end table
39939
39940 @node close
39941 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39942 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39943
39944 @table @asis
39945 @item Synopsis:
39946 @smallexample
39947 int close(int fd);
39948 @end smallexample
39949
39950 @item Request:
39951 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39952
39953 @item Return value:
39954 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39955
39956 @item Errors:
39957
39958 @table @code
39959 @item EBADF
39960 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39961
39962 @item EINTR
39963 The call was interrupted by the user.
39964 @end table
39965
39966 @end table
39967
39968 @node read
39969 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39970 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39971
39972 @table @asis
39973 @item Synopsis:
39974 @smallexample
39975 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39976 @end smallexample
39977
39978 @item Request:
39979 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39980
39981 @item Return value:
39982 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39983 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39984 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39985
39986 @item Errors:
39987
39988 @table @code
39989 @item EBADF
39990 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39991 reading.
39992
39993 @item EFAULT
39994 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39995
39996 @item EINTR
39997 The call was interrupted by the user.
39998 @end table
39999
40000 @end table
40001
40002 @node write
40003 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40004 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40005
40006 @table @asis
40007 @item Synopsis:
40008 @smallexample
40009 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40010 @end smallexample
40011
40012 @item Request:
40013 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40014
40015 @item Return value:
40016 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40017 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40018 is returned.
40019
40020 @item Errors:
40021
40022 @table @code
40023 @item EBADF
40024 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40025 writing.
40026
40027 @item EFAULT
40028 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40029
40030 @item EFBIG
40031 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40032 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40033
40034 @item ENOSPC
40035 No space on device to write the data.
40036
40037 @item EINTR
40038 The call was interrupted by the user.
40039 @end table
40040
40041 @end table
40042
40043 @node lseek
40044 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40045 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40046
40047 @table @asis
40048 @item Synopsis:
40049 @smallexample
40050 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40051 @end smallexample
40052
40053 @item Request:
40054 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40055
40056 @var{flag} is one of:
40057
40058 @table @code
40059 @item SEEK_SET
40060 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40061
40062 @item SEEK_CUR
40063 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40064 bytes.
40065
40066 @item SEEK_END
40067 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40068 bytes.
40069 @end table
40070
40071 @item Return value:
40072 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40073 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40074 value of -1 is returned.
40075
40076 @item Errors:
40077
40078 @table @code
40079 @item EBADF
40080 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40081
40082 @item ESPIPE
40083 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40084
40085 @item EINVAL
40086 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40087
40088 @item EINTR
40089 The call was interrupted by the user.
40090 @end table
40091
40092 @end table
40093
40094 @node rename
40095 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40096 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40097
40098 @table @asis
40099 @item Synopsis:
40100 @smallexample
40101 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40102 @end smallexample
40103
40104 @item Request:
40105 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40106
40107 @item Return value:
40108 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40109
40110 @item Errors:
40111
40112 @table @code
40113 @item EISDIR
40114 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40115 directory.
40116
40117 @item EEXIST
40118 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40119
40120 @item EBUSY
40121 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40122 process.
40123
40124 @item EINVAL
40125 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40126 of itself.
40127
40128 @item ENOTDIR
40129 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40130 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40131 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40132
40133 @item EFAULT
40134 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40135
40136 @item EACCES
40137 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40138
40139 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40140
40141 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40142
40143 @item ENOENT
40144 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40145
40146 @item EROFS
40147 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40148
40149 @item ENOSPC
40150 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40151 directory entry.
40152
40153 @item EINTR
40154 The call was interrupted by the user.
40155 @end table
40156
40157 @end table
40158
40159 @node unlink
40160 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40161 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40162
40163 @table @asis
40164 @item Synopsis:
40165 @smallexample
40166 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40167 @end smallexample
40168
40169 @item Request:
40170 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40171
40172 @item Return value:
40173 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40174
40175 @item Errors:
40176
40177 @table @code
40178 @item EACCES
40179 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40180
40181 @item EPERM
40182 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40183
40184 @item EBUSY
40185 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40186 being used by another process.
40187
40188 @item EFAULT
40189 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40190
40191 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40192 @var{pathname} was too long.
40193
40194 @item ENOENT
40195 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40196
40197 @item ENOTDIR
40198 A component of the path is not a directory.
40199
40200 @item EROFS
40201 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40202
40203 @item EINTR
40204 The call was interrupted by the user.
40205 @end table
40206
40207 @end table
40208
40209 @node stat/fstat
40210 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40211 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40212 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40213
40214 @table @asis
40215 @item Synopsis:
40216 @smallexample
40217 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40218 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40219 @end smallexample
40220
40221 @item Request:
40222 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40223 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40224
40225 @item Return value:
40226 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40227
40228 @item Errors:
40229
40230 @table @code
40231 @item EBADF
40232 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40233
40234 @item ENOENT
40235 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40236 path is an empty string.
40237
40238 @item ENOTDIR
40239 A component of the path is not a directory.
40240
40241 @item EFAULT
40242 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40243
40244 @item EACCES
40245 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40246
40247 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40248 @var{pathname} was too long.
40249
40250 @item EINTR
40251 The call was interrupted by the user.
40252 @end table
40253
40254 @end table
40255
40256 @node gettimeofday
40257 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40258 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40259
40260 @table @asis
40261 @item Synopsis:
40262 @smallexample
40263 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40264 @end smallexample
40265
40266 @item Request:
40267 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40268
40269 @item Return value:
40270 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40271
40272 @item Errors:
40273
40274 @table @code
40275 @item EINVAL
40276 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40277
40278 @item EFAULT
40279 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40280 @end table
40281
40282 @end table
40283
40284 @node isatty
40285 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40286 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40287
40288 @table @asis
40289 @item Synopsis:
40290 @smallexample
40291 int isatty(int fd);
40292 @end smallexample
40293
40294 @item Request:
40295 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40296
40297 @item Return value:
40298 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40299
40300 @item Errors:
40301
40302 @table @code
40303 @item EINTR
40304 The call was interrupted by the user.
40305 @end table
40306
40307 @end table
40308
40309 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40310 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40311 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40312 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40313 needed.
40314
40315
40316 @node system
40317 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40318 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40319
40320 @table @asis
40321 @item Synopsis:
40322 @smallexample
40323 int system(const char *command);
40324 @end smallexample
40325
40326 @item Request:
40327 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40328
40329 @item Return value:
40330 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40331 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40332 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40333 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40334 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40335 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40336 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40337
40338 @item Errors:
40339
40340 @table @code
40341 @item EINTR
40342 The call was interrupted by the user.
40343 @end table
40344
40345 @end table
40346
40347 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40348 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40349 the host is simplified before it's returned
40350 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40351 is discarded, and the return value consists
40352 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40353
40354 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40355 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40356 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40357
40358 @table @code
40359 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40360 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40361 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40362 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40363
40364 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40365 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40366 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40367 protocol.
40368 @end table
40369
40370 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40371 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40372 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40373
40374 @menu
40375 * Integral Datatypes::
40376 * Pointer Values::
40377 * Memory Transfer::
40378 * struct stat::
40379 * struct timeval::
40380 @end menu
40381
40382 @node Integral Datatypes
40383 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40384 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40385
40386 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40387 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40388 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40389
40390 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40391 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40392
40393 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40394
40395 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40396 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40397
40398 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40399
40400 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40401 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40402 byte order.
40403
40404 @node Pointer Values
40405 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40406 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40407
40408 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40409 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40410 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40411 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40412
40413 @smallexample
40414 @code{1aaf/12}
40415 @end smallexample
40416
40417 @noindent
40418 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40419 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40420 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40421 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40422
40423 @smallexample
40424 @code{123456/d}
40425 @end smallexample
40426
40427 @node Memory Transfer
40428 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40429 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40430
40431 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40432 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40433 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40434 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40435 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40436 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40437 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40438
40439
40440 @node struct stat
40441 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40442 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40443
40444 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40445 is defined as follows:
40446
40447 @smallexample
40448 struct stat @{
40449 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40450 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40451 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40452 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40453 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40454 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40455 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40456 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40457 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40458 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40459 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40460 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40461 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40462 @};
40463 @end smallexample
40464
40465 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40466 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40467 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40468
40469 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40470 range of values.
40471
40472 @table @code
40473
40474 @item st_dev
40475 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40476
40477 @item st_ino
40478 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40479
40480 @item st_mode
40481 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40482 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40483
40484 @item st_uid
40485 @itemx st_gid
40486 @itemx st_rdev
40487 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40488
40489 @item st_atime
40490 @itemx st_mtime
40491 @itemx st_ctime
40492 These values have a host and file system dependent
40493 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40494 support exact timing values.
40495 @end table
40496
40497 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40498 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40499 continuing.
40500
40501 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40502 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40503 get truncated on the target.
40504
40505 @node struct timeval
40506 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40507 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40508
40509 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40510 is defined as follows:
40511
40512 @smallexample
40513 struct timeval @{
40514 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40515 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40516 @};
40517 @end smallexample
40518
40519 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40520 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40521 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40522
40523 @node Constants
40524 @subsection Constants
40525 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40526
40527 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40528 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40529 values before and after the call as needed.
40530
40531 @menu
40532 * Open Flags::
40533 * mode_t Values::
40534 * Errno Values::
40535 * Lseek Flags::
40536 * Limits::
40537 @end menu
40538
40539 @node Open Flags
40540 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40541 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40542
40543 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40544
40545 @smallexample
40546 O_RDONLY 0x0
40547 O_WRONLY 0x1
40548 O_RDWR 0x2
40549 O_APPEND 0x8
40550 O_CREAT 0x200
40551 O_TRUNC 0x400
40552 O_EXCL 0x800
40553 @end smallexample
40554
40555 @node mode_t Values
40556 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40557 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40558
40559 All values are given in octal representation.
40560
40561 @smallexample
40562 S_IFREG 0100000
40563 S_IFDIR 040000
40564 S_IRUSR 0400
40565 S_IWUSR 0200
40566 S_IXUSR 0100
40567 S_IRGRP 040
40568 S_IWGRP 020
40569 S_IXGRP 010
40570 S_IROTH 04
40571 S_IWOTH 02
40572 S_IXOTH 01
40573 @end smallexample
40574
40575 @node Errno Values
40576 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40577 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40578
40579 All values are given in decimal representation.
40580
40581 @smallexample
40582 EPERM 1
40583 ENOENT 2
40584 EINTR 4
40585 EBADF 9
40586 EACCES 13
40587 EFAULT 14
40588 EBUSY 16
40589 EEXIST 17
40590 ENODEV 19
40591 ENOTDIR 20
40592 EISDIR 21
40593 EINVAL 22
40594 ENFILE 23
40595 EMFILE 24
40596 EFBIG 27
40597 ENOSPC 28
40598 ESPIPE 29
40599 EROFS 30
40600 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40601 EUNKNOWN 9999
40602 @end smallexample
40603
40604 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40605 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40606
40607 @node Lseek Flags
40608 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40609 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40610
40611 @smallexample
40612 SEEK_SET 0
40613 SEEK_CUR 1
40614 SEEK_END 2
40615 @end smallexample
40616
40617 @node Limits
40618 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40619 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40620
40621 All values are given in decimal representation.
40622
40623 @smallexample
40624 INT_MIN -2147483648
40625 INT_MAX 2147483647
40626 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40627 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40628 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40629 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40630 @end smallexample
40631
40632 @node File-I/O Examples
40633 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40634 @cindex file-i/o examples
40635
40636 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40637 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40638
40639 @smallexample
40640 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40641 @emph{request memory read from target}
40642 -> @code{m1234,6}
40643 <- XXXXXX
40644 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40645 -> @code{F6}
40646 @end smallexample
40647
40648 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40649 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40650
40651 @smallexample
40652 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40653 @emph{request memory write to target}
40654 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40655 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40656 -> @code{F6}
40657 @end smallexample
40658
40659 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40660 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40661
40662 @smallexample
40663 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40664 -> @code{F-1,9}
40665 @end smallexample
40666
40667 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40668 host is called:
40669
40670 @smallexample
40671 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40672 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40673 <- @code{T02}
40674 @end smallexample
40675
40676 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40677 host is called:
40678
40679 @smallexample
40680 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40681 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40682 <- @code{T02}
40683 @end smallexample
40684
40685 @node Library List Format
40686 @section Library List Format
40687 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40688
40689 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40690 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40691 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40692 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40693 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40694 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40695 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40696 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40697 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40698 are loaded.
40699
40700 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40701 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40702 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40703 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40704
40705 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40706 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40707 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40708 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40709 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40710 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40711
40712 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40713 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40714
40715 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40716 offset, looks like this:
40717
40718 @smallexample
40719 <library-list>
40720 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40721 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40722 </library>
40723 </library-list>
40724 @end smallexample
40725
40726 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40727 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40728
40729 @smallexample
40730 <library-list>
40731 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40732 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40733 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40734 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40735 </library>
40736 </library-list>
40737 @end smallexample
40738
40739 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40740
40741 @smallexample
40742 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40743 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40744 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40745 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40746 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40747 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40748 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40749 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40750 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40751 @end smallexample
40752
40753 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40754 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40755 section for each library.
40756
40757 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40758 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40759 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40760
40761 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40762 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40763 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40764 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40765
40766 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40767 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40768 target, the following parameters are reported:
40769
40770 @itemize @minus
40771 @item
40772 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40773 @code{struct link_map}.
40774 @item
40775 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40776 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40777 @item
40778 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40779 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40780 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40781 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40782 @item
40783 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40784 @end itemize
40785
40786 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40787 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40788 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40789
40790 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40791 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40792
40793 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40794 looks like this:
40795
40796 @smallexample
40797 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40798 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40799 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40800 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40801 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40802 </library-list-svr>
40803 @end smallexample
40804
40805 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40806
40807 @smallexample
40808 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40809 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40810 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40811 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40812 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40813 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40814 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40815 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40816 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40817 @end smallexample
40818
40819 @node Memory Map Format
40820 @section Memory Map Format
40821 @cindex memory map format
40822
40823 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40824 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40825 memory map.
40826
40827 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40828 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40829 lists memory regions.
40830
40831 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40832 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40833
40834 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40835
40836 @smallexample
40837 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40838 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40839 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40840 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40841 <memory-map>
40842 region...
40843 </memory-map>
40844 @end smallexample
40845
40846 Each region can be either:
40847
40848 @itemize
40849
40850 @item
40851 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40852 bytes from there:
40853
40854 @smallexample
40855 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40856 @end smallexample
40857
40858
40859 @item
40860 A region of read-only memory:
40861
40862 @smallexample
40863 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40864 @end smallexample
40865
40866
40867 @item
40868 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40869 bytes in length:
40870
40871 @smallexample
40872 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40873 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40874 </memory>
40875 @end smallexample
40876
40877 @end itemize
40878
40879 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40880 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40881 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40882
40883 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40884
40885 @smallexample
40886 <!-- ................................................... -->
40887 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40888 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40889 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40890 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40891 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40892 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
40893 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40894 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
40895 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40896 and its type, or device. -->
40897 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
40898 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40899 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40900 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40901 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40902 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
40903 @end smallexample
40904
40905 @node Thread List Format
40906 @section Thread List Format
40907 @cindex thread list format
40908
40909 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40910 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40911 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40912 the following structure:
40913
40914 @smallexample
40915 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40916 <threads>
40917 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40918 ... description ...
40919 </thread>
40920 </threads>
40921 @end smallexample
40922
40923 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40924 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40925 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40926 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40927 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40928 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40929 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
40930 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
40931
40932
40933 @node Traceframe Info Format
40934 @section Traceframe Info Format
40935 @cindex traceframe info format
40936
40937 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40938 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40939 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40940 collected in a traceframe.
40941
40942 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40943 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40944
40945 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40946 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40947
40948 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40949
40950 @smallexample
40951 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40952 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40953 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40954 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40955 <traceframe-info>
40956 block...
40957 </traceframe-info>
40958 @end smallexample
40959
40960 Each traceframe block can be either:
40961
40962 @itemize
40963
40964 @item
40965 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40966 @var{length} bytes from there:
40967
40968 @smallexample
40969 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40970 @end smallexample
40971
40972 @item
40973 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40974 collected:
40975
40976 @smallexample
40977 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40978 @end smallexample
40979
40980 @end itemize
40981
40982 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40983
40984 @smallexample
40985 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40986 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40987
40988 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40989 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40990 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40991 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40992 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40993 @end smallexample
40994
40995 @node Branch Trace Format
40996 @section Branch Trace Format
40997 @cindex branch trace format
40998
40999 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41000 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41001 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41002 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41003
41004 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41005 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41006
41007 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41008 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41009
41010 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41011
41012 @smallexample
41013 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41014 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41015 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41016 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41017 <btrace>
41018 block...
41019 </btrace>
41020 @end smallexample
41021
41022 @itemize
41023
41024 @item
41025 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41026 and ending at @var{end}:
41027
41028 @smallexample
41029 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41030 @end smallexample
41031
41032 @end itemize
41033
41034 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41035
41036 @smallexample
41037 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41038 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41039
41040 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41041 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41042 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41043
41044 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41045
41046 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41047
41048 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41049 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41050 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41051 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41052 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41053
41054 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41055 @end smallexample
41056
41057 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41058 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41059 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41060
41061 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41062 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41063 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41064
41065 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41066 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41067
41068 @table @code
41069 @item bts
41070 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41071 @table @code
41072 @item size
41073 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41074 @end table
41075 @item pt
41076 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41077 PT}) format.
41078 @table @code
41079 @item size
41080 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41081 @end table
41082 @end table
41083
41084 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41085 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41086
41087 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41088
41089 @smallexample
41090 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41091 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41092
41093 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41094 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41095
41096 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41097 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41098 @end smallexample
41099
41100 @include agentexpr.texi
41101
41102 @node Target Descriptions
41103 @appendix Target Descriptions
41104 @cindex target descriptions
41105
41106 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41107 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41108 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41109 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41110 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41111 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41112 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41113
41114 @itemize @bullet
41115 @item
41116 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41117 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41118 @item
41119 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41120 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41121 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41122 @item
41123 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41124 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41125 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41126 @end itemize
41127
41128 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41129 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41130 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41131 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41132 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41133
41134 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41135 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41136
41137 @menu
41138 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41139 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41140 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41141 descriptions.
41142 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41143 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41144 @end menu
41145
41146 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41147 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41148
41149 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41150 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41151 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41152 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41153 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41154 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41155 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41156 Format}.
41157
41158 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41159 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41160 specify a file are:
41161
41162 @table @code
41163 @cindex set tdesc filename
41164 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41165 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41166
41167 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41168 @item unset tdesc filename
41169 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41170 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41171
41172 @cindex show tdesc filename
41173 @item show tdesc filename
41174 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41175 @end table
41176
41177
41178 @node Target Description Format
41179 @section Target Description Format
41180 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41181
41182 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41183 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41184 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41185 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41186 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41187 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41188 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41189
41190 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41191 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41192 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41193 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41194 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41195
41196 Here is a simple target description:
41197
41198 @smallexample
41199 <target version="1.0">
41200 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41201 </target>
41202 @end smallexample
41203
41204 @noindent
41205 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41206 the x86-64 architecture.
41207
41208 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41209 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41210 are explained further below.
41211
41212 @smallexample
41213 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41214 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41215 <target version="1.0">
41216 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41217 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41218 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41219 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41220 </target>
41221 @end smallexample
41222
41223 @noindent
41224 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41225 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41226 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41227 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41228 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41229 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41230 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41231 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41232 the version mismatch.
41233
41234 @subsection Inclusion
41235 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41236 @cindex XInclude
41237 @ifnotinfo
41238 @cindex <xi:include>
41239 @end ifnotinfo
41240
41241 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41242 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41243 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41244 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41245 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41246
41247 @smallexample
41248 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41249 @end smallexample
41250
41251 @noindent
41252 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41253 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41254 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41255 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41256 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41257 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41258 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41259 original description.
41260
41261 @subsection Architecture
41262 @cindex <architecture>
41263
41264 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41265
41266 @smallexample
41267 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41268 @end smallexample
41269
41270 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41271 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41272
41273 @subsection OS ABI
41274 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41275
41276 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41277 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41278
41279 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41280
41281 @smallexample
41282 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41283 @end smallexample
41284
41285 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41286 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41287
41288 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41289 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41290
41291 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41292 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41293
41294 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41295
41296 @smallexample
41297 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41298 @end smallexample
41299
41300 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41301 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41302
41303 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41304 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41305 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41306 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41307 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41308 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41309 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41310
41311 @smallexample
41312 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41313 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41314 @end smallexample
41315
41316 @subsection Features
41317 @cindex <feature>
41318
41319 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41320 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41321 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41322 has this form:
41323
41324 @smallexample
41325 <feature name="@var{name}">
41326 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41327 @var{reg}@dots{}
41328 </feature>
41329 @end smallexample
41330
41331 @noindent
41332 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41333 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41334 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41335 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41336
41337 @subsection Types
41338
41339 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41340 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41341 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41342 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41343 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41344 and enum types.
41345
41346 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41347 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41348 Types must be defined before they are used.
41349
41350 @cindex <vector>
41351 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41352 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41353 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41354 @var{count}:
41355
41356 @smallexample
41357 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41358 @end smallexample
41359
41360 @cindex <union>
41361 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41362 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41363 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41364 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41365
41366 @smallexample
41367 <union id="@var{id}">
41368 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41369 @dots{}
41370 </union>
41371 @end smallexample
41372
41373 @cindex <struct>
41374 @cindex <flags>
41375 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41376 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41377 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41378 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41379 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41380 specified.
41381
41382 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41383
41384 @smallexample
41385 <struct id="@var{id}">
41386 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41387 @dots{}
41388 </struct>
41389 @end smallexample
41390
41391 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41392 No implicit padding is added.
41393
41394 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41395
41396 @smallexample
41397 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41398 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41399 @dots{}
41400 </struct>
41401 @end smallexample
41402
41403 @smallexample
41404 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41405 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41406 @dots{}
41407 </flags>
41408 @end smallexample
41409
41410 The @var{name} value is required.
41411 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41412 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41413 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41414
41415 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41416 is optional.
41417 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41418 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41419
41420 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41421 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41422
41423 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41424
41425 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41426 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41427
41428 @itemize @bullet
41429 @item
41430 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41431 @item
41432 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41433 @end itemize
41434
41435 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41436 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41437
41438 @itemize @bullet
41439 @item
41440 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41441
41442 @smallexample
41443 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41444 $1 = 42
41445 @end smallexample
41446
41447 @end itemize
41448
41449 @subsection Registers
41450 @cindex <reg>
41451
41452 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41453
41454 @smallexample
41455 <reg name="@var{name}"
41456 bitsize="@var{size}"
41457 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41458 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41459 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41460 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41461 @end smallexample
41462
41463 @noindent
41464 The components are as follows:
41465
41466 @table @var
41467
41468 @item name
41469 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41470
41471 @item bitsize
41472 The register's size, in bits.
41473
41474 @item regnum
41475 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41476 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41477 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41478 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41479 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41480 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41481 in order of increasing register number.
41482
41483 @item save-restore
41484 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41485 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41486 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41487 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41488 ABI.
41489
41490 @item type
41491 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41492 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41493 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41494 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41495 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41496 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41497
41498 @item group
41499 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41500 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41501 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41502 in @code{info registers}.
41503
41504 @end table
41505
41506 @node Predefined Target Types
41507 @section Predefined Target Types
41508 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41509
41510 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41511 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41512 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41513 types. The currently supported types are:
41514
41515 @table @code
41516
41517 @item bool
41518 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41519
41520 @item int8
41521 @itemx int16
41522 @itemx int32
41523 @itemx int64
41524 @itemx int128
41525 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41526
41527 @item uint8
41528 @itemx uint16
41529 @itemx uint32
41530 @itemx uint64
41531 @itemx uint128
41532 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41533
41534 @item code_ptr
41535 @itemx data_ptr
41536 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41537 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41538 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41539 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41540 may be marked as data pointers.
41541
41542 @item ieee_single
41543 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41544
41545 @item ieee_double
41546 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41547
41548 @item arm_fpa_ext
41549 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41550
41551 @item i387_ext
41552 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41553
41554 @item i386_eflags
41555 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41556
41557 @item i386_mxcsr
41558 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41559
41560 @end table
41561
41562 @node Enum Target Types
41563 @section Enum Target Types
41564 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41565
41566 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41567 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41568
41569 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41570
41571 @smallexample
41572 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41573 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41574 @dots{}
41575 </enum>
41576 @end smallexample
41577
41578 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41579
41580 @smallexample
41581 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41582 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41583 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41584 </enum>
41585 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41586 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41587 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41588 </flags>
41589 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41590 @end smallexample
41591
41592 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41593 would be printed as:
41594
41595 @smallexample
41596 (gdb) info register flags
41597 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41598 @end smallexample
41599
41600 @node Standard Target Features
41601 @section Standard Target Features
41602 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41603
41604 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41605 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41606 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41607 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41608 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41609 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41610 can recognize them.
41611
41612 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41613 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41614 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41615 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41616 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41617 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41618 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41619 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41620
41621 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41622 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41623 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41624
41625 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41626 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41627 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41628 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41629
41630 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41631 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41632 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41633
41634 @menu
41635 * AArch64 Features::
41636 * ARC Features::
41637 * ARM Features::
41638 * i386 Features::
41639 * MicroBlaze Features::
41640 * MIPS Features::
41641 * M68K Features::
41642 * NDS32 Features::
41643 * Nios II Features::
41644 * PowerPC Features::
41645 * S/390 and System z Features::
41646 * Sparc Features::
41647 * TIC6x Features::
41648 @end menu
41649
41650
41651 @node AArch64 Features
41652 @subsection AArch64 Features
41653 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41654
41655 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41656 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41657 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41658
41659 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41660 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41661 and @samp{fpcr}.
41662
41663 @node ARC Features
41664 @subsection ARC Features
41665 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41666
41667 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41668 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41669 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41670 that one of the core registers features is present.
41671 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41672
41673 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41674 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41675 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41676 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41677 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41678 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41679 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41680
41681 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41682 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41683 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41684 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41685 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41686 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41687
41688 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41689 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41690 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41691 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41692 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41693 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41694 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41695 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41696 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41697 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41698
41699 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41700 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41701
41702 @node ARM Features
41703 @subsection ARM Features
41704 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41705
41706 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41707 ARM targets.
41708 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41709 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41710
41711 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41712 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41713 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41714 and @samp{xpsr}.
41715
41716 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41717 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41718
41719 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41720 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41721 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41722 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41723
41724 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41725 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41726 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41727 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41728 halves of the double-precision registers.
41729
41730 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41731 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41732 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41733 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41734 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41735 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41736
41737 @node i386 Features
41738 @subsection i386 Features
41739 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41740
41741 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41742 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41743
41744 @itemize @minus
41745 @item
41746 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41747 @item
41748 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41749 @item
41750 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41751 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41752 @item
41753 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41754 @item
41755 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41756 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41757 @end itemize
41758
41759 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41760
41761 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41762 describe registers:
41763
41764 @itemize @minus
41765 @item
41766 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41767 @item
41768 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41769 @item
41770 @samp{mxcsr}
41771 @end itemize
41772
41773 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41774 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41775 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41776
41777 @itemize @minus
41778 @item
41779 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41780 @item
41781 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41782 @end itemize
41783
41784 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41785 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41786
41787 @itemize @minus
41788 @item
41789 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41790 @item
41791 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41792 @end itemize
41793
41794 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41795 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41796
41797 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41798 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41799
41800 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41801 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41802 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41803
41804 @itemize @minus
41805 @item
41806 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41807 @end itemize
41808
41809 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41810
41811 @itemize @minus
41812 @item
41813 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41814 @end itemize
41815
41816 It should
41817 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41818
41819 @itemize @minus
41820 @item
41821 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41822 @item
41823 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41824 @end itemize
41825
41826 It should
41827 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41828
41829 @itemize @minus
41830 @item
41831 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41832 @end itemize
41833
41834 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41835 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41836 valid for i386 and amd64.
41837
41838 @node MicroBlaze Features
41839 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41840 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41841
41842 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41843 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41844 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41845 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41846 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41847
41848 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41849 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41850
41851 @node MIPS Features
41852 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41853 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41854
41855 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41856 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41857 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41858 on the target.
41859
41860 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41861 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41862 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41863
41864 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41865 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41866 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41867 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41868
41869 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41870 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41871 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41872 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41873
41874 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41875 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41876 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41877
41878 @node M68K Features
41879 @subsection M68K Features
41880 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41881
41882 @table @code
41883 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41884 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41885 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41886 One of those features must be always present.
41887 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41888 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41889 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41890 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41891
41892 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41893 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41894 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41895 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41896 @end table
41897
41898 @node NDS32 Features
41899 @subsection NDS32 Features
41900 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41901
41902 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41903 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41904 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41905 and @samp{pc}.
41906
41907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41908 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41909 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41910 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41911
41912 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41913 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41914 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41915 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41916 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41917 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41918 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41919
41920 @node Nios II Features
41921 @subsection Nios II Features
41922 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41923
41924 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41925 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41926 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41927 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41928 @samp{mpuacc}).
41929
41930 @node PowerPC Features
41931 @subsection PowerPC Features
41932 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41933
41934 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41935 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41936 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41937 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41938
41939 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41940 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41941
41942 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41943 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41944 and @samp{vrsave}.
41945
41946 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41947 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41948 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41949 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41950 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41951 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41952
41953 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41954 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41955 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41956 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41957 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41958 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41959 user.
41960
41961 @node S/390 and System z Features
41962 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41963 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41964 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41965
41966 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41967 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41968 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41969 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41970 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41971 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41972 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41973 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41974 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41975
41976 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41977 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41978 @samp{fpc}.
41979
41980 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41981 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41982
41983 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41984 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41985 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41986 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41987 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41988 32-bit wide.
41989
41990 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41991 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41992 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41993
41994 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41995 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41996 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41997 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41998 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41999 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42000 @samp{v31}.
42001
42002 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42003 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42004 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42005
42006 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42007 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42008 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42009
42010 @node Sparc Features
42011 @subsection Sparc Features
42012 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42013 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42014 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42015 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42016
42017 @itemize @minus
42018 @item
42019 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42020 @item
42021 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42022 @item
42023 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42024 @item
42025 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42026 @end itemize
42027
42028 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42029
42030 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42031 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42032
42033 @itemize @minus
42034 @item
42035 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42036 @item
42037 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42038 @end itemize
42039
42040 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42041 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42042
42043 @itemize @minus
42044 @item
42045 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42046 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42047 @item
42048 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42049 for sparc64
42050 @end itemize
42051
42052 @node TIC6x Features
42053 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42054 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42055 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42056 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42057 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42058 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42059
42060 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42061 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42062 through @samp{B31}.
42063
42064 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42065 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42066
42067 @node Operating System Information
42068 @appendix Operating System Information
42069 @cindex operating system information
42070
42071 @menu
42072 * Process list::
42073 @end menu
42074
42075 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42076 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42077 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42078 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42079 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42080 on a different aspect of target.
42081
42082 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42083 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42084 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42085 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42086
42087 @node Process list
42088 @appendixsection Process list
42089 @cindex operating system information, process list
42090
42091 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42092 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42093 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42094 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42095
42096 An example document is:
42097
42098 @smallexample
42099 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42100 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42101 <osdata type="processes">
42102 <item>
42103 <column name="pid">1</column>
42104 <column name="user">root</column>
42105 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42106 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42107 </item>
42108 </osdata>
42109 @end smallexample
42110
42111 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42112 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42113 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42114 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42115 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42116 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42117 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42118
42119 @node Trace File Format
42120 @appendix Trace File Format
42121 @cindex trace file format
42122
42123 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42124 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42125
42126 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42127 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42128 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42129 in the future.
42130
42131 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42132 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42133 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42134 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42135 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42136 of this section.
42137
42138 @table @code
42139 @item R @var{size}
42140 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42141 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42142 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42143 a single trace file.
42144
42145 @item status @var{status}
42146 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42147 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42148 file.
42149
42150 @item tp @var{payload}
42151 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42152 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42153 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42154 reply packets.
42155
42156 @item tsv @var{payload}
42157 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42158 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42159 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42160 reply packets.
42161
42162 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42163 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42164 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42165 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42166 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42167 file. Includes are not allowed.
42168
42169 @end table
42170
42171 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42172 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42173 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42174 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42175 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42176 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42177 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42178 endianness.
42179
42180 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42181
42182 @table @code
42183 @item R @var{bytes}
42184 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42185 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42186 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42187
42188 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42189 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42190 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42191 @var{length} bytes.
42192
42193 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42194 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42195 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42196
42197 @end table
42198
42199 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42200 of blocks.
42201
42202 @node Index Section Format
42203 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42204 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42205 @cindex index section format
42206
42207 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42208 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42209 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42210 description.
42211
42212 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42213 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42214 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42215 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42216 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42217 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42218
42219 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42220
42221 @enumerate
42222 @item
42223 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42224 unless otherwise noted:
42225
42226 @enumerate
42227 @item
42228 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42229 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42230 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42231 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42232 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42233 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42234 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42235
42236 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42237 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42238 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42239 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42240
42241 @item
42242 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42243
42244 @item
42245 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42246 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42247 to the next offset.
42248
42249 @item
42250 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42251
42252 @item
42253 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42254
42255 @item
42256 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42257 @end enumerate
42258
42259 @item
42260 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42261 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42262 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42263 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42264 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42265 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42266 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42267 CU indices.
42268
42269 @item
42270 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42271 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42272 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42273 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42274
42275 @item
42276 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42277 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42278
42279 @enumerate
42280 @item
42281 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42282
42283 @item
42284 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42285 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42286
42287 @item
42288 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42289 @end enumerate
42290
42291 @item
42292 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42293 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42294
42295 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42296 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42297 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42298 constant pool.
42299
42300 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42301 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42302 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42303
42304 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42305 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42306 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42307 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42308 index version:
42309
42310 @table @asis
42311 @item Version 4
42312 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42313
42314 @item Versions 5 to 7
42315 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42316 @end table
42317
42318 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42319
42320 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42321 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42322 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42323 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42324 collision.
42325
42326 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42327 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42328 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42329 the code.
42330
42331 @item
42332 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42333 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42334 strings.
42335
42336 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42337 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42338 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42339 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42340 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42341 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42342
42343 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42344 @end enumerate
42345
42346 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42347 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42348 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42349
42350 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42351 (bit 0 = LSB):
42352
42353 @table @asis
42354
42355 @item Bits 0-23
42356 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42357 @item Bits 24-27
42358 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42359 @item Bits 28-30
42360 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42361
42362 @table @asis
42363 @item 0
42364 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42365 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42366 with previous versions of the index.
42367 @item 1
42368 The symbol is a type.
42369 @item 2
42370 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42371 @item 3
42372 The symbol is a function.
42373 @item 4
42374 Any other kind of symbol.
42375 @item 5,6,7
42376 These values are reserved.
42377 @end table
42378
42379 @item Bit 31
42380 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42381
42382 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42383 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42384 @value{GDBN} sources.
42385
42386 @end table
42387
42388 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42389 global/static attributes in the index.
42390
42391 @smallexample
42392 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42393 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42394 switch (die->tag)
42395 @{
42396 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42397 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42398 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42399 kind = TYPE;
42400 is_static = 1;
42401 break;
42402 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42403 kind = VARIABLE;
42404 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42405 break;
42406 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42407 kind = FUNCTION;
42408 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42409 break;
42410 case DW_TAG_constant:
42411 kind = VARIABLE;
42412 is_static = ! is_external;
42413 break;
42414 case DW_TAG_variable:
42415 kind = VARIABLE;
42416 is_static = ! is_external;
42417 break;
42418 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42419 kind = TYPE;
42420 is_static = 0;
42421 break;
42422 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42423 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42424 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42425 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42426 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42427 kind = TYPE;
42428 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42429 break;
42430 default:
42431 assert (0);
42432 @}
42433 @end smallexample
42434
42435 @node Man Pages
42436 @appendix Manual pages
42437 @cindex Man pages
42438
42439 @menu
42440 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42441 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42442 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42443 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42444 @end menu
42445
42446 @node gdb man
42447 @heading gdb man
42448
42449 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42450
42451 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42452 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42453 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42454 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42455 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42456 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42457 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42458 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42459 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42460 @c man end
42461
42462 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42463 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42464 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42465 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42466
42467 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42468 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42469
42470 @itemize @bullet
42471 @item
42472 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42473
42474 @item
42475 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42476
42477 @item
42478 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42479
42480 @item
42481 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42482 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42483 @end itemize
42484
42485 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42486 Modula-2.
42487
42488 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42489 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42490 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42491 by using the command @code{help}.
42492
42493 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42494 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42495 executable program as the argument:
42496
42497 @smallexample
42498 gdb program
42499 @end smallexample
42500
42501 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42502
42503 @smallexample
42504 gdb program core
42505 @end smallexample
42506
42507 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42508 to debug a running process:
42509
42510 @smallexample
42511 gdb program 1234
42512 gdb -p 1234
42513 @end smallexample
42514
42515 @noindent
42516 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42517 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42518 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42519
42520 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42521
42522 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42523 @table @env
42524 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42525 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42526
42527 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42528 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42529
42530 @item bt
42531 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42532
42533 @item print @var{expr}
42534 Display the value of an expression.
42535
42536 @item c
42537 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42538
42539 @item next
42540 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42541 function calls in the line.
42542
42543 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42544 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42545
42546 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42547 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42548
42549 @item step
42550 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42551 function calls in the line.
42552
42553 @item help [@var{name}]
42554 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42555 about using @value{GDBN}.
42556
42557 @item quit
42558 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42559 @end table
42560
42561 @ifset man
42562 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42563 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42564 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42565 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42566 @end ifset
42567 @c man end
42568
42569 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42570 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42571 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42572 encountered with no
42573 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42574 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42575 Many options have
42576 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42577 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42578 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42579 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42580 more usual convention.)
42581
42582 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42583 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42584 option is used.
42585
42586 @table @env
42587 @item -help
42588 @itemx -h
42589 List all options, with brief explanations.
42590
42591 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42592 @itemx -s @var{file}
42593 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42594
42595 @item -write
42596 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42597
42598 @item -exec=@var{file}
42599 @itemx -e @var{file}
42600 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42601 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42602 dump.
42603
42604 @item -se=@var{file}
42605 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42606 file.
42607
42608 @item -core=@var{file}
42609 @itemx -c @var{file}
42610 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42611
42612 @item -command=@var{file}
42613 @itemx -x @var{file}
42614 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42615
42616 @item -ex @var{command}
42617 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42618
42619 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42620 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42621 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42622
42623 @item -nh
42624 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42625
42626 @item -nx
42627 @itemx -n
42628 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42629
42630 @item -quiet
42631 @itemx -q
42632 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42633 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42634
42635 @item -batch
42636 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42637 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42638 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42639 commands in the command files.
42640
42641 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42642 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42643 more useful, the message
42644
42645 @smallexample
42646 Program exited normally.
42647 @end smallexample
42648
42649 @noindent
42650 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42651 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42652
42653 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42654 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42655 instead of the current directory.
42656
42657 @item -fullname
42658 @itemx -f
42659 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42660 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42661 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42662 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42663 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42664 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42665 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42666 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42667
42668 @item -b @var{bps}
42669 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42670 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42671
42672 @item -tty=@var{device}
42673 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42674 @end table
42675 @c man end
42676
42677 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42678 @ifset man
42679 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42680 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42681 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42682
42683 @smallexample
42684 info gdb
42685 @end smallexample
42686
42687 @noindent
42688 should give you access to the complete manual.
42689
42690 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42691 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42692 @end ifset
42693 @c man end
42694
42695 @node gdbserver man
42696 @heading gdbserver man
42697
42698 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42699 @format
42700 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42701 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42702
42703 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42704
42705 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42706 @c man end
42707 @end format
42708
42709 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42710 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42711 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42712
42713 @ifclear man
42714 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42715 @end ifclear
42716 @ifset man
42717 Usage (server (target) side):
42718 @end ifset
42719
42720 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42721 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42722 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42723 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42724
42725 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42726 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42727 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42728
42729 @smallexample
42730 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42731 @end smallexample
42732
42733 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42734
42735 @smallexample
42736 @ifset man
42737 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42738 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42739 @end ifset
42740 @ifclear man
42741 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42742 @end ifclear
42743 @end smallexample
42744
42745 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42746 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42747 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42748
42749 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42750
42751 @smallexample
42752 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42753 @end smallexample
42754
42755 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42756 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42757 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42758 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42759 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42760 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42761 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42762 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42763 print an error message and exit.
42764
42765 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42766 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42767
42768 @smallexample
42769 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42770 @end smallexample
42771
42772 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42773 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42774
42775 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42776 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42777 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42778 the program you want to debug.
42779
42780 @smallexample
42781 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42782 @end smallexample
42783
42784 @ifclear man
42785 @subheading Usage (host side)
42786 @end ifclear
42787 @ifset man
42788 Usage (host side):
42789 @end ifset
42790
42791 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42792 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42793 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42794 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42795 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42796 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42797 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42798 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42799 descriptor. For example:
42800
42801 @smallexample
42802 @ifset man
42803 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42804 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42805 @end ifset
42806 @ifclear man
42807 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42808 @end ifclear
42809 @end smallexample
42810
42811 @noindent
42812 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42813
42814 @smallexample
42815 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42816 @end smallexample
42817
42818 @noindent
42819 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42820 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42821 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42822 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42823 `Connection refused'.
42824
42825 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42826 described in
42827 @ifset man
42828 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42829 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42830 @end ifset
42831 @ifclear man
42832 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42833 @end ifclear
42834 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42835
42836 @smallexample
42837 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42838 @end smallexample
42839
42840 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42841 case.
42842 @c man end
42843
42844 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42845 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42846
42847 @itemize @bullet
42848
42849 @item
42850 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42851
42852 @smallexample
42853 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42854 @end smallexample
42855
42856 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42857 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42858 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42859 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42860 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42861 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42862 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42863
42864 @item
42865 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42866 program:
42867
42868 @smallexample
42869 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42870 @end smallexample
42871
42872 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42873 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42874 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42875 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42876
42877 @item
42878 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42879
42880 @smallexample
42881 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42882 @end smallexample
42883
42884 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42885 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42886 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42887 debug several processes in the same session.
42888 @end itemize
42889
42890 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42891
42892 @table @env
42893
42894 @item --help
42895 List all options, with brief explanations.
42896
42897 @item --version
42898 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42899
42900 @item --attach
42901 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42902
42903 @smallexample
42904 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42905 @end smallexample
42906
42907 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42908 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42909
42910 @item --multi
42911 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42912 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42913 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42914 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42915
42916 @smallexample
42917 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42918 @end smallexample
42919
42920 @item --debug
42921 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42922 process.
42923 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42924 the developers.
42925
42926 @item --remote-debug
42927 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42928 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42929 the developers.
42930
42931 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42932 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42933 of debugging output.
42934 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42935
42936 @item --wrapper
42937 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42938 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42939 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42940 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42941
42942 @item --once
42943 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42944 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42945 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42946 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42947
42948 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42949
42950 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42951 @c QDisableRandomization.
42952
42953 @end table
42954 @c man end
42955
42956 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42957 @ifset man
42958 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42959 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42960 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42961
42962 @smallexample
42963 info gdb
42964 @end smallexample
42965
42966 should give you access to the complete manual.
42967
42968 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42969 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42970 @end ifset
42971 @c man end
42972
42973 @node gcore man
42974 @heading gcore
42975
42976 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42977
42978 @format
42979 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42980 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42981 @c man end
42982 @end format
42983
42984 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42985 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42986 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42987 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42988 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42989 running without any change.
42990 @c man end
42991
42992 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42993 @table @env
42994 @item -o @var{filename}
42995 The optional argument
42996 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42997 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42998 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42999 @end table
43000 @c man end
43001
43002 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43003 @ifset man
43004 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43005 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43006 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43007
43008 @smallexample
43009 info gdb
43010 @end smallexample
43011
43012 @noindent
43013 should give you access to the complete manual.
43014
43015 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43016 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43017 @end ifset
43018 @c man end
43019
43020 @node gdbinit man
43021 @heading gdbinit
43022
43023 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43024
43025 @format
43026 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43027 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43028 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43029 @end ifset
43030
43031 ~/.gdbinit
43032
43033 ./.gdbinit
43034 @c man end
43035 @end format
43036
43037 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43038 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43039 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43040 described in
43041 @ifset man
43042 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43043 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43044 @end ifset
43045 @ifclear man
43046 @ref{Sequences}.
43047 @end ifclear
43048
43049 Please read more in
43050 @ifset man
43051 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43052 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43053 @end ifset
43054 @ifclear man
43055 @ref{Startup}.
43056 @end ifclear
43057
43058 @table @env
43059 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43060 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43061 @end ifset
43062 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43063 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43064 @end ifclear
43065 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43066 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43067 See more in
43068 @ifset man
43069 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43070 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43071 @end ifset
43072 @ifclear man
43073 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43074 @end ifclear
43075
43076 @item ~/.gdbinit
43077 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43078 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43079
43080 @item ./.gdbinit
43081 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43082 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43083 See more in
43084 @ifset man
43085 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43086 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43087 @end ifset
43088 @ifclear man
43089 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43090 @end ifclear
43091 @end table
43092 @c man end
43093
43094 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43095 @ifset man
43096 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43097
43098 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43099 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43100 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43101
43102 @smallexample
43103 info gdb
43104 @end smallexample
43105
43106 should give you access to the complete manual.
43107
43108 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43109 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43110 @end ifset
43111 @c man end
43112
43113 @include gpl.texi
43114
43115 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43116 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43117 @include fdl.texi
43118
43119 @node Concept Index
43120 @unnumbered Concept Index
43121
43122 @printindex cp
43123
43124 @node Command and Variable Index
43125 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43126
43127 @printindex fn
43128
43129 @tex
43130 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43131 % meantime:
43132 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43133 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43134 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43135 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43136 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43137 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43138 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43139 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43140 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43141 \page\colophon
43142 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43143 @end tex
43144
43145 @bye
This page took 0.897815 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.